1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printable and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generates the outermost <book> element that wraps the entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45 . Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
48 .set previousversion "4.98"
49 .include ./local_params
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I " "
54 .set drivernamemax "64"
60 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
61 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
62 . provided in the xfpt library.
63 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
65 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name.
67 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
69 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
70 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be in Roman.
72 .flag &!! "</emphasis>†<emphasis>"
73 .flag &!? "</emphasis>‡<emphasis>"
75 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
76 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
77 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
79 . --- Also one for multiple option def headings be grouped in a single
80 . --- table (but without the split capability).
83 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
87 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
98 .orow "$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
108 .orow "$+1" "$+2" "$+3" "$+4"
113 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
114 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
115 . --- a small number of other 2-column tables override it.
117 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
118 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
122 . --- A macro for a plain variable, including the .vitem and .vindex
128 . --- A macro for a "tainted" marker, done as a one-element table
130 .itable none 0 0 1 10pt left
135 . --- A macro for a tainted variable, adding a taint-marker
141 . --- A macro for a cmdline option, including a .oindex
142 . --- 1st arg is the option name, undecorated (we do that here).
143 . --- 2nd arg, optional, text (decorated as needed) to be appended to the name
145 .vitem &%$1%&$=2+&~$2+
149 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
150 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
151 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
155 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
159 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
167 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
168 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
169 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
170 . --- ID that ties them together.
171 . --- The index entry points to the most-recent chapter head, section or subsection
172 . --- head, or list-item.
175 &<indexterm role="concept">&
176 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
178 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
184 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
185 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
187 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
193 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
197 &<indexterm role="option">&
198 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
200 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
205 . --- The index entry points to the most-recent chapter head, section or subsection
206 . --- head, or varlist item.
209 &<indexterm role="variable">&
210 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
212 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
218 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
222 . use this for a concept-index entry for a header line
224 .cindex "&'$1'& header line"
225 .cindex "header lines" $1
227 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
230 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
231 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for ASCII
233 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
237 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
238 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
242 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
243 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
244 <revhistory><revision>
246 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
247 </revision></revhistory>
250 </year><holder>The Exim Maintainers</holder></copyright>
255 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
256 . These implement index entries of the form "x, see y" and "x, see also y".
257 . However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
258 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
259 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
261 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
265 <indexterm role="$2">
266 <primary>$3</primary>
268 <secondary>$5</secondary>
270 <$1><emphasis>$4</emphasis></$1>
275 . NB: for the 4-arg variant the ordering is awkward
277 .seeother see "$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
280 .seeother seealso "$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
283 .see variable "<emphasis>$1</emphasis>, <emphasis>$2</emphasis>, etc." "numerical variables"
284 .see concept address rewriting rewriting
285 .see concept "Bounce Address Tag Validation" BATV
286 .see concept "Client SMTP Authorization" CSA
287 .see concept "CR character" "carriage return"
288 .see concept CRL "certificate revocation list"
289 .seealso concept de-tainting "tainted data"
290 .see concept delivery "bounce message" "failure report"
291 .see concept dialup "intermittently connected hosts"
292 .see concept exiscan "content scanning"
293 .see concept fallover fallback
294 .see concept filter "Sieve filter" Sieve
295 .see concept headers "header lines"
296 .see concept ident "RFC 1413"
297 .see concept "LF character" "linefeed"
298 .seealso concept maximum limit
299 .see concept monitor "Exim monitor"
300 .see concept "no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis>" "entry for xxx"
301 .see concept NUL "binary zero"
302 .see concept "passwd file" "/etc/passwd"
303 .see concept "process id" pid
304 .see concept RBL "DNS list"
305 .see concept redirection "address redirection"
306 .see concept "return path" "envelope sender"
307 .see concept scanning "content scanning"
309 .see concept string expansion expansion
310 .see concept "top bit" "8-bit characters"
311 .see concept variables "expansion, variables"
312 .see concept "zero, binary" "binary zero"
315 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
316 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
317 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
318 . chapter "Introduction"
319 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
321 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
322 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
323 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
324 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
326 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
327 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
328 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
329 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
330 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and UnixWare.
331 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
332 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
334 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
335 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
336 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
338 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
339 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
340 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
342 The use, supply, or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
343 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of Exim,
344 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
345 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
346 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
348 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
349 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
350 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
351 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
352 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
354 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
355 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
356 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
357 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
361 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
362 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
365 .cindex "documentation"
366 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
367 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
368 renditions of this document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
369 capable of showing a change indicator.
372 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
373 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
374 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
375 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
376 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
377 Furthermore, this manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
378 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
381 .cindex "books about Exim"
382 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
383 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
384 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
385 (&url(https://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
387 The book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
388 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
389 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
390 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
392 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
393 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
394 Debian-specific features in the file
395 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
396 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
399 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
400 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
402 As Exim develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
403 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
404 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
405 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
406 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
408 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
409 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
410 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
411 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
413 All changes to Exim (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
414 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
416 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
417 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
418 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
422 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
423 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
424 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
425 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
426 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
427 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
428 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
429 .row &_openssl.txt_& "installing a current OpenSSL release"
432 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
433 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
434 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
438 .section "FTP site and websites" "SECID2"
441 The primary site for Exim source distributions is the &%exim.org%& FTP site,
442 available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP. These services, and the &%exim.org%&
443 website, are hosted at the University of Cambridge.
447 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim website contains a number of
448 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
449 online information is the Exim wiki (&url(https://wiki.exim.org)),
450 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
451 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
452 The wiki site should always redirect to the correct place, which is currently
453 provided by GitHub, and is open to editing by anyone with a GitHub account.
456 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(https://bugs.exim.org). You can use
457 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
458 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
459 Please do not ask for configuration help in the bug-tracker.
462 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
463 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
464 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
467 .row &'exim-announce@lists.exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
468 .row &'exim-users@lists.exim.org'& "General discussion list"
469 .row &'exim-users-de@lists.exim.org'& "General discussion list in German language"
470 .row &'exim-dev@lists.exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
471 .row &'exim-cvs@lists.exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
474 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
475 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
476 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
477 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
478 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
481 &url(https://alioth-lists.debian.net/cgi-bin/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
483 Please ask Debian-specific questions on that list and not on the general Exim
486 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
487 .cindex "bug reports"
488 .cindex "reporting bugs"
489 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
490 via the Bugzilla (&url(https://bugs.exim.org)). However, if you are unsure
491 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
492 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
496 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
498 .cindex "HTTPS download site"
499 .cindex "distribution" "FTP site"
500 .cindex "distribution" "https site"
501 The master distribution site for the Exim distribution is
503 &url(https://downloads.exim.org/)
505 The service is available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP.
506 We encourage people to migrate to HTTPS.
508 The content served at &url(https://downloads.exim.org/) is identical to the
509 content served at &url(https://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim) and
510 &url(ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim).
512 If accessing via a hostname containing &'ftp'&, then the file references that
513 follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at these sites.
514 If accessing via the hostname &'downloads'& then the subdirectories described
515 here are top-level directories.
517 There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
518 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
520 Within the top exim directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
521 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
522 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
523 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
527 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
529 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The three
530 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
531 The &_.xz_& file is usually the smallest, while the &_.gz_& file is the
532 most portable to old systems.
534 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
535 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
536 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
537 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
538 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
539 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
540 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
541 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from the Exim Maintainer's
542 PGP keys, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
543 &_Exim-Maintainers-Keyring.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
544 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
546 At the time of the last update, releases were being made by Jeremy Harris and signed
547 with key &'0xBCE58C8CE41F32DF'&. Other recent keys used for signing are those
548 of Heiko Schlittermann, &'0x26101B62F69376CE'&,
549 and of Phil Pennock, &'0x4D1E900E14C1CC04'&.
551 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
553 &_exim-n.nn.tar.xz.asc_&
554 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
555 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
557 For each released version, the log of changes is made available in a
558 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
559 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
561 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
562 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
563 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
564 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
566 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
567 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
568 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
569 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
571 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
572 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& and &_.xz_& forms.
575 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
577 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
578 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
579 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
580 RFC 2822 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
581 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
582 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
583 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
585 .cindex "domainless addresses"
586 .cindex "address" "without domain"
587 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
588 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
589 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
590 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
593 .cindex "transport" "external"
594 .cindex "external transports"
595 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
596 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
597 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
598 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
599 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
600 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
602 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
603 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
604 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
607 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
608 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
609 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
610 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
611 a number of common scanners are provided.
615 .section "Runtime configuration" "SECID7"
616 Exim's runtime configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
617 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
618 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
619 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
620 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
623 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
624 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
625 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
626 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
627 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
628 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
629 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
630 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages in the queue) do so in Exim's own
631 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
632 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
633 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
634 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
636 Control of messages in the queue can be done via certain privileged command
637 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
638 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
639 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
643 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
644 .cindex "terminology definitions"
645 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
646 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
647 It is the last part of a message and is separated from the &'header'& (see
648 below) by a blank line.
650 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
651 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
652 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
653 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
654 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
655 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
656 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
657 rise to further bounce messages.
659 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
660 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
661 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
664 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
665 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
666 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
669 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
670 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
671 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
673 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
674 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
675 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
676 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
677 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
678 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
679 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
680 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
682 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
683 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
684 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
685 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
686 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
687 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
690 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
691 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
692 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from RFC 2822, is used to refer to the
693 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
694 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
696 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
697 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
698 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
699 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
700 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
701 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
703 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
704 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
707 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
708 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery
709 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
710 Exim's case, the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
711 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
713 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
714 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
715 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
716 is used by other MTAs and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
717 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
719 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
720 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
721 messages in its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
722 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
723 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
724 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
731 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
732 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
734 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
735 .cindex "incorporated code"
736 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
739 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
742 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
743 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE2 library, copyright
744 © University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE2 is not longer shipped with
745 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE2 shipped with your system,
746 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
747 &url(https://github.com/PhilipHazel/pcre2/releases).
749 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
750 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
751 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
752 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
753 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
754 following statements:
757 Copyright © 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
759 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
760 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
761 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
763 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
764 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
765 &url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
766 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
767 restrictions applied to it).
770 .cindex "SPA authentication"
771 .cindex "Samba project"
772 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
773 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
774 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
775 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
779 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
780 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
781 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
782 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
783 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
784 conditions expressed therein.
787 Copyright © 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
789 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
790 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
794 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
795 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
797 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
798 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
799 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
802 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
803 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
804 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
805 details, please contact
807 Office of Technology Transfer
808 Carnegie Mellon University
810 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
811 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
812 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
815 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
818 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
819 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(https://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
821 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
822 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
823 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
824 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
825 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
826 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
827 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
832 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
835 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
836 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
837 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
838 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
841 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
842 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
846 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
847 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
848 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
849 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
850 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
851 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
852 software without specific, written prior permission.
854 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
855 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
856 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
857 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
858 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
859 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
864 .cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
865 The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
866 The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
867 derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
868 license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
872 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
873 not covered by any specific license requirements. It is assumed that the
874 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
881 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
882 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
884 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
885 "Receiving and delivering mail"
888 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
889 .cindex "design philosophy"
890 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
891 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
892 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
893 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
894 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
895 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
898 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
899 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
900 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
901 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs from being abused as
902 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
903 unsolicited junk and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
904 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
907 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
908 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
909 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
910 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
911 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
912 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
913 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
914 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
915 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
918 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
919 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
921 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
922 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
923 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
924 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
926 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
927 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
928 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
929 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
930 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
932 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
933 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
934 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
936 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
937 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
938 runs at the start of every delivery process.
943 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
944 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
945 .cindex "Sieve filter"
946 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
947 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
948 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
949 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
950 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
951 of filtering are available:
954 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
957 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
958 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
961 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
965 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
966 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
967 .cindex "format" "of message id"
968 .cindex "id of message"
973 .cindex "exim_msgdate"
974 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is 23
975 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
976 example &`16VDhn-000000001bo-D342`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
977 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
978 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
979 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
980 id is used to construct filenames, and the names of files in those systems are
981 not always case-sensitive.
983 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
984 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
985 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
986 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
987 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
988 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
992 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
993 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
994 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
995 way of representing the date and time of day).
997 After the first hyphen, the next
999 characters are the id of the process that received the message.
1001 There are two different possibilities for the final four characters:
1003 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1004 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1005 time of reception, normally in units of
1008 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1009 systems), the units are
1012 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by
1013 500000 (250000) and added to
1014 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 2 us (4 us).
1018 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1019 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1020 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1021 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1022 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1024 The exim_msgdate utility (see section &<<SECTexim_msgdate>>&) can be
1025 used to display the date, and optionally the process id, of an Exim
1029 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1030 .cindex "receiving mail"
1031 .cindex "message" "reception"
1032 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1033 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1034 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1035 there are several possibilities:
1038 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1039 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1040 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1042 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1043 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1044 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1045 command. This is called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1046 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1047 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1049 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1050 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1051 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1052 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1053 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1055 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1056 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1057 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1058 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1062 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1063 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1064 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1065 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1066 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1067 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1068 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1069 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender addresses
1070 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1071 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1072 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1073 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1074 users to change sender addresses.
1076 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1077 checking by the non-SMTP ACL if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1078 (either over TCP/IP or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1079 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1080 individual recipients or the entire message can be rejected if local policy
1081 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1082 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1084 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1085 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1086 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1087 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1088 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1089 message is received.
1095 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1096 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1097 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1098 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1099 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1100 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1101 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1102 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1104 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1105 By default, all these message files are held in a single directory called
1106 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1107 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1108 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1109 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1110 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1111 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1112 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1113 affect file system performance.
1115 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1116 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1117 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1118 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1119 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1121 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1122 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1123 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1124 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1125 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1126 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1127 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1128 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1129 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1130 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1131 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1132 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1136 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1137 .cindex "message" "life of"
1138 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1139 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1140 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1141 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1142 cannot proceed &-- for example when a message can neither be delivered to its
1143 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1144 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1146 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1147 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1148 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1149 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1150 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1153 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1154 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1155 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1156 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1157 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to all frozen messages.
1159 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1160 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1161 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1162 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1163 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1164 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1165 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator and are normally
1166 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1167 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1168 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1171 .cindex "journal file"
1172 .cindex "file" "journal"
1173 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1174 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1175 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1176 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1177 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1178 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1179 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1180 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1182 Should the system or Exim crash after a successful delivery but before
1183 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1184 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1185 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1186 deliveries caused by crashes.
1190 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1191 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1192 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1193 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1194 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1195 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1196 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1197 specify which ones are included in the binary. Runtime options specify which
1198 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1200 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1201 Each driver that is specified in the runtime configuration is an &'instance'&
1202 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1203 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1204 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1205 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1206 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1207 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1208 the driver's features in general.
1210 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1211 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1212 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1213 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1216 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1217 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1218 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1219 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1220 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1221 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1223 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1224 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1225 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1226 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1227 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1228 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1230 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1231 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1232 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1235 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1236 addresses in domains that are not recognized specifically by the local host.
1237 Typically these are addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1238 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1239 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1240 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1241 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1242 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1243 configured to fail the address.
1245 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1246 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1247 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1248 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1249 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1250 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1252 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1253 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1254 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1255 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1256 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1257 the address is bounced.
1261 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1262 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1263 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1264 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1265 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1266 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1267 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1268 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1270 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1271 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1272 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1273 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1274 sends all messages to a message-scanning program unless they have been
1275 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1276 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1277 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1282 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1283 .cindex "router" "running details"
1284 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1285 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1286 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1287 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1288 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1289 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1293 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1294 transport or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1295 original address ceases
1296 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1297 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1298 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1299 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1300 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1303 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1304 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1305 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1306 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1307 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1309 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1310 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default, the address
1311 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1312 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1313 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1315 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1316 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1317 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1318 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1319 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1321 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1322 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1323 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1325 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1326 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1327 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1328 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1330 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1331 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1334 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1335 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1336 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1337 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1338 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1340 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1341 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1342 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1343 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1344 facility for this purpose.
1347 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1348 .cindex "case of local parts"
1349 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1350 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1351 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1352 and remote transports and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1353 check, local parts are treated case-sensitively. This happens only when
1354 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1355 routed addresses are shown.
1359 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1360 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1361 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1362 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1363 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1364 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1367 .cindex affix "router precondition"
1368 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1369 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1370 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1371 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1372 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1373 of any other conditions.
1375 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1376 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1377 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1379 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1380 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1381 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1382 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1383 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1385 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1386 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1387 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1388 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1389 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1391 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1392 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1393 Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1395 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1396 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1399 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1400 of domains that it defines.
1401 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
1402 .cindex "de-tainting" "using router domains option"
1403 A match verifies the variable &$domain$& (which carries tainted data)
1404 and assigns an untainted value to the &$domain_data$& variable.
1405 Such an untainted value is often needed in the transport.
1406 For specifics of the matching operation and the resulting untainted value,
1407 refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&.
1409 When an untainted value is wanted, use this option
1410 rather than the generic &%condition%& option.
1413 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1414 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix_v$&"
1415 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1416 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1417 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix_v$&"
1418 .cindex affix "router precondition"
1419 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1420 the set of local parts that it defines.
1421 A match verifies the variable &$local_part$& (which carries tainted data)
1422 and assigns an untainted value to the &$local_part_data$& variable.
1423 Such an untainted value is often needed in the transport.
1424 For specifics of the matching operation and the resulting untainted value,
1425 refer to section &<<SECTlocparlis>>&.
1427 When an untainted value is wanted, use this option
1428 rather than the generic &%condition%& option.
1430 If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1431 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1432 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1433 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1434 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&,
1435 &$local_part_prefix_v$&, &$local_part_suffix$&
1436 and &$local_part_suffix_v$& as necessary.
1439 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1440 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1442 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1443 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1444 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1445 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1446 remaining preconditions.
1449 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1450 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1451 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1452 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1453 could lead to confusion.
1456 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1457 set of addresses that it defines.
1460 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1461 specified files is tested.
1464 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1465 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1466 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1467 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1469 Note that while using
1470 this option for address matching technically works,
1471 it does not set any de-tainted values.
1472 Such values are often needed, either for router-specific options or
1473 for transport options.
1474 Using the &%domains%& and &%local_parts%& options is usually the most
1475 convenient way to obtain them.
1479 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1480 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1481 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1482 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1483 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1484 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1485 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1489 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1490 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1491 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1494 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1495 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1496 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1497 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1498 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1500 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1501 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1503 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1504 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1505 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1506 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1507 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1508 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1511 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router, in turn, subject to
1512 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1513 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1514 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1515 processed entirely independently of each other.
1517 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1518 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1519 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1520 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1521 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1522 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1523 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1524 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1525 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1527 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1528 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1529 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1530 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1531 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1532 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1533 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1534 addresses to the same domain.
1536 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1537 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1538 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1539 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1540 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1541 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1542 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1543 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1545 .cindex "queue runner"
1546 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1547 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1548 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1549 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1550 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1551 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1552 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1553 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1554 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1556 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1557 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1558 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1559 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1560 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1561 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1563 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1564 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1565 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1566 messages to other addresses.
1568 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1569 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1570 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1573 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1574 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1575 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1581 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1582 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1583 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1584 .cindex "queue runner"
1585 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1586 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1587 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1588 intervals or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1589 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1590 first attempt will remain in your queue forever. A queue runner process works
1591 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1592 passed its retry time.
1593 You can run several queue runners at once.
1595 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1596 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1597 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1598 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1599 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1604 .subsection "Temporary delivery failure" SECID20
1605 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1606 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1607 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1608 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1609 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1610 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1611 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1612 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1615 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1616 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1617 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1619 .cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1620 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1621 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1622 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1623 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1628 .subsection "Permanent delivery failure" SECID21
1629 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1630 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1631 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1632 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1633 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1634 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1635 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1636 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1637 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1638 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1640 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1641 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1642 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1645 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1646 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1647 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1648 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1649 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1650 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1651 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1656 .subsection "Failures to deliver bounce messages" SECID22
1657 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1658 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1659 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left in the queue,
1660 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1661 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1662 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1663 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1669 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1670 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1672 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1673 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1675 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1676 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1677 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1678 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1681 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1682 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1684 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1685 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1686 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1687 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1691 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1692 following subdirectories are created:
1695 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1696 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1697 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1698 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1699 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1700 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1701 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1704 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory and are built
1705 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1706 that may be useful to some sites.
1709 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1710 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1711 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1712 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1713 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1714 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1716 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1717 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1718 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1719 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1720 overridden if necessary.
1721 .cindex compiler requirements
1722 .cindex compiler version
1723 A C99-capable compiler will be required for the build.
1726 .section "PCRE2 library" "SECTpcre"
1727 .cindex "PCRE2 library"
1728 Exim no longer has an embedded regular-expression library as the vast majority of
1729 modern systems include PCRE2 as a system library, although you may need to
1730 install the PCRE2 package or the PCRE2 development package for your operating
1731 system. If your system has a normal PCRE2 installation the Exim build
1732 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1733 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE2_LIBS
1734 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1735 or set PCRE2_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1736 If your operating system has no
1737 PCRE2 support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE2
1738 from &url(https://github.com/PhilipHazel/pcre2/releases).
1739 More information on PCRE2 is available at &url(https://www.pcre.org/).
1741 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1742 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1743 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1744 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1745 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1746 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1747 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1749 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1750 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1751 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1752 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1753 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1754 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1755 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1756 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1758 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1759 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1760 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1761 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1762 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1763 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1764 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1765 Berkeley DB library.
1768 Ownership of the Berkeley DB library has moved to a major corporation;
1769 development seems to have stalled and documentation is not freely available.
1770 This is probably not tenable for the long term use by Exim.
1773 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1774 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1778 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1779 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1781 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1782 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1783 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1784 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1785 filename is used unmodified.
1787 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1788 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1789 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1790 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1792 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1793 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1794 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1796 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1797 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1798 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while,
1799 but the latest versions when Exim last revamped support were numbered 5.&'x'&.
1800 Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased,
1801 and Exim no longer supports versions before 3.&'x'&.
1802 All versions of Berkeley DB could be obtained from
1803 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/), which is now a redirect to their new owner's
1804 page with far newer versions listed.
1805 It is probably wise to plan to move your storage configurations away from
1806 Berkeley DB format, as today there are smaller and simpler alternatives more
1807 suited to Exim's usage model.
1809 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1810 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1811 &url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/tdb/files/). It has its own interface, and also
1812 operates on a single file.
1814 It is possible to use sqlite3 (&url(https://www.sqlite.org/index.html))
1815 for the DBM library.
1819 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1820 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1821 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1822 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1823 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1827 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, for tdb you set USE_TDB,
1828 and for sqlite3 you set USE_SQLITE.
1829 An error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1830 You can set USE_NDBM if needed to override an operating system default.
1832 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1833 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1834 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1835 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1836 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1837 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1839 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1840 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1841 in one of these lines:
1846 DBMLIB = -lgdbm -lgdbm_compat
1848 The last of those was for a Linux having GDBM provide emulated NDBM facilities.
1849 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1850 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1851 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1852 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1855 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1856 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1858 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1859 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1862 When moving from one DBM library to another,
1863 for the hints databases it suffices to just remove all the files in the
1864 directory named &"db/"& under the spool directory.
1865 This is because hints are only for optimisation and will be rebuilt
1866 during normal operations.
1867 Non-hints DBM databases (used by &"dbm"& lookups in the configuration)
1868 will need individual rebuilds for the new DBM library.
1869 This is not done automatically
1874 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1875 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1876 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1877 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1878 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1879 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1880 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1881 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1882 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1883 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1884 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1885 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1887 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1888 without them. They are the location of the runtime configuration file
1889 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1890 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1891 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1892 a colon-separated list of filenames; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1894 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1895 at runtime, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1896 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1897 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1898 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at runtime, so that errors
1899 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1902 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1903 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1904 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1905 facilities, you need to set
1907 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1909 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1910 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1913 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1914 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1915 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1916 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1917 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1918 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1919 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1921 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1922 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1923 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1924 configuration files, for example, to change the C compiler, which
1925 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1930 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1931 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1933 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1934 described RFC 2047. This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1935 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1936 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1937 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1938 (default is set at build time). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1939 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1941 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1942 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1943 &url(https://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1944 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1945 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1949 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1953 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1954 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1955 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1956 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1957 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1958 Exim is usually built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1959 command as per RFC 2487. It can also support clients that expect to
1960 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1961 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1964 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1965 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1968 If you do not want TLS support you should set
1972 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
1974 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1977 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1979 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1980 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1983 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1984 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1986 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1987 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1990 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1992 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1993 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
1996 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
1998 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
1999 library and include files. For example:
2002 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
2003 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
2005 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
2006 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
2009 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
2012 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
2013 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
2014 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
2019 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
2021 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
2022 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
2023 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
2024 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
2025 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
2026 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
2027 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
2028 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
2029 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
2030 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
2031 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
2032 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
2035 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
2036 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
2037 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
2039 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
2040 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
2042 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
2044 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
2045 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
2046 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
2047 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
2048 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
2049 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
2053 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
2054 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
2055 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
2056 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
2057 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
2058 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
2061 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
2062 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
2063 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
2064 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
2065 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
2067 have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
2072 .section "Dynamically loaded module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
2073 .cindex "lookup modules"
2074 .cindex "router modules"
2075 .cindex "dynamic modules"
2076 .cindex ".so building"
2077 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2078 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2080 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2081 library dependencies without requiring all systems to install all of those
2083 Most, but not all, lookup types can be built this way.
2086 Similarly, router drivers can be built as external modules.
2087 This permits a smaller exim binary, growing only as needed for the
2088 runtime cofiguration.
2091 Set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2092 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2093 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2094 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2095 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2096 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2098 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2099 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2100 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2101 only if each is installed:
2109 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2110 .cindex "build directory"
2111 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2112 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2113 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2114 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2115 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2116 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2117 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2119 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2120 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2121 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2122 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2123 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2124 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2125 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2126 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2128 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2129 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2130 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2134 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2135 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2136 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2137 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2138 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2139 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2140 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2144 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2145 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2146 given in addition to the short output.
2150 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2151 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2152 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2153 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2154 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2155 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2156 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2159 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2160 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2162 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2163 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2164 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2165 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2167 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2168 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2169 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2170 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2171 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2172 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2173 and are often not needed.
2175 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2176 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2177 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2178 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2179 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2180 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2181 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2182 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2183 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2186 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2187 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2188 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2189 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2193 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2194 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2195 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2196 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2197 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2198 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2199 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2200 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2201 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2202 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2203 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2204 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2205 containing the lines
2210 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2211 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2213 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2214 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2215 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2218 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2219 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2220 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2221 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2222 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2223 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2224 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2225 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2226 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2227 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2233 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2234 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2235 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2236 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2237 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2238 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2239 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2240 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause runtime configuration
2243 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2244 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2245 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2246 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2247 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2248 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2249 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2250 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2251 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2252 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2253 syntax. For instance:
2256 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2258 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2259 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2260 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2263 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2264 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2265 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2269 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2270 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2272 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2273 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2274 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2275 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2276 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2277 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2280 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2281 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2283 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2284 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2287 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2288 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2290 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2291 definition of all three of these variables into your
2292 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2295 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2296 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2297 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2298 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2300 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2301 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2302 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2303 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2304 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2307 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2308 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2309 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2310 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2311 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2314 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2316 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2317 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2318 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2319 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2320 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2321 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2325 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2326 .cindex "building Eximon"
2327 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2328 where the files that are involved are
2330 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2331 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2332 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2333 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2334 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2335 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2337 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2338 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2339 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2340 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2341 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2342 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2343 LOG_DEPTH at runtime.
2347 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2348 .cindex "installing Exim"
2349 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2350 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2351 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2352 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2353 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2354 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2355 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2356 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2357 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2358 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2359 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2360 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2362 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2363 Exim's runtime configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2364 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2365 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2366 by the installation script. If a runtime configuration file already exists, it
2367 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2368 alternative files, no default is installed.
2370 .cindex "system aliases file"
2371 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2372 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2373 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2374 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2375 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2376 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2377 and outputs a comment to the user.
2379 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2380 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2381 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2382 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2383 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2385 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2386 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2387 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2388 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2389 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2392 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2393 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2396 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2398 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2399 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2400 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2401 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2402 but this usage is deprecated.
2404 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2405 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2406 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2407 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2408 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2409 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2411 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2412 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2413 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2414 for example, &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2415 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2416 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2417 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2419 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2420 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2421 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2424 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2426 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2427 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2428 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2429 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2432 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2434 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2435 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2438 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2439 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2441 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2445 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2447 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2449 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2450 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2451 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2453 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2458 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2459 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2460 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2461 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2462 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the FTP site (see section
2465 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2466 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2467 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2471 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2472 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2473 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2474 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2475 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2481 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2482 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2483 Having installed Exim, you can check that the runtime configuration file is
2484 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2485 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2489 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2490 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2491 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2492 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2493 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2496 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2498 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2500 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2502 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2503 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2504 user agent. For example:
2506 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2507 From: user@your.domain.example
2508 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2509 Subject: Testing Exim
2511 This is a test message.
2514 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2515 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2516 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2518 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2519 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2520 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2521 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2522 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2523 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2525 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2527 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2528 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2529 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2530 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2531 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2533 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2534 .cindex "lock files"
2535 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2536 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2537 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2538 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2539 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2540 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2541 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2542 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2543 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2544 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2545 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2546 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2548 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2549 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2550 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2551 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2552 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2555 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2556 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2557 within the runtime configuration, all other file and directory names
2558 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2562 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2563 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2564 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2565 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2566 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2567 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2568 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2569 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2570 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2571 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2572 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2573 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2574 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2576 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2577 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2578 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2579 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2580 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2581 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2584 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2585 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2586 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2587 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2589 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2590 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2591 favourite user agent.
2593 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2594 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2595 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2596 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2597 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2598 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2602 .section "Running the daemon" SECTdaemonLaunch
2603 The most common command line for launching the Exim daemon looks like
2607 This starts a daemon which
2609 listens for incoming smtp connections, launching handler processes for
2612 starts a queue-runner process every five minutes, to inspect queued messages
2613 and run delivery attempts on any that have arrived at their retry time
2615 Should a queue run take longer than the time between queue-runner starts,
2616 they will run in parallel.
2617 Numbers of jobs of the various types are subject to policy controls
2618 defined in the configuration.
2621 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2622 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2623 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2624 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2625 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2626 .cindex restart "on HUP signal"
2627 .cindex signal "HUP, to restart"
2628 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2629 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2630 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2636 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2637 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2638 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2640 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2642 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2643 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2644 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2645 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2646 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2648 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2650 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2652 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2653 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2654 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2659 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2660 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2662 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2663 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2664 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2665 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2666 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2667 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2668 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2669 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2670 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2673 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2675 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2676 were present before any other options.
2677 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2679 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2680 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2681 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2684 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2685 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2686 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2690 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2691 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2692 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2695 .cindex "queue runner"
2696 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2697 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2698 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2700 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2701 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2702 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2703 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2704 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2705 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2706 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2707 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2710 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2711 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2712 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2713 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2714 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2715 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2718 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2719 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2720 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2721 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2722 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2723 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2725 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2726 .cindex "envelope from"
2727 .cindex "envelope sender"
2728 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2729 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2730 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2731 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2732 users to set envelope senders.
2736 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2737 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2738 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2740 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2741 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2742 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2743 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2744 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2745 that are available to trusted users.
2747 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2748 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2749 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2750 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2751 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2753 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2754 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2755 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2756 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2758 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2759 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2760 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2761 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2763 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2764 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2769 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2770 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2771 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2777 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2778 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2779 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2780 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2781 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2782 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2783 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2784 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2786 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2787 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2788 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2789 . creates a man page for the options.
2790 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2793 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2799 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2800 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2801 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2802 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2805 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2806 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2810 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2817 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2820 .cmdopt -B <&'type'&>
2822 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2823 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2824 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2825 clean; it ignores this option.
2829 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2830 .cindex "queue runner"
2831 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2832 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2833 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2835 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2836 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2837 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2838 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2840 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2841 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2842 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2843 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2845 When a listening daemon
2846 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2847 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2848 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2849 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2850 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2851 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2854 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2855 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2856 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2860 .cindex restart "on HUP signal"
2861 .cindex signal "HUP, to restart"
2862 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2863 .cindex signal "to reload configuration"
2864 .cindex daemon "reload configuration"
2865 .cindex reload configuration
2866 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2867 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2868 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2869 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2870 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2871 because these are reread each time they are used.
2873 Either a SIGTERM or a SIGINT signal should be used to cause the daemon
2874 to cleanly shut down.
2875 Subprocesses handling recceiving or delivering messages,
2876 or for scanning the queue,
2877 will not be affected by the termination of the daemon process.
2880 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2881 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2884 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2885 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2886 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2887 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2888 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2889 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2891 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2892 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2893 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2894 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2895 test data. A line history is supported.
2897 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2898 continuations. As in Exim's runtime configuration, white space at the start of
2899 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2900 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2901 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2902 message-specific values (such as &$message_exim_id$&) are set, because no message
2903 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2905 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2906 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2907 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2908 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2910 Macro processing is done on lines before string-expansion: new macros can be
2911 defined and macros will be expanded.
2912 Because macros in the config file are often used for secrets, those are only
2913 available to admin users.
2915 The word &"set"& at the start of a line, followed by a single space,
2916 is recognised specially as defining a value for a variable.
2917 .cindex "tainted data" "expansion testing"
2918 If the sequence &",t"& is inserted before the space,
2919 the value is marked as tainted.
2920 The syntax is otherwise the same as the ACL modifier &"set ="&.
2922 .cmdopt -bem <&'filename'&>
2923 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2924 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2925 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2926 of a file. For example:
2928 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2930 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2931 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2932 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2933 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2934 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2935 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2936 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2939 .cmdopt -bF <&'filename'&>
2940 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2941 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2942 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2943 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2944 system filters are recognized.
2946 .cmdopt -bf <&'filename'&>
2947 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2948 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2949 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2950 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2951 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2952 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2953 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2954 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2957 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2958 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2959 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2961 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2963 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2964 variables that are used by the user filter.
2966 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2971 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
2972 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
2973 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
2976 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
2977 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
2978 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
2979 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
2981 When testing a filter file,
2982 .cindex "&""From""& line"
2983 .cindex "envelope from"
2984 .cindex "envelope sender"
2985 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
2986 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
2987 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
2988 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
2989 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
2992 .cmdopt -bfd <&'domain'&>
2993 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
2994 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
2995 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
2998 .cmdopt -bfl <&'local&~part'&>
2999 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
3000 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
3001 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
3002 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
3003 actually being delivered.
3005 .cmdopt -bfp <&'prefix'&>
3006 .cindex affix "filter testing"
3007 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
3008 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
3011 .cmdopt -bfs <&'suffix'&>
3012 .cindex affix "filter testing"
3013 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
3014 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
3017 .cmdopt -bh <&'IP&~address'&>
3018 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
3019 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
3020 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
3021 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
3022 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
3023 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
3024 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
3025 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
3026 after a full stop. For example:
3028 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
3029 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
3031 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
3032 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
3033 conversion to the canonical form is
3034 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
3036 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
3037 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
3038 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
3039 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
3040 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
3044 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident (RFC 1413)
3045 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
3046 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
3049 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
3050 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
3051 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
3053 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
3054 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
3055 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
3056 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
3057 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
3058 session were authenticated.
3060 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
3061 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
3062 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
3064 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
3065 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
3066 specialized SMTP test program such as
3067 &url(https://www.jetmore.org/john/code/swaks/,swaks).
3069 .cmdopt -bhc <&'IP&~address'&>
3070 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
3071 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
3072 updating the callout cache database.
3075 .cindex "alias file" "building"
3076 .cindex "building alias file"
3077 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
3078 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
3079 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
3080 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
3081 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
3084 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
3085 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
3086 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
3087 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
3088 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
3089 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
3092 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
3094 .cindex "querying exim information"
3095 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
3096 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
3097 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
3098 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
3099 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
3102 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
3103 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
3104 recognised DSCP names.
3107 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
3108 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
3109 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
3110 useful for ManageSieve (RFC 5804) implementations, in providing that protocol's
3111 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
3112 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3113 way to guarantee a correct response.
3116 .cindex "local message reception"
3117 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3118 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3119 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3120 argument can be a comma-separated list of RFC 2822 addresses. This is the
3121 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3122 if no other conflicting option is present.
3124 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3125 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3126 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3127 suppressing this for special cases.
3129 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3130 the non-SMTP ACL. See section &<<SECnonSMTP>>& for details.
3132 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3133 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3134 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3137 .cindex "message" "format"
3138 .cindex "format" "message"
3139 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3140 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3141 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3142 of the message must be as defined in RFC 2822, except that, for
3143 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3145 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3146 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3148 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3149 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3150 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3151 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3152 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3154 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3155 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3156 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3157 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3158 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3160 .cmdopt -bmalware <&'filename'&>
3161 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3162 .cindex "malware scan test"
3163 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file or directory
3164 (depending on the used scanner interface),
3165 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3166 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3167 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3168 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3169 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3171 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3172 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3173 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3174 This option requires admin privileges.
3176 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3177 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3178 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3181 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3182 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3183 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3184 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3185 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3186 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3187 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3189 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3190 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3191 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3192 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3193 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3195 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3196 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3197 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3198 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3202 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3203 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3204 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3205 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3206 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3207 arguments, for example:
3209 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3211 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3212 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3213 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3214 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3215 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3216 users, the output is as in this example:
3218 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3220 If &%config%& is given as an argument, the config is
3221 output, as it was parsed, any include file resolved, any comment removed.
3223 If &%config_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the runtime
3224 configuration file is output. (&%configure_file%& works too, for
3225 backward compatibility.)
3226 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3227 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3229 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3230 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3231 name will not be output.
3233 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3234 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3235 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3236 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3237 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3238 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3239 written directly into the spool directory.
3241 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3243 exim -bP +local_domains
3245 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3246 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3248 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3249 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3250 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3251 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3252 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3253 that driver are output. For example:
3255 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3257 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3258 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3259 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3260 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3261 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3264 .cindex "environment"
3265 If &%environment%& is given as an argument, the set of environment
3266 variables is output, line by line. Using the &%-n%& flag suppresses the value of the
3269 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3270 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3271 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3272 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3273 The output format is one item per line.
3274 For the "-bP macro <name>" form, if no such macro is found
3275 the exit status will be nonzero.
3278 .cindex "queue" "listing messages in"
3279 .cindex "listing" "messages in the queue"
3280 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3281 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3282 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3283 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3284 to allow any user to see the queue.
3286 Each message in the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3288 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3289 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3292 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3293 .cindex "size" "of message"
3294 The first line contains the length of time the message has been in the queue
3295 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3296 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3297 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3298 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3299 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3300 before the sender address.
3302 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3303 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3304 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3306 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3307 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3308 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3309 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3310 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3315 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3316 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3317 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3322 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3323 This option counts the number of messages in the queue, and writes the total
3324 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3325 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3329 .cindex queue "list of message IDs"
3330 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but only outputs message ids
3335 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3336 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3337 lots of messages in the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3338 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3341 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3344 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpi%&.
3347 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3351 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3352 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3353 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3354 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3358 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3359 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3360 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3361 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3362 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3364 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3365 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3367 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3368 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3369 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3370 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3371 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3372 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3373 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3374 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3375 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3377 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3378 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3382 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3383 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3384 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3385 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3386 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3387 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3388 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3391 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3392 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3393 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3394 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3395 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3396 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3397 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3398 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3399 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3401 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3402 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3403 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3405 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3406 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see section &<<SECnonSMTP>>&).
3407 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3408 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3410 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3411 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3412 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3414 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3415 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3416 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3417 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3418 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3420 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3421 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3424 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3425 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3426 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3427 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3428 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3429 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3430 messages to the MTA.
3433 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3434 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3435 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3436 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3437 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3438 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3439 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3443 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3444 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3445 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3446 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3447 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3448 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3449 the listening daemon.
3452 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3453 .cindex "address" "testing"
3454 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3455 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3456 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3457 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3458 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3460 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3461 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3463 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3464 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3467 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3468 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3469 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3470 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3471 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3474 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3475 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3476 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3477 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3479 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3480 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3481 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3482 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3485 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3486 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3488 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3489 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3490 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3491 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3492 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3493 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3497 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3498 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3499 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3500 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3501 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3502 name of the runtime configuration file that is in use.
3504 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3505 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3506 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3507 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3508 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3509 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3510 dynamic testing facilities.
3513 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3514 .cindex "address" "verification"
3515 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3516 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3517 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3518 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3519 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3520 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3522 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3523 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3524 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3526 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3527 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3529 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3530 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3533 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3534 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3535 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3536 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3537 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3539 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3540 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3541 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3542 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3543 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3544 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3547 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3548 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3549 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3552 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3553 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3554 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3555 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3557 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3558 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3559 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3560 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3563 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3564 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3570 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3571 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3572 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3573 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3575 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3576 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3577 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3578 each port only when the first connection is received.
3580 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3581 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3583 .cmdopt -C <&'filelist'&>
3584 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3585 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3586 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3587 This option causes Exim to find the runtime configuration file from the given
3588 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3589 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single filename,
3590 but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3591 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3592 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3594 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3595 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3596 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3597 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3598 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3599 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3600 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3601 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3602 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3604 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3605 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3606 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3607 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3608 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3609 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3610 in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3612 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3613 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3614 must start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3615 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3616 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3617 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3618 unset, any filename can be used with &%-C%&.
3620 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3621 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3622 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3625 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3626 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3627 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3628 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3629 specified by this option.
3632 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3634 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3635 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3636 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3637 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3638 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3639 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3641 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3642 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3643 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3644 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3645 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3646 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3647 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3649 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3650 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3651 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3657 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3658 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3661 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3663 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3664 Only macro names up to 22 letters long can be set.
3667 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3669 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3670 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3671 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3672 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3673 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3674 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3675 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3678 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3679 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3680 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3681 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3682 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3683 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3684 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3686 .itable none 0 0 2 20* left 80* left
3687 .irow acl "ACL interpretation"
3688 .irow auth "authenticators"
3689 .irow deliver "general delivery logic"
3690 .irow dns "DNS lookups (see also resolver)"
3691 .irow dnsbl "DNS black list (aka RBL) code"
3692 .irow exec "arguments for &[execv()]& calls"
3693 .irow expand "detailed debugging for string expansions"
3694 .irow filter "filter handling"
3695 .irow hints_lookup "hints data lookups"
3696 .irow host_lookup "all types of name-to-IP address handling"
3697 .irow ident "ident lookup"
3698 .irow interface "lists of local interfaces"
3699 .irow lists "matching things in lists"
3700 .irow load "system load checks"
3701 .irow local_scan "can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3702 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)"
3703 .irow lookup "general lookup code and all lookups"
3704 .irow memory "memory handling"
3705 .irow noutf8 "modifier: avoid UTF-8 line-drawing"
3706 .irow pid "modifier: add pid to debug output lines"
3707 .irow process_info "setting info for the process log"
3708 .irow queue_run "queue runs"
3709 .irow receive "general message reception logic"
3710 .irow resolver "turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output"
3711 .irow retry "retry handling"
3712 .irow rewrite "address rewriting""
3713 .irow route "address routing"
3714 .irow timestamp "modifier: add timestamp to debug output lines"
3715 .irow tls "TLS logic"
3716 .irow transport "transports"
3717 .irow uid "changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid"
3718 .irow verify "address verification logic"
3719 .irow all "almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&"
3721 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3722 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3723 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3724 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3725 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3726 turn everything off.
3728 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3729 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3730 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3731 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3732 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3735 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3736 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3737 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3738 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3739 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3742 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3743 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3746 .cindex debugging "UTF-8 in"
3747 .cindex UTF-8 "in debug output"
3748 The &`noutf8`& selector disables the use of
3749 UTF-8 line-drawing characters to group related information.
3750 When disabled. ascii-art is used instead.
3751 Using the &`+all`& option does not set this modifier,
3753 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3754 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3756 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3758 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3759 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3760 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3761 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3764 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3765 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3766 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3769 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3770 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3771 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3772 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3773 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3774 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3775 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3776 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3779 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3780 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3781 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3782 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3783 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3785 .cmdopt -F <&'string'&>
3786 .cindex "sender" "name"
3787 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3788 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3789 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3790 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3791 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3792 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3794 .cmdopt -f <&'address'&>
3795 .cindex "sender" "address"
3796 .cindex "address" "sender"
3797 .cindex "trusted users"
3798 .cindex "envelope from"
3799 .cindex "envelope sender"
3800 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3801 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3802 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3803 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3806 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3807 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3808 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3809 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3812 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3813 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3814 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3815 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3816 examples of shell commands:
3818 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3819 exim -f "" user@domain
3821 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3822 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3825 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3826 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3827 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3828 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3831 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3832 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3833 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3834 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3835 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3836 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3839 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3840 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3842 control = suppress_local_fixups
3844 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3845 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3848 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3851 .cmdopt -h <&'number'&>
3852 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3853 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3854 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3858 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3859 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3860 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3861 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message.
3862 Solaris 2.4 (SunOS 5.4) Sendmail has a similar &%-i%& processing option
3863 &url(https://docs.oracle.com/cd/E19457-01/801-6680-1M/801-6680-1M.pdf),
3864 p. 1M-529), and therefore a &%-oi%& command line option, which both are used
3865 by its &'mailx'& command.
3867 .cmdopt -L <&'tag'&>
3868 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3869 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3870 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3871 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3872 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3873 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3875 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3877 .cmdopt -M <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3878 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3879 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3880 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3881 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3882 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3883 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3884 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3887 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3888 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3889 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3890 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3891 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3892 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3894 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3895 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3896 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3897 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3899 .cmdopt -Mar <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3900 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3901 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3902 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3903 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3904 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3905 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3906 can be used only by an admin user.
3908 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&&&
3910 &~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3911 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3913 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3914 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3915 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3916 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3917 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3918 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3919 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3920 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3923 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3924 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3925 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3928 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3929 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3930 remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3933 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3934 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-d%& option
3935 to pass on an information string on the purpose of the process.
3937 .cmdopt -MCG <&'queue&~name'&>
3938 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3939 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3940 alternate queue is used, named by the following argument.
3943 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3944 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that a
3945 remote host supports the ESMTP &_CHUNKING_& extension.
3948 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3949 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3950 which Exim is connected advertised limits on numbers of mails, recipients or
3952 The limits are given by the following three arguments.
3955 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3956 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3957 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3960 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3961 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the connection
3962 t a remote server is via a SOCKS proxy, using addresses and ports given by
3963 the following four arguments.
3965 .cmdopt -MCQ <&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
3966 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3967 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
3968 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
3969 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
3970 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
3971 messages through the same SMTP connection.
3973 .cmdopt -MCq <&'recipient&~address'&>&~<&'size'&>
3974 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3975 by Exim to implement quota checking for local users.
3978 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3979 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3980 ESMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
3984 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3985 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
3986 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
3988 .vitem &%-MCr%&&~<&'SNI'&> &&&
3992 These options are not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3993 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MCt%& option, and passes on the fact that
3994 a TLS Server Name Indication was sent as part of the channel establishment.
3995 The argument gives the SNI string.
3996 The "r" variant indicates a DANE-verified connection.
3998 .cmdopt -MCt <&'IP&~address'&>&~<&'port'&>&~<&'cipher'&>
3999 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
4000 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
4001 connection is being proxied by a parent process for handling TLS encryption.
4002 The arguments give the local address and port being proxied, and the TLS cipher.
4004 .cmdopt -Mc <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4005 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
4006 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
4007 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message, in turn,
4008 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
4009 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
4010 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
4011 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
4012 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
4013 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
4014 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
4015 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
4016 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
4017 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
4019 .cmdopt -Mes <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
4020 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
4021 .cindex "sender" "changing"
4022 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
4023 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
4024 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
4025 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
4026 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
4027 This option can be used only by an admin user.
4029 .cmdopt -Mf <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4030 .cindex "freezing messages"
4031 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
4032 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
4033 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
4034 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
4035 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
4036 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
4039 .cmdopt -Mg <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4040 .cindex "giving up on messages"
4041 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
4042 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
4043 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
4044 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
4045 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
4046 is sent to the sender.
4047 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
4050 .cmdopt -MG <&'queue&~name'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4052 .cindex "named queues" "moving messages"
4053 .cindex "queue" "moving messages"
4054 This option requests that each listed message be moved from its current
4055 queue to the given named queue.
4056 The destination queue name argument is required, but can be an empty
4057 string to define the default queue.
4058 If the messages are not currently located in the default queue,
4059 a &%-qG<name>%& option will be required to define the source queue.
4061 .cmdopt -Mmad <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4062 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
4063 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
4064 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
4065 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
4066 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4068 .cmdopt -Mmd <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
4069 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
4070 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
4071 .cindex "removing recipients"
4072 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
4073 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
4074 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
4075 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
4076 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
4077 can be used only by an admin user.
4079 .cmdopt -Mrm <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4080 .cindex "removing messages"
4081 .cindex "abandoning mail"
4082 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
4083 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
4084 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
4085 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
4086 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
4087 placed in the queue.
4092 . .cindex REQUIRETLS
4093 . This option is used to request REQUIRETLS processing on the message.
4094 . It is used internally by Exim in conjunction with -E when generating
4098 .cmdopt -Mset <&'message&~id'&>
4099 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
4100 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
4101 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
4102 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
4103 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
4104 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
4105 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
4106 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
4107 user. See also &%-bem%&.
4109 .cmdopt -Mt <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4110 .cindex "thawing messages"
4111 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
4112 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
4113 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
4114 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
4115 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
4116 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
4119 .cmdopt -Mvb <&'message&~id'&>
4120 .cindex "listing" "message body"
4121 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
4122 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
4123 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4125 .cmdopt -Mvc <&'message&~id'&>
4126 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
4127 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
4128 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
4129 be written to the standard output in RFC 2822 format. This option can be used
4130 only by an admin user.
4132 .cmdopt -Mvh <&'message&~id'&>
4133 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
4134 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
4135 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
4136 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
4137 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4139 .cmdopt -Mvl <&'message&~id'&>
4140 .cindex "listing" "message log"
4141 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
4142 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
4143 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4146 This is a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail
4147 (&url(https://docs.oracle.com/cd/E19457-01/801-6680-1M/801-6680-1M.pdf)
4148 p. 1M-258), so Exim treats it that way too.
4151 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
4152 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
4153 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
4154 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
4155 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
4156 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
4157 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4160 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4161 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4162 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4163 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4164 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4165 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4166 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4170 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4171 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4172 When combined with &%-bP%& it makes the output more terse (suppresses
4173 option names, environment values and config pretty printing).
4175 .cmdopt -O <&'data'&>
4176 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4179 .cmdopt -oA <&'file&~name'&>
4180 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4181 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4182 alternative alias filename. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4186 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4187 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4188 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4189 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4190 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4191 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4194 .cindex "background delivery"
4195 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4196 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4197 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4198 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4199 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4200 processes to finish.
4202 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4203 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4204 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4205 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4207 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4208 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4209 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4210 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4213 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4214 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4215 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4216 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4217 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4218 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4220 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4221 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4224 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4225 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4227 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4228 message is left in the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4229 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4230 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4234 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4238 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4239 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4240 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4241 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4242 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4243 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4244 are placed in the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4245 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4246 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4247 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4251 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4252 .cindex "first pass routing"
4253 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4254 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4255 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4256 configuration file is in effect.
4258 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4259 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4260 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4261 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4262 done at this time, so the message remains in the queue until a subsequent queue
4263 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4264 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4265 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4266 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4270 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4271 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4272 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4275 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4277 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4278 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4279 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4280 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4283 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4284 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4285 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4286 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4287 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4290 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4291 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4292 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4293 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4294 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4297 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4298 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4302 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4303 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4307 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4308 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4309 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4310 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4311 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4312 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4315 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4317 .cmdopt -oMa <&'host&~address'&>
4318 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4319 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4320 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4321 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4322 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4323 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4325 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4326 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4328 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4330 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4331 followed by a colon and the port number:
4333 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4335 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4336 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4337 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4338 whichever one is last.
4340 .cmdopt -oMaa <&'name'&>
4341 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4342 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4343 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4344 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4345 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4346 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4348 .cmdopt -oMai <&'string'&>
4349 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4350 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4351 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4352 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4353 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4354 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4356 .cmdopt -oMas <&'address'&>
4357 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4358 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4359 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4360 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4361 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4362 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4363 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4364 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4366 .cmdopt -oMi <&'interface&~address'&>
4367 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4368 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4369 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4370 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4371 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4373 .cmdopt -oMm <&'message&~reference'&>
4374 .cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4375 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4376 option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4377 delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4378 messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4379 abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4380 running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4382 The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4383 The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4384 is sending the bounce.
4386 .cmdopt -oMr <&'protocol&~name'&>
4387 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4388 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4389 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4390 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4391 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4392 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4393 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4394 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4395 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4396 be set by &%-oMr%&. Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4398 .cmdopt -oMs <&'host&~name'&>
4399 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4400 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4401 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4402 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4403 uses the name it is given.
4405 .cmdopt -oMt <&'ident&~string'&>
4406 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4407 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4408 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4409 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4410 used, when there is no default.
4413 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4414 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4415 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4416 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4419 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4420 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4421 whatever that means.
4423 .cmdopt -oP <&'path'&>
4424 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4425 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4426 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4427 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4428 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4429 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4430 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4433 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4434 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4435 This option is not intended for general use.
4436 The daemon uses it when terminating due to a SIGTEM, possibly in
4437 combination with &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>.
4438 It causes the pid file to be removed.
4440 .cmdopt -or <&'time'&>
4441 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4442 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4443 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4444 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4445 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4447 .cmdopt -os <&'time'&>
4448 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4449 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4450 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4451 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4452 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4453 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4456 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4458 .cmdopt -oX <&'number&~or&~string'&>
4459 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4460 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4461 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4462 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4463 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4464 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4465 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4466 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid filename.
4469 .cindex "daemon notifier socket"
4470 This option controls the creation of an inter-process communications endpoint
4472 It is only relevant when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option is also
4474 Normally the daemon creates this socket, unless a &%-oX%& and &*no*& &%-oP%&
4475 option is also present.
4476 If this option is given then the socket will not be created. This is required
4477 if the system is running multiple daemons, in which case it should
4479 The features supported by the socket will not be available in such cases.
4481 The socket is currently used for
4483 fast ramp-up of queue runner processes
4485 caching compiled regexes
4487 obtaining a current queue size
4491 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4492 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4493 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4494 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4498 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4499 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4500 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4501 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4504 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4506 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4508 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4510 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4511 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4512 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4513 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4514 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4515 Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4518 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4519 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4520 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4521 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4522 and &%-S%& options).
4524 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4525 If other commandline options do not specify an action,
4526 the &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4527 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4528 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4529 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4530 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4533 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4534 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4535 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4536 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4537 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4540 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4541 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4542 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4543 this to be repeated periodically.
4545 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4546 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4547 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4548 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4550 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4551 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4552 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4554 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4555 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4556 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4557 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4561 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4562 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4563 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4564 .cindex "first pass routing"
4565 .cindex "queue runner" "two phase"
4566 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4567 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4568 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4571 Performance will be best if the &%queue_run_in_order%& option is false.
4573 the &%queue_fast_ramp%& option is true
4574 and a daemon-notifier socket is available
4575 then in the first phase of the run,
4576 once a threshold number of messages are routed for a given host,
4577 a delivery process is forked in parallel with the rest of the scan.
4579 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4580 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4581 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred.
4583 After the first queue scan complete,
4584 a second, normal queue scan is done, with routing and delivery taking
4586 Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4587 delivered down a single SMTP
4588 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4589 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4590 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4591 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4593 Two-phase queue runs should be used on systems which, even intermittently,
4594 have a large queue (such as mailing-list operators).
4595 They may also be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4598 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4600 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4601 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4602 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4603 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages in the queue using
4604 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4606 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4608 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4609 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4610 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4611 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4612 their retry times are tried.
4614 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4616 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4617 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4620 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4622 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4623 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4624 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains in the queue
4627 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]][l][G<name>[/<time>]]]%&
4630 .cindex "named queues" "deliver from"
4631 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4632 If the &'G'& flag and a name is present, the queue runner operates on the
4633 queue with the given name rather than the default queue.
4634 The name should not contain a &'/'& character.
4635 For a periodic queue run (see below)
4636 append to the name a slash and a time value.
4638 If other commandline options specify an action, a &'-qG<name>'& option
4639 will specify a queue to operate on.
4642 exim -bp -qGquarantine
4644 exim -qGoffpeak -Rf @special.domain.example
4647 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4648 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4649 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4650 starting message id. For example:
4652 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4654 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4655 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4656 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4658 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4660 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4661 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4662 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4663 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4664 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4665 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4667 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4668 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4669 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4670 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4671 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4672 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4673 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4674 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4675 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4677 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4679 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4680 process every 30 minutes.
4682 .cindex "named queues" "queue runners"
4683 It is possible to set up runners for multiple named queues within one daemon,
4686 exim -qGhipri/2m -q10m -qqGmailinglist/1h
4689 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4690 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4692 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4694 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4697 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4699 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4701 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4703 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4704 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4705 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4706 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4707 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4708 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4709 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4711 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4712 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4713 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4714 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4715 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4716 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4718 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4719 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4721 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4723 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4724 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4725 applied to each queue run.
4727 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4728 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4729 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4730 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4731 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4732 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4733 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4734 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4735 address will be skipped.
4737 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4738 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4739 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4742 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4743 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4744 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&), its default
4745 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4746 an arbitrary command instead.
4749 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4751 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4753 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4754 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4755 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4756 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4757 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4758 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4760 .cmdopt -Tqt <&'times'&>
4761 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4762 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4763 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4766 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4770 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4771 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4772 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4773 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4774 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4776 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4777 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4778 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4779 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4780 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4781 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4782 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4783 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4784 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4785 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4786 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4788 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4789 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4790 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4791 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4792 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4793 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4795 RFC 2822 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4796 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4797 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4798 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4799 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4800 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4801 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4802 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4803 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4806 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4807 compatibility with Sendmail.
4809 .cmdopt -tls-on-connect
4810 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4811 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4812 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4813 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4814 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4815 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4819 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4820 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4821 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4822 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4823 set. Exim ignores this option.
4826 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4827 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4828 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4829 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4830 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4831 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4835 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4836 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4837 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4840 .cmdopt -X <&'logfile'&>
4841 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4842 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4844 .cmdopt -z <&'log-line'&>
4845 This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4846 Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4847 Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4855 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4856 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4857 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4858 . creates a man page for the options.
4859 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4862 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4869 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4870 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4873 .chapter "The Exim runtime configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4874 "The runtime configuration file"
4876 .cindex "runtime configuration"
4877 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4878 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4879 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4880 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4881 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4882 Exim uses a single runtime configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4883 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4884 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4887 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4888 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4889 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4890 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4891 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4892 actually alter the string.
4894 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4895 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4896 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4897 give a colon-separated list of filenames, in which case Exim uses the first
4898 existing file in the list.
4901 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4902 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4903 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4904 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4905 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4906 The runtime configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4907 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4908 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4909 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4910 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4912 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4913 to root, anybody who is able to edit the runtime configuration file has an
4914 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4915 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4916 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4918 Up to Exim version 4.72, the runtime configuration file was also permitted to
4919 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4920 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4921 compromise the Exim user account.
4923 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4924 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4925 defines just one filename, the installation process copies the default
4926 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4927 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4928 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4933 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4934 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4935 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4936 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4937 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4938 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4939 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4940 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4941 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4942 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4943 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4945 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4946 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4947 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4948 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4949 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4950 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4951 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4952 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4953 message in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4956 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4957 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4958 start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4959 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any
4960 filename can be used with &%-C%&.
4962 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
4963 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
4964 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
4965 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
4966 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
4967 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
4969 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
4970 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
4971 necessarily be discarded.
4972 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
4973 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
4974 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
4975 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
4976 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
4977 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
4979 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
4980 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
4981 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
4982 looks for a file whose name is the configuration filename followed by a dot
4983 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
4984 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
4985 each filename in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
4987 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
4988 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
4989 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
4993 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
4994 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
4995 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
4996 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
4997 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
4998 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
4999 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
5000 space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
5003 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
5006 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
5007 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
5008 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
5010 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
5011 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
5012 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
5014 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
5015 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
5016 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
5018 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
5019 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
5020 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
5021 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
5024 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
5025 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
5026 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
5028 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
5029 want to use this feature, you must set
5031 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
5033 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
5034 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
5037 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
5038 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
5039 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
5040 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
5042 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
5043 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
5044 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
5045 and does not introduce a comment.
5047 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
5048 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
5049 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
5050 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
5051 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
5053 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
5054 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
5055 change settings as required.
5057 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
5058 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
5059 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
5060 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
5061 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
5066 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
5067 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
5068 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
5069 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
5070 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
5071 You can include other files inside Exim's runtime configuration file by
5074 &`.include`& <&'filename'&>
5075 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'filename'&>
5077 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the filename are optional. If you use
5078 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
5079 second form does nothing for non-existent files.
5080 The first form allows a relative name. It is resolved relative to
5081 the directory of the including file. For the second form an absolute filename
5084 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
5085 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
5086 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
5087 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
5089 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
5090 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
5093 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
5096 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
5097 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
5102 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
5103 .cindex "macro" "description of"
5104 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
5105 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
5106 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
5107 definition, and must be of the form
5109 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
5111 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
5112 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
5113 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
5114 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
5115 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
5117 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
5118 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
5119 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
5121 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
5122 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
5123 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
5124 scanned for each, in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
5125 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
5126 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
5127 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
5130 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
5131 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
5133 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
5134 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
5135 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
5136 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
5137 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
5138 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
5141 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
5142 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
5143 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
5148 MAC == updated value
5150 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
5151 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
5152 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
5153 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
5157 MAC == MAC and something added
5159 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
5160 from a number of other files.
5162 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
5163 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
5164 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
5165 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
5166 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
5171 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
5172 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
5173 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
5174 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
5176 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
5177 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
5179 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
5181 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
5183 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
5184 address lists. In Exim 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
5185 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
5188 .section "Builtin macros" "SECTbuiltinmacros"
5189 Exim defines some macros depending on facilities available, which may
5190 differ due to build-time definitions and from one release to another.
5191 All of these macros start with an underscore.
5192 They can be used to conditionally include parts of a configuration
5195 The following classes of macros are defined:
5197 &` _HAVE_* `& build-time defines
5198 &` _DRIVER_ROUTER_* `& router drivers
5199 &` _DRIVER_TRANSPORT_* `& transport drivers
5200 &` _DRIVER_AUTHENTICATOR_* `& authenticator drivers
5201 &` _EXP_COND_* `& expansion conditions
5202 &` _EXP_ITEM_* `& expansion items
5203 &` _EXP_OP_* `& expansion operators
5204 &` _EXP_VAR_* `& expansion variables
5205 &` _LOG_* `& log_selector values
5206 &` _OPT_MAIN_* `& main config options
5207 &` _OPT_ROUTERS_* `& generic router options
5208 &` _OPT_TRANSPORTS_* `& generic transport options
5209 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATORS_* `& generic authenticator options
5210 &` _OPT_ROUTER_*_* `& private router options
5211 &` _OPT_TRANSPORT_*_* `& private transport options
5212 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_*_* `& private authenticator options
5215 Use an &"exim -bP macros"& command to get the list of macros.
5218 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
5219 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
5220 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
5221 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
5222 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5223 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5224 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5226 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5227 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5228 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5232 message_size_limit = 50M
5234 message_size_limit = 100M
5237 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5238 (or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5239 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5240 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5241 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5243 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5244 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5245 in this line"& will always be true.
5247 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5248 to clarify complicated nestings.
5252 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5253 .cindex "common option syntax"
5254 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5255 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5256 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5257 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5258 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5259 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5260 space) and then the value. For example:
5262 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5264 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5265 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5266 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5267 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5268 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5269 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5270 word &"hide"&. For example:
5272 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5274 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5276 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5278 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5279 all instances of the same driver.
5281 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5282 that are found in option settings.
5285 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5286 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5287 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5288 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5289 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5290 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5291 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5292 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5293 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5294 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5295 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5296 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5301 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5306 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5311 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5312 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5313 .cindex "format" "integer"
5314 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5315 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5316 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5317 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5320 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5321 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024;
5322 if by the letter G, 1024x1024x1024.
5324 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5325 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5326 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5330 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5331 .cindex "integer format"
5332 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5333 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5334 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5335 Such options are always output in octal.
5338 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5339 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5340 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5341 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5342 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5346 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5347 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5348 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5349 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5350 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5360 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5361 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5362 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5366 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5367 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5368 .cindex "format" "string"
5369 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5370 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5371 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5372 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5373 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5374 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5375 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5376 therefore equivalent:
5378 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5379 trusted_users = uucp:\
5380 # This comment line is ignored
5383 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5384 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5385 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5386 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5387 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5390 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5391 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5392 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5394 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5395 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5399 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5400 character, that character replaces the pair.
5402 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5403 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5404 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5405 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5406 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5407 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5410 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5411 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5412 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5413 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5414 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5415 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5416 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5417 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5418 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5419 within a quoted configuration string.
5422 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5423 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5424 .cindex "format" "user name"
5425 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5426 .cindex "format" "group name"
5427 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5428 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5429 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5430 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5433 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5434 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5435 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5436 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5437 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5438 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5439 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5440 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5441 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5442 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5443 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5445 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5446 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5447 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5448 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5449 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5450 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5453 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5455 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5457 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5458 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The spaces around the first
5459 colon in the example above are necessary. If they were not there, the list would
5460 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5462 .section "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5463 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5464 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5465 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5466 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5467 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5468 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5469 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5471 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5473 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5474 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5475 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5477 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5478 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5479 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5480 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5481 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5482 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5483 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5484 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5485 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5487 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5489 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5490 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5491 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5492 the value in quotes. For example:
5494 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5496 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5497 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5498 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5499 enclosing an empty list item.
5503 .section "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5504 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5505 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5506 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5508 senders = user@domain :
5510 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5511 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5512 items, the second of which is empty:
5514 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5516 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5517 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5518 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5519 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5523 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5524 is at the end of the list.
5529 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5530 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5531 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5532 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5533 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5534 a sequence of lines like this:
5536 <&'instance name'&>:
5541 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5542 followed by three options settings:
5547 transport = local_delivery
5549 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5550 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5551 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5552 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5553 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5554 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5556 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5557 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5559 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5560 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5561 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5562 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5563 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5566 .cindex "generic options"
5567 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5568 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5569 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5570 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5571 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5572 .cindex "private options"
5573 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5574 they all have default values.
5576 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5577 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5578 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5580 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5581 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5582 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5583 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5584 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5585 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5586 configuration lines:
5591 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5592 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5593 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5594 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5600 command_timeout = 10s
5602 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5603 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5606 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5607 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5608 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5616 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5617 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5619 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5620 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5621 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5622 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5623 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5624 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5625 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5626 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5627 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5628 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5629 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5633 .section "Macros" "SECTdefconfmacros"
5634 All macros should be defined before any options.
5636 One macro is specified, but commented out, in the default configuration:
5638 # ROUTER_SMARTHOST=MAIL.HOSTNAME.FOR.CENTRAL.SERVER.EXAMPLE
5640 If all off-site mail is expected to be delivered to a "smarthost", then set the
5641 hostname here and uncomment the macro. This will affect which router is used
5642 later on. If this is left commented out, then Exim will perform direct-to-MX
5643 deliveries using a &(dnslookup)& router.
5645 In addition to macros defined here, Exim includes a number of built-in macros
5646 to enable configuration to be guarded by a binary built with support for a
5647 given feature. See section &<<SECTbuiltinmacros>>& for more details.
5650 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5651 The main (global) configuration option settings section must always come first
5652 in the file, after the macros.
5653 The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is the line
5655 # primary_hostname =
5657 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5658 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5659 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5660 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5662 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5664 domainlist local_domains = @
5665 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5666 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5668 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5669 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5670 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5671 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5673 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5674 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5677 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5678 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5679 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5680 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5681 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5682 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5684 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5685 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5686 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5687 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5688 domain is permitted.
5690 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5691 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5692 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5693 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5694 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5695 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5697 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5698 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5699 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5701 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5703 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5704 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5706 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5707 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5708 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5709 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5710 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5711 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5712 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5713 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5714 contents of a message to be checked.
5716 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5718 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5719 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5721 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5722 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5723 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5724 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5726 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5728 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5729 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5730 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5732 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5733 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5734 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5735 connecting to this server; in this case, the wildcard means all clients. The
5736 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5737 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5738 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5740 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5742 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5743 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5745 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5746 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5747 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5748 .cindex "submissions protocol"
5749 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5750 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5751 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
5752 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5753 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5754 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5755 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5756 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5757 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&).
5758 Mail submission from mail clients (MUAs) should be separate from inbound mail
5759 to your domain (MX delivery) for various good reasons (eg, ability to impose
5760 much saner TLS protocol and ciphersuite requirements without unintended
5762 RFC 6409 (previously 4409) specifies use of port 587 for SMTP Submission,
5763 which uses STARTTLS, so this is the &"submission"& port.
5764 RFC 8314 specifies use of port 465 as the &"submissions"& protocol,
5765 which should be used in preference to 587.
5766 You should also consider deploying SRV records to help clients find
5768 Older names for &"submissions"& are &"smtps"& and &"ssmtp"&.
5770 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5773 # qualify_recipient =
5775 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5776 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5777 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5778 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5779 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5780 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5782 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5783 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5784 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5785 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5787 # allow_domain_literals
5789 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5790 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5791 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5792 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5793 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5794 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5796 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5800 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5801 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5802 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5803 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5804 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5805 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5806 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5807 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5809 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5810 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5815 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5816 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5817 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5818 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5819 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5820 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5823 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by RFC
5824 1413 (hence their names):
5827 rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5829 These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5830 Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5831 terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5832 of an incoming SMTP connection.
5833 If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5834 information, you can change this.
5836 This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5837 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5842 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5843 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5844 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5845 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5847 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5848 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5850 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5851 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5853 The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5856 log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5857 +tls_certificate_verified
5860 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5862 # percent_hack_domains =
5864 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5865 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5866 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5868 The next two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5869 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5870 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5871 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5872 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5873 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5874 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5875 always bounce messages.
5877 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5878 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5880 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5881 discarded after 2 days in the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5882 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5883 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5884 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5886 Exim queues it's messages in a spool directory. If you expect to have
5887 large queues, you may consider using this option. It splits the spool
5888 directory into subdirectories to avoid file system degradation from
5889 many files in a single directory, resulting in better performance.
5890 Manual manipulation of queued messages becomes more complex (though fortunately
5893 # split_spool_directory = true
5896 In an ideal world everybody follows the standards. For non-ASCII
5897 messages RFC 2047 is a standard, allowing a maximum line length of 76
5898 characters. Exim adheres that standard and won't process messages which
5899 violate this standard. (Even ${rfc2047:...} expansions will fail.)
5900 In particular, the Exim maintainers have had multiple reports of
5901 problems from Russian administrators of issues until they disable this
5902 check, because of some popular, yet buggy, mail composition software.
5904 # check_rfc2047_length = false
5907 If you need to be strictly RFC compliant you may wish to disable the
5908 8BITMIME advertisement. Use this, if you exchange mails with systems
5909 that are not 8-bit clean.
5911 # accept_8bitmime = false
5914 Libraries you use may depend on specific environment settings. This
5915 imposes a security risk (e.g. PATH). There are two lists:
5916 &%keep_environment%& for the variables to import as they are, and
5917 &%add_environment%& for variables we want to set to a fixed value.
5918 Note that TZ is handled separately, by the &%timezone%& runtime
5919 option and by the TIMEZONE_DEFAULT buildtime option.
5921 # keep_environment = ^LDAP
5922 # add_environment = PATH=/usr/bin::/bin
5926 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5927 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5928 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5929 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5930 It starts with the line
5934 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5935 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5936 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5938 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5939 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5940 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5941 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5942 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5943 result of the ACL processing.
5947 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5952 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5953 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5954 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5955 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5956 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5957 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
5959 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
5960 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
5961 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
5964 deny domains = +local_domains
5965 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
5966 message = Restricted characters in address
5968 deny domains = !+local_domains
5969 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
5970 message = Restricted characters in address
5972 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
5973 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
5974 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
5975 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
5976 in Internet mail addresses.
5978 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
5979 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
5980 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
5981 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
5982 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
5983 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
5984 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
5985 policy of being as safe as possible.
5987 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
5988 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
5989 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
5990 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
5991 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
5992 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
5994 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
5995 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
5996 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
5997 have to modify this rule.
5999 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in RFC 2822, but Exim
6000 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
6001 common convention of local parts constructed as
6002 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
6003 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
6004 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
6005 filename (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
6006 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
6007 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
6009 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
6010 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
6011 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
6012 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
6013 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
6014 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
6015 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
6017 accept local_parts = postmaster
6018 domains = +local_domains
6020 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
6021 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
6022 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
6023 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
6024 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
6026 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
6027 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
6028 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
6030 require verify = sender
6032 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
6033 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
6034 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
6035 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
6036 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
6037 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
6038 discusses the details of address verification.
6040 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
6041 control = submission
6043 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
6044 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
6045 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
6046 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
6047 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
6048 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
6049 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
6050 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
6051 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
6053 accept authenticated = *
6054 control = submission
6056 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
6057 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
6058 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
6059 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
6060 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
6061 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
6063 require message = relay not permitted
6064 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
6066 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
6067 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
6069 require verify = recipient
6071 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
6072 fails, the address is rejected.
6074 # deny dnslists = black.list.example
6075 # message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
6076 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
6079 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
6080 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
6081 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
6082 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
6084 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
6085 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
6086 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
6089 # require verify = csa
6091 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
6092 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
6097 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
6098 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
6102 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
6103 of this ACL are commented out:
6106 # message = This message contains a virus \
6109 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
6110 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
6111 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
6112 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
6114 # warn spam = nobody
6115 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
6116 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
6117 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
6118 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
6120 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
6121 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
6122 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
6123 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
6124 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
6125 whatever the spam score.
6129 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
6132 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
6133 .cindex "default" "routers"
6134 .cindex "routers" "default"
6135 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
6140 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
6141 messages. An address is passed to each router, in turn, until it is either
6142 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
6143 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
6144 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
6147 # driver = ipliteral
6148 # domains = !+local_domains
6149 # transport = remote_smtp
6151 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
6152 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
6153 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
6154 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
6155 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
6157 Which router is used next depends upon whether or not the ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6158 macro has been defined, per
6160 .ifdef ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6169 If ROUTER_SMARTHOST has been defined, either at the top of the file or on the
6170 command-line, then we route all non-local mail to that smarthost; otherwise, we'll
6171 perform DNS lookups for direct-to-MX lookup. Any mail which is to a local domain will
6172 skip these routers because of the &%domains%& option.
6176 driver = manualroute
6177 domains = ! +local_domains
6178 transport = smarthost_smtp
6179 route_data = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6180 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0.0.0.0 ; 127.0.0.0/8 ; ::1
6183 This router only handles mail which is not to any local domains; this is
6184 specified by the line
6186 domains = ! +local_domains
6188 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
6189 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
6190 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
6191 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
6192 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
6193 passed on to the following routers.
6195 The name of the router driver is &(manualroute)& because we are manually
6196 specifying how mail should be routed onwards, instead of using DNS MX.
6197 While the name of this router instance is arbitrary, the &%driver%& option must
6198 be one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6200 With no pre-conditions other than &%domains%&, all mail for non-local domains
6201 will be handled by this router, and the &%no_more%& setting will ensure that no
6202 other routers will be used for messages matching the pre-conditions. See
6203 &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for more on how the pre-conditions apply. For messages which
6204 are handled by this router, we provide a hostname to deliver to in &%route_data%&
6205 and the macro supplies the value; the address is then queued for the
6206 &(smarthost_smtp)& transport.
6211 domains = ! +local_domains
6212 transport = remote_smtp
6213 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
6216 The &%domains%& option behaves as per smarthost, above.
6218 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
6219 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
6220 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
6221 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
6222 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6224 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
6225 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
6226 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
6227 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
6228 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
6229 the address fails and is bounced.
6231 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
6232 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
6233 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
6234 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
6235 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
6236 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
6237 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
6244 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
6246 file_transport = address_file
6247 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6249 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
6250 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
6251 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
6252 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
6253 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
6256 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
6257 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
6258 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
6259 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
6264 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6265 # local_part_suffix_optional
6266 file = $home/.forward
6271 file_transport = address_file
6272 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6273 reply_transport = address_reply
6275 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
6276 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
6277 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
6278 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
6279 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
6282 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6283 # local_part_suffix_optional
6285 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
6286 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
6287 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
6288 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
6289 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
6290 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
6291 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
6293 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
6294 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
6295 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
6296 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
6298 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
6299 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
6300 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
6301 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
6302 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
6303 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
6304 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
6306 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
6307 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
6308 There are two reasons for doing this:
6311 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
6312 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
6315 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
6316 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
6317 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
6318 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
6322 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
6323 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
6324 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
6325 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
6327 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
6328 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
6329 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
6331 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6333 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6339 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6340 # local_part_suffix_optional
6341 transport = local_delivery
6343 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6344 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6345 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6346 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6347 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6350 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6351 .cindex "default" "transports"
6352 .cindex "transports" "default"
6353 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6354 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6355 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6359 Two remote transports and four local transports are defined.
6363 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6368 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6369 The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6370 The &%message_size_limit%& usage is a hack to avoid sending on messages
6371 with over-long lines.
6373 The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is
6374 negotiated between client and server and not expected to cause problems
6375 but can be disabled if needed. The built-in macro _HAVE_PRDR guards the
6376 use of the &%hosts_try_prdr%& configuration option.
6378 The other remote transport is used when delivering to a specific smarthost
6379 with whom there must be some kind of existing relationship, instead of the
6380 usual federated system.
6385 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6389 # Comment out any of these which you have to, then file a Support
6390 # request with your smarthost provider to get things fixed:
6391 hosts_require_tls = *
6392 tls_verify_hosts = *
6393 # As long as tls_verify_hosts is enabled, this this will have no effect,
6394 # but if you have to comment it out then this will at least log whether
6395 # you succeed or not:
6396 tls_try_verify_hosts = *
6398 # The SNI name should match the name which we'll expect to verify;
6399 # many mail systems don't use SNI and this doesn't matter, but if it does,
6400 # we need to send a name which the remote site will recognize.
6401 # This _should_ be the name which the smarthost operators specified as
6402 # the hostname for sending your mail to.
6403 tls_sni = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6405 .ifdef _HAVE_OPENSSL
6406 tls_require_ciphers = HIGH:!aNULL:@STRENGTH
6409 tls_require_ciphers = SECURE192:-VERS-SSL3.0:-VERS-TLS1.0:-VERS-TLS1.1
6416 After the same &%message_size_limit%& hack, we then specify that this Transport
6417 can handle messages to multiple domains in one run. The assumption here is
6418 that you're routing all non-local mail to the same place and that place is
6419 happy to take all messages from you as quickly as possible.
6420 All other options depend upon built-in macros; if Exim was built without TLS support
6421 then no other options are defined.
6422 If TLS is available, then we configure "stronger than default" TLS ciphersuites
6423 and versions using the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option, where the value to be
6424 used depends upon the library providing TLS.
6425 Beyond that, the options adopt the stance that you should have TLS support available
6426 from your smarthost on today's Internet, so we turn on requiring TLS for the
6427 mail to be delivered, and requiring that the certificate be valid, and match
6428 the expected hostname. The &%tls_sni%& option can be used by service providers
6429 to select an appropriate certificate to present to you and here we re-use the
6430 ROUTER_SMARTHOST macro, because that is unaffected by CNAMEs present in DNS.
6431 You want to specify the hostname which you'll expect to validate for, and that
6432 should not be subject to insecure tampering via DNS results.
6434 For the &%hosts_try_prdr%& option see the previous transport.
6436 All other options are defaulted.
6440 file = /var/mail/$local_part_data
6447 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6448 traditional BSD mailbox format.
6450 We prefer to avoid using &$local_part$& directly to define the mailbox filename,
6451 as it is provided by a potential bad actor.
6452 Instead we use &$local_part_data$&,
6453 the result of looking up &$local_part$& in the user database
6454 (done by using &%check_local_user%& in the the router).
6456 By default &(appendfile)& runs under the uid and gid of the
6457 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6458 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6459 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6460 show how this can be done.
6462 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6463 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6464 similarly-named options above.
6470 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6471 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6472 option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6473 be returned to the sender.
6481 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6482 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6483 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6488 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6493 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6494 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6495 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6496 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6497 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6498 introduced by the line
6502 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6505 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6507 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6508 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6509 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6510 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced. The time is
6511 measured from first failure, not from the time the message was received.
6513 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6514 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6515 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6518 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6519 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6523 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6524 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6528 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6529 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6530 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6532 begin authenticators
6534 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6535 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6536 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6537 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6538 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6539 to support most MUA software.
6541 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6544 # driver = plaintext
6545 # server_set_id = $auth2
6546 # server_prompts = :
6547 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6548 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6550 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6553 # driver = plaintext
6554 # server_set_id = $auth1
6555 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6556 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6557 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6560 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6561 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6562 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6563 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6564 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6565 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6566 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6567 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6569 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6570 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6571 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6572 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6574 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6575 usercode and password are in different positions.
6576 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6578 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6582 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6583 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6585 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6587 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6589 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6590 uses the PCRE2 regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6591 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6592 regular expressions is discussed in
6593 online Perl manpages, in
6594 many Perl reference books, and also in
6595 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6596 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6597 . --- the http: URL here redirects to another page with the ISBN in the URL
6598 . --- where trying to use https: just redirects back to http:, so sticking
6599 . --- to the old URL for now. 2018-09-07.
6601 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6602 are supported by PCRE2 is included in the PCRE2 distribution, and no further
6603 description is included here. The PCRE2 functions are called from Exim using
6604 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE2 options set), except that
6605 the PCRE2_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6608 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6609 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6610 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6611 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6613 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6615 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6616 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6617 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6618 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6619 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6620 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6623 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6624 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6625 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6626 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6627 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6628 match anywhere in the subject string.
6630 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6631 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6633 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6635 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6638 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6640 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6641 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6645 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6646 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6648 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6649 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6650 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6651 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6652 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6653 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6656 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6657 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6658 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6659 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6660 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6661 The key for the lookup is &*specified*& as part of the string to be expanded.
6663 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6664 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6665 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6666 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6667 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6668 Depending on the lookup type (see below)
6669 the key for the lookup may need to be &*specified*& as above
6670 or may be &*implicit*&,
6671 given by the context in which the list is being checked.
6674 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6675 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6676 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6677 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6678 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6679 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6681 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6682 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6683 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6684 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6685 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6687 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6688 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6691 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6692 The key for an expansion-style lookup must be given explicitly.
6693 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6694 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6695 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6696 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6698 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6699 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6701 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6702 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6703 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
6704 .cindex "de-tainting" "using a lookup expansion"
6705 The result of the expansion is not tainted.
6708 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6709 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6711 The file could contains lines like this:
6716 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6717 matches the list item.
6719 The key for a list-style lookup is implicit, from the lookup context, if
6720 the lookup is a single-key type (see below).
6721 For query-style lookup types the query must be given explicitly.
6724 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6725 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6727 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6729 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6730 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6731 causes a second lookup to occur.
6733 The lookup type may optionally be followed by a comma
6734 and a comma-separated list of options.
6735 Each option is a &"name=value"& pair.
6736 Whether an option is meaningful depends on the lookup type.
6738 All lookups support the option &"cache=no_rd"&.
6739 If this is given then the cache that Exim manages for lookup results
6740 is not checked before doing the lookup.
6741 The result of the lookup is still written to the cache.
6743 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6744 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6745 lookup is permitted.
6748 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6749 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6750 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6751 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6754 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6755 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6756 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6757 .cindex "tainted data" "single-key lookups"
6758 The file string may not be tainted.
6760 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
6761 .cindex "de-tainting" "using a single-key lookup"
6762 All single-key lookups support the option &"ret=key"&.
6763 If this is given and the lookup
6764 (either underlying implementation or cached value)
6765 returns data, the result is replaced with a non-tainted
6766 version of the lookup key.
6769 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6770 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6771 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6772 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6774 For the string-expansion kind of lookups, the query is given in the first
6775 bracketed argument of the &${lookup ...}$& expansion.
6776 For the list-argument kind of lookup the query is given by the remainder of the
6777 list item after the first semicolon.
6779 .cindex "tainted data" "quoting for lookups"
6780 If tainted data is used in the query then it should be quoted by
6781 using the &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& expansion operator
6782 appropriate for the lookup.
6785 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6786 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6787 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6792 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6793 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6794 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6799 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6800 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6801 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6802 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6805 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6806 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6807 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6808 The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6809 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6810 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6811 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6812 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb and
6813 tools for building the files can be found in several places:
6815 &url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html)
6816 &url(https://www.corpit.ru/mjt/tinycdb.html)
6817 &url(https://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb)
6818 &url(https://github.com/philpennock/cdbtools) (in Go)
6820 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6821 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6822 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6823 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6826 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6827 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6828 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6829 Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6830 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6831 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6832 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6834 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6835 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6836 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6837 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6838 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6839 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6840 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6843 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6844 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6846 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6847 This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6848 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6849 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6850 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6851 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6852 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6855 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6856 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6857 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6859 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6860 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6861 This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6862 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6863 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6864 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6865 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6866 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6867 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6868 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6871 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6872 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6873 The given file must be an absolute directory path; this is searched for an entry
6874 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function.
6875 Unless the options (below) permit a path,
6876 the key may not contain any forward slash characters.
6877 If &[lstat()]& succeeds then so does the lookup.
6878 .cindex "tainted data" "dsearch result"
6879 The result is regarded as untainted.
6881 Options for the lookup can be given by appending them after the word "dsearch",
6882 separated by a comma. Options, if present, are a comma-separated list having
6883 each element starting with a tag name and an equals.
6885 Three options are supported, for the return value and for filtering match
6887 The "ret" option requests an alternate result value of
6888 the entire path for the entry. Example:
6890 ${lookup {passwd} dsearch,ret=full {/etc}}
6892 The default result is just the requested entry.
6894 The "filter" option requests that only directory entries of a given type
6895 are matched. The match value is one of "file", "dir" or "subdir" (the latter
6896 not matching "." or ".."). Example:
6898 ${lookup {passwd} dsearch,filter=file {/etc}}
6900 The default matching is for any entry type, including directories
6903 The "key" option relaxes the restriction that only a simple path component can
6904 be searched for, to permit a sequence of path components. Example:
6906 ${lookup {foo/bar} dsearch,key=path {/etc}}
6908 If this option is used, a ".." component in the key is specifically disallowed.
6909 The default operation is that the key may only be a single path component.
6911 An example of how this
6912 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6913 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6915 .subsection iplsearch
6916 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6917 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6918 The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6919 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6920 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6921 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6922 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6924 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6925 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6926 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6927 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6929 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6930 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6931 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6932 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6933 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6935 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6936 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6937 lookup types support only literal keys.
6939 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6940 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name
6941 (see section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6943 &*Warning 3*&: Do not use an IPv4-mapped IPv6 address for a key; use the
6944 IPv4, in dotted-quad form. (Exim converts IPv4-mapped IPv6 addresses to this
6945 notation before executing the lookup.)
6947 One option is supported, "ret=full", to request the return of the entire line
6948 rather than omitting the key portion.
6949 Note however that the key portion will have been de-quoted.
6953 .cindex json "lookup type"
6954 .cindex JSON expansions
6955 The given file is a text file with a JSON structure.
6956 An element of the structure is extracted, defined by the search key.
6957 The key is a list of subelement selectors
6958 (colon-separated by default but changeable in the usual way)
6959 which are applied in turn to select smaller and smaller portions
6960 of the JSON structure.
6961 If a selector is numeric, it must apply to a JSON array; the (zero-based)
6962 nunbered array element is selected.
6963 Otherwise it must apply to a JSON object; the named element is selected.
6964 The final resulting element can be a simple JSON type or a JSON object
6965 or array; for the latter two a string-representation of the JSON
6967 For elements of type string, the returned value is de-quoted.
6973 .cindex database lmdb
6974 The given file is an LMDB database.
6975 LMDB is a memory-mapped key-value store,
6976 with API modeled loosely on that of BerkeleyDB.
6977 See &url(https://symas.com/products/lightning-memory-mapped-database/)
6978 for the feature set and operation modes.
6980 Exim provides read-only access via the LMDB C library.
6981 The library can be obtained from &url(https://github.com/LMDB/lmdb)
6982 or your operating system package repository.
6983 To enable LMDB support in Exim set LOOKUP_LMDB=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
6985 You will need to separately create the LMDB database file,
6986 possibly using the &"mdb_load"& utility.
6990 .cindex "linear search"
6991 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
6992 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
6993 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
6994 The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
6995 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
6996 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
6997 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
6998 in the file is used.
7000 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
7001 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
7002 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
7003 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
7004 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
7009 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
7010 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
7011 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
7012 wildcarding of any kind.
7014 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
7015 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
7016 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
7017 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
7018 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
7019 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
7020 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
7021 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
7022 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
7025 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
7026 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
7027 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
7028 The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
7029 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
7030 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
7031 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
7032 aliases; the full map names must be used.
7034 .subsection (n)wildlsearch
7035 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
7036 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
7037 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
7038 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
7039 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
7040 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
7041 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
7042 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
7043 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
7045 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
7046 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
7047 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
7048 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
7051 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
7053 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
7054 *fish data for anythingfish
7057 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
7058 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
7060 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
7062 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
7063 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
7064 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
7066 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
7068 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
7069 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
7070 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
7072 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
7075 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
7076 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
7077 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
7078 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
7079 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
7081 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
7082 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
7083 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
7084 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
7085 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
7088 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
7089 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
7090 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
7093 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
7095 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
7098 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
7099 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
7100 be followed by optional colons.
7102 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
7103 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
7104 lookup types support only literal keys.
7107 .cindex "spf lookup type"
7108 .cindex "lookup" "spf"
7109 If Exim is built with SPF support, manual lookups can be done
7110 (as opposed to the standard ACL condition method).
7111 For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
7114 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECTquerystylelookups"
7115 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
7116 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
7117 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
7118 many of them are given in later sections.
7121 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
7122 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
7123 This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
7124 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
7125 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
7128 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7129 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7130 This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
7133 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
7134 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7135 This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
7136 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
7137 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
7138 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
7139 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
7142 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7143 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7144 The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
7145 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7148 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7149 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7150 This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
7151 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
7154 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7155 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7156 The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
7157 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7160 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
7161 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
7162 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
7163 This is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
7164 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
7165 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
7166 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
7167 password value. For example:
7169 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
7173 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7174 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7175 The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
7176 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7179 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7180 .cindex lookup Redis
7181 The format of the query is either a simple get or simple set,
7182 passed to a Redis database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7185 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7186 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
7187 The format of the query is
7188 an SQL statement that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
7191 This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
7192 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
7195 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
7196 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
7197 &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
7198 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
7199 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
7200 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
7201 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
7202 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
7203 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
7205 require condition = \
7206 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
7208 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
7209 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
7210 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
7211 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
7215 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
7216 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
7217 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
7218 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
7219 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
7220 options such as a list of local domains.
7222 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
7223 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
7224 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
7225 or may give up altogether.
7229 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
7230 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
7231 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
7232 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7233 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
7234 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
7235 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
7236 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
7238 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
7239 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
7240 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
7242 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
7243 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
7244 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
7246 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
7247 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
7248 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
7249 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
7250 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
7251 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
7252 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
7253 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
7254 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
7255 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
7257 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
7259 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
7260 looks up these keys, in this order:
7266 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
7267 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
7268 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
7269 Exim move on to try the next key.
7273 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
7274 .cindex "partial matching"
7275 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
7276 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
7277 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7278 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
7279 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
7280 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
7281 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
7282 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
7283 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
7284 a key in a DBM file is
7286 *.dates.fict.example
7288 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
7289 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
7290 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
7293 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
7294 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
7295 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
7297 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
7298 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
7299 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
7300 partial matching keys
7301 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
7302 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
7303 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
7305 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
7306 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
7307 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
7308 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
7309 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
7310 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
7313 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
7314 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
7315 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
7316 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
7317 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
7318 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
7320 2250.dates.fict.example
7321 *.2250.dates.fict.example
7322 *.dates.fict.example
7325 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
7328 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
7329 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
7330 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
7331 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
7332 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
7333 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
7335 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
7337 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7338 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
7339 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
7340 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
7342 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
7344 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7345 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
7347 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
7348 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
7349 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
7352 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
7354 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
7355 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
7357 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
7358 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
7359 for &"*"& on its own.
7361 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
7365 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
7366 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
7367 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
7368 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
7369 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
7370 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
7371 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
7373 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
7374 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
7375 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
7376 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
7377 subject key is always followed by a dot.
7379 When the lookup is done from a string-expansion,
7380 the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild and non-wild parts of the key
7381 during the expansion of the replacement text.
7382 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
7387 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
7388 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
7389 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
7390 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
7391 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
7392 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
7393 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
7395 If an option &"cache=no_rd"& is used on the lookup then
7396 the cache is only written to, cached data is not used for the operation
7397 and a real lookup is done.
7399 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
7400 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
7401 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
7402 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
7403 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
7404 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
7406 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
7407 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
7413 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
7414 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
7415 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
7416 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
7417 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
7418 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
7422 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
7423 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
7425 [name="$local_part"]
7427 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
7428 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
7429 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
7430 of the following form is provided:
7432 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
7434 For example, the way to write the NIS+ query is
7436 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
7438 .cindex "tainted data" "in lookups"
7439 &*All*& tainted data used in a query-style lookup must be quoted
7440 using a mechanism appropriate for the lookup type.
7441 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
7442 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
7443 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
7448 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
7449 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
7450 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
7451 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
7452 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
7453 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
7454 an expansion string could contain:
7456 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
7458 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
7459 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
7460 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
7461 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
7463 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
7464 and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
7465 If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
7467 For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
7468 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
7469 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
7470 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
7471 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
7473 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
7475 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7476 white space is ignored.
7477 For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
7478 an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
7479 separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
7481 .cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7482 When the type is PTR,
7483 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
7484 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
7486 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
7488 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
7489 altered and nothing is added.
7491 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7492 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7493 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7494 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
7495 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
7496 The field separator can be modified as above.
7498 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7499 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7500 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
7501 unless a field separator is specified.
7502 To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
7504 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
7506 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
7507 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
7508 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
7510 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7511 white space is ignored.
7513 .cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7514 For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
7515 successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
7516 Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
7519 ${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
7522 .subsection "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" SECTdnsdb_mod
7523 .cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
7524 .cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
7525 .cindex "options" "dnsdb"
7526 Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
7527 each followed by a comma,
7528 that may appear before the record type.
7530 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
7531 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
7532 a defer-option modifier.
7533 The possible keywords are
7534 &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
7535 With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
7536 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
7537 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
7538 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
7539 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
7540 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
7542 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7543 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7545 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
7546 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
7548 .cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
7549 Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
7550 The possible keywords are
7551 &"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
7552 With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
7554 With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
7555 is not labelled as authenticated data
7556 is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
7557 The default is &"lax"&.
7559 See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
7561 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
7562 .cindex "DNS" timeout
7563 Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
7564 The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
7566 The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
7568 Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
7569 The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
7570 The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
7572 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
7573 .cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
7575 Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7576 The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7577 value of the set of returned DNS records.
7580 .subsection "Pseudo dnsdb record types" SECID66
7581 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7582 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7583 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7584 the pseudo-type MXH:
7586 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7588 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7591 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7592 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7593 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7594 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7595 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7596 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7597 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7598 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7600 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7601 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7603 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7604 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7605 the name servers for &%edu%&.
7607 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7608 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7609 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7610 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7611 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7614 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7615 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7616 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7617 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7618 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7619 result of a successful lookup such as:
7621 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7623 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7624 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7625 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7627 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7628 The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7629 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7630 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7632 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7636 .subsection "Multiple dnsdb lookups" SECID67
7637 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7638 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7639 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7640 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7642 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7643 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7644 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7646 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7647 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7648 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7649 case, it does not treat it as a list.
7651 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7652 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7653 different separator can be specified, as described above.
7658 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7659 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7660 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7661 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7662 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7663 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7664 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7665 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7666 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7667 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7668 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7669 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7671 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7672 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7673 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7674 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7675 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7677 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7678 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7680 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7681 the way they handle the results of a query:
7684 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7687 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7688 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7690 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7691 from all of them are returned.
7695 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7696 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7697 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7698 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7701 .subsection "Format of LDAP queries" SECTforldaque
7702 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7703 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in RFC 2255. For example, in
7704 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7706 data = ${lookup ldap \
7707 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7708 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7710 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7711 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7712 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7713 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7715 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7716 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7717 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7719 Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7720 controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7721 &_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7722 your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7723 &_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7724 certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7725 running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7726 methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7730 .subsection "LDAP quoting" SECID68
7731 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7732 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7733 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7734 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7735 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7737 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7738 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7746 in accordance with RFC 2254. The resulting string is then quoted according
7747 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7751 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7753 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7757 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7759 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7761 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7763 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7764 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7765 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7769 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7770 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in RFC 2253.) The resulting string
7771 is then quoted according to the rules for URLs. For example:
7773 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7777 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7779 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7781 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7783 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7784 authentication below.
7787 .subsection "LDAP connections" SECID69
7788 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7789 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7790 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7791 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7794 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7796 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7797 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7798 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7799 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7800 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7801 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7802 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7803 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7804 failures, and timeouts.
7806 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7807 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator (RFC 1738). Because
7808 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7809 doubled. For example
7811 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7813 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7814 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7815 the local host) is used.
7817 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7818 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7819 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7820 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7823 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7824 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7825 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7826 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7828 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7830 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7831 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7833 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7835 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7836 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7837 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7838 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7839 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7840 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7841 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7844 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7845 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7846 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7849 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7852 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7856 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7857 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7861 .subsection "LDAP authentication and control information" SECID70
7862 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7863 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7864 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7865 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7866 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7867 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7868 them. The following names are recognized:
7869 .itable none 0 0 2 20* left 80* left
7870 .irow DEREFERENCE "set the dereferencing parameter"
7871 .irow NETTIME "set a timeout for a network operation"
7872 .irow USER "set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind"
7873 .irow PASS "set the password, likewise"
7874 .irow REFERRALS "set the referrals parameter"
7875 .irow SERVERS "set alternate server list for this query only"
7876 .irow SIZE "set the limit for the number of entries returned"
7877 .irow TIME "set the maximum waiting time for a query"
7879 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7880 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7881 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7882 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7884 .cindex LDAP timeout
7885 .cindex timeout "LDAP lookup"
7886 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7887 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7888 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7889 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7890 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7891 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7892 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7893 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7894 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7896 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7897 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7899 The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7900 to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7901 default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7902 server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7903 different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7904 different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7905 alternate list (colon-separated).
7907 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7908 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7911 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7912 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7915 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7916 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7917 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7918 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7920 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7921 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7922 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7924 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7925 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it to the LDAP library.
7927 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7928 quoting has two advantages:
7931 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7932 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7934 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7937 For example, a setting such as
7939 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7941 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7943 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7944 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7945 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7946 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7950 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
7951 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
7956 .subsection "Format of data returned by LDAP" SECID71
7957 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
7958 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
7959 as a sequence of values, for example
7961 cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK
7963 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
7964 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
7965 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
7966 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
7967 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
7970 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
7971 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
7972 has multiple values, they are separated by commas. Any comma that is
7973 part of an attribute's value is doubled.
7975 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
7976 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
7977 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
7978 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
7979 Any commas in attribute values are doubled
7980 (permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
7981 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
7982 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
7983 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
7985 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
7986 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
7987 &%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
7988 &%attr2%& has only one value. Both attributes are derived from &%attr%&
7989 (they have SUP &%attr%& in their schema definitions).
7992 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
7995 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
7998 ldap:///o=base?attr?sub?(uid=fred)
7999 value1.1,value1,,2,value two
8001 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
8002 attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
8004 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
8005 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
8008 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
8009 results of LDAP lookups.
8010 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
8011 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
8012 The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
8013 of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
8014 The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
8015 comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
8020 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
8021 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
8022 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
8023 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
8024 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
8025 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
8026 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
8027 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
8029 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
8031 might return the string
8033 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
8034 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
8036 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
8038 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
8044 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
8045 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
8046 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
8050 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
8051 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
8052 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
8053 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
8054 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
8055 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
8056 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
8057 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
8058 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
8059 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
8060 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
8061 .cindex lookup Redis
8062 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, Redis,
8064 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
8067 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
8070 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
8071 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
8073 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
8078 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
8080 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
8081 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
8082 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
8086 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
8087 with a newline between the data for each row.
8090 .subsection "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase, and Redis" SECID72
8091 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
8092 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
8093 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
8094 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
8095 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
8096 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
8097 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
8098 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
8099 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
8100 .cindex lookup Redis
8101 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase or Redis lookups are used, the
8102 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, &%ibase_servers%&,
8103 or &%redis_servers%&
8104 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
8106 .oindex &%mysql_servers%&
8107 .oindex &%pgsql_servers%&
8108 .oindex &%oracle_servers%&
8109 .oindex &%ibase_servers%&
8110 .oindex &%redis_servers%&
8111 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL, the global option need not be set if all
8112 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
8113 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.)
8115 each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
8116 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
8117 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
8118 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
8120 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
8122 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
8123 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
8124 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
8126 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
8127 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
8129 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
8130 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
8131 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
8132 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
8133 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
8134 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
8136 For Redis the global option need not be specified if all queries contain their
8137 own server information &-- see section &<<SECTspeserque>>&.
8138 If specified, the option must be set to a colon-separated list of server
8140 Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of three items:
8141 host, database number, and password.
8143 The host is required and may be either an IPv4 address and optional
8144 port number (separated by a colon, which needs doubling due to the
8145 higher-level list), or a Unix socket pathname enclosed in parentheses
8147 The database number is optional; if present that number is selected in the backend
8149 The password is optional; if present it is used to authenticate to the backend
8152 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
8153 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
8154 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
8155 itself are escaped with backslashes.
8157 The &%quote_redis%& expansion operator
8158 escapes whitespace and backslash characters with a backslash.
8160 .subsection "Specifying the server in the query" SECTspeserque
8161 For MySQL, PostgreSQL and Redis lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
8162 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
8163 done by appending a comma-separated option to the query type:
8165 &`,servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&
8167 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
8169 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
8170 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
8171 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
8174 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
8176 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
8177 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
8178 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
8180 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
8181 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
8182 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
8185 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
8189 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
8191 ${lookup mysql,servers=master {UPDATE ...} }
8193 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
8194 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
8195 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
8197 ${lookup pgsql,servers=master/db/name/pw {UPDATE ...} }
8200 A now-deprecated syntax places the servers specification before the query,
8201 semicolon separated:
8203 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
8205 The new version avoids issues with tainted
8206 arguments explicitly expanded as part of the query.
8207 The entire string within the braces becomes tainted,
8208 including the server sepcification - which is not permissible.
8209 If the older sytax is used, a warning message will be logged.
8210 This syntax will be removed in a future release.
8212 &*Note*&: server specifications in list-style lookups are still problematic.
8215 .subsection "Special MySQL features" SECID73
8216 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
8217 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
8218 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses.
8219 An option group name for MySQL option files can be specified in square brackets;
8220 the default value is &"exim"&.
8221 The full syntax of each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
8223 <&'hostname'&>::<&'port'&>(<&'socket name'&>)[<&'option group'&>]/&&&
8224 <&'database'&>/<&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
8226 Any of the four sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
8227 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
8229 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
8232 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
8233 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
8235 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
8236 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
8237 is zero because no rows are affected.
8239 To get an encryted connection, use a Mysql option file with the required
8240 parameters for the connection.
8243 .subsection "Special PostgreSQL features" SECID74
8244 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
8245 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
8246 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
8247 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
8250 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
8252 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
8253 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
8254 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
8256 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
8257 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
8260 .subsection "More about SQLite" SECTsqlite
8261 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
8262 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
8263 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a filename is required in
8264 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
8265 daemon as in the other SQL databases.
8267 .oindex &%sqlite_dbfile%&
8268 There are two ways of
8269 specifying the file.
8270 The first is by using the &%sqlite_dbfile%& main option.
8271 The second, which allows separate files for each query,
8272 is to use an option appended, comma-separated, to the &"sqlite"&
8273 lookup type word. The option is the word &"file"&, then an equals,
8275 The filename in this case cannot contain whitespace or open-brace charachters.
8277 A deprecated method is available, prefixing the query with the filename
8278 separated by white space.
8280 .cindex "tainted data" "sqlite file"
8281 the query cannot use any tainted values, as that taints
8282 the entire query including the filename - resulting in a refusal to open
8285 In all the above cases the filename must be an absolute path.
8287 Here is a lookup expansion example:
8289 sqlite_dbfile = /some/thing/sqlitedb
8291 ${lookup sqlite {select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
8293 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
8295 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;\
8296 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
8298 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
8299 quote, which it doubles.
8301 .cindex timeout SQLite
8302 .cindex sqlite "lookup timeout"
8303 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
8304 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
8305 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
8306 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
8307 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
8308 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
8311 .subsection "More about Redis" SECTredis
8312 .cindex "lookup" "Redis"
8313 .cindex "redis lookup type"
8314 Redis is a non-SQL database. Commands are simple get and set.
8317 ${lookup redis{set keyname ${quote_redis:objvalue plus}}}
8318 ${lookup redis{get keyname}}
8321 As of release 4.91, "lightweight" support for Redis Cluster is available.
8322 Requires &%redis_servers%& list to contain all the servers in the cluster, all
8323 of which must be reachable from the running exim instance. If the cluster has
8324 master/slave replication, the list must contain all the master and slave
8327 When the Redis Cluster returns a "MOVED" response to a query, Exim does not
8328 immediately follow the redirection but treats the response as a DEFER, moving on
8329 to the next server in the &%redis_servers%& list until the correct server is
8336 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8337 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8339 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
8340 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
8341 "Domain, host, and address lists"
8342 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
8343 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
8344 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
8345 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
8346 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
8347 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
8349 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
8350 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
8351 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
8352 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
8354 Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
8355 support all the complexity available in
8356 domain, host, address and local part lists.
8360 .section "Results of list checking" SECTlistresults
8361 The primary result of doing a list check is a truth value.
8362 In some contexts additional information is stored
8363 about the list element that matched:
8366 A &%hosts%& ACL condition
8367 will store a result in the &$host_data$& variable.
8369 A &%local_parts%& router option or &%local_parts%& ACL condition
8370 will store a result in the &$local_part_data$& variable.
8372 A &%domains%& router option or &%domains%& ACL condition
8373 will store a result in the &$domain_data$& variable.
8375 A &%senders%& router option or &%senders%& ACL condition
8376 will store a result in the &$sender_data$& variable.
8378 A &%recipients%& ACL condition
8379 will store a result in the &$recipient_data$& variable.
8382 The detail of the additional information depends on the
8383 type of match and is given below as the &*value*& information.
8388 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECTlistexpand"
8389 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
8390 Each list is expanded as a single string before it is used.
8391 .cindex "tainted data" tracking
8392 &*Note*&: As a result, if any componend was tainted then the
8393 entire result string becomes tainted.
8395 &'Exception: the router headers_remove option, where list-item
8396 splitting is done before string-expansion.'&
8399 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
8400 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
8401 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
8402 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
8403 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
8406 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
8407 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
8408 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
8410 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
8411 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
8412 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
8413 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
8414 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
8416 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
8417 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
8419 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
8420 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
8421 senders based on the receiving domain.
8426 .subsection "Negated items in lists" SECID76
8427 .cindex "list" "negation"
8428 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
8429 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
8430 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
8431 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
8432 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
8433 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
8435 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
8436 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
8437 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
8438 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
8439 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
8441 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
8443 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
8444 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
8445 list is positive. However, if the setting were
8447 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
8449 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
8450 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
8451 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
8453 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
8454 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
8459 .subsection "File names in lists" SECTfilnamlis
8460 .cindex "list" "filename in"
8461 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute
8462 filename (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
8463 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
8464 filenames are not allowed,
8465 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
8466 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
8470 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
8471 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
8473 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
8474 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
8475 white space or the start of the line. For example:
8477 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
8481 Putting a filename in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
8482 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
8483 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
8484 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
8486 If a filename is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
8487 within the file is inverted. For example, if
8489 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
8491 and the file contains the lines
8496 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
8497 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
8501 .subsection "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" SECID77
8502 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
8503 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
8504 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
8505 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
8506 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
8507 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
8508 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
8510 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
8511 list, just give the filename on its own, without a search type, as described
8512 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
8513 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
8518 .subsection "Named lists" SECTnamedlists
8519 .cindex "named lists"
8520 .cindex "list" "named"
8521 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
8522 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
8523 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
8524 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
8525 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
8526 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
8527 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
8529 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
8531 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
8532 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
8533 configured with the line
8535 domains = +local_domains
8537 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
8538 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
8542 domains = ! +local_domains
8543 transport = remote_smtp
8546 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
8547 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
8548 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
8549 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
8551 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
8552 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
8554 A named list may refer to other named lists:
8556 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
8557 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
8558 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
8560 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
8561 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
8562 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
8564 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
8565 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
8567 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
8568 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
8569 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
8571 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
8573 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
8574 referenced lists if you can.
8576 .cindex "hiding named list values"
8577 .cindex "named lists" "hiding value of"
8578 Some named list definitions may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
8579 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
8580 line option to read these values, you can precede the definition with the
8581 word &"hide"&. For example:
8583 hide domainlist filter_for_domains = ldap;PASS=secret ldap::/// ...
8587 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
8588 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
8589 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
8591 domains = +local_domains
8593 on several of your routers
8594 or in several ACL statements,
8595 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
8596 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
8597 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
8598 the same each time they are referenced.
8600 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
8601 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
8602 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
8603 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
8607 .subsection "Named lists compared with macros" SECID78
8608 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
8609 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
8610 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
8611 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
8614 ALIST = host1 : host2
8615 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
8617 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
8619 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
8621 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
8624 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
8625 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
8627 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
8629 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
8633 .subsection "Named list caching" SECID79
8634 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
8635 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
8636 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
8637 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
8638 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
8639 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
8640 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
8641 message. For example:
8643 domainlist special_domains = \
8644 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
8646 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
8647 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
8648 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
8649 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
8650 same list each time.
8652 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
8653 cache the result anyway. For example:
8655 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
8657 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
8658 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
8662 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
8663 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
8664 .cindex "list" "domain list"
8665 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
8666 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
8669 .cindex "primary host name"
8670 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
8671 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
8672 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
8673 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
8674 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
8675 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
8676 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
8677 differ only in their names.
8679 The value for a match will be the primary host name.
8683 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
8684 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
8685 .cindex "domain literal"
8686 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
8687 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
8688 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
8689 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
8690 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
8691 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial;
8692 see the &%allow_domain_literals%& main option.
8694 The value for a match will be the string &`@[]`&.
8699 .cindex "@mx_primary"
8700 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
8701 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
8702 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
8703 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
8704 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
8705 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
8706 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
8707 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
8708 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
8709 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
8711 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
8712 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
8713 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
8714 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
8715 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
8717 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
8718 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
8719 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
8720 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
8721 on a router). For example:
8723 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
8725 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
8726 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
8728 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8729 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8730 contain negative items.
8732 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8733 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8734 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8736 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8737 an.other.domain : ...
8739 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8740 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8742 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8743 an.other.domain ? ...
8745 The value for a match will be the list element string (starting &`@mx_`&).
8749 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8750 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8751 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8752 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8753 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8754 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8755 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8756 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8757 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8760 The value for a match will be the list element string (starting with the asterisk).
8761 Additionally, &$0$& will be set to the matched string
8762 and &$1$& to the variable portion which the asterisk matched.
8765 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8766 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8767 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8768 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8769 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8770 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8771 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8772 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8773 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8775 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8776 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8777 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8778 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8779 expression by expansion, of course).
8781 The value for a match will be the list element string (starting with the circumflex).
8782 Additionally, &$0$& will be set to the string matching the regular expression,
8783 and &$1$& (onwards) to any submatches identified by parentheses.
8788 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8789 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8790 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8791 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8792 must be a filename in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8793 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8795 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8797 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8798 key. In most cases, the value resulting from the lookup is not used; Exim is interested
8799 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8800 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8801 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the value is preserved in the
8802 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8803 other statements in the same ACL.
8804 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
8805 .cindex "de-tainting" "using ACL domains condition"
8806 The value will be untainted.
8808 &*Note*&: If the data result of the lookup (as opposed to the key)
8809 is empty, then this empty value is stored in &$domain_data$&.
8810 The option to return the key for the lookup, as the value,
8811 may be what is wanted.
8815 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8816 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8818 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8820 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8821 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8824 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8825 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8826 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8827 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8828 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8829 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8833 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8834 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8835 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8836 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8838 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8839 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8841 In most cases, the value resulting from the lookup is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8842 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8843 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8844 &%domains%& option on a router, the value is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8845 variable and can be referred to in other options.
8846 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
8847 .cindex "de-tainting" "using router domains option"
8848 The value will be untainted.
8851 If the pattern starts with the name of a lookup type
8852 of either kind (single-key or query-style) it may be
8853 followed by a comma and options,
8854 The options are lookup-type specific and consist of a comma-separated list.
8855 Each item starts with a tag and and equals "=" sign.
8858 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8859 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8860 between the pattern and the domain.
8862 The value for a match will be the list element string.
8863 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
8864 Note that this is commonly untainted
8865 (depending on the way the list was created).
8866 Specifically, explicit text in the configuration file in not tainted.
8867 This is a useful way of obtaining an untainted equivalent to
8868 the domain, for later operations.
8870 However if the list (including one-element lists)
8871 is created by expanding a variable containing tainted data,
8872 it is tainted and so will the match value be.
8876 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8878 domainlist funny_domains = \
8881 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8882 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8883 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8884 nis;domains.byname : \
8885 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8887 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8888 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8889 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8890 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8891 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8896 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8897 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8898 .cindex "list" "host list"
8899 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8900 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8901 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8902 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8903 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8904 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8905 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8908 .subsection "Special host list patterns" SECID80
8909 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8910 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8911 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8912 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8913 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
8916 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
8917 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
8918 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
8922 .subsection "Host list patterns that match by IP address" SECThoslispatip
8923 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
8924 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
8925 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
8926 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
8927 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
8928 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
8931 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
8932 inspecting its IP address:
8935 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
8936 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
8937 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
8938 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
8939 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
8940 with the IP address of the subject host.
8942 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
8943 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
8944 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
8945 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
8946 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
8949 .cindex "@ in a host list"
8950 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
8951 domain name, as just described.
8954 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
8955 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
8956 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
8957 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
8958 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
8959 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
8960 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
8961 that can never match a client host.
8964 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
8965 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
8966 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
8967 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
8969 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
8973 .cindex "CIDR notation"
8974 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length, for
8979 , it is matched against the IP address of the subject
8980 host under the given mask. This allows an entire network of hosts to be
8981 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
8982 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
8983 significant end of the address.
8985 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
8986 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
8987 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
8988 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
8992 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
8993 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
8996 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
8998 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
8999 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
9001 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
9002 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
9005 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
9007 could make use of a file containing
9012 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
9013 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
9014 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
9016 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
9019 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
9025 .subsection "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
9027 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
9028 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
9029 address, the pattern takes this form:
9031 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
9035 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
9037 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
9038 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
9039 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
9040 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
9041 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
9042 returned by the lookup is not used.
9044 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
9045 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
9046 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
9047 patterns of this form:
9049 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
9053 net24-dbm;/networks.db
9055 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
9056 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
9057 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
9058 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
9059 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
9061 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
9062 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
9063 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
9064 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
9065 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
9066 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
9067 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
9068 converted using colons and not dots.
9069 In all cases except IPv4-mapped IPv6, full, unabbreviated IPv6
9070 addresses are always used.
9071 The latter are converted to IPv4 addresses, in dotted-quad form.
9073 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
9074 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
9075 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
9078 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
9079 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
9080 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
9081 case the IP address is used on its own.
9085 .subsection "Host list patterns that match by host name" SECThoslispatnam
9086 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
9087 .cindex "unknown host name"
9088 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
9089 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
9090 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
9091 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
9092 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
9095 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
9096 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
9097 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
9098 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
9099 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
9100 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
9101 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
9103 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
9104 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
9106 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
9107 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
9108 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
9109 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
9110 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
9111 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
9112 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
9113 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
9114 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
9116 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
9117 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
9119 .cindex "host" "alias for"
9120 .cindex "alias for host"
9121 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
9122 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
9125 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
9126 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
9127 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
9128 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
9129 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
9132 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
9133 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
9134 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
9135 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
9136 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
9137 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
9138 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
9143 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
9144 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
9145 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
9146 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
9147 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
9149 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
9151 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
9152 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
9153 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
9160 .subsection "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" SECTbehipnot
9161 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
9162 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
9163 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
9164 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
9165 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
9167 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
9168 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
9170 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
9171 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
9172 Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
9173 lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
9174 Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
9175 does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
9176 To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
9177 &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
9178 not recognized in an indirected file).
9181 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
9182 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
9184 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
9186 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
9187 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
9190 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
9191 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
9194 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
9197 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
9198 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
9199 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
9202 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
9203 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
9206 .subsection "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
9208 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
9210 This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
9211 as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
9212 wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
9215 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
9216 IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
9217 addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
9219 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
9221 The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
9222 left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
9223 without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
9224 a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
9225 pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
9226 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
9227 if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
9230 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
9231 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
9233 accept hosts = *.friend.example
9234 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
9236 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
9237 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
9238 &`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
9243 .subsection "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
9245 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
9246 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
9247 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
9248 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
9249 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
9250 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
9251 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
9252 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
9253 host lists such as whitelists.
9257 .subsection "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
9259 .cindex "unknown host name"
9260 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
9261 If a pattern is of the form
9263 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
9267 dbm;/host/accept/list
9269 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
9270 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
9273 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
9274 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
9275 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"&
9276 (see section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
9277 There is, however, no reason why you could not use
9278 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
9279 lookup, both using the same file.
9283 .subsection "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" SECID81
9284 If a pattern is of the form
9286 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
9288 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
9289 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
9290 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
9292 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
9293 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
9295 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
9296 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
9297 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
9300 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
9301 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
9302 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
9304 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
9305 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
9306 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
9307 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
9308 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
9309 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
9315 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
9316 .cindex "list" "address list"
9317 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
9318 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
9319 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
9320 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
9321 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
9322 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
9323 using this option setting:
9327 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
9328 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
9329 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
9330 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
9332 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
9335 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
9337 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
9338 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
9339 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
9340 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
9341 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
9342 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
9343 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
9345 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
9346 *@+hostile_domains:\
9347 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
9348 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
9350 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
9351 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
9352 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
9353 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
9354 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
9356 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
9357 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
9358 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
9359 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
9360 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
9362 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
9365 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
9366 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
9370 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
9371 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
9372 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
9373 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
9374 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
9375 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
9376 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
9378 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
9379 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
9381 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
9382 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
9385 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
9386 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
9387 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
9390 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
9391 mysql;select address from blocked where \
9392 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
9394 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
9395 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
9396 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
9397 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
9399 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
9400 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
9402 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
9403 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
9404 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
9405 default. For example, with this lookup:
9407 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
9409 the file could contains lines like this:
9411 user1@domain1.example
9414 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
9417 nimrod@jaeger.example
9421 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
9422 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
9424 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
9426 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
9427 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
9429 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
9430 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
9431 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
9435 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
9436 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
9441 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
9442 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
9443 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
9444 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
9445 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
9446 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
9447 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
9448 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
9449 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
9451 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
9452 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
9453 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
9454 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
9455 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
9458 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
9460 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
9462 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
9464 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
9466 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
9467 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
9468 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
9469 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
9470 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
9471 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
9473 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
9476 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
9479 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
9480 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
9481 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
9482 might have entries like
9484 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
9485 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
9488 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
9489 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
9490 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
9491 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
9493 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
9494 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
9495 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
9498 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
9499 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
9500 can only return a single list of local parts.
9503 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
9504 in these two examples:
9507 senders = *@+my_list
9509 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
9510 example it is a named domain list.
9515 .subsection "Case of letters in address lists" SECTcasletadd
9516 .cindex "case of local parts"
9517 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
9518 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
9519 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
9520 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
9521 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However, RFC 2505 (&'Anti-Spam
9522 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
9523 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
9524 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
9527 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
9528 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
9529 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
9530 the address list itself, in files included as plain filenames, and in any file
9531 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
9532 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
9533 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
9536 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
9537 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
9538 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
9539 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
9540 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
9541 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
9542 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
9543 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
9547 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
9548 .cindex "list" "local part list"
9549 .cindex "local part" "list"
9550 These behave in the same way as domain and host lists, with the following
9553 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
9554 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
9555 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
9556 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
9557 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
9558 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
9559 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
9560 option is case-sensitive from the start.
9562 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
9563 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
9564 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
9565 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
9566 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
9567 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
9568 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
9570 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
9575 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9576 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9578 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
9579 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
9580 Many strings in Exim's runtime configuration are expanded before use. Some of
9581 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
9583 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
9584 .cindex expansion "string concatenation"
9585 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
9586 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
9587 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
9588 escape character, as described in the following section.
9590 .cindex "tainted data" tracking
9591 If any porttion of the result string is tainted, the entire result is.
9593 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
9594 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
9595 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with † after
9596 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
9597 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
9599 .cindex "tainted data" expansion
9600 .cindex "tainted data" definition
9601 .cindex expansion "tainted data"
9602 and expansion of data deriving from the sender (&"tainted data"&)
9603 is not permitted (including acessing a file using a tainted name).
9605 Common ways of obtaining untainted equivalents of variables with
9607 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
9608 come down to using the tainted value as a lookup key in a trusted database.
9609 This database could be the filesystem structure,
9610 or the password file,
9611 or accessed via a DBMS.
9612 Specific methods are indexed under &"de-tainting"&.
9616 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
9617 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
9618 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
9619 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
9620 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
9621 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
9622 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
9623 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
9625 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
9626 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
9627 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
9628 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
9630 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
9632 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
9633 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
9638 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
9639 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
9640 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
9641 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
9642 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
9643 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
9644 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
9647 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
9648 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
9649 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
9652 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
9653 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
9654 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
9656 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
9657 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
9658 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
9659 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
9660 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
9661 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
9662 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
9665 When reading lines from the standard input,
9666 macros can be defined and ACL variables can be set.
9670 set acl_m_myvar = bar
9672 Such macros and variables can then be used in later input lines.
9674 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
9675 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
9676 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
9679 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
9680 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
9681 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a filename. The file is
9682 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
9684 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
9686 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
9687 Exim message identifier. For example:
9689 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
9691 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
9692 is therefore restricted to admin users.
9695 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
9696 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
9697 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
9698 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
9699 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
9700 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
9701 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
9702 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
9703 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
9704 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
9705 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
9706 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
9712 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
9713 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
9714 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
9715 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
9716 white space is significant.
9719 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
9720 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
9721 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
9726 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
9727 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
9728 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
9729 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
9730 given, the expansion fails.
9732 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9733 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9734 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
9735 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
9739 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
9740 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
9741 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
9742 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
9743 string easier to understand.
9745 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9746 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9747 expansion item below.
9750 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9751 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
9752 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
9753 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
9754 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
9755 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
9756 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
9757 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
9758 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
9759 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
9760 the result of the expansion.
9761 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
9762 the expansion result is an empty string.
9763 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
9766 .vitem "&*${authresults{*&<&'authserv-id'&>&*}}*&"
9767 .cindex authentication "results header"
9768 .chindex Authentication-Results:
9769 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
9770 This item returns a string suitable for insertion as an
9771 &'Authentication-Results:'&
9773 The given <&'authserv-id'&> is included in the result; typically this
9774 will be a domain name identifying the system performing the authentications.
9775 Methods that might be present in the result include:
9784 Example use (as an ACL modifier):
9786 add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
9788 This is safe even if no authentication results are available
9789 and would generally be placed in the DATA ACL.
9792 .vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
9793 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9794 .cindex "expansion" "extracting certificate fields"
9795 .cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
9796 .cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
9797 The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
9798 The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
9799 the certificate. Supported fields are:
9803 &`subject `& RFC4514 DN
9804 &`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
9809 &`subj_altname `& tagged list
9813 If the field is found,
9814 <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9815 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9816 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9817 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9819 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9820 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9823 Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
9825 The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
9826 output a Distinguished Name string which is
9828 parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
9829 (the exceptions being elements containing commas).
9830 RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
9831 a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
9832 result is a list (newline-separated by default).
9833 The separator may be changed by another modifier of
9834 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9835 Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
9837 The field selectors marked as "time" above
9838 take an optional modifier of "int"
9839 for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9840 Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9841 in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9843 The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9844 newline-separated by default,
9845 (embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9846 The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9847 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9849 The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9850 prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9851 Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9852 which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9853 if so the element tags are omitted.
9855 If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9857 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9858 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9860 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9861 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9865 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9866 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9867 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9869 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function.
9872 a local function that is to be called in this way,
9873 first &_DLFUNC_IMPL_& should be defined,
9874 and second &_local_scan.h_& should be included.
9875 The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9876 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9877 must have the following type:
9879 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9881 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9882 function should return one of the following values:
9884 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9885 into the expanded string that is being built.
9887 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9888 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9890 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9891 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9893 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9895 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9896 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9897 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
9900 .vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
9901 .cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
9902 .cindex "environment" "values from"
9903 The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
9905 This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
9906 If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
9907 and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
9909 Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9910 appear, for example:
9912 ${env{USER}{$value} fail }
9914 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9915 {<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9917 If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
9919 If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
9922 The environment is adjusted by the &%keep_environment%& and
9923 &%add_environment%& main section options.
9926 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9927 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9928 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
9929 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
9930 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9931 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9932 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9933 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9935 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
9938 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
9939 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
9940 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
9941 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
9942 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
9943 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9944 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9945 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9946 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9948 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9949 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9950 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
9953 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
9954 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
9956 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
9957 appear, for example:
9959 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
9961 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
9962 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
9964 .vitem "&*${extract json{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9965 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
9966 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
9967 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9968 .cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON object"
9969 .cindex JSON expansions
9970 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
9971 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
9972 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
9973 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
9975 { <&'"key1"'&> : <&'value1'&> , <&'"key2"'&> , <&'value2'&> ... }
9978 The braces, commas and colons, and the quoting of the member name are required;
9979 the spaces are optional.
9980 Matching of the key against the member names is done case-sensitively.
9981 For the &"json"& variant,
9982 if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
9984 For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
9985 leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
9986 . XXX should be a UTF-8 compare
9988 The results of matching are handled as above.
9991 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
9992 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9993 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
9994 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
9995 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
9996 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
9997 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
9998 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
9999 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
10000 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
10001 <&'string3'&> as before.
10003 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
10004 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
10005 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
10006 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
10007 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
10008 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
10009 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
10010 provided. For example:
10012 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
10016 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
10018 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
10019 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
10022 .vitem "&*${extract json {*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
10023 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
10024 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
10025 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
10026 .cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON array"
10027 .cindex JSON expansions
10028 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
10029 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
10031 Field selection and result handling is as above;
10032 there is no choice of field separator.
10033 For the &"json"& variant,
10034 if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
10036 For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
10037 leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
10040 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
10041 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
10042 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
10044 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10045 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10047 in this list, its value is placed in &$item$&, and then the condition is
10049 Any modification of &$value$& by this evaluation is discarded.
10050 If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
10051 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
10052 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
10053 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
10055 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}}
10057 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
10058 to what it was before.
10059 See also the &%map%& and &%reduce%& expansion items.
10062 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10063 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
10064 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10065 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
10066 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
10067 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
10069 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
10070 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
10071 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
10072 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10074 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10076 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
10077 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
10078 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
10079 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
10080 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
10082 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
10084 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
10085 letters appear. For example:
10087 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
10088 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
10089 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
10092 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
10093 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
10094 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
10095 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
10096 "&*$lheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
10097 &*$lh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
10098 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
10099 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
10100 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
10101 .vindex "&$header_$&"
10102 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
10103 .vindex "&$lheader_$&"
10104 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
10105 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
10106 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
10107 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
10108 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
10112 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
10113 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
10114 lines) may be present.
10116 The difference between the four pairs of expansions is in the way
10117 the data in the header line is interpreted.
10120 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
10121 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
10122 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
10125 .cindex "list" "of header lines"
10126 &%lheader%& gives a colon-separated list, one element per header when there
10127 are multiple headers with a given name.
10128 Any embedded colon characters within an element are doubled, so normal Exim
10129 list-processing facilities can be used.
10130 The terminating newline of each element is removed; in other respects
10131 the content is &"raw"&.
10134 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
10135 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
10136 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
10137 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
10138 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
10139 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
10140 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
10141 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
10144 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
10145 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
10146 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
10147 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
10148 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
10149 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
10152 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
10153 command of the following form:
10155 headers charset "UTF-8"
10157 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
10158 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
10159 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
10160 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
10161 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
10164 Header names follow the syntax of RFC 2822, which states that they may contain
10165 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
10166 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
10167 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
10169 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
10170 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
10171 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
10172 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
10173 router or transport are not accessible.
10175 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in
10176 ACLs that are obeyed before the data phase completes,
10177 because the header structure is not set up until the message is received.
10178 They are visible in DKIM, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
10179 Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
10180 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
10181 point they are added.
10182 When any of the above ACLs are
10183 running, however, header lines added by earlier ACLs are visible.
10185 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
10186 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
10187 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
10188 white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
10189 expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
10190 expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
10191 section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
10194 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
10195 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
10196 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
10197 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
10198 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
10199 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
10200 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
10201 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
10203 .cindex "tainted data" "message headers"
10204 When the headers are from an incoming message,
10205 the result of expanding any of these variables is tainted.
10208 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
10209 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
10211 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
10212 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
10213 RFC 2104. This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
10214 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
10215 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
10216 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
10217 present. For example:
10219 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
10221 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
10224 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
10226 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
10227 an Exim configuration:
10229 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
10231 In a router or a transport you could then have:
10234 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
10235 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
10236 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
10238 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
10239 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
10240 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
10241 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
10242 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example, by using the
10243 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
10246 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
10247 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
10248 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
10249 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
10250 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
10251 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
10253 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
10255 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
10256 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
10257 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
10258 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
10259 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
10261 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
10262 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
10263 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
10265 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
10269 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
10274 .vitem &*${imapfolder{*&<&'foldername'&>&*}}*&
10275 .cindex expansion "imap folder"
10276 .cindex "&%imapfolder%& expansion item"
10277 This item converts a (possibly multilevel, or with non-ASCII characters)
10278 folder specification to a Maildir name for filesystem use.
10279 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMDA>>&.
10283 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
10284 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10285 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10286 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
10287 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
10288 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
10289 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
10290 some of the braces:
10292 ${length_<n>:<string>}
10294 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> bytes or the whole
10295 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
10296 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
10297 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10300 .vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
10301 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
10302 .cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
10303 .cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
10304 .cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
10305 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
10306 apart from an optional leading minus,
10307 and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
10309 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10310 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10312 The first field of the list is numbered one.
10313 If the number is negative, the fields are
10314 counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
10315 The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
10316 then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
10318 If the modulus of the
10319 number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
10320 the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
10324 ${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
10328 ${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
10330 yields &"result: 42"&.
10332 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
10333 If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
10335 You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
10338 .vitem &*${listquote{*&<&'separator'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
10339 .cindex quoting "for list"
10340 .cindex list quoting
10341 This item doubles any occurrence of the separator character
10342 in the given string.
10343 An empty string is replaced with a single space.
10344 This converts the string into a safe form for use as a list element,
10345 in a list using the given separator.
10348 .vitem "&*${lookup&~{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
10349 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&" &&&
10350 "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
10351 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
10352 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
10353 .cindex "file" "lookups"
10354 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
10355 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
10356 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
10357 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
10358 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
10360 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
10361 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
10362 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
10363 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
10364 out by the system administrator.
10366 .vindex "&$value$&"
10367 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
10368 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
10369 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
10370 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
10371 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
10372 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
10373 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
10374 original lookup fails.
10376 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
10377 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
10378 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
10379 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
10380 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
10381 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
10382 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
10383 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
10385 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
10386 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
10387 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
10388 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
10390 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
10391 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
10392 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
10393 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
10395 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
10397 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
10399 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
10400 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
10402 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
10407 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
10408 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
10410 After expansion, <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10411 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10413 in this list, its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
10414 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
10415 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
10416 setting is not included in the output. For example:
10418 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
10420 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
10421 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &%filter%&
10422 and &%reduce%& expansion items.
10424 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10425 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10426 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10427 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10428 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10429 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10430 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10432 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10434 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
10435 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
10436 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
10437 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
10440 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
10442 returns the string &"6/33"&.
10446 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
10447 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
10448 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
10449 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
10450 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
10451 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
10452 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
10453 name of the subroutine, is nine.
10455 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
10456 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the entire expansion is
10457 forced to fail, in the same way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item
10458 does (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). Whatever you return is evaluated
10459 in a scalar context, thus the return value is a scalar. For example, if you
10460 return a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
10463 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
10464 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
10465 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
10467 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
10468 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10471 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
10472 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
10473 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
10474 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
10475 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
10476 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
10477 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
10478 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10480 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
10481 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
10482 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
10483 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
10484 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
10485 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
10486 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
10487 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
10488 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
10489 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
10491 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
10492 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
10493 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
10494 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
10496 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
10497 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
10498 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
10499 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
10500 is the expansion of the third argument.
10502 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
10503 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
10504 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10506 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
10507 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
10508 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
10509 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
10510 The filename and end-of-line (eol) string are first expanded separately. The file is
10511 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
10512 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
10513 newlines are left in the string.
10514 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
10515 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
10516 the string expansion fails.
10518 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
10519 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10523 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
10524 {*&<&'options'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
10525 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
10526 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
10527 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
10528 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
10529 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
10532 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
10533 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
10535 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
10536 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
10537 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
10538 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
10539 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
10542 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
10544 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
10545 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
10546 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
10547 (unless it is an empty string; no terminating NUL is ever sent)
10548 and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
10549 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
10550 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
10552 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
10555 The third argument is a list of options, of which the first element is the timeout
10556 and must be present if any options are given.
10557 Further elements are options of form &'name=value'&.
10560 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:shutdown=no}}
10563 The following option names are recognised:
10566 Defines if the result data can be cached for use by a later identical
10567 request in the same process.
10568 Values are &"yes"& or &"no"& (the default).
10569 If not, all cached results for this connection specification
10570 will be invalidated.
10574 Defines whether or not a write-shutdown is done on the connection after
10575 sending the request. Values are &"yes"& (the default) or &"no"&
10576 (preferred, eg. by some webservers).
10580 Controls the use of Server Name Identification on the connection.
10581 Any nonempty value will be the SNI sent; TLS will be forced.
10585 Controls the use of TLS on the connection.
10586 Values are &"yes"& or &"no"& (the default).
10587 If it is enabled, a shutdown as described above is never done.
10591 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
10592 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
10593 turns them into spaces:
10595 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
10597 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
10598 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
10599 addition, the following errors can occur:
10602 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
10604 Failure to connect the socket;
10606 Failure to write the request string;
10608 Timeout on reading from the socket.
10611 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
10612 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
10613 errors occurs. For example:
10615 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
10618 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
10619 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
10620 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
10621 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
10622 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
10624 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
10625 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10628 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10629 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
10630 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
10631 .vindex "&$value$&"
10633 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string. After expansion,
10634 <&'string1'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by default, but the
10635 separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10636 Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
10637 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
10638 list is assigned to &$item$&, in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
10639 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
10640 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
10641 added to the expansion output. The &%reduce%& expansion item can be used in a
10642 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
10644 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
10646 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
10649 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
10651 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
10652 restored to what they were before. See also the &%filter%& and &%map%&
10655 . A bit of a special-case logic error in writing an expansion;
10656 . probably not worth including in the mainline of documentation.
10657 . If only we had footnotes (the html output variant is the problem).
10660 . &*Note*&: if an &'expansion condition'& is used in <&'string3'&>
10661 . and that condition modifies &$value$&,
10662 . then the string expansions dependent on the condition cannot use
10663 . the &$value$& of the reduce iteration.
10666 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
10667 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
10668 expansion item in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
10670 .vitem "&*${run<&'options'&> {*&<&'command&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
10671 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
10672 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
10673 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
10674 This item runs an external command, as a subprocess.
10675 One option is supported after the word &'run'&, comma-separated
10676 and without whitespace.
10678 If the option &'preexpand'& is not used,
10679 the command string before expansion is split into individual arguments by spaces
10680 and then each argument is separately expanded.
10681 Then the command is run
10682 in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
10683 executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
10684 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
10685 The command name may not be tainted, but the remaining arguments can be.
10687 &*Note*&: if tainted arguments are used, they are supplied by a
10688 potential attacker;
10689 a careful assessment for security vulnerabilities should be done.
10691 If the option &'preexpand'& is used,
10692 the command string is first expanded as a whole.
10693 The expansion result is split apart into individual arguments by spaces,
10694 and then the command is run as above.
10695 Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
10696 which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
10697 simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
10698 script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
10699 variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
10700 quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
10701 in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
10702 around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
10703 variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
10705 Neither the command nor any argument may be tainted.
10707 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
10708 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
10709 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
10710 .vindex "&$value$&"
10711 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
10712 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
10713 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
10714 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
10715 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
10718 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
10719 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
10720 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
10721 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
10723 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
10724 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
10725 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
10728 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
10729 log_message = Output of id: $value
10731 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
10732 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
10734 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
10736 Note that &$value$& will not persist beyond the reception of a single message.
10738 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
10739 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
10740 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
10742 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
10743 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
10747 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
10748 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
10751 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
10752 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
10753 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
10754 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
10756 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
10757 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10760 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
10761 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
10762 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
10763 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
10764 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
10765 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
10766 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
10767 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
10769 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
10771 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
10772 if any $, } or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
10773 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
10775 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
10777 yields &"defabc"&, and
10779 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
10781 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
10782 the regular expression from string expansion.
10784 The regular expression is compiled in 8-bit mode, working against bytes
10785 rather than any Unicode-aware character handling.
10788 .vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
10789 .cindex sorting "a list"
10790 .cindex list sorting
10791 .cindex expansion "list sorting"
10792 After expansion, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a list, colon-separated by
10793 default, but the separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
10794 The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
10795 of a two-argument expansion condition.
10796 The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
10797 The comparison should return true when applied to two values
10798 if the first value should sort before the second value.
10799 The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
10800 the element being placed in &$item$&,
10801 to give values for comparison.
10803 The item result is a sorted list,
10804 with the original list separator,
10805 of the list elements (in full) of the original.
10809 ${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
10811 sorts a list of numbers, and
10813 ${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
10815 will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
10819 .vitem &*${srs_encode&~{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'return&~path'&>&*}{*&<&'original&~domain'&>&*}}*&
10820 SRS encoding. See SECT &<<SECTSRS>>& for details.
10824 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'start'&>&*}{*&<&'len'&>&*}{*&<&'subject'&>&*}}*&
10825 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10826 .cindex "substring extraction"
10827 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
10828 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10829 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10830 if <&'start'&> and <&'len'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10831 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10833 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<subject>}
10835 The second number is optional (in both notations).
10836 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
10839 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
10840 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
10841 length required. For example
10843 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
10845 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
10846 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
10847 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
10848 given offset. The first byte (character) in the string has offset zero.
10850 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
10851 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last byte (character) is offset -1,
10852 the second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
10854 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
10856 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
10857 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
10858 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
10860 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
10862 yields an empty string, but
10864 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
10868 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
10869 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all bytes (characters) in the
10870 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
10871 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
10874 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
10876 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
10878 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10882 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
10883 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
10884 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
10885 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
10886 This item does single-character (in bytes) translation on its subject string. The second
10887 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
10888 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
10889 replacement list. For example
10891 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
10893 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
10894 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
10895 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
10898 All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10904 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
10905 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
10906 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
10907 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
10908 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
10909 following operations can be performed:
10912 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10913 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10914 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
10915 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address, as it might appear in a
10916 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
10917 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
10919 The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
10922 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
10923 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
10924 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
10925 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in RFC
10926 2822 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
10927 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
10928 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
10929 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
10930 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
10932 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
10933 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
10934 character. For example:
10936 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
10938 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. The string is expanded
10939 first, so if the expanded string starts with >, it may change the output
10940 separator unintentionally. This can be avoided by setting the output
10941 separator explicitly:
10943 ${addresses:>:$h_from:}
10946 Compare the &%address%& (singular)
10947 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
10948 address. See the &%filter%&, &%map%&, and &%reduce%& items for ways of
10951 To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
10952 a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
10953 unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
10954 email address separator. For the example header line:
10956 From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
10958 The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
10959 properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
10960 It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
10961 example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
10962 de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
10963 The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
10964 quoted. The fourth example shows SMTPUTF8 handling.
10966 # exim -be '${addresses:From: \
10967 =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
10969 # exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
10970 Last:user@example.com
10971 # exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
10973 # exim -be '${addresses:フィル <フィリップ@example.jp>}'
10977 .vitem &*${base32:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10978 .cindex "&%base32%& expansion item"
10979 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10980 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10981 base 32 and output as a (empty, for zero) string of characters.
10982 Only lowercase letters are used.
10984 .vitem &*${base32d:*&<&'base-32&~digits'&>&*}*&
10985 .cindex "&%base32d%& expansion item"
10986 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
10987 The string must consist entirely of base-32 digits.
10988 The number is converted to decimal and output as a string.
10990 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
10991 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
10992 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
10993 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
10994 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
10995 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
10996 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive
10997 filenames), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just
10998 to be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
11000 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
11001 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
11002 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
11003 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
11004 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
11005 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
11008 .vitem &*${base64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11009 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
11010 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
11011 .cindex "&%base64%& expansion item"
11012 .cindex certificate "base64 of DER"
11013 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
11015 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11016 returns the base64 encoding of the DER form of the certificate.
11019 .vitem &*${base64d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11020 .cindex "expansion" "base64 decoding"
11021 .cindex "base64 decoding" "in string expansion"
11022 .cindex "&%base64d%& expansion item"
11023 This operator converts a base64-encoded string into the un-coded form.
11026 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11027 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
11028 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
11029 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the domain is extracted
11030 from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
11033 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11034 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
11035 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
11036 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
11037 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
11038 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
11039 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
11041 .vitem &*${escape8bit:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11042 .cindex "expansion" "escaping 8-bit characters"
11043 .cindex "&%escape8bit%& expansion item"
11044 If the string contains any characters with the most significant bit set,
11045 they are converted to escape sequences starting with a backslash.
11046 Backslashes and DEL characters are also converted.
11049 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11050 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
11051 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
11052 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
11053 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
11054 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
11055 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
11056 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
11057 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
11058 C programming language):
11060 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
11061 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
11062 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
11063 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
11064 .irow "" "and (&&)"
11066 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
11068 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
11069 space is permitted before or after operators.
11071 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
11072 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
11073 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
11074 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
11075 times, which often do have leading zeros.
11077 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
11079 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
11080 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
11083 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
11084 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
11085 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
11086 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
11087 &`${eval:0xc&5} `& yields 4
11088 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
11089 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
11090 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
11091 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
11092 &`${eval:~255&0x1234} `& yields 4608
11093 &`${eval:-(~255&0x1234)} `& yields -4608
11096 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
11100 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
11103 {$recipients_count} \
11104 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
11107 message = Too many bad recipients
11109 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
11110 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
11113 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11114 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
11115 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
11118 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
11120 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
11121 and then re-expands what it has found.
11124 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11126 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
11127 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
11128 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
11129 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
11130 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
11131 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
11132 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
11133 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
11134 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
11136 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
11137 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
11138 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
11139 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
11140 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
11141 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
11142 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
11145 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11146 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
11147 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
11148 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
11149 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
11150 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
11152 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
11154 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
11155 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
11159 .vitem &*${headerwrap_*&<&'cols'&>&*_*&<&'limit'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11160 .cindex header "wrapping operator"
11161 .cindex expansion "header wrapping"
11162 This operator line-wraps its argument in a way useful for headers.
11163 The &'cols'& value gives the column number to wrap after,
11164 the &'limit'& gives a limit number of result characters to truncate at.
11165 Either just the &'limit'& and the preceding underbar, or both, can be omitted;
11166 the defaults are 80 and 998.
11167 Wrapping will be inserted at a space if possible before the
11168 column number is reached.
11169 Whitespace at a chosen wrap point is removed.
11170 A line-wrap consists of a newline followed by a tab,
11171 and the tab is counted as 8 columns.
11175 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
11176 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
11177 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
11178 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
11179 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
11180 be useful for processing the output of the various hashing functions.
11184 .vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11185 .cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
11186 .cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
11187 This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
11188 escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
11189 as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example, a
11190 byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
11193 .vitem &*${ipv6denorm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11194 .cindex "&%ipv6denorm%& expansion item"
11195 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
11196 This expands an IPv6 address to a full eight-element colon-separated set
11197 of hex digits including leading zeroes.
11198 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
11199 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
11201 .vitem &*${ipv6norm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11202 .cindex "&%ipv6norm%& expansion item"
11203 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
11204 .cindex "IP address" "canonical form"
11205 This converts an IPv6 address to canonical form.
11206 Leading zeroes of groups are omitted, and the longest
11207 set of zero-valued groups is replaced with a double colon.
11208 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
11209 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
11212 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11213 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
11214 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
11215 .cindex "lower casing"
11216 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
11217 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
11218 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
11222 Case is defined per the system C locale.
11224 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11225 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
11226 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
11227 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
11228 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
11229 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
11231 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
11233 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
11234 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
11235 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
11236 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11239 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11240 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
11241 .cindex "list" "item count"
11242 .cindex "list" "count of items"
11243 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
11244 The string is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
11247 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
11248 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
11249 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
11250 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
11251 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
11252 If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
11253 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
11254 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
11255 matching list is returned.
11256 &*Note*&: Neither string-expansion of lists referenced by named-list syntax elements,
11257 nor expansion of lookup elements, is done by the &%listnamed%& operator.
11260 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11261 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
11262 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
11263 The string is interpreted as an RFC 2822 address and the local part is
11264 extracted from it. If the string does not parse successfully, the result is
11266 The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
11269 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*& &&&
11270 &*${mask_n:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
11271 .cindex "masked IP address"
11272 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
11273 .cindex "CIDR notation"
11274 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
11275 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
11276 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
11277 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
11278 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
11279 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
11280 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
11282 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
11284 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&.
11286 Since this operation is expected to
11287 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the
11290 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
11291 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
11293 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
11297 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
11299 If the optional form &*mask_n*& is used, IPv6 address result are instead
11300 returned in normailsed form, using colons and with zero-compression.
11301 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
11304 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11306 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
11307 .cindex certificate fingerprint
11308 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
11309 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
11310 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
11312 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11313 returns the MD5 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
11316 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11317 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
11318 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
11319 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
11320 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
11321 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
11323 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
11325 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
11328 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11329 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
11330 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
11331 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
11332 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
11333 is an empty string or
11334 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
11335 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
11336 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
11337 respectively For example,
11345 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
11346 variable or a message header.
11348 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11349 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
11350 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
11351 required to do so by the rules of RFC 2822 for quoting local parts. For
11352 example, a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
11353 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
11354 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
11356 This quoting determination is not SMTPUTF8-aware, thus quoting non-ASCII data
11357 will likely use the quoting form.
11358 Thus &'${quote_local_part:フィル}'& will always become &'"フィル"'&.
11361 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11362 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
11363 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
11364 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
11365 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
11367 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
11373 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
11374 yields an unchanged string.
11377 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
11378 .cindex "random number"
11379 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
11380 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
11381 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
11382 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
11383 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
11384 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
11385 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
11386 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
11390 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
11391 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
11392 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
11393 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
11394 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
11395 for DNS. For example,
11397 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
11398 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
11403 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
11407 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11408 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
11409 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
11410 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
11411 This operator encodes text according to the rules of RFC 2047. This is an
11412 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
11413 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
11414 &%headers_charset%& option, which gets its default at build time. If the string
11415 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
11418 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
11420 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
11421 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
11425 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11426 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
11427 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
11428 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
11429 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per RFC 2047. Binary zero
11430 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
11431 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
11432 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
11434 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
11435 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
11436 to use this operator as well.
11440 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11441 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
11442 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
11443 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
11444 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
11445 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
11446 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
11449 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11450 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
11451 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
11452 .cindex certificate fingerprint
11453 .cindex "&%sha1%& expansion item"
11454 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
11455 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11457 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11458 returns the SHA-1 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
11461 .vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11462 &*${sha2:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11463 &*${sha2_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11464 .cindex "SHA-256 hash"
11465 .cindex "SHA-2 hash"
11466 .cindex certificate fingerprint
11467 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
11468 .cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
11469 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
11470 The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash value of the string
11472 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11474 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11475 returns the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
11477 The operator can also be spelled &%sha2%& and does the same as &%sha256%&
11478 (except for certificates, which are not supported).
11479 Finally, if an underbar
11480 and a number is appended it specifies the output length, selecting a
11481 member of the SHA-2 family of hash functions.
11482 Values of 256, 384 and 512 are accepted, with 256 being the default.
11485 .vitem &*${sha3:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11486 &*${sha3_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11487 .cindex "SHA3 hash"
11488 .cindex "expansion" "SHA3 hashing"
11489 .cindex "&%sha3%& expansion item"
11490 The &%sha3%& operator computes the SHA3-256 hash value of the string
11492 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11494 If a number is appended, separated by an underbar, it specifies
11495 the output length. Values of 224, 256, 384 and 512 are accepted;
11496 with 256 being the default.
11498 The &%sha3%& expansion item is only supported if Exim has been
11499 compiled with GnuTLS 3.5.0 or later,
11500 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later.
11501 The macro "_CRYPTO_HASH_SHA3" will be defined if it is supported.
11504 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11505 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
11506 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
11507 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
11508 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
11509 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
11510 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
11511 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
11512 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
11513 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
11514 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
11515 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
11516 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
11518 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
11519 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
11520 systems for files larger than 2GB.
11522 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11523 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
11524 Now deprecated, a synonym for the &%base64%& expansion operator.
11528 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11529 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
11530 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
11531 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
11532 The item is replaced by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
11533 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
11534 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11537 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11538 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
11539 .cindex "substring extraction"
11540 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
11541 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
11542 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
11543 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
11545 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
11547 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
11548 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
11549 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11551 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11552 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
11553 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
11554 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
11557 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11558 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
11559 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
11560 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
11561 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
11562 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
11565 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11566 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
11567 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
11568 .cindex "upper casing"
11569 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
11570 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
11571 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
11572 Case is defined per the system C locale.
11574 .vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11575 .cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
11576 .cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
11577 .cindex "incorrect utf-8"
11578 .cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
11579 .cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
11580 This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
11581 In versions of Exim before 4.92, this did not correctly do so for a truncated
11582 final codepoint's encoding, and the character would be silently dropped.
11583 If you must handle detection of this scenario across both sets of Exim behavior,
11584 the complexity will depend upon the task.
11585 For instance, to detect if the first character is multibyte and a 1-byte
11586 extraction can be successfully used as a path component (as is common for
11587 dividing up delivery folders), you might use:
11589 condition = ${if inlist{${utf8clean:${length_1:$local_part}}}{:?}{yes}{no}}
11591 (which will false-positive if the first character of the local part is a
11592 literal question mark).
11594 .vitem "&*${utf8_domain_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11595 "&*${utf8_domain_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11596 "&*${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11597 "&*${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&"
11598 .cindex expansion UTF-8
11599 .cindex UTF-8 expansion
11601 .cindex internationalisation
11602 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11603 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11604 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11605 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11606 These convert EAI mail name components between UTF-8 and a-label forms.
11607 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
11610 .vitem &*${xtextd:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11611 .cindex "text forcing in strings"
11612 .cindex "string" "xtext decoding"
11614 .cindex "&%xtextd%& expansion item"
11615 This performs xtext decoding of the string (per RFC 3461 section 4).
11626 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
11627 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
11628 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
11629 while expanding strings:
11632 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
11633 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
11634 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
11635 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
11638 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11639 .cindex "numeric comparison"
11640 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
11641 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
11643 .itable none 0 0 2 10* left 90* left
11645 .irow "== " "equal"
11646 .irow "> " "greater"
11647 .irow ">= " "greater or equal"
11649 .irow "<= " "less or equal"
11653 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
11655 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
11656 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
11657 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
11658 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
11659 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
11662 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
11663 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
11664 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
11667 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
11668 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
11669 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
11670 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
11671 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
11672 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
11673 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
11674 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
11675 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
11676 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
11677 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
11678 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
11679 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
11680 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
11682 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11683 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11684 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
11685 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
11686 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
11687 (case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
11689 An empty string is treated as false.
11690 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
11691 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
11692 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
11694 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
11695 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
11698 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
11702 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11703 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11704 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
11705 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
11706 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
11707 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
11708 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
11709 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
11711 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
11713 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11714 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
11715 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
11716 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
11717 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
11718 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
11719 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
11720 included in the binary.
11722 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
11723 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
11724 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
11725 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
11726 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
11727 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
11728 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
11729 string in LDAP form is:
11731 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
11733 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
11734 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
11736 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
11738 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
11743 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
11744 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11745 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11746 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
11747 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
11748 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
11752 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
11753 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11754 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11755 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
11756 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
11757 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
11760 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
11761 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
11762 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
11763 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
11764 whatever its length.
11767 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
11768 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
11769 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
11770 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
11772 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
11773 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
11774 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
11775 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
11776 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
11777 support &[crypt16()]&.
11779 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
11780 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
11781 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
11782 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
11783 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
11785 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
11786 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
11787 Exim is seen as very low priority.
11789 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
11790 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
11791 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
11792 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
11793 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
11795 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
11796 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
11797 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
11798 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
11799 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
11800 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
11802 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
11804 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
11805 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
11807 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
11808 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
11809 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
11810 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
11811 exists in the message. For example,
11813 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
11815 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
11816 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
11818 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11819 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11820 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11821 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11822 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
11823 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
11824 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
11825 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
11826 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent, where
11827 case is defined per the system C locale.
11829 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
11830 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
11831 .cindex "file" "existence test"
11832 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
11833 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
11834 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
11835 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
11836 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
11838 &*Note:*& Testing a path using this condition is not a sufficient way of
11840 Consider using a dsearch lookup.
11842 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
11843 .cindex "delivery" "first"
11844 .cindex "first delivery"
11845 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
11846 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
11847 .cindex retry condition
11848 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
11849 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
11852 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11853 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11854 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11855 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
11856 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
11858 These conditions iterate over a list. The first argument is expanded to form
11859 the list. By default, the list separator is a colon, but it can be changed by
11860 the normal method (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
11861 The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
11862 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
11863 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
11865 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
11866 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
11867 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
11869 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
11870 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
11871 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
11873 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
11874 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
11875 that the condition must be false for at least one item.
11879 ${if forany{$recipients_list}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
11881 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &%forany%& or &%forall%& is
11882 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
11884 To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
11886 .vitem "&*forall_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11887 "&*forany_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11888 "&*forall_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11889 "&*forany_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11890 .cindex JSON "iterative conditions"
11891 .cindex JSON expansions
11892 .cindex expansion "&*forall_json*& condition"
11893 .cindex expansion "&*forany_json*& condition"
11894 .cindex expansion "&*forall_jsons*& condition"
11895 .cindex expansion "&*forany_jsons*& condition"
11896 As for the above, except that the first argument must, after expansion,
11898 The array separator is not changeable.
11899 For the &"jsons"& variants the elements are expected to be JSON strings
11900 and have their quotes removed before the evaluation of the condition.
11904 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11905 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11906 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11907 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11908 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
11909 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
11910 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11911 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
11912 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
11914 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11916 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11917 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11918 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11919 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11920 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
11921 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
11922 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
11923 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
11924 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
11926 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
11929 .vitem &*inbound_srs&~{*&<&'local&~part'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}*&
11930 SRS decode. See SECT &<<SECTSRS>>& for details.
11933 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'list'&>&*}*& &&&
11934 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'list'&>&*}*&
11935 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11936 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11937 Both strings are expanded; the second string is treated as a list of simple
11938 strings; if the first string is a member of the second, then the condition
11940 For the case-independent &%inlisti%& condition, case is defined per the system C locale.
11942 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
11943 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
11945 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
11946 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
11947 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
11948 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
11951 The variable &$value$& will be set for a successful match and can be
11952 used in the success clause of an &%if%& expansion item using the condition.
11953 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
11954 .cindex "de-tainting" "using an inlist expansion condition"
11955 It will have the same taint status as the list; expansions such as
11957 ${if inlist {$h_mycode:} {0 : 1 : 42} {$value}}
11959 can be used for de-tainting.
11960 Any previous &$value$& is restored after the if.
11963 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11964 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11965 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11966 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
11967 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
11968 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
11969 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
11970 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
11971 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
11972 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
11973 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
11975 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
11976 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
11977 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
11978 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
11979 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
11981 &*Note*&: The checks used to be just on the form of the address; actual numerical
11982 values were not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passed the IPv4
11984 This is no longer the case.
11986 The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
11987 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
11989 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
11991 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
11993 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
11994 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
11995 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
11996 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
11997 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
11998 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
11999 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
12000 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
12001 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
12002 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
12003 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
12004 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
12005 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
12009 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
12010 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12011 .cindex "string" "comparison"
12012 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
12013 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
12014 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
12015 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
12016 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
12017 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
12019 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
12021 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
12022 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12023 .cindex "string" "comparison"
12024 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
12025 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
12026 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
12027 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
12028 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
12029 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
12031 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
12034 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12035 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
12036 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
12037 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
12038 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
12039 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
12040 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
12041 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
12042 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
12043 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
12044 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
12047 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
12049 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
12050 backslashes is also required.
12052 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
12053 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
12054 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
12055 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
12056 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
12057 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
12058 All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware,
12059 but we might change this in a future Exim release.
12061 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
12062 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
12063 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
12064 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
12065 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
12066 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
12067 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
12068 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
12070 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12071 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
12072 See &*match_local_part*&.
12074 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12075 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
12076 See &*match_local_part*&.
12078 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12079 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
12080 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
12081 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
12082 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
12083 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
12085 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
12087 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
12090 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
12092 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
12094 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
12095 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
12096 in a single test such as
12097 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
12098 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
12099 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
12100 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
12102 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
12104 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
12106 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
12108 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists
12109 (see section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&),
12110 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
12111 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
12112 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
12113 masks. For example:
12115 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
12117 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
12118 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
12119 address mask, for example:
12121 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
12123 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
12124 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
12126 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
12130 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
12131 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
12133 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
12135 The variable &$value$& will be set for a successful match and can be
12136 used in the success clause of an &%if%& expansion item using the condition.
12137 Any previous &$value$& is restored after the if.
12139 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12140 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
12141 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
12142 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
12143 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
12144 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
12145 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
12146 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
12149 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
12151 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
12152 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument
12153 is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
12154 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
12156 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
12158 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
12159 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
12160 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items to
12161 have their local parts matched casefully. Domains are always matched
12164 The variable &$value$& will be set for a successful match and can be
12165 used in the success clause of an &%if%& expansion item using the condition.
12166 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
12167 .cindex "de-tainting" "using a match_local_part expansion condition"
12168 It will have the same taint status as the list; expansions such as
12170 ${if match_local_part {$local_part} {alice : bill : charlotte : dave} {$value}}
12172 can be used for de-tainting.
12173 Any previous &$value$& is restored after the if.
12175 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
12176 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
12178 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
12179 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
12180 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
12181 matched using &%match_ip%&.
12183 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
12184 .cindex "PAM authentication"
12185 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
12186 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
12187 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
12188 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
12189 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
12190 (&url(https://mirrors.edge.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
12191 available in Solaris
12192 and in some GNU/Linux distributions.
12193 The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
12194 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
12198 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
12199 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
12201 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
12202 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
12203 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
12204 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
12205 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
12206 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
12207 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
12209 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
12210 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
12212 The &%listquote%& expansion item can be used for this.
12213 For example, the configuration
12214 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
12216 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${listquote{:}{$auth2}}}}
12218 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
12219 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
12220 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
12221 . --- 2018-09-07: the pam_exim modified variant has gone, removed claims re using Exim via that
12224 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12225 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
12227 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
12228 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
12229 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
12230 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
12231 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
12232 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
12234 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
12235 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
12236 building Exim. For example:
12238 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
12240 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
12241 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
12242 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
12243 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
12245 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
12246 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
12247 configuration, you might have this:
12249 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
12251 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
12253 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
12255 .vitem &*queue_running*&
12256 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
12257 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
12258 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
12259 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
12260 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
12263 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
12265 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
12266 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
12267 Radius authentication (RFC 2865) is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
12268 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
12269 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
12272 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
12273 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
12274 this library, you need to set
12276 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
12278 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
12279 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
12281 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
12283 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
12284 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
12285 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
12287 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
12288 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
12289 the authentication is successful. For example:
12291 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
12295 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
12296 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
12297 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
12299 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
12300 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
12301 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
12302 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
12303 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
12304 by a process that is not running as root.
12306 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
12307 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
12308 building Exim. For example:
12310 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
12312 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
12313 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
12314 from the Cyrus SASL library.
12316 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
12317 two are mandatory. For example:
12319 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
12321 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
12322 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
12323 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
12328 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
12329 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
12330 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
12331 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
12332 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
12333 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
12334 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
12338 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
12339 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
12340 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
12341 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
12342 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
12345 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
12347 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
12348 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
12349 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
12351 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
12352 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
12353 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
12354 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
12355 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
12356 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
12357 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
12358 parsed but not evaluated.
12360 .ecindex IIDexpcond
12365 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
12366 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
12367 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
12368 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
12369 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
12370 .cindex "tainted data"
12371 Variables marked as &'tainted'& are likely to carry data supplied by
12372 a potential attacker.
12373 Variables without such marking may also, depending on how their
12374 values are created.
12375 Such variables should not be further expanded,
12377 or used as command-line arguments for external commands.
12380 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
12381 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
12382 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
12383 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
12384 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
12385 In the expansion condition case
12386 they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
12387 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
12388 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
12389 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
12390 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
12391 matching condition.
12392 If the subject string was tainted then any captured substring will also be.
12394 .vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
12395 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
12396 any arguments are copied to these variables,
12397 any unused variables being made empty.
12399 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
12400 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
12401 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
12402 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
12403 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
12404 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
12405 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
12406 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
12407 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
12408 during subsequent delivery.
12410 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
12411 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
12412 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
12413 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
12414 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
12415 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
12416 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
12417 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
12420 .vitem &$acl_narg$&
12421 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
12422 this variable has the number of arguments.
12424 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
12425 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
12426 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
12427 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers of the verb.
12428 The message can be preserved by coding like this:
12430 warn !verify = sender
12431 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
12433 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
12434 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
12436 &*Note*&: The variable is cleared at the end of processing the ACL verb.
12438 .vitem &$address_data$&
12439 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
12440 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
12441 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
12442 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
12443 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
12444 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
12447 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
12448 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
12449 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
12450 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
12451 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
12452 from the child's routing.
12454 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12455 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
12456 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
12459 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
12460 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
12461 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
12463 .vitem &$address_file$&
12464 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
12465 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
12466 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
12467 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
12468 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
12470 /home/r2d2/savemail
12472 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
12473 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
12474 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
12475 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
12476 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
12477 to the relevant file.
12479 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
12480 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
12481 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
12482 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
12484 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth4$&"
12485 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
12486 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
12487 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPtlsauth>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
12489 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
12490 .cindex "authentication" "id"
12491 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
12492 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
12493 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
12494 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
12495 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
12496 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
12497 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
12499 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
12500 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
12501 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
12502 command line option.
12503 This second case also sets up information used by the
12504 &$authresults$& expansion item.
12506 .vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
12507 .cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
12508 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
12509 When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
12510 will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
12511 id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
12512 available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
12513 A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
12514 authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
12518 .tvar &$authenticated_sender$&
12519 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
12520 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
12521 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
12522 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
12523 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
12524 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
12525 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
12526 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
12527 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
12529 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12530 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
12531 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
12532 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
12533 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
12536 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
12537 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
12538 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
12539 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
12540 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
12541 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
12542 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
12543 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
12544 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&).
12545 Failure includes cancellation of a authentication attempt,
12546 and any negative response to an AUTH command,
12547 (including, for example, an attempt to use an undefined mechanism).
12549 .vitem &$av_failed$&
12550 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
12551 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
12552 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
12553 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
12554 the ACL malware condition.
12556 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
12557 .cindex "message body" "line count"
12558 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
12559 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
12560 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12561 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
12563 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
12564 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
12565 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
12566 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12567 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
12568 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12569 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
12571 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
12572 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
12573 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
12574 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
12575 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12577 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
12578 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
12579 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
12580 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
12581 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12583 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
12584 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
12585 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12586 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12587 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
12588 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12589 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
12591 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
12592 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
12593 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12594 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12595 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
12596 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12597 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
12599 .vitem &$callout_address$&
12600 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
12601 After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
12602 address that was connected to.
12604 .vitem &$compile_number$&
12605 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
12606 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
12607 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
12608 compilations of the same version of Exim.
12610 .vitem &$config_dir$&
12611 .vindex "&$config_dir$&"
12612 The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
12613 &$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
12614 contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
12615 &$config_dir$& is ".".
12617 .vitem &$config_file$&
12618 .vindex "&$config_file$&"
12619 The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
12621 .vitem &$connection_id$&
12622 .vindex "&$connection_id$&"
12623 .cindex connection "identifier logging"
12624 An identifier for the accepted connection, for use in custom logging.
12626 .vitem &$dkim_verify_status$&
12627 Results of DKIM verification.
12628 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12630 .vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
12631 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
12632 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
12633 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
12634 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
12636 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
12637 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
12638 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
12639 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
12640 &$dkim_created$& &&&
12641 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
12642 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
12643 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
12644 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
12645 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
12646 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
12647 &$dkim_key_notes$& &&&
12648 &$dkim_key_length$&
12649 These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
12650 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12652 .vitem &$dkim_signers$&
12653 .vindex &$dkim_signers$&
12654 When a message has been received this variable contains
12655 a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
12656 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12658 .vitem &$dmarc_domain_policy$& &&&
12659 &$dmarc_status$& &&&
12660 &$dmarc_status_text$& &&&
12661 &$dmarc_used_domains$&
12662 Results of DMARC verification.
12663 For details see section &<<SECDMARC>>&.
12665 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
12666 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
12667 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
12669 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
12670 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
12671 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
12672 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
12673 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
12674 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
12675 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
12676 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
12677 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
12680 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
12681 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
12682 case for &$domain$&.
12684 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12685 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
12686 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
12687 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
12689 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
12690 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
12691 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
12692 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
12693 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
12694 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
12696 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
12697 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
12698 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
12700 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
12703 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
12704 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
12705 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
12706 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
12707 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
12708 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
12709 the &(smtp)& transport.
12712 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12713 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
12714 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
12715 rewrite domains by file lookup.
12718 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
12719 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
12720 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
12721 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
12722 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
12723 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
12726 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
12727 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
12728 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
12729 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
12732 .cindex "tainted data"
12733 If the origin of the data is an incoming message,
12734 the result of expanding this variable is tainted and may not
12735 be further expanded or used as a filename.
12736 When an untainted version is needed, one should be obtained from
12737 looking up the value in a local (therefore trusted) database.
12738 Often &$domain_data$& is usable in this role.
12741 .vitem &$domain_data$&
12742 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
12743 When the &%domains%& condition on a router
12746 against a list, the match value is copied to &$domain_data$&.
12747 This is an enhancement over previous versions of Exim, when it only
12748 applied to the data read by a lookup.
12749 For details on match values see section &<<SECTlistresults>>& et. al.
12751 If the router routes the
12752 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
12753 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
12756 &$domain_data$& set in an ACL is available during
12757 the rest of the ACL statement.
12759 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
12760 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
12761 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
12763 .vitem &$exim_path$&
12764 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
12765 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
12767 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
12768 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
12769 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
12771 .vitem &$exim_version$&
12772 .vindex "&$exim_version$&"
12773 This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
12774 The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
12775 Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
12776 There may be other characters following the minor version.
12777 This value may be overridden by the &%exim_version%& main config option.
12779 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
12781 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
12782 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
12783 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
12784 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
12785 See the full description in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
12787 .vitem &$headers_added$&
12788 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
12789 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
12790 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
12791 The headers are a newline-separated list.
12795 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
12796 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
12797 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
12798 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
12799 by a setting on the transport itself.
12801 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
12802 of the environment variable HOME, which is subject to the
12803 &%keep_environment%& and &%add_environment%& main config options.
12807 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
12808 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
12809 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
12810 to local and remote transports.
12812 .cindex "transport" "filter"
12813 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12814 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
12815 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
12816 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
12817 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
12818 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
12821 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
12822 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
12823 client is connected.
12826 .vitem &$host_address$&
12827 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
12828 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
12829 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
12830 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
12832 .vitem &$host_data$&
12833 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
12834 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
12835 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
12836 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
12838 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
12839 message = $host_data
12842 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
12843 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
12844 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
12845 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
12846 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
12847 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
12848 variables is set to &"1"&.
12851 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
12852 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
12855 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
12856 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
12857 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
12860 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
12861 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
12862 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
12863 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
12864 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
12865 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
12866 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
12867 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
12868 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
12869 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
12871 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
12872 Performing these checks sets up information used by the
12873 &%authresults%& expansion item.
12876 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
12877 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
12878 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
12880 .vitem &$host_port$&
12881 .vindex "&$host_port$&"
12882 This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
12883 for an outbound connection.
12885 .vitem &$initial_cwd$&
12886 .vindex "&$initial_cwd$&
12887 This variable contains the full path name of the initial working
12888 directory of the current Exim process. This may differ from the current
12889 working directory, as Exim changes this to "/" during early startup, and
12890 to &$spool_directory$& later.
12893 .vindex "&$inode$&"
12894 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
12895 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
12896 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
12897 a unique name for the file.
12899 .vitem &$interface_address$& &&&
12901 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
12902 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
12903 These are obsolete names for &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
12907 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
12908 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
12909 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
12913 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
12914 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
12915 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
12918 .vitem &$load_average$&
12919 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
12920 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
12921 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
12922 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
12924 .tvar &$local_part$&
12925 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
12926 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
12927 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
12928 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
12930 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12931 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
12932 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
12933 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
12936 .cindex "tainted data"
12937 If the origin of the data is an incoming message,
12938 the result of expanding this variable is tainted and
12939 may not be further expanded or used as a filename.
12941 &*Warning*&: the content of this variable is usually provided by a potential
12943 Consider carefully the implications of using it unvalidated as a name
12945 This presents issues for users' &_.forward_& and filter files.
12946 For traditional full user accounts, use &%check_local_users%& and the
12947 &$local_part_data$& variable rather than this one.
12948 For virtual users, store a suitable pathname component in the database
12949 which is used for account name validation, and use that retrieved value
12950 rather than this variable.
12951 Often &$local_part_data$& is usable in this role.
12952 If needed, use a router &%address_data%& or &%set%& option for
12953 the retrieved data.
12955 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
12956 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
12957 the parent address, not to the filename or command (see &$address_file$& and
12960 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
12961 local part of the recipient address.
12963 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12964 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
12965 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
12967 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
12970 "abc:xyz"@test.example
12971 abc\:xyz@test.example
12973 the value of &$local_part$& is
12977 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
12978 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
12981 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
12983 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
12984 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
12985 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
12987 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
12988 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
12989 When the &%local_parts%& condition on a router or ACL
12990 matches a local part list
12991 the match value is copied to &$local_part_data$&.
12992 This is an enhancement over previous versions of Exim, when it only
12993 applied to the data read by a lookup.
12994 For details on match values see section &<<SECTlistresults>>& et. al.
12996 The &%check_local_user%& router option also sets this variable.
12998 .vindex &$local_part_prefix$& &&&
12999 &$local_part_prefix_v$& &&&
13000 &$local_part_suffix$& &&&
13001 &$local_part_suffix_v$&
13002 .cindex affix variables
13003 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
13004 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
13005 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
13006 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
13007 .cindex "tainted data"
13008 If the specification did not include a wildcard then
13009 the affix variable value is not tainted.
13011 If the affix specification included a wildcard then the portion of
13012 the affix matched by the wildcard is in
13013 &$local_part_prefix_v$& or &$local_part_suffix_v$& as appropriate,
13014 and both the whole and varying values are tainted.
13016 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
13017 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
13018 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
13019 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
13021 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
13022 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
13023 See &$local_user_uid$&.
13025 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
13026 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
13027 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
13028 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
13029 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
13030 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
13031 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
13032 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
13034 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
13035 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
13036 This contains the expanded value of the
13037 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
13040 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
13041 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
13042 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
13043 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
13044 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
13045 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
13047 .vitem &$log_space$&
13048 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
13049 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
13050 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
13051 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
13052 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
13053 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
13056 .vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
13057 .vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
13058 This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
13059 a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
13060 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13061 It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
13062 &"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
13063 and &"yes"& if it was.
13064 Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
13065 the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
13066 as authenticated data.
13068 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
13069 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
13070 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
13071 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
13072 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
13073 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
13074 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
13077 .vitem &$malware_name$&
13078 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
13079 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
13080 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
13081 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
13083 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
13084 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
13085 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
13086 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
13087 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
13088 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
13090 It is not valid if the &%spool_wireformat%& option is used.
13092 .vitem &$message_age$&
13093 .cindex "message" "age of"
13094 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
13095 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
13096 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
13099 .tvar &$message_body$&
13100 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
13101 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
13102 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
13103 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
13104 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
13105 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
13106 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
13107 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
13109 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
13110 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
13111 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
13112 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
13113 zeros are always converted into spaces.
13115 .tvar &$message_body_end$&
13116 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
13117 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
13118 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
13119 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
13122 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
13123 .cindex "body of message" "size"
13124 .cindex "message body" "size"
13125 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
13126 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
13127 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
13128 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
13129 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
13131 If the spool file is wireformat
13132 (see the &%spool_wireformat%& main option)
13133 the CRLF line-terminators are included in the count.
13135 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
13136 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
13137 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
13138 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
13139 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
13140 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
13141 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
13142 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
13144 .tvar &$message_headers$&
13145 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
13146 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
13147 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
13148 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
13150 .tvar &$message_headers_raw$&
13151 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
13152 contents of header lines is done.
13154 .vitem &$message_id$&
13155 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
13157 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
13158 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
13159 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
13160 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
13161 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
13162 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
13163 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
13164 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
13165 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
13166 from the body is not counted.
13168 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
13169 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
13170 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
13171 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
13172 header and the body).
13174 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
13177 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
13178 message = Too many lines in message header
13180 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
13181 message has not yet been received.
13183 This variable is not valid if the &%spool_wireformat%& option is used.
13185 .vitem &$message_size$&
13186 .cindex "size" "of message"
13187 .cindex "message" "size"
13188 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
13189 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
13190 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
13191 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
13192 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
13193 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
13194 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
13195 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
13196 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
13198 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
13199 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
13200 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
13201 value may not, of course, be truthful.
13203 .vitem &$mime_anomaly_level$& &&&
13204 &$mime_anomaly_text$& &&&
13205 &$mime_boundary$& &&&
13206 &$mime_charset$& &&&
13207 &$mime_content_description$& &&&
13208 &$mime_content_disposition$& &&&
13209 &$mime_content_id$& &&&
13210 &$mime_content_size$& &&&
13211 &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$& &&&
13212 &$mime_content_type$& &&&
13213 &$mime_decoded_filename$& &&&
13214 &$mime_filename$& &&&
13215 &$mime_is_coverletter$& &&&
13216 &$mime_is_multipart$& &&&
13217 &$mime_is_rfc822$& &&&
13218 &$mime_part_count$&
13219 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
13220 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
13221 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
13223 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
13224 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
13225 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
13227 .tvar &$original_domain$&
13228 .vindex "&$domain$&"
13229 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
13230 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
13231 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
13232 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
13233 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
13234 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
13235 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
13237 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
13238 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
13239 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
13241 .tvar &$original_local_part$&
13242 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
13243 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
13244 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
13245 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
13246 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
13247 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
13248 the original address.
13250 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
13251 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
13252 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
13253 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
13254 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
13256 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
13257 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
13258 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
13260 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
13261 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
13262 .cindex "sender" "gid"
13263 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
13264 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
13265 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
13266 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
13267 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
13268 normally the gid of the Exim user.
13270 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
13271 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
13272 .cindex "sender" "uid"
13273 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
13274 .vindex "&$originator_uid$&"
13275 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
13276 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
13277 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
13280 .tvar &$parent_domain$&
13281 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
13282 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
13284 .tvar &$parent_local_part$&
13285 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
13286 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
13289 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
13291 This variable contains the current process id.
13293 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
13294 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
13295 .cindex "transport" "filter"
13296 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
13297 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
13298 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
13299 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
13300 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
13301 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
13302 variable"& error if encountered.
13303 &*Note*&: This value permits data supplied by a potential attacker to
13304 be used in the command for a &(pipe)& transport.
13305 Such configurations should be carefully assessed for security vulnerbilities.
13307 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
13308 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
13309 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
13310 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
13311 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
13312 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
13313 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
13316 .vitem &$proxy_external_address$& &&&
13317 &$proxy_external_port$& &&&
13318 &$proxy_local_address$& &&&
13319 &$proxy_local_port$& &&&
13321 These variables are only available when built with Proxy Protocol
13323 For details see chapter &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
13325 .vitem &$prdr_requested$&
13326 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
13327 This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
13328 current message, otherwise &"no"&.
13330 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$& &&&
13331 &$prvscheck_keynum$& &&&
13332 &$prvscheck_result$&
13333 These variables are used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
13334 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
13335 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
13337 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
13338 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
13339 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
13341 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
13342 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
13343 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
13344 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
13346 .vitem &$queue_name$&
13347 .vindex &$queue_name$&
13348 .cindex "named queues" variable
13349 .cindex queues named
13350 The name of the spool queue in use; empty for the default queue.
13352 .vitem &$queue_size$&
13353 .vindex "&$queue_size$&"
13354 .cindex "queue" "size of"
13355 .cindex "spool" "number of messages"
13356 This variable contains the number of messages queued.
13357 It is evaluated on demand, but no more often than once every minute.
13358 If there is no daemon notifier socket open, the value will be
13363 .cindex router variables
13364 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& option of a router.
13365 They can be given any name that starts with &$r_$&.
13366 The values persist for the address being handled through subsequent routers
13367 and the eventual transport.
13369 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
13370 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
13371 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
13372 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
13373 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
13375 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
13376 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
13377 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
13378 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
13379 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
13380 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
13382 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
13383 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
13384 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
13385 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
13386 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
13388 .vitem &$received_count$&
13389 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
13390 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
13391 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
13392 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
13395 .tvar &$received_for$&
13396 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
13397 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
13398 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
13399 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
13401 .vitem &$received_ip_address$& &&&
13403 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
13404 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
13405 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, these
13406 variables are set to the address and port on the local IP interface.
13407 (The remote IP address and port are in
13408 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
13409 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
13412 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
13413 could be used, for example, to make the filename for a TLS certificate depend
13414 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
13415 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
13416 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
13418 For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
13420 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
13421 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
13422 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
13423 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
13424 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
13425 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
13426 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
13427 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
13428 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
13430 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
13431 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
13432 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
13433 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
13434 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
13435 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
13437 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
13438 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
13439 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
13441 .vitem &$received_time$&
13442 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
13443 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
13444 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13446 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
13447 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
13448 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
13449 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
13450 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
13452 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
13453 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
13455 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
13456 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
13457 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
13458 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
13460 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
13461 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
13462 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
13463 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
13466 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
13467 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
13470 &"route"&: Routing failed.
13473 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
13474 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
13478 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
13481 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
13484 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
13485 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
13487 .tvar &$recipients$&
13488 .tvar &$recipients_list$&
13489 These variables both contain the envelope recipients for a message.
13491 The first uses a comma and a space separate the addresses in the replacement text.
13492 &*Note*&: an address can legitimately contain a comma;
13493 this variable is not intended for further processing.
13495 The second is a proper Exim list; colon-separated.
13497 However, the variables
13498 are not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
13499 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use either of them only in these
13503 In a system filter file.
13505 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
13506 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
13507 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
13508 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
13510 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
13514 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
13515 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
13516 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
13517 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
13518 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
13519 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
13522 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
13523 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
13524 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
13525 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
13527 .vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
13528 .cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
13529 When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
13530 these variables contain the
13531 captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
13532 If the subject string was tainted then so will any captured substring.
13535 .tvar &$reply_address$&
13536 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
13537 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
13538 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
13539 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
13540 decoding or character code translation takes place.
13542 .vitem &$return_path$&
13543 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
13544 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
13545 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
13546 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
13547 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
13548 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
13549 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
13550 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
13551 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
13552 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
13555 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
13556 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
13557 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
13559 .vitem &$router_name$&
13560 .cindex "router" "name"
13561 .cindex "name" "of router"
13562 .vindex "&$router_name$&"
13563 During the running of a router, or a transport called,
13564 this variable contains the router name.
13567 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
13568 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
13569 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
13570 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
13571 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
13572 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
13573 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
13576 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
13577 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
13578 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
13579 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
13580 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
13581 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
13582 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
13583 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
13585 .tvar &$sender_address$&
13586 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
13587 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
13588 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
13589 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
13591 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
13592 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
13593 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
13594 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
13595 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
13596 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
13597 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
13598 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
13600 .tvar &$sender_address_domain$&
13601 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
13603 .tvar &$sender_address_local_part$&
13604 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
13606 .vitem &$sender_data$&
13607 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
13608 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
13609 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
13610 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
13613 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
13614 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
13616 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
13617 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
13618 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
13619 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
13621 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
13622 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
13623 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
13624 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
13625 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
13626 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
13627 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
13628 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
13629 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
13630 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
13631 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
13632 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
13633 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
13635 .vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
13636 .vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
13637 This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
13638 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13639 done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
13641 .tvar &$sender_helo_name$&
13642 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
13643 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
13644 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
13645 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
13647 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
13648 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
13649 When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
13650 this variable contains that
13651 host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
13653 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
13654 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
13655 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
13656 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
13657 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
13658 &$authenticated_id$&.
13660 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
13661 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
13662 If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
13663 (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
13664 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
13665 resolver library states that both
13666 the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
13667 other times, this variable is false.
13669 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13670 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
13671 library, by setting:
13676 In addition, on Linux with glibc 2.31 or newer the resolver library will
13677 default to stripping out a successful validation status.
13678 This will break a previously working Exim installation.
13679 Provided that you do trust the resolver (ie, is on localhost) you can tell
13680 glibc to pass through any successful validation with a new option in
13681 &_/etc/resolv.conf_&:
13686 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
13687 validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
13689 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
13690 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
13692 This requires that your system resolver library support EDNS0 (and that
13693 DNSSEC flags exist in the system headers). If the resolver silently drops
13694 all EDNS0 options, then this will have no effect. OpenBSD's asr resolver
13695 is known to currently ignore EDNS0, documented in CAVEATS of asr_run(3).
13698 .tvar &$sender_host_name$&
13699 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13700 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
13701 other means, this variable is empty.
13703 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
13704 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
13705 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
13706 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
13707 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
13708 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
13709 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
13711 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
13712 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
13713 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
13714 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
13716 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
13717 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
13718 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
13721 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
13722 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
13723 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
13724 following are true:
13727 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
13729 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
13730 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
13731 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
13733 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
13734 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
13735 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
13737 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
13738 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
13739 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
13741 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
13742 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
13743 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
13744 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
13746 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
13748 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
13749 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
13753 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
13754 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
13755 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
13756 number that was used on the remote host.
13758 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
13759 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
13760 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13761 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
13762 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
13765 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
13766 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
13767 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
13768 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
13770 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
13771 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
13772 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
13773 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
13774 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
13775 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
13776 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
13777 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
13778 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
13779 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
13780 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
13783 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
13784 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
13785 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
13786 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
13787 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
13789 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
13790 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
13791 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
13792 about the failure. The details are the same as for
13793 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
13795 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
13796 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
13797 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13798 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
13799 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
13800 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
13801 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
13803 .vitem &$sending_port$&
13804 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
13805 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13806 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
13807 connections, see &$received_port$&.
13809 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
13810 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
13811 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
13812 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
13813 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
13814 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
13816 .tvar &$smtp_command$&
13817 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
13818 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
13819 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
13824 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
13825 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
13826 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
13827 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
13829 .tvar &$smtp_command_argument$&
13830 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
13831 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
13832 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
13833 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
13834 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
13836 .vitem &$smtp_command_history$&
13837 .cindex SMTP "command history"
13838 .vindex "&$smtp_command_history$&"
13839 A comma-separated list (with no whitespace) of the most-recent SMTP commands
13840 received, in time-order left to right. Only a limited number of commands
13843 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
13844 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
13845 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
13846 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
13847 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
13848 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
13849 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
13850 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
13851 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
13852 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
13853 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
13855 .vitem &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
13856 .vindex "&$smtp_notquit_reason$&"
13857 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, this variable is set to a string
13858 that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP connection.
13860 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
13861 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
13862 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
13863 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
13864 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
13865 message is junk mail.
13867 .vitem &$spam_score$& &&&
13868 &$spam_score_int$& &&&
13870 &$spam_report$& &&&
13872 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
13873 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
13874 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
13876 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$& &&&
13877 &$spf_received$& &&&
13879 &$spf_result_guessed$& &&&
13880 &$spf_smtp_comment$&
13881 These variables are only available if Exim is built with SPF support.
13882 For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
13884 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
13885 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
13886 The name of Exim's spool directory.
13888 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
13889 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
13890 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
13891 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
13892 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
13893 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
13895 .vitem &$spool_space$&
13896 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
13897 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
13898 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
13899 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
13900 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
13901 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
13902 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
13904 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
13906 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
13909 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
13910 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
13911 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
13912 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
13913 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
13914 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
13916 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
13917 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
13918 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13919 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
13920 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13921 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13922 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
13923 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
13925 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
13926 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13929 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
13930 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
13931 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
13932 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
13933 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
13934 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
13936 .vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
13937 .vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
13938 .cindex certificate variables
13939 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13940 inbound connection when the message was received.
13941 It is only useful as the argument of a
13942 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13943 or a &%def%& condition.
13945 &*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
13946 when a list of more than one
13947 file is used for &%tls_certificate%&, this variable is not reliable.
13948 The macro "_TLS_BAD_MULTICERT_IN_OURCERT" will be defined for those versions.
13950 .vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
13951 .vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
13952 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13953 inbound connection when the message was received.
13954 It is only useful as the argument of a
13955 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13956 or a &%def%& condition.
13957 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13958 which is not the leaf.
13960 .vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
13961 .vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
13962 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
13963 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13964 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13965 or a &%def%& condition.
13967 .vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
13968 .vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
13969 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
13970 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
13971 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
13972 or a &%def%& condition.
13973 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
13974 which is not the leaf.
13976 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
13977 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
13978 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
13979 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
13981 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
13982 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
13985 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
13986 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
13987 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
13988 outbound SMTP connection was made,
13989 and &"0"& otherwise.
13991 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
13992 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
13993 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
13994 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
13995 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
13996 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
13997 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
13998 &$tls_in_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
13999 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
14001 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
14002 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
14003 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
14005 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher_std$&
14006 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher_std$&"
14007 As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
14009 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
14010 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
14012 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
14013 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
14014 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
14015 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
14017 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher_std$&
14018 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher_std$&"
14019 As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
14021 .vitem &$tls_out_dane$&
14022 .vindex &$tls_out_dane$&
14023 DANE active status. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
14025 .vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
14026 .vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
14027 When a message is received from a remote client connection
14028 the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
14030 0 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
14031 1 No response to request
14032 2 Response not verified
14033 3 Verification failed
14034 4 Verification succeeded
14037 .vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
14038 .vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
14039 When a message is sent to a remote host connection
14040 the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
14041 See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
14043 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
14044 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
14045 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
14046 .cindex certificate "extracting fields"
14047 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
14048 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
14049 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
14050 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
14051 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
14052 which is not the leaf.
14054 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
14055 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
14058 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
14059 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
14060 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
14061 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
14062 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
14063 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
14064 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
14065 which is not the leaf.
14068 .vitem &$tls_in_resumption$& &&&
14069 &$tls_out_resumption$&
14070 .vindex &$tls_in_resumption$&
14071 .vindex &$tls_out_resumption$&
14072 .cindex TLS resumption
14073 Observability for TLS session resumption. See &<<SECTresumption>>& for details.
14076 .tvar &$tls_in_sni$&
14077 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
14078 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
14080 .cindex SNI "observability on server"
14081 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
14082 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
14083 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
14084 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
14085 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
14086 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
14087 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
14089 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
14090 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
14093 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
14094 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
14095 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
14097 .cindex SNI "observability in client"
14099 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
14102 .vitem &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
14103 .vindex &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
14104 Bitfield of TLSA record types found. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
14106 .vitem &$tls_in_ver$&
14107 .vindex "&$tls_in_ver$&"
14108 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP connection
14109 this variable is set to the protocol version, eg &'TLS1.2'&.
14111 .vitem &$tls_out_ver$&
14112 .vindex "&$tls_out_ver$&"
14113 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP connection
14114 this variable is set to the protocol version.
14117 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
14118 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
14119 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
14120 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
14122 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
14123 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
14124 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
14126 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
14127 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
14128 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
14130 .vitem &$tod_full$&
14131 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
14132 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
14133 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
14134 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
14135 values for those that are behind (west).
14138 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
14139 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
14140 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
14142 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
14143 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
14144 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
14145 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
14148 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
14149 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
14150 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
14153 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
14154 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
14155 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
14156 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
14158 .vitem &$transport_name$&
14159 .cindex "transport" "name"
14160 .cindex "name" "of transport"
14161 .vindex "&$transport_name$&"
14162 During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
14165 .vindex "&$value$&"
14166 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
14167 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
14168 &*reduce*& expansion.
14170 .vitem &$verify_mode$&
14171 .vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
14172 While a router or transport is being run in verify mode or for cutthrough delivery,
14173 contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
14176 .vitem &$version_number$&
14177 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
14178 The version number of Exim. Same as &$exim_version$&, may be overridden
14179 by the &%exim_version%& main config option.
14181 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
14182 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
14183 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
14184 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
14186 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
14187 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
14188 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
14189 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
14195 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14196 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14198 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
14199 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
14200 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
14201 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
14202 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
14203 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
14208 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
14211 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
14212 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
14213 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
14214 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
14215 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
14216 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
14217 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
14218 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
14219 a newly created Perl interpreter.
14221 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
14222 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
14223 should usually be something like
14225 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
14227 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
14228 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
14229 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
14230 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
14231 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
14232 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
14233 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
14234 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
14238 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
14239 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
14240 a startup when Exim is entered.
14242 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
14243 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
14246 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
14247 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
14250 .oindex "&%perl_taintmode%&"
14251 .cindex "Perl" "taintmode"
14252 To provide more security executing Perl code via the embedded Perl
14253 interpreter, the &%perl_taintmode%& option can be set. This enables the
14254 taint mode of the Perl interpreter. You are encouraged to set this
14255 option to a true value. To avoid breaking existing installations, it
14258 &*Note*&: This is entirely separate from Exim's tainted-data tracking.
14261 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
14262 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
14263 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
14264 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
14268 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
14269 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
14271 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
14272 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
14273 with an error message of the form
14275 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
14277 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
14278 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
14279 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
14280 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
14281 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
14282 that was passed to &%die%&.
14285 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
14286 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
14287 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
14290 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
14292 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
14293 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
14294 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
14296 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
14297 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
14298 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
14299 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
14301 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
14302 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
14303 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
14304 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
14305 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
14306 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
14307 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
14310 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
14311 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
14312 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
14313 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
14314 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
14315 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
14316 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
14317 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
14318 avoided, but the output is lost.
14320 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
14321 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
14322 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
14323 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
14324 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
14325 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
14326 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
14328 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
14330 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
14331 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
14332 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
14333 as the first subroutine argument.
14337 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14338 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14340 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
14341 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
14342 "Starting the daemon"
14343 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
14344 .cindex "interface" "listening"
14345 .cindex "network interface"
14346 .cindex "interface" "network"
14347 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
14348 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
14349 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
14350 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
14351 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
14352 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
14353 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
14354 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
14355 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
14356 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
14357 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
14360 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
14361 and ports to listen on.
14363 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
14364 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
14365 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
14366 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
14367 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
14368 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
14369 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
14370 as an error situation.
14372 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
14373 for the outgoing connection.
14377 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
14378 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
14379 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
14380 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
14381 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
14383 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
14384 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
14385 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
14386 chapter describes how they operate.
14388 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
14389 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
14393 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
14394 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
14395 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
14399 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
14401 (For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
14403 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
14404 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
14407 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
14408 described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
14409 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
14410 colons. For example:
14412 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
14415 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
14417 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
14418 in &%local_interfaces%&:
14421 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
14422 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
14424 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
14425 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
14428 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
14429 with a colon separator, for example:
14431 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
14432 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
14436 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
14437 default setting contains just one port:
14439 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
14441 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
14442 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
14443 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
14444 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
14445 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
14449 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
14450 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
14451 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
14452 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
14453 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
14454 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
14456 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
14458 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
14460 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14462 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
14466 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
14467 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
14468 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
14469 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
14470 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
14471 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
14474 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
14475 changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) if required.
14476 If there are any items that do not
14477 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
14478 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
14479 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
14480 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
14484 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
14487 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
14489 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
14490 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
14491 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
14495 .section "Support for the submissions (aka SSMTP or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
14496 .cindex "submissions protocol"
14497 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
14498 .cindex "smtps protocol"
14499 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
14500 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
14501 Exim supports the use of TLS-on-connect, used by mail clients in the
14502 &"submissions"& protocol, historically also known as SMTPS or SSMTP.
14503 For some years, IETF Standards Track documents only blessed the
14504 STARTTLS-based Submission service (port 587) while common practice was to support
14505 the same feature set on port 465, but using TLS-on-connect.
14506 If your installation needs to provide service to mail clients
14507 (Mail User Agents, MUAs) then you should provide service on both the 587 and
14510 If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a list of port numbers or
14511 service names, connections to those ports must first establish TLS, before
14512 proceeding to the application layer use of the SMTP protocol.
14514 The common use of this option is expected to be
14516 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
14519 There is also a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports
14520 to behave in this way when a daemon is started.
14522 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
14523 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
14524 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
14525 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
14526 connections via the daemon.)
14531 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
14532 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
14533 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
14534 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
14535 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
14536 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
14537 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
14538 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
14540 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
14542 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
14543 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
14544 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
14545 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
14546 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
14547 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
14549 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
14551 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
14552 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
14553 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
14554 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
14555 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
14557 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
14558 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
14559 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
14560 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
14561 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
14562 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
14563 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
14564 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
14565 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
14566 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
14567 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
14568 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
14570 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
14571 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
14572 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
14573 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
14574 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
14578 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
14579 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
14581 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
14582 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14584 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
14585 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
14586 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
14587 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
14589 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
14591 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
14593 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
14595 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
14596 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
14598 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
14599 IPv4 loopback address only:
14601 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
14603 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
14605 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
14607 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
14611 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
14612 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
14613 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
14614 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
14617 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
14618 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
14619 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
14620 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
14622 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
14623 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
14624 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
14625 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
14626 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
14627 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
14628 used for listening. Consider this example:
14630 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
14632 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
14634 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14636 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
14637 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
14640 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
14641 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
14642 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
14643 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
14644 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
14645 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
14646 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
14647 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
14651 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
14652 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
14653 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
14654 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
14655 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
14656 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
14662 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14663 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14665 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
14666 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
14667 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
14668 The first part of the runtime configuration file contains three types of item:
14671 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
14672 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
14674 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
14675 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
14676 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
14678 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
14679 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
14680 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
14681 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
14685 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
14686 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
14687 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
14688 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
14689 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
14690 listed in more than one group.
14692 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
14694 .row &%add_environment%& "environment variables"
14695 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
14696 .row &%debug_store%& "do extra internal checks"
14697 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14698 .row &%keep_environment%& "environment variables"
14699 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
14700 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
14701 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
14702 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
14703 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
14704 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
14705 .row &%spool_wireformat%& "use wire-format spool data files when possible"
14706 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
14710 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
14712 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
14713 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14714 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
14715 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
14716 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
14717 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
14722 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
14724 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
14725 .row &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& "require admin for various checks"
14726 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
14727 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
14728 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14729 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14730 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
14731 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
14732 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
14733 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
14734 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
14735 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
14740 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
14742 .row &%event_action%& "custom logging"
14743 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
14744 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14745 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
14746 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
14747 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
14748 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
14749 .row &%panic_coredump%& "request coredump on fatal errors"
14750 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
14751 .row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
14752 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
14753 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
14754 .row &%syslog_pid%& "pid in syslog lines"
14755 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
14756 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
14757 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
14762 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
14764 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
14765 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
14766 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
14767 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
14772 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
14774 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
14775 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14776 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14777 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
14778 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
14779 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
14780 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
14781 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
14782 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
14783 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
14784 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
14785 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
14786 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
14787 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
14788 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
14793 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
14795 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
14796 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
14801 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
14803 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
14804 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
14805 .row &%perl_taintmode%& "enable taint mode in Perl"
14810 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
14812 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
14813 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
14814 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
14815 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
14816 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
14817 .row &%notifier_socket%& "override compiled-in value"
14818 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14819 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14820 .row &%smtp_backlog_monitor%& "level to log listen backlog"
14825 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
14827 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
14828 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
14829 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
14830 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
14831 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
14832 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
14833 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
14834 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14835 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
14836 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
14837 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
14838 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
14839 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
14840 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
14841 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
14842 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
14844 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
14845 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
14846 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
14847 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
14848 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
14853 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
14855 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
14856 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
14857 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
14858 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
14859 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
14860 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
14861 .row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
14862 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
14863 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
14864 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
14865 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
14866 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
14867 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
14868 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
14869 .row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
14870 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
14871 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
14872 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
14873 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
14874 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
14875 .row &%acl_smtp_wellknown%& "ACL for WELLKNOWN"
14876 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
14877 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
14879 .row &%dns_cname_loops%& "follow CNAMEs returned by resolver"
14880 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
14881 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
14882 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14883 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14884 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
14885 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
14886 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
14887 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
14888 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
14889 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14890 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14891 .row &%hosts_proxy%& "use proxy protocol for these hosts"
14892 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
14893 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
14894 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
14895 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
14896 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14897 .row &%proxy_protocol_timeout%& "timeout for proxy protocol negotiation"
14898 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
14899 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
14900 .row &%spf_smtp_comment_template%& "template for &$spf_smtp_comment$&"
14905 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
14907 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
14909 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
14911 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
14912 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
14913 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
14918 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
14920 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
14921 .row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
14922 .row &%hosts_require_alpn%& "mandatory ALPN"
14923 .row &%hosts_require_helo%& "mandatory HELO/EHLO"
14924 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
14925 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
14926 .row &%tls_alpn%& "acceptable protocol names"
14927 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
14928 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
14929 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
14930 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
14931 .row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
14932 .row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
14933 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
14934 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
14935 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
14936 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
14937 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
14938 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
14939 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
14944 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
14946 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
14947 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
14948 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
14949 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
14950 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
14951 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
14952 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
14953 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
14958 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
14960 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
14961 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
14962 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
14963 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
14964 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
14965 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
14966 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
14967 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
14973 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
14975 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
14982 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
14983 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
14986 .row &%dkim_verify_hashes%& "DKIM hash methods accepted for signatures"
14987 .row &%dkim_verify_keytypes%& "DKIM key types accepted for signatures"
14988 .row &%dkim_verify_min_keysizes%& "DKIM key sizes accepted for signatures"
14989 .row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domains for which DKIM ACL is run"
14990 .row &%dmarc_forensic_sender%& "DMARC sender for report messages"
14991 .row &%dmarc_history_file%& "DMARC results log"
14992 .row &%dmarc_tld_file%& "DMARC toplevel domains file"
14993 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
14994 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
14995 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
14996 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
14997 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
14998 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
14999 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
15000 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
15001 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
15002 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
15003 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
15004 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
15005 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
15006 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
15008 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
15009 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
15010 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
15011 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
15012 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
15013 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
15014 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
15015 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
15016 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
15017 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
15018 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
15019 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
15020 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
15021 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
15022 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
15023 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
15028 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
15030 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
15031 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
15032 .row &%chunking_advertise_hosts%& "advertise CHUNKING to these hosts"
15033 .row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
15034 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
15035 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
15036 .row &%limits_advertise_hosts%& "advertise LIMITS to these hosts"
15037 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
15038 .row &%pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
15039 .row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
15040 .row &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& "advertise SMTPUTF8 to these hosts"
15041 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
15042 .row &%wellknown_advertise_hosts%& "advertise WELLKNOWN to these hosts"
15047 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
15049 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
15050 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
15051 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
15052 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
15054 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
15055 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
15056 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
15057 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
15058 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
15059 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
15060 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
15061 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
15062 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
15063 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
15068 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
15070 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
15071 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
15073 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
15074 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
15075 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
15076 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
15077 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
15082 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
15084 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
15085 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
15086 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
15087 .row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
15088 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
15089 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
15090 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
15091 .row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
15092 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
15093 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
15094 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
15095 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
15096 .row &%queue_fast_ramp%& "parallel delivery with 2-phase queue run"
15097 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
15098 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
15099 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
15100 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
15101 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
15102 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
15103 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
15104 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
15105 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
15106 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
15107 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
15108 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
15113 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
15115 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
15116 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
15117 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
15118 .row &%bounce_return_linesize_limit%& "limit on returned message line length"
15119 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
15120 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
15121 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
15122 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
15123 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
15124 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
15125 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
15126 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
15127 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
15128 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
15129 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
15134 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
15135 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
15138 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
15140 .cindex "8-bit characters"
15141 .cindex "log" "selectors"
15142 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
15143 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" 8BITMIME
15144 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
15145 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
15146 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
15147 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
15149 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
15150 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
15151 It now defaults to true.
15152 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
15154 &url(https://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
15157 To log received 8BITMIME status use
15159 log_selector = +8bitmime
15162 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
15163 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
15164 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
15165 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
15166 read and is on the point of being accepted. See section &<<SECnonSMTP>>& for
15169 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
15170 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
15171 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
15174 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
15175 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
15176 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
15177 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
15178 non-SMTP message. See section &<<SECnonSMTP>>& for further details.
15180 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
15181 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
15182 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
15183 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
15185 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for general information on ACLs, and chapter
15186 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
15188 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
15189 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
15190 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
15191 See section &<<SECconnectACL>>& for further details.
15193 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
15194 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
15195 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
15196 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
15197 acknowledgment is sent. See section &<<SECdataACLS>>& for further details.
15199 .option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
15200 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
15201 .cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
15202 .cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
15203 .cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
15204 This option defines the ACL that,
15205 if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
15206 is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
15207 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
15208 acknowledgment is sent. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>& for further details.
15210 .option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
15211 .cindex DKIM "ACL for"
15212 This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
15213 (by default, or as specified in the dkim_verify_signers option)
15214 of a received message.
15215 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>& for further details.
15217 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
15218 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
15219 .cindex "ETRN" advertisement
15220 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
15222 If no value is set then the ETRN facility is not advertised.
15223 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15225 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
15226 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
15227 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
15228 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15230 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
15231 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
15232 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
15233 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
15234 command is received. See section &<<SECheloACL>>& for further details.
15237 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
15238 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
15239 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
15240 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15242 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
15243 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
15244 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
15246 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for general information on ACLs, and chapter
15247 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
15249 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
15250 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
15251 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
15252 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
15253 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
15255 .option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
15256 .cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
15257 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
15258 ends without a QUIT command being received.
15259 See section &<<SECTNOTQUITACL>>& for further details.
15261 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
15262 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
15263 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
15266 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
15267 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
15268 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
15269 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15271 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
15272 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
15273 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
15274 received. See section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& for further details.
15276 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
15277 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
15278 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
15279 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15281 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
15282 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
15283 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
15284 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15286 .option acl_smtp_wellknown main string&!! unset
15287 .cindex "WELLKNOWN, ACL for"
15288 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP WELLKNOWN command is
15289 received. See section &<<SECTWELLKNOWNACL>>& for further details.
15291 .option add_environment main "string list" empty
15292 .cindex "environment" "set values"
15293 This option adds individual environment variables that the
15294 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes may use.
15295 Each list element should be of the form &"name=value"&.
15297 See &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the environment of &(pipe)& transports.
15299 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
15300 .cindex "admin user"
15301 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
15302 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
15303 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
15304 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
15305 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
15306 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
15307 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
15309 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
15310 .cindex "domain literal"
15311 If this option is set, the RFC 2822 domain literal format is permitted in
15312 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
15313 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
15314 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
15316 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
15317 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
15318 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
15319 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
15320 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
15321 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
15322 the local host's IP addresses.
15324 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
15325 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
15326 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
15327 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
15328 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
15329 that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
15330 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
15331 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
15332 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
15334 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
15335 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
15336 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
15337 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
15338 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
15339 that at least two other MTAs permit this.
15340 This option allows Exim users to experiment if they wish.
15342 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
15343 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
15344 letters, digits, and hyphens.
15346 If Exim is built with internationalization support
15347 and the SMTPUTF8 ESMTP option is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>&)
15348 this option can be left as default.
15350 if you want to look up such domain names in the DNS, you must also
15351 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
15352 suitable setting is:
15354 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
15355 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
15357 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
15359 dns_check_names_pattern =
15361 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
15364 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15365 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
15366 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
15367 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" AUTH
15368 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
15369 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
15370 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
15371 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
15372 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
15373 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
15374 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
15375 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
15377 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
15378 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
15379 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
15380 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
15381 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
15382 which Exim advertises AUTH.
15384 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
15385 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
15386 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
15387 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
15389 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
15391 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
15392 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
15393 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
15394 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
15397 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
15398 .cindex "thawing messages"
15399 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
15400 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
15401 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
15402 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
15403 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
15404 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
15406 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
15407 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
15408 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
15411 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
15412 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
15413 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
15415 sophie:/var/run/sophie
15417 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
15418 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
15421 .option bi_command main string unset
15423 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
15424 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
15425 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
15426 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
15429 .option bounce_message_file main string&!! unset
15430 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
15431 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
15432 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
15433 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
15434 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&.
15435 .cindex bounce_message_file "tainted data"
15436 The option is expanded to give the file path, which must be
15437 absolute and untainted.
15438 See also &%warn_message_file%&.
15441 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
15442 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
15443 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
15444 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
15446 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
15447 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
15448 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
15449 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
15450 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
15451 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
15452 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
15453 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
15454 point at which the error was detected are returned.
15455 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
15457 .option bounce_return_linesize_limit main integer 998
15458 .cindex "size" "of bounce lines, limit"
15459 .cindex "bounce message" "line length limit"
15460 .cindex "limit" "bounce message line length"
15461 This option sets a limit in bytes on the line length of messages
15462 that are returned to senders due to delivery problems,
15463 when &%bounce_return_message%& is true.
15464 The default value corresponds to RFC limits.
15465 If the message being returned has lines longer than this value it is
15466 treated as if the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& (below) restriction was exceeded.
15468 The option also applies to bounces returned when an error is detected
15469 during reception of a message.
15470 In this case lines from the original are truncated.
15472 The option does not apply to messages generated by an &(autoreply)& transport.
15475 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
15476 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
15477 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
15478 &%bounce_return_body%&.
15481 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
15482 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
15483 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
15484 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
15485 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
15486 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
15487 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
15488 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
15489 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
15491 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
15492 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
15493 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
15494 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
15495 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
15498 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
15499 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
15500 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
15501 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
15502 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
15503 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
15504 connection. A typical setting might be:
15506 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
15508 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
15510 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
15512 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
15515 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
15516 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
15517 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
15518 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
15519 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15520 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15523 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
15524 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
15525 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15526 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15529 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
15530 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
15531 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15532 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15535 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
15536 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
15537 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15538 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15541 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
15542 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
15543 callout verification. The default value is
15545 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
15547 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
15550 .options check_log_inodes main integer 100 &&&
15551 check_log_space main integer 10M
15552 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
15554 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
15555 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
15556 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
15557 RFC 2047 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
15558 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
15559 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
15560 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
15561 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
15562 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
15563 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
15566 .options check_spool_inodes main integer 100 &&&
15567 check_spool_space main integer 10M
15568 .cindex "checking disk space"
15569 .cindex "disk space, checking"
15570 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
15571 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
15572 message is accepted.
15574 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
15575 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
15576 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
15577 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
15578 When any of these options are nonzero, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
15579 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
15580 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
15581 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
15584 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
15585 either value is greater than zero, for example:
15587 check_spool_space = 100M
15588 check_spool_inodes = 100
15590 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
15591 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
15594 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
15595 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
15596 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
15598 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
15599 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
15600 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
15601 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
15602 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
15603 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
15605 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
15606 number of kilobytes (though specified in bytes).
15607 If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
15609 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
15610 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
15611 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
15613 There is a slight performance penalty for these checks.
15614 Versions of Exim preceding 4.88 had these disabled by default;
15615 high-rate installations confident they will never run out of resources
15616 may wish to deliberately disable them.
15618 .option chunking_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15619 .cindex CHUNKING advertisement
15620 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
15621 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" CHUNKING
15622 The CHUNKING extension (RFC3030) will be advertised in the EHLO message to
15624 Hosts may use the BDAT command as an alternate to DATA.
15626 .option commandline_checks_require_admin main boolean &`false`&
15627 .cindex "restricting access to features"
15628 This option restricts various basic checking features to require an
15629 administrative user.
15630 This affects most of the &%-b*%& options, such as &%-be%&.
15632 .option debug_store main boolean &`false`&
15633 .cindex debugging "memory corruption"
15634 .cindex memory debugging
15635 This option, when true, enables extra checking in Exim's internal memory
15636 management. For use when a memory corruption issue is being investigated,
15637 it should normally be left as default.
15639 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
15640 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
15641 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
15642 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
15643 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
15644 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
15646 .options daemon_startup_retries main integer 9 &&&
15647 daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
15648 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
15649 These options control the retrying done by
15650 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
15651 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
15652 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
15653 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
15655 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
15656 .cindex "warning of delay"
15657 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
15658 .cindex "queue" "delay warning"
15659 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
15660 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
15661 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
15662 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
15663 message has been in the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
15664 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
15667 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
15669 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
15670 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
15671 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
15672 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
15676 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
15677 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
15679 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
15681 Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
15682 which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
15683 Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
15685 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
15686 .vindex "&$domain$&"
15687 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
15688 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
15689 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
15690 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
15691 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
15692 not sent. The default is:
15694 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
15695 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
15696 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
15697 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
15700 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
15701 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
15702 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
15703 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
15705 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
15706 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
15707 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
15708 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
15709 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
15710 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
15711 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
15712 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
15714 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
15715 .cindex "load average"
15716 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
15717 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
15718 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
15719 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
15720 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15723 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
15724 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
15725 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
15726 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15727 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
15728 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
15729 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
15730 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15732 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
15733 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
15734 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
15735 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
15736 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
15737 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
15738 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
15739 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
15741 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
15742 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
15743 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
15744 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
15747 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
15748 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
15749 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
15750 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
15751 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
15752 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
15753 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
15756 .option dkim_verify_hashes main "string list" "sha256 : sha512"
15757 .cindex DKIM "selecting signature algorithms"
15758 This option gives a list of hash types which are acceptable in signatures,
15759 and an order of processing.
15760 Signatures with algorithms not in the list will be ignored.
15762 Acceptable values include:
15769 Note that the acceptance of sha1 violates RFC 8301.
15771 .option dkim_verify_keytypes main "string list" "ed25519 : rsa"
15772 This option gives a list of key types which are acceptable in signatures,
15773 and an order of processing.
15774 Signatures with algorithms not in the list will be ignored.
15777 .option dkim_verify_min_keysizes main "string list" "rsa=1024 ed25519=250"
15778 This option gives a list of key sizes which are acceptable in signatures.
15779 The list is keyed by the algorithm type for the key; the values are in bits.
15780 Signatures with keys smaller than given by this option will fail verification.
15782 The default enforces the RFC 8301 minimum key size for RSA signatures.
15784 .option dkim_verify_minimal main boolean false
15785 If set to true, verification of signatures will terminate after the
15788 .option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
15789 .cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
15790 This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
15791 It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
15792 the ACL once for each signature in the message.
15793 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
15796 .options dmarc_forensic_sender main string&!! unset &&&
15797 dmarc_history_file main string unset &&&
15798 dmarc_tld_file main string unset
15799 .cindex DMARC "main section options"
15800 These options control DMARC processing.
15801 See section &<<SECDMARC>>& for details.
15804 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
15805 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
15806 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
15807 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
15808 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
15809 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
15810 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
15811 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
15812 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
15813 by a setting such as this:
15815 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
15817 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does,
15818 except for TLSA lookups (where knowing about such failures
15819 is security-relevant).
15820 It also applies when the
15821 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
15822 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
15823 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
15824 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
15825 options are applied after this global option.
15827 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
15828 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
15829 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
15830 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
15831 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
15832 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
15833 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
15834 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
15835 value of this option. The default pattern is
15837 dns_check_names_pattern = \
15838 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
15840 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
15841 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
15842 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
15843 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
15844 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
15847 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
15848 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
15849 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
15851 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
15852 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
15853 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
15854 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
15856 .option dns_cname_loops main integer 1
15857 .cindex DNS "CNAME following"
15858 This option controls the following of CNAME chains, needed if the resolver does
15859 not do it internally.
15860 As of 2018 most should, and the default can be left.
15861 If you have an ancient one, a value of 10 is likely needed.
15863 The default value of one CNAME-follow is needed
15864 thanks to the observed return for an MX request,
15865 given no MX presence but a CNAME to an A, of the CNAME.
15868 .option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
15869 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15870 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15871 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
15872 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
15873 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
15875 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
15877 On Linux with glibc 2.31 or newer this is insufficient, the resolver library
15878 will default to stripping out a successful validation status.
15879 This will break a previously working Exim installation.
15880 Provided that you do trust the resolver (ie, is on localhost) you can tell
15881 glibc to pass through any successful validation with a new option in
15882 &_/etc/resolv.conf_&:
15888 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
15889 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
15890 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
15891 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
15892 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
15893 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
15894 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
15895 domain matches this list.
15897 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
15898 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
15899 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
15900 Note that all lookups, including those done for verification, are affected;
15901 this will result in verify failure for IPv6 connections or ones using names
15902 only valid for IPv6 addresses.
15905 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
15906 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15907 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
15908 .cindex "DNS" timeout
15909 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
15910 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
15911 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
15912 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
15913 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
15914 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
15915 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
15916 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
15918 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
15921 .option dns_retry main integer 0
15922 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
15925 .option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
15926 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15927 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
15928 If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
15929 (Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
15930 DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
15931 match with this expanded domain list.
15933 Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
15934 authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
15935 bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
15936 mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
15937 Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
15938 a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
15940 Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
15941 to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
15942 zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
15944 If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
15945 in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
15946 authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
15947 authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
15948 record in the authoritative section is used instead.
15950 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15951 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
15952 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
15953 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
15954 .cindex "DNS" "OpenBSD
15955 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
15956 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
15957 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
15960 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
15962 OpenBSD's asr resolver routines are known to ignore the EDNS0 option; this
15963 means that DNSSEC will not work with Exim on that platform either, unless Exim
15964 is linked against an alternative DNS client library.
15967 .option drop_cr main boolean false
15968 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
15969 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
15970 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
15972 .option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
15973 .cindex "bounce messages" "success"
15974 .cindex "DSN" "success"
15975 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
15976 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" DSN
15977 DSN extensions (RFC3461) will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
15978 and accepted from, these hosts.
15979 Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ORCPT options on RCPT TO commands,
15980 and RET and ENVID options on MAIL FROM commands.
15981 A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
15982 A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
15984 &*Note*&: Supplying success-DSN messages has been criticised
15985 on privacy grounds; it can leak details of internal forwarding.
15987 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
15988 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
15989 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
15990 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
15991 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
15992 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
15994 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
15996 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
15997 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
15999 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
16000 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
16001 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
16002 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
16003 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
16004 message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
16005 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
16006 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
16007 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
16010 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
16011 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
16012 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
16013 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
16014 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
16015 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
16016 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
16017 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
16018 must be enclosed in double quotes.
16020 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
16021 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
16022 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
16023 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
16024 are examined. For example:
16026 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
16027 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
16028 postmaster@mydomain.example
16030 .vindex "&$domain$&"
16031 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
16032 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
16033 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
16034 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
16035 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
16036 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
16039 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
16040 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
16041 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
16043 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
16045 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
16046 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
16047 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
16048 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
16049 overrides the default.
16051 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
16052 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
16053 and warning messages. For example:
16055 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
16057 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid RFC 2822
16058 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
16059 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
16060 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
16064 .option event_action main string&!! unset
16066 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
16067 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
16070 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
16071 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
16072 .cindex "Exim group"
16073 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
16074 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
16075 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
16076 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
16077 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
16081 .option exim_path main string "see below"
16082 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
16083 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
16084 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
16085 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
16086 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
16088 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
16089 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
16090 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
16091 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
16094 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
16095 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
16096 .cindex "Exim user"
16097 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
16098 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
16099 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
16100 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
16102 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
16103 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
16104 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
16105 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
16108 .option exim_version main string "current version"
16109 .cindex "Exim version"
16110 .cindex customizing "version number"
16111 .cindex "version number of Exim" override
16112 This option overrides the &$version_number$&/&$exim_version$& that Exim reports in
16113 various places. Use with care; this may fool stupid security scanners.
16116 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
16117 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
16118 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
16119 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
16122 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
16123 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
16125 . .option "extract_addresses_remove_ &~&~arguments"
16126 . but apparently this results in searchability problems; bug 1197
16128 .option extract_addresses_remove_arguments main boolean true
16130 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
16131 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
16132 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
16133 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
16134 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
16135 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
16136 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
16137 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
16138 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
16139 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
16143 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
16144 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
16145 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
16146 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
16147 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
16148 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
16149 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
16150 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
16153 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
16154 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
16155 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
16156 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
16160 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
16161 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
16162 .cindex "frozen messages" "sending a message when freezing"
16163 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
16164 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
16165 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
16166 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
16167 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
16168 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
16169 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
16170 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
16171 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
16172 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
16173 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
16174 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
16175 logging that you require.
16178 .options gecos_name main string&!! unset &&&
16179 gecos_pattern main string unset
16181 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
16182 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
16183 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
16184 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
16185 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
16186 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
16187 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
16188 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
16190 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
16191 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
16192 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
16195 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
16196 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
16197 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
16198 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
16200 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
16205 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
16206 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
16207 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
16208 implementations of TLS.
16211 .option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
16212 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
16213 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
16216 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
16221 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
16222 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
16223 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
16224 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
16225 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
16226 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
16230 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
16231 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
16232 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
16233 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
16234 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
16235 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
16236 sections are rejected.
16239 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
16240 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
16241 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
16242 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
16243 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
16244 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
16245 zero means &"no limit"&.
16250 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16251 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
16252 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
16253 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
16254 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
16255 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
16256 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
16257 if you want to do semantic checking.
16258 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
16262 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
16263 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
16264 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
16265 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
16266 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
16267 non-ip-literal EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
16268 hyphens, and dots. For examplem if you really must allow underscores,
16271 helo_allow_chars = _
16273 This option does not apply to names that look like ip-literals.
16274 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
16277 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
16278 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
16279 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
16280 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
16281 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
16282 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
16283 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
16287 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16288 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
16289 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
16290 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
16291 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
16292 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
16293 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
16294 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
16295 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
16296 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
16297 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
16298 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
16300 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
16301 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
16302 EHLO command either:
16305 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
16307 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
16308 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
16309 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
16310 calling host address, or
16312 when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
16315 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
16316 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
16317 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
16319 If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
16320 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
16321 &$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
16323 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16324 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
16325 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
16326 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
16327 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
16328 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
16329 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
16330 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
16331 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
16334 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16335 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
16336 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
16337 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held in the queue
16338 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
16339 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
16340 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
16341 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
16342 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
16344 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
16345 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
16346 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
16347 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
16348 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
16350 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
16351 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
16352 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
16353 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
16356 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
16357 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
16358 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
16359 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
16360 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
16361 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
16362 default configuration file contains
16366 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
16367 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
16369 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
16370 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
16371 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
16373 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
16374 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
16375 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
16376 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
16377 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
16378 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
16381 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
16382 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
16383 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
16384 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
16385 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
16388 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
16389 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
16390 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
16391 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
16395 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
16396 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
16397 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
16398 as soon as the connection is made.
16399 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
16400 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
16401 connections immediately.
16403 If the connection is on a TLS-on-connect port then the TCP connection is
16404 just dropped. Otherwise, an SMTP error is sent first.
16406 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
16407 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
16408 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
16409 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
16410 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
16413 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
16414 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
16415 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
16416 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
16417 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
16418 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
16419 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
16420 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
16421 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
16423 hosts_connection_nolog = :
16425 The hosts affected by this option also do not log "no MAIL in SMTP connection"
16426 lines, as may commonly be produced by a monitoring system.
16429 .option hosts_require_alpn main "host list&!!" unset
16430 .cindex ALPN "require negotiation in server"
16432 .cindex TLS "Application Layer Protocol Names"
16433 If the TLS library supports ALPN
16434 then a successful negotiation of ALPN will be required for any client
16435 matching the list, for TLS to be used.
16436 See also the &%tls_alpn%& option.
16438 &*Note*&: prevention of fallback to in-clear connection is not
16439 managed by this option, and should be done separately.
16442 .option hosts_require_helo main "host list&!!" *
16443 .cindex "HELO/EHLO" requiring
16444 Exim will require an accepted HELO or EHLO command from a host matching
16445 this list, before accepting a MAIL command.
16448 .option hosts_proxy main "host list&!!" unset
16449 .cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
16450 This option enables use of Proxy Protocol proxies for incoming
16451 connections. For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
16454 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
16455 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
16456 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
16457 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
16458 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
16460 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
16461 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
16463 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
16464 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
16465 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
16466 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
16467 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
16468 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
16469 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
16472 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
16473 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
16474 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
16475 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
16476 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
16480 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
16481 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
16482 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
16483 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
16484 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
16485 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
16487 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
16488 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
16489 message has been in the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
16490 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
16491 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
16492 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
16493 for frozen messages. For example,
16495 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
16497 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
16498 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
16499 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
16500 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
16501 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
16502 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
16505 .options ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset &&&
16506 ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
16507 .cindex "&""From""& line"
16508 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
16509 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
16510 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
16511 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
16512 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
16513 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
16514 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
16515 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
16519 .option keep_environment main "string list" unset
16520 .cindex "environment" "values from"
16521 This option contains a string list of environment variables to keep.
16522 You have to trust these variables or you have to be sure that
16523 these variables do not impose any security risk. Keep in mind that
16524 during the startup phase Exim is running with an effective UID 0 in most
16525 installations. As the default value is an empty list, the default
16526 environment for using libraries, running embedded Perl code, or running
16527 external binaries is empty, and does not not even contain PATH or HOME.
16529 Actually the list is interpreted as a list of patterns
16530 (&<<SECTlistexpand>>&), except that it is not expanded first.
16532 WARNING: Macro substitution is still done first, so having a macro
16533 FOO and having FOO_HOME in your &%keep_environment%& option may have
16534 unexpected results. You may work around this using a regular expression
16535 that does not match the macro name: ^[F]OO_HOME$.
16537 Current versions of Exim issue a warning during startup if you do not mention
16538 &%keep_environment%& in your runtime configuration file and if your
16539 current environment is not empty. Future versions may not issue that warning
16542 See the &%add_environment%& main config option for a way to set
16543 environment variables to a fixed value. The environment for &(pipe)&
16544 transports is handled separately, see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for
16548 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
16549 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
16550 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
16551 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
16555 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
16556 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
16557 .cindex certificate "directory for LDAP"
16558 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
16559 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
16560 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
16561 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
16562 and constrained to be a directory.
16565 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
16566 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
16567 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
16568 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
16569 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
16570 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
16571 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
16572 and constrained to be a file.
16575 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
16576 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
16577 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
16578 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
16579 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
16580 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
16583 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
16584 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
16585 .cindex certificate "key for LDAP"
16586 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
16587 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
16588 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
16589 identity to be proven.
16592 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
16593 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
16594 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
16595 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
16596 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
16599 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
16600 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
16601 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
16602 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
16603 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
16607 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
16608 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
16609 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
16610 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
16611 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
16612 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
16616 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
16617 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
16618 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
16619 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
16620 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
16622 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
16623 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
16624 This option is ignored for &`ldapi`& connections.
16627 .option ldap_version main integer unset
16628 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
16629 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
16630 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
16631 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
16632 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
16633 has been built with LDAP support.
16637 .option limits_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16638 .cindex LIMITS "suppressing advertising"
16639 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" LIMITS
16640 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
16641 LIMITS extension (RFC 9422) to specific hosts.
16642 If permitted, Exim as a server will advertise in the EHLO response
16643 the limit for RCPT commands set by the &%recipients_max%& option (if it is set)
16644 and the limit for MAIL commands set by the &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%&
16647 .option local_from_check main boolean true
16648 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
16649 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
16650 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
16651 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
16652 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
16653 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
16655 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
16656 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
16657 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
16659 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
16660 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
16661 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
16662 and the default qualify domain.
16664 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
16665 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
16666 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
16667 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
16669 .cindex "envelope from"
16670 .cindex "envelope sender"
16671 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
16672 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
16673 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
16675 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
16676 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
16677 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
16682 .options local_from_prefix main string unset &&&
16683 local_from_suffix main string unset
16684 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
16685 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
16686 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
16687 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
16688 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
16689 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
16692 local_from_prefix = *-
16694 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
16696 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
16698 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
16699 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
16703 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
16704 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
16705 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
16706 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
16707 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
16708 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
16709 &%local_interfaces%& is
16711 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
16713 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
16715 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
16718 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
16719 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
16720 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
16721 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
16722 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
16723 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
16724 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
16725 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
16729 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
16730 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
16731 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
16732 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
16733 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
16734 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
16735 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
16736 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
16741 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
16742 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
16743 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
16744 .cindex multiple "systems sharing a spool"
16745 .cindex "multiple hosts" "sharing a spool"
16746 .cindex "shared spool directory"
16747 .cindex "spool directory" sharing
16748 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
16749 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
16750 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required
16751 (eg. because they share a spool directory),
16752 each host must set a different
16753 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
16754 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
16755 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
16756 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
16757 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
16758 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number%& is set, the final four
16759 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
16760 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
16761 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
16765 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
16766 .cindex "log" "file path for"
16767 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
16768 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
16769 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
16770 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or runtime,
16771 or if the option is unset at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
16772 they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
16773 A path must start with a slash.
16774 To send to syslog, use the word &"syslog"&.
16775 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
16776 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
16777 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
16778 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
16779 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
16780 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
16781 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
16784 .option log_selector main string unset
16785 .cindex "log" "selectors"
16786 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
16787 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
16788 minus characters. For example:
16790 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
16792 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
16793 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
16796 .option log_timezone main boolean false
16797 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
16798 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
16799 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
16800 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
16801 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
16802 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
16803 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
16804 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
16805 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
16806 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
16807 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
16808 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
16811 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
16812 .cindex "too many open files"
16813 .cindex "open files, too many"
16814 .cindex "file" "too many open"
16815 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
16816 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
16817 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
16818 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
16819 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
16820 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
16821 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
16822 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
16823 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
16824 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
16825 &%lookup_open_max%&.
16828 .option max_username_length main integer 0
16829 .cindex "length of login name"
16830 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
16831 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
16832 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
16833 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
16834 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
16835 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
16838 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
16839 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
16840 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
16841 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
16842 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
16843 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
16844 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
16845 option is set true, this no longer happens.
16848 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
16849 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
16850 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
16851 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
16852 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
16853 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
16854 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
16857 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
16858 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
16859 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
16860 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
16861 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
16862 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
16863 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
16864 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
16865 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
16866 empty string, the option is ignored.
16869 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
16870 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
16871 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
16872 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by RFC 2822 to
16873 take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
16874 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
16875 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
16876 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
16877 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
16878 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
16879 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
16880 colons will become hyphens.
16883 .option message_logs main boolean true
16884 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
16885 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
16886 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
16887 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
16888 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
16889 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
16890 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
16891 which is not affected by this option.
16894 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
16895 .cindex "message" "size limit"
16896 .cindex "limit" "message size"
16897 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
16898 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
16899 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
16900 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
16901 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
16902 optionally followed by K or M.
16904 .cindex "SIZE" "ESMTP extension, advertising"
16905 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" SIZE
16906 If nonzero the value will be advertised as a parameter to the ESMTP SIZE
16907 service extension keyword.
16909 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
16910 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
16911 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
16912 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
16913 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
16915 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
16916 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
16917 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
16918 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
16919 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
16920 message that an individual transport can process.
16922 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
16923 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
16924 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
16925 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
16926 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
16927 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
16928 some problems may result.
16930 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
16931 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
16932 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
16935 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
16936 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
16937 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
16939 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
16941 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
16942 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
16943 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
16944 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
16945 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
16948 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
16949 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
16950 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
16951 contains a full description of this facility.
16955 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
16956 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
16957 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
16958 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
16959 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
16962 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
16963 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
16964 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
16965 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
16966 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
16969 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
16970 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
16971 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
16972 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
16973 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
16975 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
16976 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
16979 never_users = root:daemon:bin
16981 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
16982 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
16986 .option notifier_socket main string "$spool_directory/exim_daemon_notify"
16987 This option gives the name for a unix-domain socket on which the daemon
16988 listens for work and information-requests.
16989 Only installations running multiple daemons sharing a spool directory
16990 should need to modify the default.
16992 The option is expanded before use.
16993 If the platform supports Linux-style abstract socket names, the result
16994 is used with a nul byte prefixed.
16996 it should be a full path name and use a directory accessible
16999 If this option is set as empty,
17000 or the command line &%-oY%& option is used, or
17001 the command line uses a &%-oX%& option and does not use &%-oP%&,
17002 then a notifier socket is not created.
17005 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2 +no_sslv3 +single_dh_use +no_ticket +no_renegotiation"
17006 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
17007 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
17008 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
17009 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
17011 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
17012 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
17013 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
17014 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
17015 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
17016 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
17017 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
17019 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
17020 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
17021 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
17022 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
17023 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
17025 The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
17027 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
17028 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
17029 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
17030 some now infamous attacks.
17034 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
17035 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
17036 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
17038 # Disable older protocol versions:
17039 openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
17042 Possible options may include:
17046 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
17048 &`cipher_server_preference`&
17050 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
17054 &`legacy_server_connect`&
17056 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
17058 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
17060 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
17062 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
17064 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
17068 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
17082 &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
17086 &`single_ecdh_use`&
17088 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
17090 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
17092 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
17096 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
17099 As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
17100 all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
17101 to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
17102 to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
17103 release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
17104 where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
17107 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
17108 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
17109 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
17110 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
17111 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
17114 .option panic_coredump main boolean false
17115 This option is rarely needed but can help for some debugging investigations.
17116 If set, when an internal error is detected by Exim which is sufficient
17117 to terminate the process
17118 (all such are logged in the paniclog)
17119 then a coredump is requested.
17121 Note that most systems require additional administrative configuration
17122 to permit write a core file for a setuid program, which is Exim's
17123 common installed configuration.
17125 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
17126 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
17127 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
17128 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
17129 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
17130 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
17131 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
17132 also applied to RFC 2822 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
17133 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
17134 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
17137 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
17138 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
17139 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
17140 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
17141 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
17142 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
17143 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
17146 .options perl_at_start main boolean false &&&
17147 perl_startup main string unset
17149 These options are available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
17150 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of their use.
17152 .option perl_taintmode main boolean false
17154 This option enables the taint mode of the embedded Perl interpreter.
17157 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
17158 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
17159 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
17160 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
17161 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
17162 PostgreSQL support.
17165 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
17166 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
17167 .cindex "pid file, path for"
17168 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
17169 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
17172 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
17174 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
17176 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
17177 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
17178 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
17181 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17182 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
17183 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PIPELINING
17184 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
17185 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
17186 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
17187 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
17188 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
17189 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
17190 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
17192 .option pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17193 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
17194 .cindex "pipelining" PIPECONNECT
17195 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PIPECONNECT
17196 If Exim is built without the DISABLE_PIPE_CONNECT build option
17197 this option controls which hosts the facility is advertised to
17198 and from which pipeline early-connection (before MAIL) SMTP
17199 commands are acceptable.
17200 When used, the pipelining saves on roundtrip times.
17202 See also the &%hosts_pipe_connect%& smtp transport option.
17204 The SMTP service extension keyword advertised is &"PIPECONNECT"&;
17205 it permits the client to pipeline
17206 TCP connection and hello command (cleatext phase),
17207 or TLS-establishment and hello command (encrypted phase),
17208 on later connections to the same host.
17211 .option prdr_enable main boolean false
17212 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
17213 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PRDR
17214 This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
17215 to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
17216 If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
17217 If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
17218 an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
17219 is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
17221 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
17222 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
17223 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
17224 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
17225 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
17226 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
17227 volume of mail. Use with care!
17230 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
17231 .cindex "name" "of local host"
17232 .cindex "host" "name of local"
17233 .cindex "local host" "name of"
17234 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
17235 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
17236 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
17237 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
17238 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
17239 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
17241 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
17242 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
17243 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
17244 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
17245 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
17246 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
17249 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
17250 .cindex "printing characters"
17251 .cindex "8-bit characters"
17252 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
17253 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
17254 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
17255 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
17256 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
17259 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
17260 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses RFC 2047 encoding of
17261 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
17262 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
17263 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
17267 .option process_log_path main string unset
17268 .cindex "process log path"
17269 .cindex "log" "process log"
17270 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
17271 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
17272 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
17273 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
17274 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
17275 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
17276 different spool directories.
17279 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
17280 .cindex "restricting access to features"
17284 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
17285 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
17286 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
17289 .option proxy_protocol_timeout main time 3s
17290 .cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
17291 This option sets the timeout for proxy protocol negotiation.
17292 For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
17295 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
17296 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
17297 .cindex "address" "qualification"
17298 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
17299 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
17300 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
17301 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
17302 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
17303 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
17305 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
17306 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
17307 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
17308 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
17309 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
17310 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
17311 &%primary_hostname%& value.
17314 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
17315 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
17316 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
17320 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
17321 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
17322 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17323 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
17324 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
17325 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
17326 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
17327 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
17330 .option queue_fast_ramp main boolean true
17331 .cindex "queue runner" "two phase"
17332 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
17333 If set to true, two-phase queue runs, initiated using &%-qq%& on the
17334 command line, may start parallel delivery processes during their first
17335 phase. This will be done when a threshold number of messages have been
17336 routed for a single host.
17339 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
17340 .cindex "restricting access to features"
17342 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
17343 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
17344 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
17345 See also &%prod_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
17348 .option queue_only main boolean false
17349 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17350 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
17351 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
17352 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits in the queue for the
17353 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
17354 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
17356 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
17357 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
17358 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
17359 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
17362 .option queue_only_file main "string list" unset
17363 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17364 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
17365 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
17366 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
17367 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
17368 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
17369 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
17370 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
17372 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
17374 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
17375 &_/some/file_& exists.
17378 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
17379 .cindex "load average"
17380 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17381 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
17382 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
17383 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
17384 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
17385 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
17386 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
17389 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
17390 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
17391 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
17392 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
17395 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
17396 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
17397 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
17398 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
17399 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
17400 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
17401 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
17402 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
17403 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
17404 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
17405 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
17406 re-evaluated for each message.
17409 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
17410 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17411 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
17412 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
17413 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
17414 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
17417 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
17418 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
17419 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
17420 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
17421 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
17422 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
17423 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
17424 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
17425 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
17426 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
17427 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
17428 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
17429 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
17433 .option queue_run_max main integer&!! 5
17434 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
17435 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
17436 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
17437 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
17438 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
17439 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
17440 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
17441 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
17443 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
17444 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
17445 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
17446 the daemon's command line.
17448 .cindex queues named
17449 .cindex "named queues" "resource limit"
17450 To set limits for different named queues use
17451 an expansion depending on the &$queue_name$& variable.
17453 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
17454 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17455 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
17456 .cindex "first pass routing"
17457 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
17458 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
17459 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
17460 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
17461 message waits in the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
17462 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
17463 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
17464 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
17465 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
17466 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
17470 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
17471 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
17472 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
17473 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
17474 the value is zero, it will wait forever. This setting is overridden by the
17475 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
17476 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
17478 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
17479 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
17480 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
17481 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
17482 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
17483 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
17484 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
17485 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
17486 &"Received:"& and conform to the RFC 2822 specification for &'Received:'&
17488 The default setting is:
17491 received_header_text = Received: \
17492 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
17493 {${if def:sender_ident \
17494 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
17495 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
17496 by $primary_hostname \
17497 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol }}\
17498 ${if def:tls_in_ver { ($tls_in_ver)}}\
17499 ${if def:tls_in_cipher_std { tls $tls_in_cipher_std\n\t}}\
17500 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
17501 ${if def:sender_address \
17502 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
17503 id $message_exim_id\
17504 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
17507 The references to the TLS version and cipher are
17508 omitted when Exim is built without TLS
17509 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
17510 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
17511 header lines such as the following:
17513 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
17514 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
17515 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
17516 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
17517 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
17518 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
17519 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
17521 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
17522 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
17523 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
17524 message was accepted.
17527 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
17528 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
17529 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
17530 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
17531 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
17532 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
17533 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
17534 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
17537 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17538 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
17539 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
17540 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
17541 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
17542 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
17543 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
17544 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
17545 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
17546 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
17547 option was not set.
17550 .option recipients_max main integer&!! 50000
17551 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
17552 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
17553 If the value resulting from expanding this option
17554 is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
17555 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
17556 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
17557 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
17558 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
17561 For SMTP message the expansion is done after the connection is
17562 accepted (but before any SMTP conversation) and may depend on
17563 the IP addresses and port numbers of the connection.
17564 &*Note*&: If an expansion is used for the option,
17565 care should be taken that a resonable value results for
17568 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
17569 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
17570 RCPT commands in a single message.
17573 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
17574 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
17575 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
17576 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
17577 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
17578 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
17579 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
17582 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 4
17583 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
17584 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
17585 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
17586 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
17587 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
17588 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
17589 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
17590 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
17591 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
17592 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
17593 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
17594 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
17595 tagged with its process id.
17597 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
17598 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
17599 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
17600 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
17603 See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option,
17604 and the &%serialize_hosts%& smtp transport option.
17606 .cindex "number of deliveries"
17607 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
17608 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
17609 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
17610 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
17611 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
17612 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
17613 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
17614 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
17615 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
17616 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
17618 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
17619 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
17620 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
17621 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
17624 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
17625 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
17626 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
17627 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
17628 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
17630 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
17632 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
17633 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
17636 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
17637 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
17638 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
17639 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
17640 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
17644 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
17645 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
17646 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
17647 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
17648 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
17649 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
17650 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
17654 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
17655 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
17656 RFC 2821, section 4.4, states that an SMTP server must insert a
17657 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
17658 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
17659 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
17660 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
17661 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
17662 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
17663 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
17666 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
17667 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
17670 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
17672 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
17673 RFC 1413 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
17674 an item in the list.
17675 The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
17678 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
17679 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
17680 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
17681 This sets the timeout on RFC 1413 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
17682 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
17685 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17686 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
17687 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
17688 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
17689 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
17690 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
17691 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
17692 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
17693 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
17694 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
17697 .option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
17698 .cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
17699 .cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
17700 This option controls logging of slow lookups.
17701 If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
17702 and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
17703 Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
17707 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
17708 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
17709 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
17710 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
17711 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
17712 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
17713 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
17714 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
17715 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
17716 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
17717 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
17721 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
17722 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
17723 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
17725 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
17726 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
17727 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
17728 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
17729 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
17730 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
17732 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
17733 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
17734 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
17735 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
17738 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
17739 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
17740 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
17741 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
17742 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
17743 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
17744 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
17745 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
17747 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
17748 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
17749 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
17750 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
17751 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
17752 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
17753 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
17754 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
17757 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17758 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
17759 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
17760 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
17764 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
17765 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
17766 . We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
17767 . non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
17768 . zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
17769 . html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
17770 . inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
17771 . searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
17772 . the option name to split.
17774 .option smtp_accept_max_per_connection main integer&!! 1000
17775 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
17776 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
17777 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
17778 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
17779 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
17780 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
17781 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
17783 The option is expanded after the HELO or EHLO is received
17784 and may depend on values available at that time.
17785 An empty or zero value after expansion removes the limit.
17788 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
17789 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
17790 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
17791 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
17792 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
17793 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
17794 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
17795 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
17796 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
17797 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
17798 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
17800 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
17801 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
17802 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
17803 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
17804 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
17805 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
17809 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
17810 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
17811 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17812 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
17813 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
17814 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
17815 in the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
17816 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
17817 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
17818 to all messages received in the same connection.
17820 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
17821 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
17822 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
17823 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
17826 . See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
17828 .option smtp_accept_queue_per_connection main integer 10
17829 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17830 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
17831 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
17832 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
17833 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
17834 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
17835 number, subsequent messages are placed in the queue, but no delivery processes
17836 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
17837 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
17838 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
17839 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
17842 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
17843 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
17844 .cindex "host" "reserved"
17845 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
17846 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
17847 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
17848 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
17849 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
17850 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
17851 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
17852 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
17855 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
17856 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
17857 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
17858 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
17861 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
17862 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
17863 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
17864 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
17865 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
17866 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
17867 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
17868 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
17869 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
17871 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
17872 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
17873 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
17874 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
17876 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
17877 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
17878 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
17879 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
17880 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
17883 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
17884 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
17887 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
17888 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
17889 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
17890 &%helo_data%& value.
17892 .option smtp_backlog_monitor main integer 0
17893 .cindex "connection backlog" monitoring
17894 If this option is set to greater than zero, and the backlog of available
17895 TCP connections on a socket listening for SMTP is larger than it, a line
17896 is logged giving the value and the socket address and port.
17897 The value is retrived jsut before an accept call.
17898 This facility is only available on Linux.
17900 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
17901 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
17902 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
17903 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
17904 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
17905 If a connect ACL does not supply a message,
17906 this string (which is expanded every time it is used) is output as the initial
17907 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
17909 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
17910 $version_number $tod_full
17912 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error;
17913 a forced fail just closes the connection.
17914 If you want to create a
17915 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
17916 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
17917 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
17918 multiline response).
17921 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
17922 .cindex "checking disk space"
17923 .cindex "disk space, checking"
17924 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
17925 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
17926 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
17927 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
17928 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
17929 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
17932 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
17933 .cindex "connection backlog" "set maximum"
17934 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
17935 .cindex "backlog of connections"
17936 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
17937 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
17938 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
17939 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
17940 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
17941 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
17942 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
17943 attacks by SYN flooding.
17946 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
17947 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
17948 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
17949 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
17950 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
17951 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
17952 fewer, but they still exist.
17954 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
17955 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
17956 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
17957 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
17958 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
17959 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
17960 does detect many instances.
17962 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
17963 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
17964 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
17965 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
17969 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
17970 .cindex "ETRN" "command to be run"
17971 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" ETRN
17972 .vindex "&$domain$&"
17973 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
17974 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
17975 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
17976 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
17977 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
17980 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
17981 $sender_host_address
17983 If the option is not set, the argument for the ETRN command must
17984 be a &'#'& followed by an address string.
17985 In this case an &'exim -R <string>'& command is used;
17986 if the ETRN ACL has set up a named-queue then &'-MCG <queue>'& is appended.
17988 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
17989 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
17990 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
17991 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
17992 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
17996 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
17997 .cindex "ETRN" "serializing"
17998 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
17999 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
18000 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
18003 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
18004 .cindex "load average"
18005 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
18006 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
18007 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
18008 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
18009 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
18010 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
18014 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
18015 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
18016 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
18017 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
18018 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
18020 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
18022 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
18023 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
18024 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
18025 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
18026 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
18028 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
18029 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
18030 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
18031 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
18032 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
18033 not count towards the limit.
18037 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
18038 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
18039 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
18040 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
18041 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
18044 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
18045 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
18049 .options smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset &&&
18050 smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset &&&
18051 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
18052 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
18053 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
18054 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
18055 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
18056 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
18059 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
18060 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
18061 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
18062 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
18064 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
18065 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
18066 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
18067 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
18071 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
18073 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
18074 fractional parts are allowed here.
18076 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
18078 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
18079 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
18082 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
18083 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
18085 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
18086 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
18088 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
18089 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
18090 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
18091 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
18095 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
18096 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
18097 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
18098 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
18099 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
18100 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
18101 the message is abandoned.
18102 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
18104 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
18105 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
18107 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
18108 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
18110 If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
18111 expanded before use and may depend on
18112 &$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
18116 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
18117 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
18118 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
18119 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
18120 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
18123 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
18124 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
18125 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
18128 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
18129 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
18130 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
18131 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
18132 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
18133 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
18134 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
18135 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
18136 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
18137 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
18139 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
18140 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
18144 .option smtputf8_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
18145 .cindex "SMTPUTF8" "ESMTP extension, advertising"
18146 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" SMTPUTF8
18147 When Exim is built with support for internationalised mail names,
18148 the availability thereof is advertised in
18149 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
18150 chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>& for details of Exim's support for internationalisation.
18153 .option spamd_address main string "127.0.0.1 783"
18154 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
18155 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
18156 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
18160 .option spf_guess main string "v=spf1 a/24 mx/24 ptr ?all"
18161 This option is available when Exim is compiled with SPF support.
18162 See section &<<SECSPF>>& for more details.
18164 .option spf_smtp_comment_template main string&!! "Please%_see%_http://www.open-spf.org/Why"
18165 This option is available when Exim is compiled with SPF support. It
18166 allows the customisation of the SMTP comment that the SPF library
18167 generates. You are strongly encouraged to link to your own explanative
18168 site. The template must not contain spaces. If you need spaces in the
18169 output, use the proper placeholder. If libspf2 can not parse the
18170 template, it uses a built-in default broken link. The following placeholders
18171 (along with Exim variables (but see below)) are allowed in the template:
18175 &*%{L}*&: Envelope sender's local part.
18177 &*%{S}*&: Envelope sender.
18179 &*%{O}*&: Envelope sender's domain.
18181 &*%{D}*&: Current(?) domain.
18183 &*%{I}*&: SMTP client Ip.
18185 &*%{C}*&: SMTP client pretty IP.
18187 &*%{T}*&: Epoch time (UTC).
18189 &*%{P}*&: SMTP client domain name.
18191 &*%{V}*&: IP version.
18193 &*%{H}*&: EHLO/HELO domain.
18195 &*%{R}*&: Receiving domain.
18197 The capitalized placeholders do proper URL encoding, if you use them
18198 lowercased, no encoding takes place. This list was compiled from the
18201 A note on using Exim variables: As
18202 currently the SPF library is initialized before the SMTP EHLO phase,
18203 the variables useful for expansion are quite limited.
18206 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
18207 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
18208 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
18209 .cindex "directories, multiple"
18210 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
18211 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
18212 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
18213 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
18214 arrival of the message.
18216 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
18217 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
18218 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
18219 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
18220 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
18222 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
18223 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
18224 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
18225 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
18226 automatically deleted.
18228 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
18229 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
18230 trying to deliver each one, in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
18231 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
18232 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
18233 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
18234 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages in the queue. However,
18235 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
18236 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
18239 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
18240 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
18241 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
18242 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
18243 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
18244 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
18245 &$primary_hostname$&.
18247 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
18248 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
18249 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
18250 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
18251 as failures in the configuration file.
18253 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
18254 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
18256 .option spool_wireformat main boolean false
18257 .cindex "spool directory" "file formats"
18258 If this option is set, Exim may for some messages use an alternative format
18259 for data-files in the spool which matches the wire format.
18260 Doing this permits more efficient message reception and transmission.
18261 Currently it is only done for messages received using the ESMTP CHUNKING
18264 The following variables will not have useful values:
18266 $max_received_linelength
18271 Users of the local_scan() API (see &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&),
18272 and any external programs which are passed a reference to a message data file
18273 (except via the &"regex"&, &"malware"& or &"spam"&) ACL conditions)
18274 will need to be aware of the different formats potentially available.
18276 Using any of the ACL conditions noted will negate the reception benefit
18277 (as a Unix-mbox-format file is constructed for them).
18278 The transmission benefit is maintained.
18280 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
18281 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
18282 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
18283 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
18285 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
18286 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
18287 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
18288 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
18289 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
18290 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
18292 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
18293 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
18294 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
18295 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
18296 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
18297 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
18298 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
18301 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
18302 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
18303 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
18304 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
18305 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
18306 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
18307 domain causes a syntax error.
18308 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
18312 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
18313 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
18314 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
18315 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
18316 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
18317 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
18318 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
18319 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
18320 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
18321 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
18322 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
18323 the LOG_ALERT priority.
18326 .option syslog_facility main string unset
18327 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
18328 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
18329 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
18330 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
18331 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
18332 details of Exim's logging.
18335 .option syslog_pid main boolean true
18336 .cindex "syslog" "pid"
18337 If &%syslog_pid%& is set false, the PID on Exim's log lines are
18338 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. (Syslog normally prefixes
18339 the log lines with the PID of the logging process automatically.) You need
18340 to enable the &`+pid`& log selector item, if you want Exim to write it's PID
18341 into the logs.) See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
18345 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
18346 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
18347 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
18348 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
18349 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
18353 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
18354 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
18355 .cindex timestamps syslog
18356 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
18357 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
18358 details of Exim's logging.
18361 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
18362 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
18363 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
18364 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
18365 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
18366 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
18367 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
18368 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
18369 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
18370 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
18371 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
18372 A forced expansion failure results in no filter operation.
18375 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
18376 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
18377 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
18378 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
18379 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
18380 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
18383 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
18384 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
18385 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
18386 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
18387 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
18389 .option system_filter_group main string unset
18390 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
18391 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
18392 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
18393 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
18395 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
18396 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
18397 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
18398 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
18399 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
18400 contains the pipe command.
18403 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
18404 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
18405 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
18406 is used in a system filter.
18409 .option system_filter_user main string unset
18410 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
18411 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
18412 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
18413 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
18414 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
18415 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
18416 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
18417 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
18418 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
18420 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
18421 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
18422 transport option overrides.
18425 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
18426 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
18427 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
18428 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
18429 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
18430 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
18431 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
18432 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
18433 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
18434 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
18435 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
18436 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
18440 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
18441 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
18442 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
18443 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
18444 message of any kind that has been in the queue for longer than the given time
18445 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
18446 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
18447 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
18448 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
18449 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
18451 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
18452 frozen messages remain in the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
18453 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
18456 .option timezone main string unset
18457 .cindex "timezone, setting"
18458 .cindex "environment" "values from"
18459 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
18460 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
18461 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
18462 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
18466 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
18467 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
18468 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
18469 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
18470 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
18471 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
18474 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
18475 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
18476 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
18477 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
18478 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" STARTTLS
18479 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
18480 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
18481 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
18482 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
18483 Note that the default value requires that a certificate be supplied
18484 using the &%tls_certificate%& option. If TLS support for incoming connections
18485 is not required the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option should be set empty.
18488 .option tls_alpn main "string list&!!" "smtp : esmtp"
18489 .cindex TLS "Application Layer Protocol Names"
18491 .cindex ALPN "set acceptable names for server"
18492 If this option is set,
18493 the TLS library supports ALPN,
18494 and the client offers either more than one
18495 ALPN name or a name which does not match the list,
18496 the TLS connection is declined.
18499 .option tls_certificate main "string list&!!" unset
18500 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
18501 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
18502 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
18503 files which contain the server's certificates (in PEM format).
18504 Commonly only one file is needed.
18505 The server's private key is also
18506 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
18507 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
18509 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
18510 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
18511 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
18512 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
18514 &*Note*&: If you use filenames based on IP addresses, change the list
18515 separator in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) to avoid confusion under IPv6.
18517 &*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
18518 when a list of more than one
18519 file is used, the &$tls_in_ourcert$& variable is unreliable.
18520 The macro "_TLS_BAD_MULTICERT_IN_OURCERT" will be defined for those versions.
18522 .cindex SNI "selecting server certificate based on"
18523 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
18524 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
18525 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
18526 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
18528 If this option is unset or empty a self-signed certificate will be
18530 Under Linux this is generated at daemon startup; on other platforms it will be
18531 generated fresh for every connection.
18533 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
18534 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
18535 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
18536 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
18537 be the name of a file that contains CRLs in PEM format.
18539 Under OpenSSL the option can specify a directory with CRL files.
18541 &*Note:*& Under OpenSSL the option must, if given, supply a CRL
18542 for each signing element of the certificate chain (i.e. all but the leaf).
18543 For the file variant this can be multiple PEM blocks in the one file.
18545 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
18548 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
18549 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
18550 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
18551 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
18552 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
18553 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
18555 The value must be at least 1024.
18557 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
18558 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
18559 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
18561 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
18564 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
18565 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
18566 larger prime than requested.
18569 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
18570 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
18571 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
18572 to be used by Exim.
18574 &*Note: The Exim Maintainers strongly recommend using a filename with site-generated
18575 local DH parameters*&, which has been supported across all versions of Exim. The
18576 other specific constants available are a fallback so that even when
18577 "unconfigured", Exim can offer Perfect Forward Secrecy in older ciphersuites in TLS.
18579 If &%tls_dhparam%& is a filename starting with a &`/`&,
18580 then it names a file from which DH
18581 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
18582 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
18583 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
18584 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
18585 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
18586 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
18588 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
18591 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
18592 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
18593 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
18594 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
18596 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
18597 a default DH prime; the default is Exim-specific but lacks verifiable provenance.
18599 In older versions of Exim the default was the 2048 bit prime described in section
18600 2.2 of RFC 5114, "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
18601 in IKE is assigned number 23.
18603 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
18604 of DH primes specified in RFC 2409, RFC 3526, RFC 5114, RFC 7919, or from other
18605 sources. As names, Exim uses a standard specified name, else "ike" followed by
18606 the number used by IKE, or "default" which corresponds to
18607 &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
18609 The available standard primes are:
18610 &`ffdhe2048`&, &`ffdhe3072`&, &`ffdhe4096`&, &`ffdhe6144`&, &`ffdhe8192`&,
18611 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
18612 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
18613 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& and &`ike24`&.
18615 The available additional primes are:
18616 &`exim.dev.20160529.1`&, &`exim.dev.20160529.2`& and &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
18618 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
18619 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
18620 The open cryptographic community has suspicions about the integrity of some
18621 of the later IKE values, which led into RFC7919 providing new fixed constants
18622 (the "ffdhe" identifiers).
18624 At this point, all of the "ike" values should be considered obsolete;
18625 they are still in Exim to avoid breaking unusual configurations, but are
18626 candidates for removal the next time we have backwards-incompatible changes.
18627 Two of them in particular (&`ike1`& and &`ike22`&) are called out by RFC 8247
18628 as MUST NOT use for IPSEC, and two more (&`ike23`& and &`ike24`&) as
18630 Because of this, Exim regards them as deprecated; if either of the first pair
18631 are used, warnings will be logged in the paniclog, and if any are used then
18632 warnings will be logged in the mainlog.
18633 All four will be removed in a future Exim release.
18635 The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
18636 to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
18637 whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
18638 tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
18639 need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
18642 Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
18643 is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
18644 applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
18645 used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
18646 mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
18647 prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
18648 acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
18651 .option tls_eccurve main string list&!! &`auto`&
18652 .cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
18653 This option selects EC curves for use by Exim when used with OpenSSL.
18654 It has no effect when Exim is used with GnuTLS
18655 (the equivalent can be done using a priority string for the
18656 &%tls_require_ciphers%& option).
18658 After expansion it must contain
18659 one or (only for OpenSSL versiona 1.1.1 onwards) more
18660 EC curve names, such as &`prime256v1`&, &`secp384r1`&, or &`P-521`&.
18661 Consult your OpenSSL manual for valid curve names.
18663 For OpenSSL versions before (and not including) 1.0.2, the string
18664 &`auto`& selects &`prime256v1`&. For more recent OpenSSL versions
18665 &`auto`& tells the library to choose.
18667 If the option expands to an empty string, the effect is undefined.
18670 .option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
18671 .cindex TLS "certificate status"
18672 .cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
18674 must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
18675 status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
18676 Certificate Authority.
18678 Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
18679 The macro "_HAVE_TLS_OCSP" will be defined for those versions.
18681 For OpenSSL 1.1.0 or later, and
18682 for GnuTLS 3.5.6 or later the expanded value of this option can be a list
18683 of files, to match a list given for the &%tls_certificate%& option.
18684 The ordering of the two lists must match.
18685 The macro "_HAVE_TLS_OCSP_LIST" will be defined for those versions.
18687 The file(s) should be in DER format,
18688 except for GnuTLS 3.6.3 or later
18690 when an optional filetype prefix can be used.
18691 The prefix must be one of "DER" or "PEM", followed by
18692 a single space. If one is used it sets the format for subsequent
18693 files in the list; the initial format is DER.
18694 If multiple proofs are wanted, for multiple chain elements
18695 (this only works under TLS1.3)
18696 they must be coded as a combined OCSP response.
18698 Although GnuTLS will accept PEM files with multiple separate
18699 PEM blobs (ie. separate OCSP responses), it sends them in the
18700 TLS Certificate record interleaved with the certificates of the chain;
18701 although a GnuTLS client is happy with that, an OpenSSL client is not.
18703 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
18706 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
18707 operate the SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
18708 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
18709 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
18713 .option tls_privatekey main "string list&!!" unset
18714 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
18715 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
18716 files which contains the server's private keys.
18717 If this option is unset, or if
18718 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
18719 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
18720 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
18722 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
18725 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
18726 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
18727 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
18728 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
18729 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
18730 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
18734 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
18735 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
18736 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
18737 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
18738 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
18739 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
18740 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
18741 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
18742 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
18743 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
18744 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
18747 .option tls_resumption_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
18748 .cindex TLS resumption
18749 This option controls which connections to offer the TLS resumption feature.
18750 See &<<SECTresumption>>& for details.
18753 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
18754 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
18755 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
18756 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
18759 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
18760 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
18761 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
18762 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
18764 or the absolute path to
18765 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
18766 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
18768 The "system" value for the option will use a
18769 system default location compiled into the SSL library.
18770 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
18771 and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
18774 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
18775 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
18777 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
18779 either by file or directory
18780 are added to those given by the system default location.
18782 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
18783 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
18784 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
18785 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
18786 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
18787 use the explicit directory version. (If your peer is Exim up to 4.85,
18788 using GnuTLS, you may need to send the CAs (thus using the file
18789 variant). Otherwise the peer doesn't send its certificate.)
18791 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
18793 A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
18797 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
18798 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
18799 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
18800 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
18801 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
18802 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
18803 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
18804 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
18806 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
18807 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
18808 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
18810 &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
18811 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
18812 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
18813 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
18815 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
18816 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
18817 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
18818 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
18819 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
18820 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
18821 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
18824 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
18828 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
18829 .cindex "trusted groups"
18830 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
18831 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
18832 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
18833 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
18834 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
18835 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
18836 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
18839 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
18840 .cindex "trusted users"
18841 .cindex "user" "trusted"
18842 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
18843 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
18844 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
18845 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
18846 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
18847 Exim user are trusted.
18849 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
18850 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
18851 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
18852 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
18853 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
18854 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
18855 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
18856 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
18857 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
18860 .option unknown_username main string unset
18861 See &%unknown_login%&.
18863 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
18864 .cindex "trusted users"
18865 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
18866 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
18867 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
18868 .cindex "envelope from"
18869 .cindex "envelope sender"
18870 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
18871 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
18872 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
18873 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
18874 is used) is ignored.
18876 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
18877 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
18879 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
18881 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
18882 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
18883 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
18884 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
18885 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
18886 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
18887 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
18888 followed by a hyphen
18889 by a setting like this:
18891 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
18893 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
18894 restriction, you can use
18896 untrusted_set_sender = *
18898 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
18899 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
18900 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
18901 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
18902 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
18903 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
18904 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
18905 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
18907 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
18908 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
18909 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
18910 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
18914 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
18915 .cindex "&""From""& line"
18916 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
18917 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
18918 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
18919 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
18920 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
18921 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
18922 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
18923 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
18925 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
18926 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
18928 The pattern can be seen by running
18930 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
18932 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
18933 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
18934 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
18935 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
18936 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
18937 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
18940 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
18941 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
18944 .option warn_message_file main string&!! unset
18945 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
18946 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
18947 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
18948 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
18949 been in the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
18950 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
18951 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&.
18952 .cindex warn_message_file "tainted data"
18953 The option is expanded to give the file path, which must be
18954 absolute and untainted.
18955 See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
18958 .option wellknown_advertise_hosts main boolean unset
18959 .cindex WELLKNOWN advertisement
18960 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" WELLKNOWN
18961 This option enables the advertising of the SMTP WELLKNOWN extension.
18962 See also the &%acl_smtp_wellknown%& ACL (&<<SECTWELLKNOWNACL>>&).
18964 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
18965 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
18966 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
18967 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
18968 .ecindex IIDconfima
18969 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
18974 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18975 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
18977 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
18978 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
18979 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
18980 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
18981 Those that are preconditions are marked with ‡ in the &"use"& field.
18983 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
18984 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
18985 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
18986 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
18987 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
18989 The name of a router is limited to be &drivernamemax; ASCII characters long;
18990 prior to Exim 4.95 names would be silently truncated at this length, but now
18994 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
18995 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
18996 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
18997 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
18998 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
18999 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
19000 delivery of the address to be deferred.
19002 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
19003 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
19004 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
19005 routers, and the eventual transport.
19007 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
19008 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
19009 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
19010 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
19011 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
19013 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
19014 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
19015 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
19016 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
19017 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
19019 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
19020 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
19021 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
19023 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
19025 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
19027 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
19029 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
19030 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
19032 See also the &%set%& option below.
19034 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
19035 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
19036 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
19037 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
19038 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
19039 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
19040 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
19044 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
19046 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
19047 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
19048 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
19049 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
19050 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
19055 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
19056 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
19057 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
19058 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
19059 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
19060 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
19061 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
19062 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
19063 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
19064 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
19067 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
19069 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
19072 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
19074 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
19075 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
19076 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
19077 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
19080 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
19081 .cindex "case of local parts"
19082 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
19083 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
19084 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
19085 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
19086 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
19087 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
19088 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
19091 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19092 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
19093 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
19094 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
19095 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
19096 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
19097 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
19098 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
19099 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
19101 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
19102 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
19103 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
19104 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
19108 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
19109 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
19110 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
19111 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
19113 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
19114 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
19115 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
19116 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
19117 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
19119 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
19120 .cindex "de-tainting" "using router check_local_user option"
19121 &$local_part_data$& is set to an untainted version of the local part and
19122 &$home$& is set from the password data. The latter can be tested in other
19123 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
19124 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
19125 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
19126 the router is skipped.
19128 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
19129 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
19130 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
19131 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
19132 setting to achieve this. For example:
19134 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
19136 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
19137 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
19138 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
19142 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
19143 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
19144 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
19145 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
19146 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
19147 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
19148 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
19149 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
19151 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
19152 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
19154 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
19155 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
19157 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
19158 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
19159 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
19161 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
19163 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
19165 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
19168 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
19170 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
19171 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
19175 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
19176 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
19177 be specified using &%condition%&.
19179 Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
19180 are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
19181 they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
19182 parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
19183 ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
19184 Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
19185 Router rules processing behavior.
19187 This is best illustrated in an example:
19189 # If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
19190 # in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
19192 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
19195 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
19198 In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
19199 &"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
19200 default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
19201 (which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
19202 string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
19203 with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
19204 resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
19205 &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
19207 In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
19208 &%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
19209 mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
19210 conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
19213 Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
19214 true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
19215 match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
19216 contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
19217 expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
19220 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
19221 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
19222 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
19223 option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
19224 the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
19225 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
19226 output, and Exim carries on processing.
19227 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
19228 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
19229 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
19230 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
19231 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
19232 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
19233 The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
19237 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
19238 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
19239 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
19240 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
19241 transport option of the same name.
19243 .option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" *
19244 .cindex "MX record" "security"
19245 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
19246 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
19247 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
19248 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
19249 the DNSSEC request bit set.
19250 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
19252 .option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
19253 .cindex "MX record" "security"
19254 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
19255 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
19256 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
19257 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
19258 the DNSSEC request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
19259 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
19260 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
19263 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
19264 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
19265 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
19266 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the current domain matches
19268 The data returned by the list check
19269 is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
19270 expansions of the driver's private options and in the transport.
19271 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
19272 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
19274 A complex example, using a file like:
19280 and checking both domain and local_part
19282 domains = ${domain:${lookup {$local_part@$domain} lseach,ret=key {/path/to/accountsfile}}}
19283 local_parts = ${local_part:${lookup {$local_part@$domain} lseach,ret=key {/path/to/accountsfile}}}
19288 .option driver routers string unset
19289 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
19293 .option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
19294 .cindex "DSN" "success"
19295 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
19296 If this option is set true, and extended DSN (RFC3461) processing is in effect,
19297 Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
19298 instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
19299 Not effective on redirect routers.
19303 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
19304 .cindex "envelope from"
19305 .cindex "envelope sender"
19306 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
19307 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
19308 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
19309 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
19310 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
19311 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
19312 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
19314 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
19315 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
19316 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
19319 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
19320 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
19321 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
19322 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
19324 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
19325 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
19326 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
19327 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
19333 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
19334 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
19335 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
19336 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
19337 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
19339 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
19340 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
19341 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
19342 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
19343 setting &%return_path%&.
19345 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
19346 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
19347 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
19351 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
19352 .cindex "address" "testing"
19353 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
19354 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
19355 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
19356 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
19357 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
19358 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
19359 on for the system alias file.
19360 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19363 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
19364 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
19365 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
19369 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
19370 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
19371 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
19372 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
19376 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
19377 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
19378 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
19382 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
19383 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
19384 verifying a sender, verification fails.
19388 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
19389 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
19390 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
19391 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
19392 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
19393 changed (see section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&), and a port can be specified with
19394 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
19395 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
19396 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
19398 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
19399 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
19400 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
19401 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
19402 transport for further details.
19405 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
19406 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
19407 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19408 .cindex "transport" "local"
19409 .cindex "router" "setting group"
19410 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
19411 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
19413 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
19414 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
19415 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
19416 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
19417 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
19421 .option headers_add routers list&!! unset
19422 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
19423 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
19424 This option specifies a list of text headers,
19425 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
19426 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
19427 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
19428 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
19429 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
19430 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
19431 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
19432 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
19433 &"see"& the added header lines.
19435 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
19436 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
19437 an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
19438 failures are treated as configuration errors.
19440 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
19441 for a router; all listed headers are added.
19443 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
19444 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
19446 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
19447 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
19448 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
19449 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
19450 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
19451 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
19452 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
19453 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
19454 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
19455 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
19459 .option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
19460 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
19461 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
19462 This option specifies a list of text headers,
19463 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
19464 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
19465 However, the option has no effect when an address is just being verified.
19466 Each list item is separately expanded, at transport time.
19467 If an item ends in *, it will match any header with the given prefix.
19469 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
19470 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
19471 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
19472 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
19473 &"see"& the original header lines.
19475 The &%headers_remove%& option is handled after &%errors_to%& and
19476 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
19477 the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
19480 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
19481 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
19483 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
19484 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
19486 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
19487 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
19488 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
19489 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
19491 &*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
19492 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
19493 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
19497 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
19498 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
19499 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
19500 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
19501 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
19502 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
19503 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
19506 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
19510 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
19512 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
19513 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
19514 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
19515 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
19516 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
19517 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
19519 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
19520 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
19522 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
19523 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
19525 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
19526 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
19528 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
19529 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
19530 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
19531 domain that is being routed.
19533 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
19534 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
19537 .option initgroups routers boolean false
19538 .cindex "additional groups"
19539 .cindex "groups" "additional"
19540 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19541 .cindex "transport" "local"
19542 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
19543 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
19544 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
19545 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
19546 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
19550 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
19551 .cindex affix "router precondition"
19552 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
19553 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
19554 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
19555 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
19556 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
19559 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
19560 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
19561 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
19562 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
19563 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
19564 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
19565 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
19566 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
19567 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
19569 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19570 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
19571 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
19572 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
19573 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
19574 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
19575 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
19576 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
19577 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
19578 the relevant transport.
19580 .vindex &$local_part_prefix_v$&
19581 If wildcarding (above) was used then the part of the prefix matching the
19582 wildcard is available in &$local_part_prefix_v$&.
19584 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
19585 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
19586 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
19589 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
19590 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
19591 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
19592 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
19593 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
19597 local_part_prefix = real-
19599 transport = local_delivery
19601 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
19602 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
19604 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
19605 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
19608 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
19609 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
19610 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
19611 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
19614 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
19615 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
19619 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
19620 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
19621 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
19622 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
19623 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
19624 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
19625 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
19626 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
19627 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
19631 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
19632 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
19636 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
19637 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
19638 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
19639 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
19640 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19642 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
19643 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
19646 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain_data
19648 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
19649 the data returned by the list check
19650 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
19651 expansions of the router's private options or in the transport.
19652 You might use this option, for
19653 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
19654 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
19655 each virtual domain:
19659 local_parts = postmaster
19660 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
19664 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
19665 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
19666 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
19667 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
19668 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
19669 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
19670 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
19671 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
19672 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
19673 redirect addresses.
19677 .option more routers boolean&!! true
19678 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
19679 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
19680 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
19681 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
19682 delivery to be deferred.
19684 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
19685 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
19687 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
19688 means of the setting
19692 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
19693 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
19694 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
19696 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
19697 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
19698 controls what happens next.
19701 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
19702 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
19703 .cindex "router" "timeout"
19704 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
19705 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
19706 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
19707 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
19708 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
19710 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
19711 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
19712 applies to all of them.
19716 .option pass_router routers string unset
19717 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
19718 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
19719 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
19720 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
19721 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
19722 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
19723 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
19724 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
19725 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
19726 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
19730 .option redirect_router routers string unset
19731 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
19732 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
19733 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
19734 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
19735 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
19737 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
19738 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
19739 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
19740 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
19744 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
19745 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
19746 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
19747 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
19748 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
19749 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
19750 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
19752 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
19753 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used
19754 (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
19755 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
19756 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
19758 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
19759 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
19760 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
19761 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
19762 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
19765 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
19766 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
19769 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
19770 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
19771 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
19772 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
19773 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
19774 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
19775 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
19776 transport (e.g., &_.procmailrc_&).
19778 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
19779 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
19780 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
19781 operates as follows:
19783 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
19784 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
19785 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
19786 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
19789 require_files = mail:/some/file
19790 require_files = $local_part_data:$home/.procmailrc
19792 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
19793 &%require_files%& condition fails.
19795 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
19796 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
19797 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
19798 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
19800 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
19801 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
19802 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
19803 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
19804 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
19806 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
19807 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
19808 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
19809 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
19810 check again in that process.
19812 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
19813 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
19814 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
19815 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
19816 not exist. If the filename (or the exclamation mark that precedes the filename
19817 for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
19818 as if the file did not exist. For example:
19820 require_files = +/some/file
19822 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
19823 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
19824 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
19828 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
19829 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
19830 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
19831 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
19832 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
19833 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
19834 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
19835 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
19838 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
19839 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
19840 router. The default value is true for any router that has any of
19841 &%check_local_user%&,
19844 &%local_part_prefix%&,
19845 &%local_part_suffix%&,
19848 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
19849 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
19852 Failing to set this option when it is needed
19853 (because a remote router handles only some of the local-parts for a domain)
19854 can result in incorrect error messages being generated.
19856 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
19857 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
19858 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
19862 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
19863 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
19864 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
19866 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
19867 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
19868 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
19869 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
19870 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
19871 cause the router to defer.
19873 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
19874 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
19876 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19878 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
19879 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
19881 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
19882 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
19883 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
19884 of these values that is set:
19887 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
19889 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
19891 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
19893 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
19896 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
19897 router, but not for the transport.
19901 .option self routers string freeze
19902 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
19903 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
19904 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
19905 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
19906 and &(manualroute)& routers.
19907 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
19909 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
19910 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
19911 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
19912 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
19913 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
19915 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
19916 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
19917 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
19918 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
19919 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
19924 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
19926 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
19927 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
19928 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
19929 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
19931 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
19932 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
19933 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
19938 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
19939 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
19940 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
19941 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
19942 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
19943 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
19949 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
19950 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
19951 be passed to the next router.
19954 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
19957 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
19958 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
19959 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
19960 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
19961 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
19962 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
19967 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
19968 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
19969 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
19970 address matches something on the list.
19971 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19974 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
19975 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
19976 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
19977 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
19978 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
19979 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
19980 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
19984 .option set routers "string list" unset
19985 .cindex router variables
19986 This option may be used multiple times on a router;
19987 because of this the list aspect is mostly irrelevant.
19988 The list separator is a semicolon but can be changed in the
19991 Each list-element given must be of the form &"name = value"&
19992 and the names used must start with the string &"r_"&.
19993 Values containing a list-separator should have them doubled.
19994 When a router runs, the strings are evaluated in order,
19995 to create variables which are added to the set associated with
19997 This is done immediately after all the preconditions, before the
19998 evaluation of the &%address_data%& option.
19999 The variable is set with the expansion of the value.
20000 The variables can be used by the router options
20001 (not including any preconditions)
20002 and by the transport.
20003 Later definitions of a given named variable will override former ones.
20004 Variable use is via the usual &$r_...$& syntax.
20006 This is similar to the &%address_data%& option, except that
20007 many independent variables can be used, with choice of naming.
20010 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
20011 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
20012 .cindex "packet radio"
20013 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
20014 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
20015 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
20016 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
20017 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
20018 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
20019 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
20020 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
20022 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
20023 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
20024 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
20025 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
20026 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
20027 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
20028 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
20029 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
20030 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
20031 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
20033 translate_ip_address = \
20034 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
20037 The file would contain lines like
20039 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
20040 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
20042 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
20047 .option transport routers string&!! unset
20048 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
20049 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
20050 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
20051 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
20052 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
20053 delivery is deferred.
20055 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
20056 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
20057 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
20061 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
20062 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
20063 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
20064 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
20065 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
20066 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
20067 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
20068 overridden by a setting on the transport.
20069 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
20070 logged, and delivery is deferred.
20071 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
20077 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
20078 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
20079 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
20080 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
20081 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
20082 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
20083 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
20084 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
20085 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
20086 logged, and delivery is deferred.
20088 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
20089 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
20090 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
20091 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
20092 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
20094 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
20100 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
20101 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
20102 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
20103 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
20104 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
20105 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
20106 delivery to be deferred.
20108 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
20109 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
20110 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
20111 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
20112 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
20113 sometimes true and sometimes false).
20115 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
20116 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
20117 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
20118 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
20119 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
20120 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
20121 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
20122 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
20124 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
20125 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
20126 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
20127 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
20128 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
20129 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
20130 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
20131 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
20132 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
20133 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
20135 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
20136 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
20137 subsequent routers.
20140 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
20141 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
20142 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
20143 .cindex "transport" "local"
20144 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
20145 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
20146 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
20147 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
20148 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
20149 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
20150 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
20151 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
20152 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
20153 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
20154 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
20155 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
20159 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
20160 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
20161 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
20164 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
20165 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
20167 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
20168 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
20169 delivering in cutthrough mode or
20170 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
20171 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
20172 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
20173 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
20175 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
20176 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
20177 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
20181 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
20182 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
20184 delivering in cutthrough mode
20185 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
20186 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
20188 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
20191 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
20192 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
20193 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
20194 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
20196 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
20197 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
20198 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
20205 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20206 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20208 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
20209 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
20210 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
20211 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
20212 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
20213 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
20214 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
20215 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
20216 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
20220 domains = mydomain.example
20222 transport = local_delivery
20224 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
20225 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
20226 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
20227 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
20234 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20235 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20237 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
20238 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
20239 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
20240 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
20241 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
20242 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
20244 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
20245 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
20246 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
20247 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
20250 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
20251 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
20252 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
20253 except that IPv6 addresses are sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
20254 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
20255 generic option, the router declines.
20257 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
20258 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
20259 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
20261 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
20262 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
20263 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
20264 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
20265 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
20266 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
20269 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
20270 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
20271 Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
20272 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
20273 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
20274 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
20276 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
20277 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
20278 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
20279 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
20280 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
20281 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
20282 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
20283 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
20284 case routing fails.
20287 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
20288 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
20289 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
20290 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
20291 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
20293 The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
20294 is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
20296 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
20298 The domain does not exist in DNS
20300 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
20301 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
20302 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
20304 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
20306 MX record points to a non-existent host.
20308 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
20309 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
20311 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
20312 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
20314 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
20315 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
20317 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
20318 not be found in the MX records (see below)
20324 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
20325 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
20326 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
20328 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
20329 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
20330 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
20331 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
20332 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
20333 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
20334 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
20337 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
20338 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
20339 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records (see RFC 2782) in
20340 addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
20341 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
20342 required. For example,
20346 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
20347 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
20348 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
20349 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
20350 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
20353 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
20354 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
20355 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
20356 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
20357 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
20358 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
20360 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
20361 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
20362 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
20363 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
20364 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
20365 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
20366 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
20367 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
20369 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
20370 when there is a DNS lookup error.
20375 .option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
20376 .cindex "MX record" "not found"
20377 DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
20378 which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
20379 rather than the default behaviour of decline.
20380 This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
20381 domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
20382 However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
20386 .option ipv4_only "string&!!" unset
20387 .cindex IPv6 disabling
20388 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
20389 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
20390 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
20391 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
20392 only A records are used.
20394 .option ipv4_prefer "string&!!" unset
20395 .cindex IPv4 preference
20396 .cindex DNS "IPv4 preference"
20397 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
20398 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
20399 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
20400 A records are sorted before AAAA records (inverting the default).
20402 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
20403 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
20404 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
20405 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
20406 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
20407 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
20408 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
20411 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
20413 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
20414 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
20415 the address record.
20418 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
20419 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
20420 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
20421 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
20426 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
20427 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
20428 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
20429 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
20430 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
20431 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
20432 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
20433 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
20434 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
20439 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
20440 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
20441 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
20442 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
20443 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
20444 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
20445 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
20446 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
20447 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
20448 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
20449 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
20451 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
20452 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
20455 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
20456 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
20457 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
20458 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
20459 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
20463 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
20464 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
20465 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
20466 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
20467 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
20468 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
20469 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
20470 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
20472 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
20473 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
20474 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
20475 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
20476 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
20477 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
20478 without processing them independently,
20479 provided the following conditions are met:
20482 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
20483 &%headers_remove%&.
20485 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
20492 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
20493 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
20494 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
20495 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
20496 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
20497 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
20498 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
20499 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
20500 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
20501 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
20503 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
20504 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
20509 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
20510 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
20511 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
20512 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
20517 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
20518 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
20519 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
20520 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
20523 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
20525 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
20526 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
20527 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
20528 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
20529 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
20530 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
20533 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
20534 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
20535 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
20536 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
20537 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
20539 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
20540 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
20541 such as that implied by
20545 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
20546 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
20547 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
20548 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
20558 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20559 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20561 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
20562 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
20563 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
20564 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
20565 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
20566 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
20567 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
20568 takes the form of an RFC 2822 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
20569 router handles the address
20573 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
20574 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
20575 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
20577 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
20579 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
20580 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
20582 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
20583 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
20584 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
20585 &%self%& option determines what happens.
20587 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
20588 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
20589 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
20590 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
20594 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20595 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20597 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
20598 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
20599 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
20600 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
20601 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
20602 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
20605 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
20607 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
20609 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
20610 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
20611 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
20612 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
20613 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
20614 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
20615 must not be specified for it.
20617 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
20618 .option hosts iplookup string unset
20619 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
20620 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
20621 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
20622 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
20623 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
20626 .option optional iplookup boolean false
20627 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
20628 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
20629 delivery to the address is deferred.
20632 .option port iplookup integer 0
20633 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
20634 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
20638 .option protocol iplookup string udp
20639 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
20640 protocols is to be used.
20643 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
20644 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
20647 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
20649 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
20650 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
20653 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
20654 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
20655 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
20656 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
20657 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
20658 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
20659 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
20660 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
20663 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
20664 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
20665 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
20666 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
20667 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
20668 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
20669 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
20670 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
20671 following could be used:
20673 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
20674 reroute = $local_part@$1
20677 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
20678 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
20679 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
20680 call. It does not apply to UDP.
20685 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20686 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20688 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
20689 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
20690 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
20691 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
20692 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
20693 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
20694 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
20695 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
20696 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
20697 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
20699 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
20700 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
20701 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
20702 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
20703 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
20704 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
20705 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
20708 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
20709 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
20710 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
20711 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
20712 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
20713 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
20714 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
20717 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
20718 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
20719 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
20720 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
20721 below, following the list of private options.
20724 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
20726 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
20727 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
20729 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
20730 See &%host_find_failed%&.
20732 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
20733 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
20734 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
20735 of the following values:
20744 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
20745 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
20746 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
20749 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
20750 router only if &%more%& is true.
20752 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
20753 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
20754 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
20755 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
20757 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
20758 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
20759 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
20762 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
20763 .cindex "randomized host list"
20764 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
20765 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
20766 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
20767 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
20768 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
20769 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
20770 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
20771 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
20773 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
20774 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
20775 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
20776 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
20778 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
20780 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
20781 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
20782 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
20783 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
20784 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
20787 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
20788 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
20789 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
20792 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
20794 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
20795 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
20799 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
20800 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
20801 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
20802 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
20805 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
20806 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
20807 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
20808 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
20809 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
20810 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
20811 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
20812 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
20814 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
20815 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
20816 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
20817 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
20818 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
20819 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
20820 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
20821 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
20826 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
20827 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
20828 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
20829 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
20830 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
20831 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
20833 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
20835 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
20839 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
20840 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
20842 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
20843 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
20844 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
20845 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
20846 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
20847 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
20848 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
20849 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
20850 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
20851 in a &%route_list%&).
20853 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
20854 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
20855 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
20856 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
20860 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
20861 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
20862 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
20863 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
20864 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
20865 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
20866 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
20869 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
20870 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
20872 This data can be accessed by setting
20874 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
20876 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
20877 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
20878 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
20879 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
20880 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
20885 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
20886 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
20887 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
20888 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
20889 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports.
20890 If the list is written with spaces, it must be protected with quotes.
20891 The format of each item
20892 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
20893 as described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&.
20895 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
20896 variables are set during its expansion:
20899 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
20900 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
20901 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
20903 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
20906 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
20908 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
20911 .vindex "&$value$&"
20912 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
20913 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
20915 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
20919 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
20920 semicolon is the default route list separator.
20924 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
20925 Each item in the list of hosts can be either a host name or an IP address,
20926 optionally with an attached port number, or it can be a single "+"
20927 (see &%hosts_randomize%&).
20928 When no port is given, an IP address
20929 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
20930 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
20931 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
20934 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
20935 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
20936 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
20938 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
20939 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
20942 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
20943 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
20944 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
20945 number follows. For example:
20947 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
20951 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
20952 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
20953 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
20954 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
20955 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
20958 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
20959 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
20960 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
20961 records in the DNS. For example:
20963 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
20965 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
20968 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
20970 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
20971 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
20972 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
20973 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
20974 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
20975 happens is controlled by the
20976 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
20977 &%self%& option of the router.
20979 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
20980 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
20981 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
20982 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
20983 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
20984 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
20985 defined by MX preferences.
20987 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
20988 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
20989 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
20991 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
20992 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
20993 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
20994 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
20996 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
20997 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
21000 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
21001 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
21002 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
21004 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
21005 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
21009 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
21010 The options are a sequence of words, space-separated.
21011 One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
21012 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
21013 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
21014 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
21015 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
21018 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
21019 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
21021 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
21022 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
21024 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
21025 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
21026 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
21028 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
21029 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
21030 timeout), delivery is deferred.
21032 &%ipv4_only%&: in direct DNS lookups, look up only A records.
21034 &%ipv4_prefer%&: in direct DNS lookups, sort A records before AAAA records.
21039 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
21040 domain2 host4:host5
21042 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
21043 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
21044 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
21045 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
21048 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
21049 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
21050 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
21051 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
21054 &*Compatibility*&: From Exim 4.85 until fixed for 4.90, there was an
21055 inadvertent constraint that a transport name as an option had to be the last
21060 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
21061 &%host_find_failed%& option.
21064 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
21065 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
21069 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
21070 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
21071 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
21074 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
21075 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
21076 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
21077 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
21079 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
21081 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
21082 your first router something like this:
21085 driver = manualroute
21086 domains = !+local_domains
21087 transport = remote_smtp
21088 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
21090 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
21091 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
21092 they are tried in order
21093 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
21094 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
21097 driver = manualroute
21098 transport = remote_smtp
21099 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
21101 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
21102 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
21103 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
21104 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
21105 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
21106 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
21107 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
21108 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
21111 .cindex "mail hub example"
21112 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
21113 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
21114 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
21115 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
21116 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
21117 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
21118 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
21119 lookup is easier to manage.
21121 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
21122 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
21126 driver = manualroute
21127 transport = remote_smtp
21128 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
21130 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
21131 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
21132 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
21133 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
21134 domain can be used to find the host:
21137 driver = manualroute
21138 transport = remote_smtp
21139 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
21141 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
21142 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
21143 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
21147 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
21148 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
21149 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
21150 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
21151 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
21152 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
21155 driver = manualroute
21156 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
21157 route_list = saved.domain.example
21159 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
21160 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
21161 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
21164 driver = manualroute
21166 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
21167 *.saved.domain2.example \
21168 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
21171 .vindex "&$domain$&"
21173 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
21174 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
21175 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
21176 the address if the lookup fails.
21179 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
21180 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
21181 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
21182 one way it can be done:
21188 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
21189 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
21190 return_fail_output = true
21195 driver = manualroute
21197 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
21199 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
21201 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
21203 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
21204 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
21205 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
21207 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
21208 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
21217 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21218 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21220 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
21221 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
21222 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
21223 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
21224 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
21225 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
21226 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
21227 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
21228 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
21229 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
21231 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
21233 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
21234 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
21235 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
21236 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
21237 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
21240 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
21241 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
21242 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
21243 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
21244 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
21245 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
21248 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
21249 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
21250 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
21251 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
21252 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
21253 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
21254 not set, a value for the gid also.
21256 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
21257 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
21258 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
21259 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
21260 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
21261 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
21265 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
21266 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
21267 before running the command.
21270 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
21271 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
21272 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
21276 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
21277 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
21278 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
21279 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
21280 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
21283 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
21286 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
21287 &%no_more%& is set.
21289 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
21290 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
21291 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
21292 included in the SMTP response.
21294 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
21295 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
21296 included in any SMTP response.
21298 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
21300 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
21301 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
21303 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
21304 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
21305 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
21308 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
21309 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
21312 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
21313 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
21315 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
21316 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
21317 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
21318 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
21320 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
21321 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
21322 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
21323 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
21324 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
21326 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
21327 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
21328 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
21329 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
21330 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
21332 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
21333 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
21334 variable. For example, this return line
21336 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
21338 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
21339 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
21340 .ecindex IIDquerou1
21341 .ecindex IIDquerou2
21346 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21347 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21349 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
21350 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
21351 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
21352 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
21353 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
21354 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
21355 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
21356 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
21357 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
21358 redirected in several different ways:
21361 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
21364 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
21366 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
21368 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
21370 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
21372 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
21374 It can be discarded.
21377 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
21378 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
21379 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
21380 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
21382 If success DSNs have been requested
21383 .cindex "DSN" "success"
21384 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
21385 redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
21389 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
21390 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
21391 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
21392 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
21393 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
21394 aliases, in a configuration like this:
21398 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
21400 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
21401 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
21402 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
21403 cause delivery to be deferred.
21405 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
21406 &_.forward_& files, like this:
21411 file = $home/.forward
21414 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
21415 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
21416 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
21417 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only RFC 2822 address
21420 .cindex "tainted data" "in filenames"
21421 .cindex redirect "tainted data"
21422 Tainted data may not be used for a filename.
21424 &*Warning*&: It is unwise to use &$local_part$& or &$domain$&
21425 directly for redirection,
21426 as they are provided by a potential attacker.
21427 In the examples above, &$local_part$& is used for looking up data held locally
21428 on the system, and not used directly (the second example derives &$home$& via
21429 the passsword file or database, using &$local_part$&).
21433 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
21434 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
21435 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
21436 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
21439 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
21440 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
21441 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
21442 practice the router may not be able to operate.
21444 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
21445 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
21446 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
21447 saves some resources.
21455 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
21456 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
21457 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
21458 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
21459 can be interpreted in two different ways:
21462 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
21463 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
21464 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
21465 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
21466 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
21467 document is intended for use by end users.
21469 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
21470 described in the next section.
21473 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the filename given
21474 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
21475 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
21476 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
21477 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
21481 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
21482 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
21483 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
21484 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
21485 addresses, filenames, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
21486 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
21487 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
21488 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
21489 commas or newlines.
21490 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
21493 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
21494 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
21495 next newline character is ignored.
21497 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
21498 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
21499 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
21500 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
21503 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21504 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
21505 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
21506 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
21507 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
21508 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
21511 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
21515 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
21516 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
21517 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
21518 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
21519 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
21520 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
21521 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
21522 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
21523 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
21524 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
21525 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
21527 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
21528 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
21529 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
21530 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
21531 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
21533 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
21535 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
21536 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
21537 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
21538 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
21539 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
21542 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid RFC
21543 2822 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
21544 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
21545 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
21546 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
21548 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
21549 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
21554 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
21555 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
21558 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
21560 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
21561 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
21562 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
21563 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
21564 should really contain
21566 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
21568 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
21569 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
21570 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
21574 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
21575 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
21576 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
21579 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
21580 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
21581 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
21582 as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
21583 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
21584 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
21585 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
21587 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
21588 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
21589 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
21590 in double quotes, for example:
21592 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
21594 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
21595 quote just the command. An item such as
21597 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
21599 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
21601 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
21602 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
21603 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
21604 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
21605 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
21606 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
21607 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
21608 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
21609 an &%accept%& router.
21612 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
21613 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
21614 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
21615 parse as a valid RFC 2822 address that includes a domain. For example,
21617 /home/world/minbari
21619 is treated as a filename, but
21621 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
21623 is treated as an address. For a filename, a transport must be specified using
21624 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
21625 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
21626 filename, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
21628 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
21629 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
21631 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
21632 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
21633 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
21634 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
21637 .cindex "included address list"
21638 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
21639 If an item is of the form
21641 :include:<path name>
21643 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
21644 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
21645 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
21646 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
21647 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
21648 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
21650 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
21652 It must be given as
21654 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
21656 .cindex "tainted data" "in filenames"
21657 .cindex redirect "tainted data"
21658 Tainted data may not be used for a filename.
21660 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
21661 .cindex "delivery" "discard"
21662 .cindex "delivery" "blackhole"
21663 .cindex "black hole"
21664 .cindex "abandoning mail"
21665 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
21666 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
21667 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
21671 can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
21672 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
21673 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
21675 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
21676 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
21677 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
21678 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
21682 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
21683 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
21684 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
21685 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
21686 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
21687 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
21688 redirection items of the form
21693 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
21694 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
21695 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
21696 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
21698 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
21700 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
21702 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
21703 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
21705 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
21706 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
21707 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
21709 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
21710 By default for verify, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
21711 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
21712 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
21713 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
21714 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
21715 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
21716 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
21717 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
21720 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
21721 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
21722 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
21723 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
21725 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
21726 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
21727 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
21728 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
21729 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
21731 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
21732 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
21733 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain in the queue so that a
21734 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
21735 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
21739 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
21740 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
21741 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
21742 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
21743 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
21744 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
21745 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
21749 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
21750 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
21751 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
21752 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
21753 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
21754 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
21755 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
21756 aliasing scheme of the type
21758 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
21762 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
21763 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
21764 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
21767 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
21768 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
21770 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
21771 the pipes are distinct.
21775 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
21776 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
21777 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
21778 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
21779 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
21780 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
21781 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
21782 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
21783 can be used to avoid this.
21786 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
21787 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
21788 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
21789 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
21790 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
21791 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
21792 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
21796 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
21798 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
21799 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
21802 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
21803 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
21804 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
21807 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
21808 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
21809 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
21810 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
21813 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
21814 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
21815 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
21816 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
21817 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
21818 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
21819 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
21821 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
21822 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
21825 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
21826 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
21827 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
21828 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
21829 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
21833 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
21834 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
21835 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
21836 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
21837 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
21838 let ordinary users do.
21842 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
21843 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
21844 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
21845 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
21846 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
21847 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
21849 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
21850 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
21851 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
21852 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
21853 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
21854 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
21856 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
21858 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
21859 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
21860 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
21861 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
21862 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
21863 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
21864 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
21865 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
21868 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
21869 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
21870 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
21871 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
21872 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
21873 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
21874 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
21875 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
21879 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
21880 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
21881 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
21882 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
21883 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
21884 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
21887 .option data redirect string&!! unset
21888 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
21889 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
21890 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
21891 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
21892 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
21894 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
21895 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
21896 terminated with newline characters. For example:
21898 data = #Exim filter\n\
21899 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
21901 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
21902 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
21903 choice into a newline.
21906 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
21907 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
21908 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
21909 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
21910 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
21913 .option file redirect string&!! unset
21914 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
21915 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
21916 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
21917 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
21918 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
21919 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
21920 entirely of comments), the router declines.
21922 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
21923 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
21924 runs a check on the containing directory,
21925 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
21926 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
21927 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
21928 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
21929 not, the router declines.
21932 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
21933 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
21934 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
21935 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
21936 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
21937 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
21938 it is running, the filename is in &$address_file$&.
21941 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
21942 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
21943 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
21944 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
21945 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
21948 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
21949 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21950 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21951 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
21955 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
21956 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21957 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21958 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
21959 &%allow_filter%& is true.
21964 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
21965 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21966 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
21967 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21968 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
21969 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
21970 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
21971 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
21972 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
21973 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
21974 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
21977 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
21978 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21979 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21980 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
21981 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
21984 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
21985 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21986 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21987 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
21988 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
21989 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
21991 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
21992 .cindex "restricting access to features"
21993 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
21994 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
21995 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
21996 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
21997 &_.forward_& files).
22000 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
22001 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22002 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22003 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
22004 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
22007 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
22008 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22009 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22010 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
22011 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
22012 of the embedded Perl support.
22015 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
22016 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22017 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22018 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
22019 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
22022 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
22023 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22024 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22025 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
22026 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
22029 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
22030 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22031 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22032 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
22033 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
22034 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
22035 &%one_time%& is set.
22038 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
22039 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22040 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22041 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
22042 to make use of &%run%& items.
22045 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
22046 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22047 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22048 If this option is true, items of the form
22050 :include:<path name>
22052 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
22055 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
22056 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22057 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22058 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
22059 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
22060 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
22061 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
22064 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
22065 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22066 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22067 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
22068 &%allow_filter%& is true.
22071 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
22072 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
22073 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
22074 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
22075 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
22080 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
22081 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
22082 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
22083 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
22084 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
22085 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
22086 bounce may well quote the generated address.
22089 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
22091 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
22092 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
22093 file did not exist.
22096 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
22098 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
22099 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
22100 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
22102 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
22103 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
22104 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
22105 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
22106 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
22107 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
22108 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
22109 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
22113 .option include_directory redirect string unset
22114 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
22115 redirection list must start with this directory.
22118 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
22119 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
22120 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
22123 .option one_time redirect boolean false
22124 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
22125 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
22126 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
22127 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
22128 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
22129 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
22130 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
22131 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
22132 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
22133 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
22134 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
22135 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
22136 before they subscribed.
22138 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
22139 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
22140 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
22141 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
22144 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
22145 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
22146 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
22147 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
22149 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
22150 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
22151 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
22153 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
22156 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
22157 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
22158 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
22159 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
22160 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
22164 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
22165 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
22166 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
22167 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
22168 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
22169 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
22170 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
22171 See &%check_owner%& above.
22174 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
22175 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
22176 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
22177 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
22180 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
22181 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
22182 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
22183 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
22184 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
22185 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
22186 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
22189 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
22190 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
22191 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
22192 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
22193 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
22194 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
22195 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
22196 &$qualify_recipient$&.
22198 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
22199 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
22200 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
22203 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
22204 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
22205 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
22206 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
22207 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
22208 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
22209 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
22210 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
22211 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
22212 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
22215 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
22216 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
22217 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
22218 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
22219 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
22220 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
22223 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
22224 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
22225 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
22226 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
22227 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
22228 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
22231 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
22232 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
22233 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
22234 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
22235 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
22238 .option sieve_inbox redirect string&!! inbox
22240 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
22241 name of the mailbox used for "keep" operations (explicit or implicit).
22244 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
22245 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
22246 :subaddress part of an address.
22248 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
22249 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
22250 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
22251 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
22254 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
22255 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
22256 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
22257 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
22258 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
22259 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
22260 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
22264 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
22265 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
22266 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
22267 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
22268 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
22269 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
22270 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
22271 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
22272 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
22273 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
22274 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
22275 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
22276 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
22277 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
22278 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
22279 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
22281 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
22282 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
22283 the following routers.
22285 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
22286 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
22287 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
22288 so it is passed to the following routers.
22290 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
22291 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
22292 action is specified by RFC 3028. The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
22293 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
22295 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
22296 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
22297 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
22298 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
22304 file = $home/.forward
22305 file_transport = address_file
22306 pipe_transport = address_pipe
22307 reply_transport = address_reply
22310 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
22311 syntax_errors_text = \
22312 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
22313 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
22314 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
22315 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
22316 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
22317 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
22318 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
22319 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
22320 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
22321 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
22323 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
22324 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
22325 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
22330 local_part_prefix = real-
22331 transport = local_delivery
22333 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
22334 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
22336 condition = ${if match {$sender_host_address}\
22337 {\N^(|127\.0\.0\.1)$\N}}
22341 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
22342 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
22345 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
22346 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
22347 .ecindex IIDredrou1
22348 .ecindex IIDredrou2
22355 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22356 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22358 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
22359 "Environment for local transports"
22360 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
22361 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment" "local transports"
22362 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
22363 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
22364 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
22365 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
22366 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
22368 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
22369 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
22370 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
22371 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
22373 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
22374 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
22375 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
22376 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
22377 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
22381 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
22382 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
22383 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
22384 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
22385 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
22386 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
22387 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
22390 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
22391 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
22395 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
22397 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
22398 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
22399 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
22400 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
22405 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
22406 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
22407 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
22408 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
22409 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
22410 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
22411 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
22412 group (set by the transport). For example:
22415 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
22419 transport = group_delivery
22422 # This transport overrides the group
22424 driver = appendfile
22425 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part_data
22428 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
22429 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
22430 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
22433 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
22434 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
22435 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
22436 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
22437 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
22438 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
22440 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
22441 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
22442 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
22443 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
22444 original gid is also used.
22446 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
22447 following that is set is used:
22450 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
22452 A &%group%& setting of the router;
22454 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
22455 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
22457 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
22459 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
22460 the uid is the creator's uid;
22462 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
22465 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
22466 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
22467 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
22468 The first of the following that is set is used:
22471 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
22473 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
22475 A &%user%& setting of the router;
22477 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
22482 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
22483 &%never_users%& list.
22489 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
22490 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
22491 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
22492 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
22493 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
22494 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
22495 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
22496 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
22497 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
22498 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
22501 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
22503 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
22505 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
22507 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
22510 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
22513 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
22515 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
22519 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
22520 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
22521 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
22525 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
22526 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22527 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22528 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
22529 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
22530 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
22531 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
22532 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
22533 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
22534 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
22535 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
22536 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
22537 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
22538 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
22546 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22547 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22549 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
22550 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
22551 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
22552 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
22553 The name of a transport is limited to be &drivernamemax; ASCII characters long;
22554 prior to Exim 4.95 names would be silently truncated at this length, but now
22557 The following generic options apply to all transports:
22560 .option body_only transports boolean false
22561 .cindex "transport" "body only"
22562 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
22563 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
22564 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
22565 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
22566 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
22567 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
22568 automatically suppress them.
22571 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
22572 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
22573 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
22574 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
22575 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
22576 logged, and delivery is deferred.
22579 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
22580 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
22581 deliveries by the transport or for any
22582 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
22583 what you are doing.
22586 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
22587 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
22588 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
22589 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
22591 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
22592 output, and Exim carries on processing.
22593 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
22594 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
22595 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
22596 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
22598 The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
22599 transport and the router that called it.
22601 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
22602 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
22603 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
22604 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
22605 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
22606 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
22607 safely be resent to other recipients.
22610 .option driver transports string unset
22611 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
22612 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
22615 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
22616 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
22617 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
22618 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
22619 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
22620 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
22621 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
22622 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
22623 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
22624 resent to other recipients.
22626 &*Note:*& If used on a transport handling multiple recipients
22627 (the smtp transport unless &%max_rcpt%& is 1, the appendfile, pipe or lmtp
22628 transport if &%batch_max%& is greater than 1)
22629 then information about Bcc recipients will be leaked.
22630 Doing so is generally not advised.
22633 .option event_action transports string&!! unset
22635 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
22636 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
22639 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
22640 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
22641 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
22642 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
22643 &%user%& (see below).
22646 .option headers_add transports list&!! unset
22647 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
22648 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
22649 This option specifies a list of text headers,
22650 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
22651 which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
22652 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
22653 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
22654 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
22655 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
22656 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
22658 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
22659 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
22662 .option headers_only transports boolean false
22663 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
22664 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
22665 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
22666 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
22667 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
22668 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
22669 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
22672 .option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
22673 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
22674 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
22675 This option specifies a list of text headers,
22676 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
22677 to be removed from the message.
22678 However, the option has no effect when an address is just being verified.
22679 Each list item is separately expanded.
22680 If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
22681 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
22682 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
22683 If an item ends in *, it will match any header with the given prefix.
22685 Matching headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
22686 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
22689 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
22690 for a transport; all listed headers are removed.
22692 &*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
22693 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
22694 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
22698 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
22699 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
22700 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
22701 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
22702 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
22703 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
22704 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
22705 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
22708 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
22711 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
22712 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
22713 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
22714 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
22715 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
22716 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
22717 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
22718 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
22719 change envelope recipients at this time.
22722 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
22723 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
22725 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
22726 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
22727 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
22728 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
22729 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
22730 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
22731 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
22735 .option initgroups transports boolean false
22736 .cindex "additional groups"
22737 .cindex "groups" "additional"
22738 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
22739 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
22740 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
22741 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
22744 .option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
22745 .cindex limit "transport parallelism"
22746 .cindex transport "parallel processes"
22747 .cindex transport "concurrency limit"
22748 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
22749 If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
22750 it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
22751 The control does not apply to shadow transports.
22753 .cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
22754 Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
22755 incremented whenever a transport process is being created. The record
22756 is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
22757 Obviously there is scope for
22758 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
22759 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
22761 If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
22762 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
22763 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
22764 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
22765 are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
22768 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
22769 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
22770 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
22771 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
22772 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
22773 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
22774 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
22775 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
22776 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
22777 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
22778 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
22779 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
22780 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
22785 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
22786 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
22787 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
22788 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
22789 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
22790 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
22791 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
22792 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
22795 local_part_prefix = *-
22797 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
22800 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
22802 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
22803 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
22804 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
22805 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
22806 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
22809 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
22810 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
22811 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
22812 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
22813 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
22814 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
22815 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
22816 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
22817 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
22819 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
22820 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
22821 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
22822 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
22824 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
22825 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
22826 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
22829 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
22830 .cindex "envelope sender"
22831 .cindex "envelope from"
22832 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
22833 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
22834 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
22835 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
22836 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
22837 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
22838 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
22839 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
22840 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
22842 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
22843 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
22845 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
22846 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
22847 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
22848 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
22849 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
22850 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
22851 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
22853 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
22854 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
22855 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
22856 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
22857 &%errors_to%& in a router.
22861 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
22862 .chindex Return-path:
22863 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
22864 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
22865 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
22866 have easy access to it.
22868 RFC 2821 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
22869 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
22870 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
22871 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
22872 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
22876 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
22877 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
22880 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
22881 .cindex "shadow transport"
22882 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
22883 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
22884 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
22886 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
22887 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
22888 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
22889 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
22890 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
22891 cause a log line to be written.
22893 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
22894 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
22895 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
22896 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
22897 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
22900 ST=<shadow transport name>
22902 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
22903 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
22904 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
22905 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
22906 headers that some sites insist on.
22909 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
22910 .cindex "transport" "filter"
22911 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
22912 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
22913 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
22914 individual users or via a system filter.
22915 If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
22917 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
22918 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
22919 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
22920 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock).
22921 The command must be specified as an absolute path.
22923 The process run by the command must use its standard input as the message
22924 data to be transformed, and write the results on its standard output.
22926 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
22927 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
22928 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
22929 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
22930 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
22931 &(pipe)& transports.
22933 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
22934 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
22935 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
22936 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
22937 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
22939 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
22940 care not to break RFC 2822 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
22941 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
22942 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
22944 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
22945 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
22946 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
22947 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
22948 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
22949 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
22951 .cindex "SIZE" "ESMTP extension"
22952 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
22953 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
22954 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
22955 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
22956 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
22957 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
22958 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
22960 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
22961 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
22962 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
22963 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
22964 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
22965 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
22966 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
22967 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
22968 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
22969 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
22972 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
22973 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
22974 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
22975 which the message is being sent. For example:
22976 . used to have $sender_address in this cmdline, but it's tainted
22978 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
22979 $host $host_address $pipe_addresses
22982 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
22983 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
22984 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
22986 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
22987 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
22988 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
22991 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
22993 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
22994 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise.
22996 Option strings in general have any fully-surrounding double quote wrapping
22997 removed early in parsing (see &<<SECTstrings>>&).
22998 Then, for this option, quotes protect against whitespace being
22999 regarded as a separator while splitting into the command argument vector.
23000 Either double or single quotes can be used here;
23001 the former interprets backlash-quoted charachters
23002 and the latter does not.
23004 If double quotes had been used in this example, they would have been
23005 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
23006 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
23007 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
23008 Exim tried to expand the first one.
23010 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
23011 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
23012 arguments. Consider this example:
23014 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
23015 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
23017 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
23018 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
23020 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
23021 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
23025 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
23026 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
23027 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
23028 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
23029 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
23030 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
23031 bounced from a transport filter.
23033 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
23034 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
23035 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
23038 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
23039 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
23040 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
23041 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
23042 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
23043 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
23044 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
23045 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
23046 becomes a temporary error.
23049 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
23050 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
23051 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
23052 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
23053 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
23054 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
23055 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
23058 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
23059 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
23060 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
23062 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
23063 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
23064 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
23065 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
23067 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
23068 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
23069 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
23076 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23077 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23079 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
23081 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
23082 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
23083 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
23084 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
23085 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
23086 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
23087 copy of the message is delivered each time.
23089 .cindex "batched local delivery"
23090 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
23091 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
23092 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
23093 local transport, for example:
23096 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
23097 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
23098 recipients saves space.
23100 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
23101 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
23103 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
23104 to a scanner program or
23105 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
23109 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
23110 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
23111 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
23113 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
23114 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
23115 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
23116 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
23117 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
23118 to certain conditions:
23121 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23122 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
23123 batching is possible.
23125 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23126 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
23127 addresses with the same domain are batched.
23129 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
23130 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
23131 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
23132 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
23133 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
23136 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
23137 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
23138 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
23142 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
23143 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
23144 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
23145 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
23146 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
23147 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
23148 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
23151 escape_string = ".."
23153 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
23154 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
23155 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
23157 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
23158 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
23159 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
23160 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
23161 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
23162 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
23164 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
23165 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23166 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
23167 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
23168 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
23169 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
23170 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
23171 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
23172 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
23177 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23178 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23180 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
23181 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
23182 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
23183 .cindex "directory creation"
23184 .cindex "creating directories"
23185 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
23186 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
23187 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
23188 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
23189 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
23190 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
23191 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
23192 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
23193 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
23194 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
23196 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
23197 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
23198 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
23201 .cindex "quota" "system"
23202 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
23203 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
23204 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
23206 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
23207 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
23208 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
23209 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
23211 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
23212 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
23215 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
23216 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
23217 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
23218 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
23223 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
23224 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
23225 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
23226 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
23227 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
23229 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
23230 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23231 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
23232 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
23233 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
23234 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
23235 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
23236 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
23237 operation. There are two cases:
23240 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
23241 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
23242 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
23243 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
23244 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
23245 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
23246 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
23248 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
23249 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
23250 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
23252 If the &%create_file%& option is set to a path which
23253 matches (see the option definition below for details)
23254 a file or directory name
23255 for the delivery, that name becomes de-tainted.
23257 .cindex "tainted data" "in filenames"
23258 .cindex appendfile "tainted data"
23259 Tainted data may not be used for a file or directory name.
23260 This means that, for instance, &$local_part$& cannot be used directly
23261 as a component of a path. It can however be used as the key for a lookup
23262 which returns a path (or component).
23265 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
23266 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
23267 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
23268 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
23273 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
23275 require "fileinto";
23276 fileinto "folder23";
23278 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
23279 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute filename. In the
23280 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the
23285 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
23286 way of handling this requirement:
23288 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
23289 {/var/mail/$local_part_data} \
23290 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
23292 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
23296 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
23297 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
23298 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
23301 An alternative for the &"keep"& aspect is to use the &%sieve_inbox%& option
23302 on the redirect router that calls the Sieve filter,
23303 to explicitly set the filename used.
23306 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
23307 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
23308 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
23309 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
23310 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
23311 path to the transport.
23313 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
23314 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
23317 &*Note 3*&: Permitting a user to enable writes to an absolute path
23318 may be a security issue.
23323 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
23324 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
23328 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
23329 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
23330 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
23331 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
23332 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
23333 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
23334 delivery is deferred.
23337 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
23338 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
23339 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
23340 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
23341 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
23342 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
23343 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
23344 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
23347 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
23348 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23349 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
23350 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
23354 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
23355 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23358 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
23359 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
23360 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
23361 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
23362 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
23365 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
23366 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
23367 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
23368 process is running.
23371 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
23372 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23373 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
23374 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
23375 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
23376 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
23377 contains is significant.
23379 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
23380 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
23381 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
23382 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
23383 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
23385 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
23386 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
23387 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
23388 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
23389 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
23390 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
23392 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
23393 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
23394 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
23395 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
23397 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
23398 .cindex "directory creation"
23399 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
23400 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
23401 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
23403 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
23404 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
23405 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
23406 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
23407 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
23411 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
23412 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
23413 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
23414 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
23415 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
23418 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
23419 &"belowhome"&, or to an absolute path.
23421 In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
23422 set for the transport, and the file or directory being created must
23424 The "belowhome" checking additionally checks for attempts to use "../"
23425 to evade the testing.
23426 This option is not useful when an explicit filename is
23427 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when filenames
23428 are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
23429 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
23430 &%file_must_exist%&.
23432 In the fourth case,
23433 the value given for this option must be an absolute path for an
23434 existing directory.
23435 The value is used for checking instead of a home directory;
23436 checking is done in "belowhome" mode.
23438 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
23439 .cindex "de-tainting" "using appendfile create_file option"
23440 If "belowhome" checking is used, the file or directory path
23441 becomes de-tainted.
23444 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
23445 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
23446 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
23447 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
23449 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
23450 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
23451 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
23452 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
23453 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
23455 The result of expansion must not be tainted, unless the &%create_file%& option
23459 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
23461 .vindex "&$inode$&"
23462 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
23463 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
23464 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
23466 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
23468 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
23469 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
23473 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
23474 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
23475 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
23478 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
23479 See &%check_string%& above.
23482 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
23483 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
23484 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
23485 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
23486 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
23487 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
23490 The result of expansion must not be tainted, unless the &%create_file%& option
23493 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
23494 .cindex "locking files"
23495 .cindex "lock files"
23496 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
23497 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
23499 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
23500 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
23503 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part_data
23504 file = /home/$local_part_data/inbox
23507 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
23508 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
23509 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
23510 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
23511 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
23512 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
23516 .option file_format appendfile string unset
23517 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
23518 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
23519 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
23520 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
23521 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
23522 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
23523 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
23524 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
23527 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
23528 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
23530 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
23531 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
23532 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
23533 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
23534 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
23535 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
23536 delivery is deferred.
23539 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
23540 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
23541 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
23542 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
23545 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
23546 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
23547 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
23548 .cindex "locking files"
23549 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
23550 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
23551 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
23552 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
23553 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
23554 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
23555 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
23556 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
23558 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
23559 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
23560 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
23561 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
23563 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
23564 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
23567 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
23569 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
23570 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
23571 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
23573 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
23574 local deliveries because of errors of the form
23576 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
23579 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
23580 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
23581 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
23582 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
23585 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
23586 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
23587 for details of locking.
23590 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
23591 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
23592 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
23595 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
23596 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
23597 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
23600 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
23601 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
23602 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
23603 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
23604 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
23607 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
23608 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
23609 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
23610 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
23611 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
23612 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
23613 external source that maintains the data.
23616 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
23617 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
23618 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
23619 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
23620 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
23621 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
23622 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
23623 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
23627 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
23628 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
23629 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
23630 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
23631 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
23632 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
23633 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
23634 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
23635 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
23636 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
23639 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
23640 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
23641 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
23642 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
23643 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
23644 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
23645 calculation. The default value is:
23647 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
23649 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
23650 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
23652 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
23654 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
23656 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
23657 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
23658 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
23659 directly into that directory.
23662 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
23663 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
23664 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
23667 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
23668 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
23669 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
23672 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
23673 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
23674 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
23675 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
23676 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
23677 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
23678 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
23679 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
23681 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
23682 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
23683 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
23684 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
23685 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
23686 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
23687 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
23688 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
23689 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
23690 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
23693 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
23694 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
23695 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
23696 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
23697 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
23698 below for further details.
23701 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
23702 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
23703 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
23706 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
23707 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
23708 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
23711 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
23712 .cindex "locking files"
23713 .cindex "file" "locking"
23714 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
23715 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
23716 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
23717 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
23718 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
23719 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
23720 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
23722 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
23723 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
23724 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
23731 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
23732 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
23733 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
23734 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
23735 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
23736 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
23737 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
23738 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
23740 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
23741 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
23742 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
23743 append messages to it.
23746 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
23747 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23748 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
23749 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
23750 in which case it is:
23752 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
23753 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
23755 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23756 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
23758 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
23759 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
23760 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
23761 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
23766 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23767 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
23769 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
23770 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
23771 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
23772 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
23773 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
23774 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
23775 value, and this option is ignored.
23778 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
23779 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
23780 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
23781 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
23782 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
23785 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
23786 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
23787 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
23788 on users about incoming mail.
23791 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
23792 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
23793 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
23794 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
23795 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
23796 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
23797 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
23798 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
23799 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
23801 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
23802 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
23803 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
23805 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
23806 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
23807 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
23808 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
23809 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
23810 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
23812 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
23813 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
23814 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, optionally followed by a slash
23815 and further option modifiers. If Exim is running on a system with
23816 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
23819 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
23820 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
23822 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
23824 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
23825 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
23826 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
23827 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
23828 system quota failures.
23830 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
23831 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
23832 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
23833 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
23834 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
23835 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
23836 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
23837 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
23838 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
23839 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
23842 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
23843 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
23844 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
23845 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
23846 delivery directory.
23849 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
23850 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
23851 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
23852 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
23853 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
23856 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
23857 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
23859 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
23860 See &%quota%& above.
23863 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
23864 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
23865 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
23866 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
23867 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the filename, and it
23868 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
23869 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
23871 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
23872 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
23873 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
23874 the file length to the filename. For example:
23876 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
23877 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
23879 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
23880 number of lines in the message.
23882 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
23883 filename (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
23884 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message filenames.
23886 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
23888 This option should not be used when other message-handling software
23889 may duplicate messages by making hardlinks to the files. When that is done Exim
23890 will count the message size once for each filename, in contrast with the actual
23891 disk usage. When the option is not set, calculating total usage requires
23892 a system-call per file to get the size; the number of links is then available also
23893 as is used to adjust the effective size.
23896 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
23897 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
23898 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
23900 quota_warn_message = "\
23901 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
23902 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
23903 This message is automatically created \
23904 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
23905 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
23906 a warning threshold that is\n\
23907 set by the system administrator.\n"
23911 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
23912 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
23913 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
23914 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
23915 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
23916 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
23917 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
23918 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
23919 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
23923 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
23925 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
23926 percent sign is ignored.
23928 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
23929 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
23930 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
23931 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
23932 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
23933 &'From:'& line, the default is:
23935 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
23937 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
23938 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
23941 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
23942 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
23946 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
23947 .cindex "envelope from"
23948 .cindex "envelope sender"
23949 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
23950 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
23951 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
23952 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
23953 for details of batch SMTP.
23956 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
23957 .cindex "carriage return"
23959 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
23960 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
23961 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
23962 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
23964 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
23965 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
23966 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
23967 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
23968 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
23969 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
23972 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
23973 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
23974 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
23975 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
23976 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
23977 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
23980 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
23981 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
23982 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
23983 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
23984 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
23986 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
23987 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
23988 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
23989 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
23991 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
23992 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
23993 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
23994 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
23995 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
23998 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
23999 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
24002 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
24003 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
24004 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
24005 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
24006 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
24007 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
24008 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
24010 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
24011 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
24012 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
24013 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
24016 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
24017 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
24018 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
24021 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
24022 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
24023 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
24024 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
24025 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
24026 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
24027 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
24028 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
24029 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
24031 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
24032 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
24033 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
24034 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
24039 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
24040 .cindex "appending to a file"
24041 .cindex "file" "appending"
24042 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
24045 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
24049 .cindex "directory creation"
24050 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
24051 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
24052 &%directory_mode%& option.
24055 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
24056 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
24060 .cindex "file" "locking"
24061 .cindex "locking files"
24062 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
24063 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
24064 reliably over NFS, as follows:
24067 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
24068 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
24069 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
24071 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock filename.
24073 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
24074 Unlink the hitching post name.
24076 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
24077 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
24078 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
24079 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
24081 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
24082 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
24083 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
24084 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
24085 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
24086 it before trying again.
24090 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
24091 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
24092 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
24095 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
24096 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
24097 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
24098 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
24099 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
24100 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
24101 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
24102 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
24103 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
24107 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
24108 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
24109 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
24110 delivery is deferred.
24113 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
24114 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
24115 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
24119 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
24120 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
24121 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
24124 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
24125 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
24126 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
24129 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
24130 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
24131 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
24132 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
24133 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
24134 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
24135 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
24136 that prevents link following.
24139 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
24140 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
24141 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
24142 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
24143 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
24146 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
24149 .cindex "file" "locking"
24150 .cindex "locking files"
24151 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
24152 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
24153 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
24154 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
24155 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
24157 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
24159 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
24160 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
24161 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
24163 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
24164 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
24165 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
24167 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
24168 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
24169 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
24170 delivery is deferred.
24172 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
24173 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
24174 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
24175 immediately. It retries up to
24177 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
24179 times (rounded up).
24182 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
24183 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
24186 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
24187 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
24188 .cindex "&""From""& line"
24189 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
24190 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
24191 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
24192 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
24193 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
24194 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
24195 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
24197 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
24198 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
24199 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
24200 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
24201 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
24202 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
24203 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
24205 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
24206 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
24207 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
24208 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
24211 .cindex "maildir format"
24212 .cindex "mailstore format"
24213 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
24214 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
24215 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
24216 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
24217 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
24219 .cindex "directory creation"
24220 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
24221 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
24222 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
24223 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
24224 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
24225 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
24230 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
24231 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
24232 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
24233 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
24234 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
24235 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
24236 &_new_& subdirectory.
24238 In the filename, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
24239 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
24240 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
24241 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
24242 filename. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
24243 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
24244 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
24246 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
24247 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
24248 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
24249 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
24250 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
24251 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
24252 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
24253 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
24255 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
24256 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
24257 folders. Consider this example:
24259 maildir_format = true
24260 directory = /var/mail/$local_part_data\
24261 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
24262 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
24263 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
24265 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
24266 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
24267 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
24268 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
24269 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
24270 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
24272 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
24273 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
24274 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
24275 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
24276 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
24278 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
24279 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
24280 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
24282 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
24283 .cindex "maildir++"
24284 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
24285 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
24286 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
24287 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
24288 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
24289 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
24290 amount of space used.
24292 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
24293 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
24294 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
24295 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
24296 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
24297 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
24302 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
24303 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
24304 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
24305 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
24306 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
24307 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
24310 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
24311 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
24312 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
24313 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
24314 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
24315 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
24316 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
24317 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
24318 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
24319 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
24320 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
24321 backwards compatibility).
24323 For one common implementation, you might set:
24325 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
24327 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
24329 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
24330 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
24331 &[stat()]& each message file.
24334 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
24335 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
24336 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
24337 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
24338 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
24339 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
24340 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
24341 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
24342 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
24344 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
24345 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
24346 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
24347 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
24348 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
24349 need to know the quota.
24351 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
24352 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
24354 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
24355 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
24356 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
24360 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
24361 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
24362 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
24363 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
24364 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
24365 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
24366 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
24367 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
24369 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
24370 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
24371 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
24372 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
24373 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
24374 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
24376 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
24377 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
24378 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
24379 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
24380 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
24381 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
24383 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
24384 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
24385 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
24386 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
24389 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
24390 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
24391 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
24392 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
24393 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
24395 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
24397 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
24398 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
24399 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
24400 .ecindex IIDapptra1
24401 .ecindex IIDapptra2
24408 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24409 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24411 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
24412 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
24413 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
24414 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
24415 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
24416 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
24417 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
24418 to the rules in RFCs 2822 and 3834, respectively.
24420 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
24421 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
24422 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
24423 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
24424 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
24427 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
24428 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
24429 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
24430 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
24431 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
24433 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
24434 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
24435 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
24436 transport is run as a consequence of a
24438 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
24439 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
24440 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
24441 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
24442 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
24443 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
24445 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
24446 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
24447 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
24448 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
24450 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
24451 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
24452 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
24453 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
24454 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
24455 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
24456 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
24458 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
24459 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
24460 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
24461 the transport defers.
24462 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
24463 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
24465 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
24466 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
24467 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
24468 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
24470 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
24471 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
24472 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
24473 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
24474 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
24475 problems. They are just discarded.
24479 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
24480 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
24482 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
24483 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
24484 message when the message is specified by the transport.
24487 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
24488 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
24489 when the message is specified by the transport.
24492 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
24493 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
24494 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
24495 string comes first.
24498 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
24499 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
24500 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
24503 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
24504 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
24505 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
24508 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
24509 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
24510 specified by the transport.
24513 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
24514 This specifies additional RFC 2822 headers that are to be added to the message
24515 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
24516 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
24519 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
24520 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
24521 the message is specified by the transport.
24524 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
24525 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
24529 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
24530 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
24531 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
24532 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
24533 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
24537 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
24538 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
24539 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
24540 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
24542 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
24543 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty filename, the message
24544 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
24545 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
24546 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
24547 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
24548 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
24551 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
24552 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
24553 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
24554 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
24555 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
24557 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
24558 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
24559 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
24560 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
24561 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
24562 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
24565 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
24566 See &%once%& above.
24569 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
24570 See &%once%& above.
24571 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
24574 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
24575 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
24576 specified by the transport.
24579 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
24580 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
24581 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
24582 configuration option.
24585 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
24586 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
24587 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
24588 automatic responses. For example:
24590 subject = Re: $h_subject:
24592 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
24593 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
24594 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
24595 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
24600 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
24601 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
24602 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
24603 the text comes first.
24606 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
24607 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
24608 when the message is specified by the transport.
24609 .ecindex IIDauttra1
24610 .ecindex IIDauttra2
24615 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24616 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24618 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
24619 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
24620 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
24621 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
24622 .cindex "LMTP" "over a unix-domain socket"
24623 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol (RFC 2033) over a pipe to a
24625 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
24626 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
24627 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
24628 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
24629 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
24630 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
24634 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
24635 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
24636 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
24639 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
24640 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
24643 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
24644 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
24645 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
24646 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
24647 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
24650 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
24651 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
24652 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
24653 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
24654 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
24655 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
24658 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
24659 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
24660 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
24661 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
24662 in its response to the LHLO command.
24664 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
24665 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
24666 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
24667 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
24670 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
24671 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
24672 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
24673 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
24678 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
24682 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
24683 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
24687 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24688 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24690 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
24691 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
24692 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
24693 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
24694 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
24695 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
24696 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
24697 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
24701 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24702 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
24703 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
24704 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
24705 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
24707 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
24708 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
24709 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
24710 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
24711 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
24712 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
24713 that are routed to the transport.
24715 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
24716 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
24717 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
24718 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
24719 &%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
24720 (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
24721 this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
24725 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
24726 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
24727 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
24729 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
24730 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
24731 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
24732 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
24733 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
24734 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
24735 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
24737 .cindex "tainted data" "in pipe command"
24738 .cindex pipe "tainted data"
24739 Tainted data may not be used for the command name.
24742 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
24743 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
24744 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
24745 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
24746 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
24747 Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
24748 of "1" to enforce serialization.
24753 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
24754 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
24755 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
24756 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
24757 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
24758 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
24759 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
24760 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
24761 &"local delivery failed"&.
24763 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
24764 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
24765 will be sent as normal.
24767 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
24768 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
24769 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
24770 apply in this case.
24772 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
24773 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
24774 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
24775 a non-existent command may be the problem.
24777 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
24778 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
24779 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
24780 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
24781 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
24782 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
24783 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
24788 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
24789 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
24790 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
24791 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
24792 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
24795 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
24796 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
24797 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
24798 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
24800 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
24801 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
24802 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
24803 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
24804 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
24806 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
24808 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
24809 arguments. You have to write
24811 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
24813 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
24814 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
24815 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
24816 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
24817 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
24818 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
24821 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
24824 .cindex "transport" "filter"
24825 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
24826 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
24827 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
24828 &`$pipe_addresses`& (no quotes).
24829 This is not a general expansion variable; the only
24830 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
24831 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
24832 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
24833 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
24834 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
24836 If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, special handling takes place
24837 for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
24838 is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
24839 argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
24840 &'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
24841 the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
24842 should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
24843 run while preserving the argument vector separation.
24845 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
24846 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
24847 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
24848 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
24849 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
24850 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
24851 control what is done with it.
24853 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
24854 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
24855 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
24856 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
24857 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
24858 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
24859 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
24860 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
24861 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
24862 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
24863 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
24867 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
24868 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
24869 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
24870 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
24871 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
24872 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
24873 environment. The environment for the &(pipe)& transport is not subject
24874 to the &%add_environment%& and &%keep_environment%& main config options.
24875 &*Note*&: Using enviroment variables loses track of tainted data.
24876 Writers of &(pipe)& transport commands should be wary of data supplied
24877 by potential attackers.
24879 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
24880 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
24881 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
24882 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
24883 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
24884 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
24885 &`LOGNAME `& see below
24886 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
24887 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
24888 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
24889 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
24890 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
24891 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
24892 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
24893 &`USER `& see below
24895 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
24896 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
24897 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
24898 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
24899 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
24900 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
24901 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
24904 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
24905 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
24906 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
24910 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
24911 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
24912 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
24913 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
24916 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
24917 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
24921 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
24922 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
24923 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
24924 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
24925 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
24926 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
24927 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
24928 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
24929 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
24930 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
24931 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
24934 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
24936 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
24937 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
24938 &%use_shell%& is set.
24941 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
24942 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
24945 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
24946 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
24947 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
24950 .option check_string pipe string unset
24951 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
24952 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
24953 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
24954 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
24955 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
24956 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
24957 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
24961 .option command pipe string&!! unset
24962 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
24963 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
24964 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
24965 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
24966 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
24967 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
24969 .cindex "tainted data"
24970 No part of the resulting command may be tainted.
24973 .option environment pipe "string list&!!" unset
24974 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
24975 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
24976 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
24977 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
24978 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
24979 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
24982 .option escape_string pipe string unset
24983 See &%check_string%& above.
24986 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
24987 .cindex "exec failure"
24988 .cindex "failure of exec"
24989 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
24990 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
24991 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
24992 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
24993 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
24996 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
24997 .cindex "signal exit"
24998 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
24999 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
25000 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
25001 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
25004 .option force_command pipe boolean false
25005 .cindex "force command"
25006 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
25007 Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
25008 the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
25009 is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
25010 useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
25011 command. For example:
25013 command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
25017 Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
25018 &%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
25019 separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
25022 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
25023 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
25024 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
25025 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
25026 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
25027 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
25029 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
25030 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
25033 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
25034 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
25035 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
25036 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
25037 and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
25038 written to the main log.
25041 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
25042 If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
25043 stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
25044 the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
25045 failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
25046 option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
25050 .option log_output pipe boolean false
25051 If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
25052 stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
25053 the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
25054 exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
25057 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
25058 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
25059 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
25060 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
25061 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
25062 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
25063 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
25064 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
25067 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
25068 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
25069 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
25072 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
25076 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
25077 .cindex "&""From""& line"
25078 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
25079 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
25080 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
25085 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
25086 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
25089 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
25090 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
25091 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
25092 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
25096 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
25097 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
25100 .option path pipe string&!! "/bin:/usr/bin"
25101 This option is expanded and
25102 specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
25103 variable of the subprocess.
25104 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
25105 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
25106 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
25109 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
25110 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
25111 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
25112 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
25113 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
25114 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
25115 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
25116 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
25117 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
25120 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
25121 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
25122 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
25123 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
25124 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
25125 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
25126 accept the message is used.
25129 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
25130 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
25131 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
25132 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
25133 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
25134 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
25137 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
25138 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
25139 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
25140 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
25141 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
25142 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
25143 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
25147 .option return_output pipe boolean false
25148 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
25149 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
25150 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
25151 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
25152 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
25153 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
25154 of them may be set.
25158 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
25159 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
25160 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
25161 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
25162 and &%return_output%& is not set,
25163 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
25164 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
25165 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
25166 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
25167 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
25168 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
25169 and 73, respectively.
25172 .option timeout pipe time 1h
25173 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
25174 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
25175 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
25176 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
25177 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
25178 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
25180 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
25181 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
25182 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
25183 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
25184 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
25185 delivery to be deferred.
25187 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
25188 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
25191 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
25192 .cindex "envelope sender"
25193 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
25194 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
25195 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
25196 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
25197 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
25199 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
25200 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
25201 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
25202 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
25203 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
25204 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
25208 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
25209 .cindex "carriage return"
25211 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
25212 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
25213 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
25214 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
25216 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
25217 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
25218 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
25219 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
25220 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
25223 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
25224 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
25225 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
25226 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
25227 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
25228 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
25229 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
25230 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
25231 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
25236 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
25237 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
25238 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
25239 .cindex "external local delivery"
25240 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
25241 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
25242 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
25243 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
25244 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
25245 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
25246 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
25247 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
25248 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
25249 configuration for &%procmail%&:
25254 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part_data
25258 check_string = "From "
25259 escape_string = ">From "
25261 user = $local_part_data
25268 transport = procmail_pipe
25270 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
25271 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
25272 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
25273 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
25274 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
25275 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
25277 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
25281 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
25282 use a shell to run pipe commands.
25285 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
25286 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
25287 . Used to have R: local_part_suffix = .* + T: -m $local_part_suffix_v
25288 . but that suffix is tainted so cannot be used in a command arg
25289 . Really, you'd want to use a lookup for acceptable suffixes to do real detainting
25292 local_delivery_cyrus:
25294 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
25295 -- $local_part_data
25307 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
25309 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
25310 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
25312 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
25313 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
25316 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25317 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25319 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
25320 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
25321 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
25322 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
25323 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
25324 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
25325 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
25326 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
25329 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
25330 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
25334 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
25335 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
25336 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
25337 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
25338 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
25339 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
25340 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
25342 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
25343 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
25344 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
25345 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
25346 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
25347 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
25352 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
25353 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
25354 no further messages are sent over that connection.
25358 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
25360 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25361 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
25362 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
25363 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
25364 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
25365 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
25366 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
25367 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
25370 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
25371 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
25372 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
25373 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
25374 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
25375 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
25376 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
25377 are the values that were set when the message was received.
25378 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
25379 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
25380 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
25381 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
25382 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
25383 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
25385 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
25386 and will be removed in a future release.
25389 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
25390 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
25391 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
25394 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
25395 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
25396 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
25397 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
25398 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
25399 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
25400 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
25401 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
25403 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
25404 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
25405 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
25406 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
25407 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
25408 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
25409 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
25410 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
25411 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
25414 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
25416 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
25417 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
25418 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
25419 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
25420 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
25423 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
25424 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
25425 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
25426 particular connection.
25428 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
25429 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
25430 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
25431 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
25433 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
25434 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
25435 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
25437 authenticated_sender = $local_part
25439 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
25440 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
25442 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
25443 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
25447 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
25448 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
25449 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
25450 authenticated as a client.
25453 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
25454 .cindex timeout "smtp transport command"
25455 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
25456 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
25457 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
25460 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
25461 .cindex timeout "smtp transport connect"
25462 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
25463 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
25464 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
25465 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
25466 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
25467 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by RFC 1123.
25470 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
25471 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
25472 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
25473 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
25474 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
25475 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
25476 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
25479 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" LIMITS
25480 If the peer advertises a LIMITS extension with a MAILMAX value,
25481 and either TLSS is in use or was not advertised,
25482 that value also constrains the result of this option.
25485 .option dane_require_tls_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
25486 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers for DANE"
25487 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
25488 .cindex DANE "TLS ciphers"
25489 This option may be used to override &%tls_require_ciphers%& for connections
25490 where DANE has been determined to be in effect.
25491 If not set, then &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used.
25492 Normal SMTP delivery is not able to make strong demands of TLS cipher
25493 configuration, because delivery will fall back to plaintext. Once DANE has
25494 been determined to be in effect, there is no plaintext fallback and making the
25495 TLS cipherlist configuration stronger will increase security, rather than
25496 counter-intuitively decreasing it.
25497 If the option expands to be empty or is forced to fail, then it will
25498 be treated as unset and &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used instead.
25501 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
25502 .cindex timeout "for transmitted SMTP data blocks"
25503 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
25504 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
25505 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
25508 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
25509 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25510 .option dkim_domain smtp "string list&!!" unset
25511 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25512 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
25513 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25514 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
25515 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25516 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
25517 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25518 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
25519 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25520 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
25521 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25522 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "per RFC"
25523 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25524 .option dkim_timestamps smtp string&!! unset
25525 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25528 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
25529 .cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
25530 .cindex retry "final cutoff"
25531 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
25532 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
25535 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
25536 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
25537 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
25538 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
25539 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
25540 unhappy at this prospect, so...
25542 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
25543 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
25544 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
25545 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
25546 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
25547 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
25548 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
25549 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
25553 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
25554 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
25555 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
25556 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
25557 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
25560 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
25561 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
25562 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
25563 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
25567 .option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" *
25568 .cindex "MX record" "security"
25569 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
25570 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
25571 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
25572 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
25573 the DNSSEC request bit set. Setting this transport option is only useful if the
25574 transport overrides or sets the host names. See the &%dnssec_request_domains%&
25579 .option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
25580 .cindex "MX record" "security"
25581 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
25582 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
25583 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
25584 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
25585 the DNSSEC request bit set. Setting this transport option is only
25586 useful if the transport overrides or sets the host names. See the
25587 &%dnssec_require_domains%& router option.
25591 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
25592 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
25593 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
25594 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
25595 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
25596 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
25597 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
25599 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
25600 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
25601 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
25602 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
25603 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
25606 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
25607 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
25608 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
25609 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
25610 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
25611 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
25612 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
25613 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
25615 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
25616 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
25617 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
25618 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
25619 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
25620 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
25622 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
25623 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
25624 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
25625 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
25626 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
25628 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
25629 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
25630 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
25631 copy of the message is sent.
25633 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
25634 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
25635 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
25636 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
25640 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
25641 .cindex timeout "for transmitted SMTP data accept"
25642 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
25643 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
25646 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
25647 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
25648 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
25649 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
25650 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
25651 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
25653 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
25654 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
25655 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
25656 implementations of TLS.
25658 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
25659 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
25660 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
25661 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
25662 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
25663 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
25664 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
25669 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
25670 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
25671 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
25672 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
25673 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
25674 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
25675 interface address, you could use this:
25677 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address} \
25678 {${listextract{1}{<\n $value}}} \
25679 {$primary_hostname}}
25681 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
25684 .option host_name_extract smtp "string list&!!" "see below"
25685 .cindex "load balancer" "hosts behind"
25686 .cindex TLS resumption
25687 Some mail-accepting sites
25688 (notably Microsoft)
25689 operate many servers behind a network load-balancer. When this is done,
25690 with separated TLS session caches, TLS session resuption becomes problematic.
25691 It will only succeed when the same server happens to be selected by the
25692 load-balancer, matching the session stored in the client's cache.
25694 Exim can pull out a server name, if there is one, from the response to the
25695 client's SMTP EHLO command.
25696 For normal STARTTLS use, the default value of this option:
25698 ${if and { {match {$host} {.outlook.com\$}} \
25699 {match {$item} {\N^250-([\w.]+)\s\N}} \
25702 suffices for one known case.
25704 During the expansion of this option the &$item$& variable will have the
25705 server's EHLO response.
25707 For TLS-on-connect connections we do not have an EHLO
25708 response to use. Because of this the default value of this option is
25709 set to a static string for those cases, meaning that resumption will
25710 always be attempted if permitted by the &%tls_resumption_hosts%& option.
25712 The result of the option expansion is included in the key used to store and
25713 retrieve the TLS session, for session resumption.
25715 Operators of high-load sites may wish to evaluate their logs for indications
25716 of other destination sites operating load-balancers, and develop a suitable
25717 expression for this option.
25718 The smtp:ehlo event and the &$tls_out_resumption$& variable
25719 will be useful for such work.
25721 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
25722 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
25723 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
25724 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
25725 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
25726 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
25728 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
25729 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
25730 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
25731 &%hosts_override%& is set.
25733 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
25734 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
25735 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
25736 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
25737 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
25738 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
25739 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
25741 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
25742 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
25743 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
25744 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
25745 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
25746 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
25747 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
25750 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
25751 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
25754 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
25755 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
25756 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
25757 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
25758 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
25759 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
25760 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
25761 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
25762 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
25763 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
25766 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
25767 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
25768 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PIPELINING
25769 Exim will not use the ESMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
25770 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
25772 .option hosts_pipe_connect smtp "host list&!!" unset
25773 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
25774 .cindex "pipelining" PIPECONNECT
25775 If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
25776 this option controls which to hosts the facility watched for
25777 and recorded, and used for subsequent connections.
25779 The retry hints database is used for the record,
25780 and records are subject to the &%retry_data_expire%& option.
25781 When used, the pipelining saves on roundtrip times.
25782 It also turns SMTP into a client-first protocol
25783 so combines well with TCP Fast Open.
25785 See also the &%pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts%& main option.
25788 When the facility is used, if the transport &%interface%& option is unset
25789 the &%helo_data%& option
25790 will be expanded before the &$sending_ip_address$& variable
25792 A check is made for the use of that variable, without the
25793 presence of a &"def:"& test on it, but suitably complex coding
25794 can avoid the check and produce unexpected results.
25795 You have been warned.
25798 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
25799 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
25800 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
25801 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25803 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
25804 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
25805 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
25806 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
25807 to any host that matches this list.
25810 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
25811 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
25812 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
25813 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
25814 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
25815 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
25816 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
25817 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
25820 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
25821 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
25822 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
25827 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
25828 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
25829 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
25830 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
25831 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
25832 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
25833 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
25834 explanation of when this might be needed.
25836 .option hosts_noproxy_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
25837 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
25838 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
25839 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
25840 For any host that matches this list, a TLS session which has
25841 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
25842 message on the same session.
25844 The traditional implementation closes down TLS and re-starts it in the new
25845 process, on the same open TCP connection, for each successive message
25846 sent. If permitted by this option a pipe to to the new process is set up
25847 instead, and the original process maintains the TLS connection and proxies
25848 the SMTP connection from and to the new process and any subsequents.
25849 The new process has no access to TLS information, so cannot include it in
25854 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
25855 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
25856 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
25857 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
25858 &%fallback_hosts%&.
25861 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
25862 .cindex "randomized host list"
25863 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
25864 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
25865 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
25866 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
25867 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
25868 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
25869 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
25870 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
25872 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
25873 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
25874 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
25875 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
25877 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
25879 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
25880 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
25881 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
25883 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
25884 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
25885 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
25886 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
25887 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
25888 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
25889 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
25890 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
25891 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
25894 .option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" "see below"
25895 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
25896 Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
25897 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
25898 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
25900 The default is &"**"& if DANE is not in use for the connection,
25901 or if DANE-TA us used.
25902 It is empty if DANE-EE is used.
25904 .option hosts_require_alpn smtp "host list&!!" unset
25905 .cindex ALPN "require negotiation in client"
25907 .cindex TLS "Application Layer Protocol Names"
25908 If the TLS library supports ALPN
25909 then a successful negotiation of ALPN will be required for any host
25910 matching the list, for TLS to be used.
25911 See also the &%tls_alpn%& option.
25913 &*Note*&: prevention of fallback to in-clear connection is not
25914 managed by this option; see &%hosts_require_tls%&.
25916 .option hosts_require_dane smtp "host list&!!" unset
25917 .cindex DANE "transport options"
25918 .cindex DANE "requiring for certain servers"
25919 If built with DANE support, Exim will require that a DNSSEC-validated
25920 TLSA record is present for any host matching the list,
25921 and that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made.
25922 There will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
25923 See the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router and transport options.
25924 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
25926 .option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
25927 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
25928 Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
25929 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
25930 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
25932 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
25933 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
25934 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
25935 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
25936 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
25937 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
25939 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
25940 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
25941 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
25942 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
25943 connects. If authentication fails
25944 and &%hosts_require_auth%& permits,
25945 Exim will try to transfer the message unauthenticated.
25946 See also chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
25948 .option hosts_try_chunking smtp "host list&!!" *
25949 .cindex CHUNKING "enabling, in client"
25950 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
25951 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
25952 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
25953 CHUNKING support, Exim will attempt to use BDAT commands rather than DATA.
25954 Unless DKIM signing is being done,
25955 BDAT will not be used in conjunction with a transport filter.
25957 .option hosts_try_dane smtp "host list&!!" *
25958 .cindex DANE "transport options"
25959 .cindex DANE "attempting for certain servers"
25960 If built with DANE support, Exim will look up a
25961 TLSA record for any host matching the list,
25962 If one is found and that lookup was DNSSEC-validated,
25963 then Exim requires that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made for that host;
25964 there will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
25965 See the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router and transport options.
25966 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
25968 .option hosts_try_fastopen smtp "host list&!!" *
25969 .cindex "fast open, TCP" "enabling, in client"
25970 .cindex "TCP Fast Open" "enabling, in client"
25971 .cindex "RFC 7413" "TCP Fast Open"
25972 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided
25973 the facility is supported by this system, Exim will attempt to
25974 perform a TCP Fast Open.
25975 No data is sent on the SYN segment but, if the remote server also
25976 supports the facility, it can send its SMTP banner immediately after
25977 the SYN,ACK segment. This can save up to one round-trip time.
25979 The facility is only active for previously-contacted servers,
25980 as the initiator must present a cookie in the SYN segment.
25982 On (at least some) current Linux distributions the facility must be enabled
25983 in the kernel by the sysadmin before the support is usable.
25984 There is no option for control of the server side; if the system supports
25985 it it is always enabled. Note that lengthy operations in the connect ACL,
25986 such as DNSBL lookups, will still delay the emission of the SMTP banner.
25988 .option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
25989 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
25990 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PRDR
25991 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
25992 PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
25993 for multi-recipient messages.
25994 The option can usually be left as default.
25996 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
25997 .cindex "bind IP address"
25998 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
26000 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26001 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
26002 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
26003 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
26004 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
26005 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
26006 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
26007 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
26010 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
26011 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
26012 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
26013 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
26014 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
26015 separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
26018 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
26020 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
26021 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
26022 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
26023 interface to use if the host has more than one.
26026 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
26027 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
26028 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
26029 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
26030 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
26031 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
26032 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
26033 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
26034 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
26035 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
26039 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
26040 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
26041 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
26042 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
26043 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
26045 .option max_rcpt smtp integer&!! 100
26046 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
26049 limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
26050 SMTP message transaction.
26051 A value setting of zero disables the limit.
26053 If a constant is given,
26054 each set of addresses is treated independently, and
26055 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
26058 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" LIMITS
26059 If the peer advertises a LIMITS extension with a RCPTMAX value,
26060 and either TLSS is in use or was not advertised,
26061 that value also constrains the result of this option
26062 and no parallel connections will be caused on meeting the RCPTMAX limit.
26065 .option message_linelength_limit smtp integer 998
26066 .cindex "line length" limit
26067 This option sets the maximum line length, in bytes, that the transport
26068 will send. Any messages with lines exceeding the given value
26069 (before a transport filter, if any)
26070 will fail and a failure-DSN ("bounce") message will if possible be returned
26072 The default value is that defined by the SMTP standards.
26074 It is generally wise to also check in the data ACL so that messages
26075 received via SMTP can be refused without producing a bounce.
26078 .option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
26079 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26080 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
26081 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
26082 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
26083 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
26084 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
26085 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
26087 It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
26088 &$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
26089 &$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
26091 If the connection is DANE-enabled then this option is ignored;
26092 only messages having the domain used for the DANE TLSA lookup are
26093 sent on the connection.
26095 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" LIMITS
26096 If the peer advertises a LIMITS extension with a RCPTDOMAINMAX value,
26097 and either TLSS is in use or was not advertised,
26098 this option is regarded as being false.
26101 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
26102 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
26103 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
26104 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
26105 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
26106 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
26107 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
26108 variable that contains an outgoing port.
26110 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
26111 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
26113 but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"& the default is &"lmtp"&
26114 and if &%protocol%& is set to &"smtps"& the default is &"smtps"&.
26115 If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
26118 Note that at least one Linux distribution has been seen failing
26119 to put &"smtps"& in its &"/etc/services"& file, resulting is such deferrals.
26123 .option protocol smtp string smtp
26124 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
26125 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
26126 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
26128 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
26129 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
26130 protocol (RFC 2033) instead of SMTP. This protocol is sometimes used for local
26131 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
26132 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
26134 &*Note*&: When using LMTP it should be considered whether the default values
26135 for some other features, such as DANE, are appropriate.
26137 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
26138 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
26139 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
26140 The Internet standards bodies used to strongly discourage use of this mode,
26141 but as of RFC 8314 it is preferred over STARTTLS for message submission
26142 (as distinct from MTA-MTA communication).
26145 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
26146 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
26147 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
26148 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
26149 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
26150 addresses is not affected.
26152 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
26153 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
26154 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
26155 Exim to use only the host name.
26156 Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
26159 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
26160 .cindex "serializing connections"
26161 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
26162 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
26163 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
26164 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
26165 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
26166 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
26167 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
26169 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
26170 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
26171 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
26172 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
26173 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
26174 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
26176 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
26177 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
26178 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
26179 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
26180 are used for ETRN serialization.
26182 See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
26185 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
26186 .cindex "SIZE" "ESMTP extension"
26187 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
26188 .cindex "size" "of message"
26189 .cindex "transport" "filter"
26190 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
26191 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
26192 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
26193 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
26194 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
26195 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
26196 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
26198 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
26199 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
26202 .option socks_proxy smtp string&!! unset
26203 .cindex proxy SOCKS
26204 This option enables use of SOCKS proxies for connections made by the
26205 transport. For details see section &<<SECTproxySOCKS>>&.
26208 .option tls_alpn smtp string&!! unset
26209 .cindex TLS "Application Layer Protocol Names"
26211 .cindex ALPN "set name in client"
26212 If this option is set
26213 and the TLS library supports ALPN,
26214 the value given is used.
26216 As of writing no value has been standardised for email use.
26217 The authors suggest using &"smtp"&.
26221 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
26222 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
26223 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
26225 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26226 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
26227 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
26228 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
26229 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
26232 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
26233 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
26234 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
26235 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
26239 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
26240 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
26241 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
26242 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
26243 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
26246 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
26247 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
26248 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
26249 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
26250 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
26251 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
26254 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
26257 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
26258 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
26260 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26261 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
26262 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
26263 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
26264 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
26265 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
26266 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
26267 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
26270 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
26271 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
26272 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
26274 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26275 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
26276 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
26277 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
26278 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
26279 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
26280 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
26281 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
26282 ciphers is a preference order.
26285 .option tls_resumption_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
26286 .cindex TLS resumption
26287 This option controls which connections to use the TLS resumption feature.
26288 See &<<SECTresumption>>& for details.
26292 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
26293 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
26295 .cindex SNI "setting in client"
26296 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
26297 If this option is set
26298 and the connection is not DANE-validated
26299 then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
26300 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
26301 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
26302 certificate and private key for the session.
26304 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
26306 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
26312 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
26313 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
26314 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
26315 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
26316 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
26317 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
26318 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
26319 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
26320 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
26321 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
26325 .option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
26326 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
26327 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
26328 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
26329 certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
26330 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
26331 Note that unless the host is in this list
26332 TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
26333 when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
26334 The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
26335 certificate verification succeeds.
26338 .option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
26339 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
26340 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
26341 This option give a list of hosts for which,
26342 while verifying the server certificate,
26343 checks will be included on the host name
26344 (note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
26345 versus the Subject-Alternate-Name (or, if none, Subject-Name) fields.
26346 Wildcard names are permitted,
26347 limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
26349 There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
26352 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
26353 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
26354 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
26356 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26357 The value of this option must be either the
26359 or the absolute path to
26360 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
26361 for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
26363 The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
26364 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
26365 is taken as empty and an explicit location
26368 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
26369 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
26371 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
26373 either by file or directory
26374 are added to those given by the system default location.
26376 The values of &$host$& and
26377 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
26378 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
26380 For back-compatibility,
26381 if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
26382 (a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
26383 and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
26386 .option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
26387 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
26388 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
26389 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
26390 certificate verification must succeed.
26391 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
26392 If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
26393 operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
26394 &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
26395 that connections use TLS.
26396 Fallback to in-clear communication will be done unless restricted by
26397 the &%hosts_require_tls%& option.
26399 .option utf8_downconvert smtp integer&!! -1
26400 .cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
26401 .cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
26402 If built with internationalization support,
26403 this option controls conversion of UTF-8 in message envelope addresses
26405 If, after expansion, the value is 1, 0, or -1 then this value overrides
26406 any value previously set for the message. Otherwise, any previously
26407 set value is used. To permit use of a previous value,
26408 set this option to an empty string.
26409 For details on the values see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
26414 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
26416 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
26417 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
26418 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
26419 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
26420 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
26423 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
26424 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
26425 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
26426 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
26429 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
26430 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
26431 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
26433 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
26434 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
26435 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
26436 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
26437 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
26439 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
26440 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
26441 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
26442 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
26443 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
26444 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
26445 see below for an exception).
26447 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
26448 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
26449 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
26450 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
26451 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
26453 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
26454 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
26455 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
26456 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
26457 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
26458 reached their retry times.
26460 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
26461 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
26462 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
26463 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
26464 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
26465 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
26466 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
26467 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
26468 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
26469 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
26472 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
26473 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
26474 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
26475 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
26476 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
26477 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
26479 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
26480 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
26481 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
26482 possible IP addresses have been tried.
26483 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
26484 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
26490 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26491 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26493 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
26494 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
26495 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
26496 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
26497 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
26498 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
26500 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
26501 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
26502 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
26503 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
26504 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
26505 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
26506 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
26508 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
26509 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
26510 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
26511 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
26514 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
26515 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
26516 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
26517 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
26519 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
26520 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
26521 facility; you do not have to use it.
26523 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
26524 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
26525 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
26526 address to which it applies.
26528 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
26529 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
26530 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
26531 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
26532 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
26533 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
26536 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
26537 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
26538 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
26539 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
26542 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
26543 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
26544 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
26545 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
26546 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
26549 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
26550 illustrated by these examples:
26553 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
26554 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
26555 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
26556 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
26558 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
26559 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
26564 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
26565 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
26566 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
26567 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
26568 message's processing.
26570 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
26571 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
26572 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SSECTrewriteS>>&), but no
26573 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
26574 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
26575 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
26576 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
26577 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
26578 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
26580 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26581 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
26582 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
26583 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
26584 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
26585 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
26586 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
26587 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
26588 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
26589 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
26591 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
26592 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
26593 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
26594 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
26595 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
26596 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
26598 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
26599 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
26600 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
26602 .cindex "envelope from"
26603 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
26604 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
26605 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
26606 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
26607 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
26608 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
26609 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
26610 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
26611 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
26613 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
26614 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
26620 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
26621 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
26622 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
26623 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the runtime
26624 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
26625 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full RFC
26626 2822 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
26627 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
26628 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
26629 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
26631 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
26633 might produce the output
26635 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
26636 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
26637 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
26638 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
26639 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
26640 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
26641 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
26642 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
26644 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
26645 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
26646 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
26647 set for a particular transport.
26650 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
26651 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
26652 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
26655 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
26657 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
26658 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
26659 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
26660 any colons must be doubled, of course).
26662 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
26663 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
26664 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
26665 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
26668 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
26669 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
26670 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
26672 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
26673 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
26674 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
26675 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
26676 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
26677 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
26678 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
26680 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26681 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
26682 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
26683 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
26684 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
26688 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
26689 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
26692 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
26693 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
26694 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
26695 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
26696 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
26697 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
26698 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
26699 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
26700 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
26702 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
26703 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
26704 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
26706 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
26707 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
26708 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
26709 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
26710 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
26711 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
26712 of pattern they are set as follows:
26715 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
26716 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
26717 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
26720 *queen@*.fict.example
26722 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
26724 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
26728 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
26729 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
26732 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
26733 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
26734 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
26735 rewriting rule of the form
26737 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
26739 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
26745 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
26746 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
26747 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
26748 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
26749 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
26753 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
26754 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
26755 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
26756 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
26757 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
26759 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
26761 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
26764 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26765 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
26766 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
26767 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
26768 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
26769 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
26770 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
26771 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
26772 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
26773 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
26774 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
26775 entry written to the panic log.
26779 .subsection "Rewriting flags" "SSECID153"
26780 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
26783 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
26786 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
26788 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
26791 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
26792 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
26796 .subsection "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
26798 .cindex rewriting flags
26799 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
26800 &<<SSECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
26801 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
26802 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
26803 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
26805 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
26806 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
26807 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
26808 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
26809 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
26810 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
26811 &`h`& rewrite all headers
26812 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
26813 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
26814 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
26816 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
26817 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
26818 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
26820 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
26821 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
26824 .subsection "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" SSECTrewriteS
26825 .cindex SMTP "rewriting malformed addresses"
26826 .cindex RCPT "rewriting argument of"
26827 .cindex MAIL "rewriting argument of"
26828 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
26829 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
26830 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
26831 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
26832 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
26834 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26835 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
26836 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
26837 compliant with RFCs 2821 and 2822 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
26838 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
26839 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
26840 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
26841 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
26844 .subsection "Flags controlling the rewriting process" SSECID155
26845 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
26846 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
26847 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
26850 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
26851 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
26852 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
26854 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
26855 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
26856 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
26857 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
26859 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
26860 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
26861 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
26863 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
26864 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
26865 to the working part of the address, with any comments and RFC 2822 &"phrase"&
26866 left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
26868 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
26872 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
26875 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
26876 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
26877 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
26878 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete RFC
26879 2822 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
26880 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
26881 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to RFC 2047. The character set
26882 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which gets its default at build time.
26884 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
26885 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
26889 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
26890 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
26892 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
26893 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
26894 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
26896 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
26897 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
26898 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
26899 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
26900 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
26901 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
26902 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
26903 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
26905 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
26906 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
26908 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
26910 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
26911 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
26913 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
26914 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
26915 messages that originate outside the local host:
26917 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
26918 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
26920 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
26923 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
26924 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
26925 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
26926 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
26927 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
26928 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
26929 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
26930 components. For example, the rule
26932 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
26934 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
26935 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
26936 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
26937 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
26938 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
26939 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
26940 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
26947 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26948 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26950 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
26951 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
26952 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
26953 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
26954 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
26955 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
26956 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
26957 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
26958 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
26959 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
26960 address, domain and error.
26962 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
26963 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
26964 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
26965 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
26966 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
26967 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
26968 log selector is set, the message
26969 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
26970 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
26971 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
26972 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
26974 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
26975 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
26976 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
26977 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
26978 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
26979 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
26980 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
26981 domain are maintained independently.
26983 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
26984 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
26985 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
26986 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
26987 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
26988 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
26989 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
26990 the local address is reached.
26992 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
26993 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
26994 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
26995 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
26996 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
26998 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
26999 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
27000 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
27001 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
27002 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
27003 messages that it should now be retaining.
27007 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
27008 .cindex "retry" "rules"
27009 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
27010 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
27011 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
27012 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
27013 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
27014 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
27015 message's sender, respectively.
27018 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
27019 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
27020 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
27021 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
27022 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
27023 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
27026 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
27028 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
27031 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
27033 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
27034 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
27037 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
27038 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
27039 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
27040 expressions work in address lists.
27042 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
27043 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
27047 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
27048 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
27049 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
27050 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
27051 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
27052 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
27053 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
27054 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
27055 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
27057 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
27058 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
27059 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
27060 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
27063 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
27064 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
27065 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
27066 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
27067 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
27068 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
27069 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
27070 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
27071 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
27072 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
27077 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
27079 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
27080 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
27081 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
27082 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
27083 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
27084 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
27086 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
27090 and the retry rules are
27092 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
27093 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
27095 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
27096 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
27097 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
27098 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
27099 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
27100 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
27102 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
27103 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
27104 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
27105 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
27107 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
27108 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
27109 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
27111 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
27113 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
27114 textual form of the IP address.
27116 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
27117 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
27118 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
27119 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
27122 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
27123 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
27124 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
27126 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
27127 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
27128 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
27130 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
27131 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
27133 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
27134 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
27137 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
27138 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
27139 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
27140 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
27141 retry rule of this form:
27143 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
27145 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
27146 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
27149 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
27150 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
27151 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
27152 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
27155 A DNS lookup for a host failed.
27156 Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
27157 its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
27158 Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
27159 its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
27161 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
27162 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
27164 .vitem &%refused_A%&
27165 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
27168 A connection was refused.
27170 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
27171 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
27173 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
27174 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
27176 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
27177 A connection attempt timed out.
27179 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
27180 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
27181 obtained from an MX record.
27183 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
27184 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
27185 obtained from an MX record.
27188 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
27190 .vitem &%tls_required%&
27191 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
27192 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
27193 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
27196 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
27199 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
27200 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
27201 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
27202 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
27203 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
27204 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
27208 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
27209 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
27210 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
27211 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
27212 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
27216 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
27217 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
27218 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
27220 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
27221 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
27222 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
27223 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
27224 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
27225 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
27226 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
27228 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
27229 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
27232 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
27233 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
27234 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
27239 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
27240 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
27241 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
27242 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
27243 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
27246 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
27248 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
27250 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
27252 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
27253 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
27256 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
27258 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
27259 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
27260 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
27261 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
27262 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
27264 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
27265 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
27267 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
27269 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
27270 list is never matched.
27276 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
27277 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
27278 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
27279 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
27281 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
27283 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
27284 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
27285 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
27286 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
27287 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
27289 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
27290 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
27291 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
27292 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
27293 The available algorithms are:
27296 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
27299 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
27300 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
27301 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
27303 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
27304 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
27305 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
27306 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
27307 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
27308 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
27309 queue processing times.
27312 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
27313 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
27314 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
27315 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
27316 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
27317 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
27318 interval is found. The main configuration variable
27319 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
27320 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
27321 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
27322 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
27323 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
27325 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
27326 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
27327 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
27328 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
27329 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
27330 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
27333 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
27334 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
27335 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
27336 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
27337 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
27338 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
27339 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
27340 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
27341 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
27342 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
27343 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
27344 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
27346 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
27347 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
27348 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
27349 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
27350 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
27351 deliveries that have been deferred.
27354 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
27355 Here are some example retry rules:
27357 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
27358 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
27359 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
27360 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
27361 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
27362 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
27364 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
27365 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
27366 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
27367 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
27368 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
27369 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
27370 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
27373 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
27374 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
27375 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
27376 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
27377 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
27379 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
27380 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
27381 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
27382 were not obtained from an MX record.
27384 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
27385 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
27386 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
27387 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
27388 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
27392 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
27393 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
27394 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
27395 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
27396 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
27397 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
27398 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
27399 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
27400 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
27401 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
27402 failing for the first time.
27404 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
27405 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
27406 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
27407 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
27409 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
27410 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
27411 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
27416 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
27417 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
27418 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
27419 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
27420 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
27421 default retry rule:
27423 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
27425 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
27426 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
27427 failure for the recipient address that counts.
27429 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
27430 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
27431 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
27432 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
27433 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
27435 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
27436 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
27437 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
27439 .cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
27440 .cindex retry "final cutoff"
27441 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
27442 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
27443 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
27444 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses,
27445 as set by the &%retry_data_expire%& option, is
27446 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
27447 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
27448 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
27449 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
27451 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
27452 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
27453 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
27454 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
27455 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
27458 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
27459 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
27460 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
27461 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
27462 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
27463 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
27464 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
27465 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
27466 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
27469 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
27470 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
27471 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
27472 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
27473 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
27474 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
27475 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
27476 failing messages remain in the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
27479 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
27480 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
27481 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
27482 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
27483 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
27484 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
27485 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
27486 time out the address.
27488 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
27489 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
27490 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
27491 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
27492 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
27493 considered immediately.
27494 .ecindex IIDretconf1
27495 .ecindex IIDregconf2
27502 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27503 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27505 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
27506 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
27507 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
27508 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's runtime configuration is concerned
27509 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
27510 described in RFC 2554, which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
27511 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
27512 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
27513 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
27516 The name of an authenticator is limited to be &drivernamemax; ASCII characters long;
27517 prior to Exim 4.95 names would be silently truncated at this length, but now
27520 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
27521 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" AUTH
27522 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
27525 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
27526 the client's EHLO command.
27528 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
27529 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
27531 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
27532 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
27533 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
27534 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
27535 with the AUTH command.
27537 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
27539 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
27540 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
27541 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
27544 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
27545 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
27546 unauthenticated connection.
27549 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
27550 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
27551 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
27552 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
27554 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
27555 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
27556 &`Connected to server.example.`&
27557 &`Escape character is '^]'.`&
27558 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
27559 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
27560 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
27561 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
27566 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
27567 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
27568 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
27569 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
27570 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
27571 included by setting
27574 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
27578 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
27583 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
27584 authentication mechanism (RFC 2195), and the second provides an interface to
27585 the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
27586 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
27587 work via a socket interface.
27588 The fourth provides for negotiation of authentication done via non-SMTP means,
27589 as defined by RFC 4422 Appendix A.
27590 The fifth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
27591 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
27592 The sixth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
27593 supporting setting a server keytab.
27594 The seventh can be configured to support
27595 the PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
27596 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs.
27597 The eighth authenticator
27598 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
27599 The last is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
27600 instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
27602 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
27603 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
27604 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
27605 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
27606 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
27607 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
27608 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
27610 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
27611 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
27612 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
27613 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
27614 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
27615 both sets of options, is required. For example:
27619 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27620 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
27622 client_secret = secret2
27624 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
27625 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
27627 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
27628 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
27629 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
27632 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
27633 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
27634 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
27635 authenticating data.
27637 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
27638 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
27639 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
27640 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
27641 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
27642 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
27643 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
27644 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
27645 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
27646 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
27649 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
27650 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
27651 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
27652 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
27656 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
27657 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
27658 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
27660 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
27661 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
27662 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
27663 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
27664 encrypted by a setting such as:
27666 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
27670 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
27671 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
27672 result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
27673 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
27676 .option driver authenticators string unset
27677 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
27678 authenticators is to be used.
27681 .option public_name authenticators string unset
27682 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
27683 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
27684 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens (RFC 2222),
27685 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
27686 defaults to the driver's instance name.
27689 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
27690 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
27691 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
27692 mechanism is not advertised.
27693 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
27694 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
27695 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
27698 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
27699 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
27700 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
27703 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
27704 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
27706 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
27707 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
27708 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
27709 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
27710 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
27711 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
27712 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
27713 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
27714 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
27718 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
27719 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
27720 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
27721 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
27722 out the values of variables.
27723 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
27724 output, and Exim carries on processing.
27727 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
27728 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
27729 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
27730 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
27731 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
27732 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
27733 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
27734 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
27735 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
27736 On a failing authentication the expansion result is instead saved in
27737 the &$authenticated_fail_id$& variable.
27738 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
27741 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
27742 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
27743 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
27744 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
27745 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
27746 remembered for later use.
27747 How it is used is described in the following section.
27753 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
27754 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
27755 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
27756 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
27757 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
27761 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
27762 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
27764 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
27766 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
27767 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
27768 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
27769 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
27770 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
27771 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
27772 given for the MAIL command.
27774 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
27775 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
27778 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
27779 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
27780 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
27781 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
27782 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
27783 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
27784 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
27789 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
27790 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
27791 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
27792 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
27794 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
27795 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
27796 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
27797 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
27798 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
27803 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
27804 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
27805 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
27806 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
27810 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
27812 If the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
27813 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
27816 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
27817 the mechanisms are advertised.
27819 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
27820 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
27821 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
27822 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
27823 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
27824 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
27825 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
27827 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
27829 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
27831 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
27832 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
27833 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
27836 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
27838 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
27839 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
27840 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
27842 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
27843 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
27844 command. This is the case if
27847 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
27849 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
27851 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
27852 server authenticators.
27856 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
27857 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
27858 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
27860 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
27861 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
27862 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
27863 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
27864 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
27865 rejected with a 504 error.
27867 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
27868 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
27869 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
27870 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
27871 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
27872 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
27873 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
27874 no successful authentication.
27876 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
27877 Successful authentication sets up information used by the
27878 &%authresults%& expansion item.
27880 .cindex authentication "failure event, server"
27881 If an authenticator is run and does not succeed,
27882 an event (see &<<CHAPevents>>&) of type "auth:fail" is raised.
27883 While the event is being processed the variables
27884 &$sender_host_authenticated$& (with the authenticator name)
27885 and &$authenticated_fail_id$& (as set by the authenticator &%server_set_id%& option)
27887 If the event is serviced and a string is returned then the string will be logged
27888 instead of the default log line.
27889 See <<CHAPevents>> for details on events.
27892 .section "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
27893 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
27894 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
27895 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
27896 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
27897 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
27898 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
27902 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
27904 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
27905 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
27906 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
27907 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
27908 command line to run this script on such data might be
27910 encode '\0user\0password'
27912 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
27913 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
27914 whose code value is zero.
27916 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
27917 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
27918 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
27919 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
27921 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
27922 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
27923 example, a command such as
27925 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
27927 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
27929 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to produce
27930 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
27932 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
27934 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
27935 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
27936 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
27937 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
27941 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
27942 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
27943 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
27944 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
27945 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
27946 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
27949 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
27950 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
27951 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
27952 of the authenticator.
27955 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
27956 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
27957 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
27958 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
27959 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
27960 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
27961 delivery to be deferred.
27963 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
27964 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
27965 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
27969 .cindex authentication "failure event, client"
27970 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code),
27971 an event (see &<<CHAPevents>>&) of type "auth:fail" is raised.
27972 While the event is being processed the variable
27973 &$sender_host_authenticated$& (with the authenticator name)
27975 If the event is serviced and a string is returned then the string will be logged.
27976 See <<CHAPevents>> for details on events.
27979 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
27980 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
27981 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
27982 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
27983 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
27984 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
27985 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
27986 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
27987 deliver the message unauthenticated.
27990 Note that the hostlist test for whether to do authentication can be
27991 confused if name-IP lookups change between the time the peer is decided
27992 upon and the time that the transport runs. For example, with a manualroute
27993 router given a host name, and with DNS "round-robin" used by that name: if
27994 the local resolver cache times out between the router and the transport
27995 running, the transport may get an IP for the name for its authentication
27996 check which does not match the connection peer IP.
27997 No authentication will then be done, despite the names being identical.
27999 For such cases use a separate transport which always authenticates.
28001 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
28002 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
28003 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
28004 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
28005 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
28006 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
28007 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
28008 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
28009 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
28010 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
28011 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
28012 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
28013 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
28020 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28021 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28023 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
28024 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
28025 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
28026 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
28027 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
28028 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
28029 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
28030 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
28031 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
28032 connections as you do for login accounts.
28034 .section "Avoiding cleartext use" "SECTplain_TLS"
28035 The following generic option settings will disable &(plaintext)& authenticators when
28036 TLS is not being used:
28038 server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
28039 client_condition = ${if def:tls_out_cipher}
28042 &*Note*&: a plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not vulnerable to casual snooping,
28043 but is still vulnerable to a Man In The Middle attack unless certificates
28044 (including their names) have been properly verified.
28046 .section "Plaintext server options" "SECID171"
28047 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
28048 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
28050 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
28051 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
28052 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
28054 .option server_prompts plaintext "string list&!!" unset
28055 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
28056 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
28059 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
28060 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
28061 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
28062 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
28063 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
28064 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
28065 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
28067 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
28068 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
28069 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
28070 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
28071 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
28072 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
28073 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
28075 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
28076 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
28077 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
28078 string expansions that also use them for other things.
28080 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
28081 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
28082 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
28084 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
28085 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
28086 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
28087 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
28088 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
28089 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
28090 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
28091 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
28092 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
28093 string as the error text.
28095 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
28096 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
28097 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
28101 .section "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
28102 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
28103 .cindex authentication PLAIN
28104 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
28105 The PLAIN authentication mechanism (RFC 2595) specifies that three strings be
28106 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
28107 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
28108 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
28110 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
28111 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
28112 configured as follows:
28116 public_name = PLAIN
28118 server_condition = \
28119 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
28120 server_set_id = $auth2
28122 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
28123 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
28124 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
28125 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
28127 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
28128 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
28129 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
28130 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
28134 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
28136 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
28138 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
28139 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
28143 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
28144 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
28146 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
28147 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
28148 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
28149 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
28150 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
28152 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
28153 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
28154 authenticating clients it could make sense.
28156 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
28157 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
28158 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
28159 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
28160 This is an incorrect example:
28162 server_condition = \
28163 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
28165 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
28166 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
28167 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
28168 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
28169 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
28170 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
28171 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
28173 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
28174 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
28176 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
28177 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
28178 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
28179 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
28180 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
28183 .section "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
28184 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
28185 .cindex authentication LOGIN
28186 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
28187 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
28188 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
28189 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
28193 public_name = LOGIN
28194 server_prompts = User Name : Password
28195 server_condition = \
28196 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
28197 server_set_id = $auth1
28199 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
28200 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
28201 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
28202 strings are used to obtain two data items.
28204 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
28205 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
28206 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
28207 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
28208 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
28212 public_name = LOGIN
28213 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
28214 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
28217 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
28218 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
28219 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
28220 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
28222 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
28223 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
28224 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
28225 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
28226 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
28227 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
28228 uninterpreted string.
28231 .section "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
28232 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
28233 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
28234 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
28235 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
28241 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
28242 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
28243 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
28245 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
28246 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
28247 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
28248 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
28251 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
28252 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
28253 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
28254 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
28255 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
28256 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
28257 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
28258 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
28259 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
28260 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
28261 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
28262 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
28264 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
28265 splitting takes priority and happens first.
28267 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
28268 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
28269 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
28270 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
28273 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
28274 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
28278 public_name = PLAIN
28279 client_send = ^username^mysecret
28281 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
28282 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs.
28283 Note that due to the ambiguity of parsing three consectutive circumflex characters
28284 there is no way to provide a password having a leading circumflex.
28288 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
28292 public_name = LOGIN
28293 client_send = : username : mysecret
28295 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
28296 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
28298 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
28299 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
28304 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28305 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28307 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
28308 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
28309 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
28310 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
28311 .cindex authentication CRAM-MD5
28312 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in RFC 2195. The server
28313 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
28314 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
28315 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
28316 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
28317 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
28318 available in plain text at either end.
28321 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
28322 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
28323 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
28324 authenticator as a server:
28326 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
28327 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
28328 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
28329 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
28330 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
28331 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
28332 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
28333 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
28334 returned to the client.
28336 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
28337 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
28338 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
28339 numeric variables for other things.
28341 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
28342 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
28343 user name, authentication fails.
28347 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28348 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
28349 server_set_id = $auth1
28351 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
28352 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
28353 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
28354 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
28358 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28359 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
28361 server_set_id = $auth1
28363 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
28364 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
28366 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
28367 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
28368 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
28373 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28374 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
28375 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
28376 server_set_id = $auth1
28379 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
28380 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
28381 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
28385 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
28386 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
28387 computing the response to the server's challenge.
28390 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
28391 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
28392 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
28396 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
28397 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
28398 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
28399 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
28400 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
28401 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
28402 send the message to the current server.
28404 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
28409 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28411 client_secret = secret
28413 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
28414 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
28418 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28419 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28421 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
28422 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
28423 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
28424 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
28426 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick while
28427 at A L Digital Ltd.
28429 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
28430 library implementation of the RFC 2222 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
28431 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
28432 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
28433 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
28435 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
28436 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
28437 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
28438 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
28440 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example, in GSSAPI
28441 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
28442 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
28443 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
28444 depending on the driver you are using.
28446 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
28447 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
28448 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
28449 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
28450 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
28453 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
28454 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
28455 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
28456 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
28457 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
28458 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
28459 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
28460 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
28463 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
28464 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
28465 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
28466 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
28467 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
28468 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
28472 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
28473 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
28474 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
28475 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
28478 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
28479 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
28480 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
28481 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
28485 driver = cyrus_sasl
28486 public_name = X-ANYTHING
28487 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
28488 server_set_id = $auth1
28491 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
28492 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
28495 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
28496 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
28499 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
28500 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
28501 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
28502 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
28505 driver = cyrus_sasl
28506 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28507 server_set_id = $auth1
28510 driver = cyrus_sasl
28511 public_name = PLAIN
28512 server_set_id = $auth2
28514 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
28515 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
28516 but it is present in many binary distributions.
28517 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
28518 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
28523 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28524 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28525 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
28526 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
28527 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
28528 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
28529 Dovecot 2 POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
28530 Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
28531 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
28532 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
28533 authenticator only. There is only one non-generic option:
28535 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
28537 This option must specify the UNIX socket that is the interface to Dovecot
28538 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
28539 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
28540 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
28544 public_name = PLAIN
28545 server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher}
28546 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
28547 server_set_id = $auth1
28552 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
28553 server_set_id = $auth1
28556 &*Note*&: plaintext authentication methods such as PLAIN and LOGIN
28557 should not be advertised on cleartext SMTP connections.
28558 See the discussion in section &<<SECTplain_TLS>>&.
28560 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
28561 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
28562 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
28563 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
28564 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
28565 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
28567 The Dovecot configuration to match the above will look
28570 conf.d/10-master.conf :-
28575 unix_listener auth-client {
28582 conf.d/10-auth.conf :-
28584 auth_mechanisms = plain login ntlm
28587 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
28588 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
28591 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28592 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28593 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
28594 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
28595 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
28596 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
28597 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
28598 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
28599 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
28600 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
28601 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
28602 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
28603 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
28604 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM family"
28605 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides integration for the GNU SASL
28606 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
28607 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
28608 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
28609 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
28610 without code changes in Exim.
28612 The library is expected to add support in an upcoming
28613 realease for the SCRAM-SHA-256 method.
28614 The macro _HAVE_AUTH_GSASL_SCRAM_SHA_256 will be defined
28617 To see the list of mechanisms supported by the library run Exim with "auth" debug
28618 enabled and look for a line containing "GNU SASL supports".
28619 Note however that some may not have been tested from Exim.
28622 .option client_authz gsasl string&!! unset
28623 This option can be used to supply an &'authorization id'&
28624 which is different to the &'authentication_id'& provided
28625 by &%client_username%& option.
28626 If unset or (after expansion) empty it is not used,
28627 which is the common case.
28629 .option client_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
28630 See &%server_channelbinding%& below.
28632 .option client_password gsasl string&!! unset
28633 This option is exapanded before use, and should result in
28634 the password to be used, in clear.
28636 .option client_username gsasl string&!! unset
28637 This option is exapanded before use, and should result in
28638 the account name to be used.
28641 .option client_spassword gsasl string&!! unset
28642 This option is only supported for library versions 1.9.1 and greater.
28643 The macro _HAVE_AUTH_GSASL_SCRAM_S_KEY will be defined when this is so.
28645 If a SCRAM mechanism is being used and this option is set
28646 and correctly sized
28647 it is used in preference to &%client_password%&.
28648 The value after expansion should be
28649 a 40 (for SHA-1) or 64 (for SHA-256) character string
28650 with the PBKDF2-prepared password, hex-encoded.
28652 Note that this value will depend on the salt and iteration-count
28653 supplied by the server.
28654 The option is expanded before use.
28655 During the expansion &$auth1$& is set with the client username,
28656 &$auth2$& with the iteration count, and
28657 &$auth3$& with the salt.
28659 The intent of this option
28660 is to support clients that can cache thes salted password
28661 to save on recalculation costs.
28662 The cache lookup should return an unusable value
28663 (eg. an empty string)
28664 if the salt or iteration count has changed
28666 If the authentication succeeds then the above variables are set,
28667 .vindex "&$auth4$&"
28668 plus the calculated salted password value value in &$auth4$&,
28669 during the expansion of the &%client_set_id%& option.
28670 A side-effect of this expansion can be used to prime the cache.
28673 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
28674 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
28675 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
28676 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
28677 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
28680 This should have meant that certificate identity and verification becomes a
28681 non-issue, as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and
28682 server to see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
28685 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
28686 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
28687 When using this feature the "-PLUS" variants of the method names need to be used.
28689 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
28690 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
28691 of Exim might have switched the default to be true.
28693 . However, Channel Binding in TLS has proven to be vulnerable in current versions.
28694 . Do not plan to rely upon this feature for security, ever, without consulting
28695 . with a subject matter expert (a cryptographic engineer).
28697 This option was deprecated in previous releases due to doubts over
28698 the "Triple Handshake" vulnerability.
28699 Exim takes suitable precausions (requiring Extended Master Secret if TLS
28700 Session Resumption was used) for safety.
28703 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
28704 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
28705 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
28706 Some mechanisms will use this data.
28709 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
28710 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
28711 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
28712 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
28717 public_name = X-ANYTHING
28718 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
28719 server_set_id = $auth1
28723 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
28724 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
28725 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
28726 the password itself.
28728 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
28729 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
28730 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
28731 if available, else the empty string.
28732 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
28733 else the empty string.
28735 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
28737 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
28738 option to be simply "true".
28741 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
28742 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
28743 Some mechanisms will use this data.
28746 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! 4096
28747 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
28748 The &$auth1$&, &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& variables are available
28749 when this option is expanded.
28751 The result of expansion should be a decimal number,
28752 and represents both a lower-bound on the security, and
28753 a compute cost factor imposed on the client
28754 (if it does not cache results, or the server changes
28755 either the iteration count or the salt).
28756 A minimum value of 4096 is required by the standards
28757 for all current SCRAM mechanism variants.
28759 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
28760 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
28761 The &$auth1$&, &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& variables are available
28762 when this option is expanded.
28763 The value should be a base64-encoded string,
28764 of random data typically 4-to-16 bytes long.
28765 If unset or empty after expansion the library will provides a value for the
28766 protocol conversation.
28769 .option server_key gsasl string&!! unset
28770 .option server_skey gsasl string&!! unset
28771 These options can be used for the SCRAM family of mechanisms
28772 to provide stored information related to a password,
28773 the storage of which is preferable to plaintext.
28775 &%server_key%& is the value defined in the SCRAM standards as ServerKey;
28776 &%server_skey%& is StoredKey.
28778 They are only available for version 1.9.0 (or later) of the gsasl library.
28779 When this is so, the macros
28780 _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_GSASL_SERVER_KEY
28781 and _HAVE_AUTH_GSASL_SCRAM_S_KEY
28784 The &$authN$& variables are available when these options are expanded.
28786 If set, the results of expansion should for each
28787 should be a 28 (for SHA-1) or 44 (for SHA-256) character string
28788 of base64-coded data, and will be used in preference to the
28789 &%server_password%& option.
28790 If unset or not of the right length, &%server_password%& will be used.
28792 The libgsasl library release includes a utility &'gsasl'& which can be used
28793 to generate these values.
28796 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
28797 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
28798 Some mechanisms will use this data.
28801 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
28802 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
28803 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
28804 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
28806 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
28807 meanings for these variables:
28810 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
28811 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
28813 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
28814 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
28816 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
28817 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
28820 On a per-mechanism basis:
28823 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
28824 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
28825 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
28827 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
28828 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
28829 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
28831 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
28832 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
28833 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
28834 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
28837 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
28838 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
28839 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
28842 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
28843 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
28845 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
28847 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28848 server_realm = imap.example.org
28849 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
28850 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
28851 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
28852 server_condition = yes
28856 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28857 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28859 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
28860 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
28861 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
28862 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
28863 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
28864 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
28865 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
28868 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
28869 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
28870 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
28871 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
28873 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
28874 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
28875 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
28876 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
28878 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
28879 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
28880 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
28884 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
28885 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
28886 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
28887 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
28889 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
28890 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
28891 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
28892 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
28894 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
28896 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
28897 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
28899 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
28900 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
28901 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
28906 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28907 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28909 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
28910 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
28911 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
28912 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
28913 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
28914 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
28915 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
28916 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
28917 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
28918 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
28919 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
28920 taken from the Samba project (&url(https://www.samba.org/)). The code for the
28921 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
28925 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
28926 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
28928 The server sends back a challenge.
28930 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
28931 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
28934 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
28938 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
28939 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
28940 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
28942 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
28943 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
28944 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
28945 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
28946 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
28947 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
28948 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
28949 for other things. For example:
28954 server_password = \
28955 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
28957 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
28958 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
28964 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
28965 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
28966 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
28970 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
28971 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
28974 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
28975 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
28978 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
28979 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
28980 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
28986 client_username = msn/msn_username
28987 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
28988 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
28990 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
28991 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
28997 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28998 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29000 .chapter "The external authenticator" "CHAPexternauth"
29001 .scindex IIDexternauth1 "&(external)& authenticator"
29002 .scindex IIDexternauth2 "authenticators" "&(external)&"
29003 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
29004 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
29005 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
29006 The &(external)& authenticator provides support for
29007 authentication based on non-SMTP information.
29008 The specification is in RFC 4422 Appendix A
29009 (&url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4422)).
29010 It is only a transport and negotiation mechanism;
29011 the process of authentication is entirely controlled
29012 by the server configuration.
29014 The client presents an identity in-clear.
29015 It is probably wise for a server to only advertise,
29016 and for clients to only attempt,
29017 this authentication method on a secure (eg. under TLS) connection.
29019 One possible use, compatible with the
29020 K-9 Mail Android client (&url(https://k9mail.github.io/)),
29021 is for using X509 client certificates.
29023 It thus overlaps in function with the TLS authenticator
29024 (see &<<CHAPtlsauth>>&)
29025 but is a full SMTP SASL authenticator
29026 rather than being implicit for TLS-connection carried
29027 client certificates only.
29029 The examples and discussion in this chapter assume that
29030 client-certificate authentication is being done.
29032 The client must present a certificate,
29033 for which it must have been requested via the
29034 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
29035 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
29036 For authentication to be effective the certificate should be
29037 verifiable against a trust-anchor certificate known to the server.
29039 .section "External options" "SECTexternsoptions"
29040 .cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (server)"
29041 The &(external)& authenticator has two server options:
29043 .option server_param2 external string&!! unset
29044 .option server_param3 external string&!! unset
29045 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(external)& authenticator"
29046 These options are expanded before the &%server_condition%& option
29047 and the result are placed in &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& resectively.
29048 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
29049 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
29051 They can be used to clarify the coding of a complex &%server_condition%&.
29053 .section "Using external in a server" "SECTexternserver"
29054 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(external)& authenticator"
29055 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
29056 "in &(external)& authenticator"
29057 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
29058 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(external)& authenticator"
29060 When running as a server, &(external)& performs the authentication test by
29061 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
29062 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
29063 values when decoded. The decoded value is treated as
29064 an identity for authentication and
29065 placed in the expansion variable &$auth1$&.
29067 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the value is also placed in
29068 the expansion variable &$1$&. However, the use of this
29069 variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
29070 string expansions that also use them for other things.
29072 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
29073 Once an identity has been received,
29074 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
29075 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
29076 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
29077 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
29078 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
29079 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
29080 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
29081 string as the error text.
29085 ext_ccert_san_mail:
29087 public_name = EXTERNAL
29089 server_advertise_condition = $tls_in_certificate_verified
29090 server_param2 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
29091 {$tls_in_peercert}}
29092 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth2} \
29093 {eq {$item}{$auth1}}}
29094 server_set_id = $auth1
29096 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
29097 of your configured trust-anchors
29098 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
29099 and which has a mail-SAN matching the claimed identity sent by the client.
29101 &*Note*&: up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN.
29102 The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
29103 TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
29107 .section "Using external in a client" "SECTexternclient"
29108 .cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (client)"
29109 The &(external)& authenticator has one client option:
29111 .option client_send external string&!! unset
29112 This option is expanded and sent with the AUTH command as the
29113 identity being asserted.
29119 public_name = EXTERNAL
29121 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
29122 client_send = myaccount@smarthost.example.net
29126 .ecindex IIDexternauth1
29127 .ecindex IIDexternauth2
29133 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29134 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29136 .chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
29137 .scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
29138 .scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
29139 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
29140 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
29141 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
29142 The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
29143 authentication based on client certificates.
29145 It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
29146 advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
29147 It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
29148 the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
29149 by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
29150 the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
29152 The client must present a verifiable certificate,
29153 for which it must have been requested via the
29154 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
29155 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
29157 If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
29158 run immediately after a TLS connection being negotiated
29159 (due to either STARTTLS or TLS-on-connect)
29160 and can authenticate the connection.
29161 If it does, SMTP authentication is not subsequently offered.
29163 A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
29166 .cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
29167 The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
29169 .option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
29170 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
29171 This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
29172 the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
29173 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
29174 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
29176 .option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
29177 .option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
29178 As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
29180 &%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
29187 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
29188 {$tls_in_peercert}}
29189 server_condition = ${if and { {eq{$tls_in_certificate_verified}{1}} \
29192 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
29193 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
29194 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
29196 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
29198 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
29199 of your configured trust-anchors
29200 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
29201 and which has a SAN with a good account name.
29203 Note that, up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
29204 The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
29205 TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
29207 Likewise, a traditional plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
29209 . An alternative might use
29211 . server_param1 = ${sha256:$tls_in_peercert}
29213 . to require one of a set of specific certs that define a given account
29214 . (the verification is still required, but mostly irrelevant).
29215 . This would help for per-device use.
29217 . However, for the future we really need support for checking a
29218 . user cert in LDAP - which probably wants a base-64 DER.
29220 .ecindex IIDtlsauth1
29221 .ecindex IIDtlsauth2
29224 Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
29225 the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
29226 a connect- or helo-ACL.
29230 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29231 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29233 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
29234 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
29235 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
29236 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
29237 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
29240 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
29241 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
29242 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
29243 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
29244 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
29245 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
29246 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
29247 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
29248 certificates are used.
29250 RFC 3207 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
29251 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
29252 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
29253 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
29254 between them is encrypted.
29256 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
29257 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
29258 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
29259 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
29262 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
29263 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
29264 in order to get TLS to work.
29268 .section "Support for the &""submissions""& (aka &""ssmtp""& and &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
29270 .cindex "submissions protocol"
29271 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
29272 .cindex "smtps protocol"
29273 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
29274 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
29275 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
29276 The history of port numbers for TLS in SMTP is a little messy and has been
29277 contentious. As of RFC 8314, the common practice of using the historically
29278 allocated port 465 for "email submission but with TLS immediately upon connect
29279 instead of using STARTTLS" is officially blessed by the IETF, and recommended
29280 by them in preference to STARTTLS.
29282 The name originally assigned to the port was &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, but as
29283 clarity emerged over the dual roles of SMTP, for MX delivery and Email
29284 Submission, nomenclature has shifted. The modern name is now &"submissions"&.
29286 This approach was, for a while, officially abandoned when encrypted SMTP was
29287 standardized, but many clients kept using it, even as the TCP port number was
29288 reassigned for other use.
29289 Thus you may encounter guidance claiming that you shouldn't enable use of
29291 In practice, a number of mail-clients have only ever supported submissions,
29292 not submission with STARTTLS upgrade.
29293 Ideally, offer both submission (587) and submissions (465) service.
29295 Exim supports TLS-on-connect by means of the &%tls_on_connect_ports%&
29296 global option. Its value must be a list of port numbers;
29297 the most common use is expected to be:
29299 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
29301 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
29302 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
29303 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
29304 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
29305 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
29308 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
29309 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the TLS-only behaviour for all ports.
29316 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
29317 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
29318 TLS is supported in Exim using either the OpenSSL or GnuTLS library.
29319 To build Exim to use OpenSSL you need to set
29325 To build Exim to use GnuTLS, you need to set
29331 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
29332 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
29334 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
29337 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
29338 cannot be the path of a directory
29339 for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
29340 (for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
29342 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
29344 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
29345 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
29346 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
29347 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with RFC 2253. This
29348 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
29350 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
29351 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
29352 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
29353 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
29354 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
29355 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
29356 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
29359 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
29360 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
29362 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
29363 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
29364 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
29365 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
29367 With GnuTLS, if an explicit list is used for the &%tls_privatekey%& main option,
29368 it must be ordered to match the &%tls_certificate%& list.
29370 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
29371 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
29372 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
29373 implementation, then patches are welcome.
29375 The output from "exim -bV" will show which (if any) support was included
29377 Also, the macro "_HAVE_OPENSSL" or "_HAVE_GNUTLS" will be defined.
29381 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
29382 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
29383 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
29384 but not the chosen filename.
29385 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
29386 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
29388 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
29389 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
29390 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
29391 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
29393 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
29394 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
29395 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
29396 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
29397 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
29398 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
29399 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
29401 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
29402 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
29403 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
29404 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
29405 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
29407 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
29408 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
29409 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
29410 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
29411 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
29412 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
29414 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
29415 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
29416 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
29418 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
29419 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
29420 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
29421 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
29424 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
29427 # chown exim:exim new-params
29428 # chmod 0600 new-params
29429 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
29430 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
29431 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
29432 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
29433 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
29434 # chmod 0400 new-params
29435 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
29437 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
29438 stalling is removed.
29440 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
29441 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
29442 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
29443 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
29444 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
29445 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
29446 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
29447 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
29448 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
29449 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
29450 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
29452 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
29453 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
29454 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
29455 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
29457 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
29458 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
29459 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
29460 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
29461 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
29464 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
29465 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
29466 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
29467 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
29468 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
29469 are acceptable for TLS versions prior to 1.3.
29470 The list is colon separated and may contain names like
29471 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
29472 directly to this function call.
29473 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
29474 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
29475 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
29476 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
29479 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
29481 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
29482 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
29483 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
29486 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
29487 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
29488 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
29492 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
29495 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
29496 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
29499 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
29500 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
29502 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
29503 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
29506 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
29507 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
29508 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
29509 not be moved to the end of the list.
29512 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
29515 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
29516 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
29519 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
29520 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
29521 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
29522 choice of clients used:
29524 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
29525 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
29530 This example will prefer ECDSA-authenticated ciphers over RSA ones:
29532 tls_require_ciphers = ECDSA:RSA:!COMPLEMENTOFDEFAULT
29535 For TLS version 1.3 the control available is less fine-grained
29536 and Exim does not provide access to it at present.
29537 The value of the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is ignored when
29538 TLS version 1.3 is negotiated.
29540 As of writing the library default cipher suite list for TLSv1.3 is
29542 TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256
29546 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
29548 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
29549 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
29550 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
29551 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
29552 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
29553 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
29554 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
29555 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
29556 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
29557 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
29559 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
29560 and controls both protocols and ciphers.
29562 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
29563 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
29564 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
29565 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
29566 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
29567 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
29569 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
29570 "Priority strings". This is online as
29571 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
29572 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
29573 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
29574 then the example code
29575 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string)
29576 on that site can be used to test a given string.
29580 # Disable older versions of protocols
29581 tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
29584 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
29585 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
29586 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
29588 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
29589 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
29590 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
29591 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
29595 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
29601 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
29602 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
29603 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" STARTTLS
29604 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
29605 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
29606 but not to any others. The default value of this option is *, which means
29607 that STARTTLS is always advertised. Set it to blank to never advertise;
29608 this is reasonable for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
29610 If STARTTLS is to be used you
29611 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available.
29613 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
29614 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
29615 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
29618 554 Security failure
29620 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
29621 rejected with a 554 error code.
29623 To enable TLS operations on a server, the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option
29624 must be set to match some hosts. The default is * which matches all hosts.
29626 If this is all you do, TLS encryption will be enabled but not authentication -
29627 meaning that the peer has no assurance it is actually you he is talking to.
29628 You gain protection from a passive sniffer listening on the wire but not
29629 from someone able to intercept the communication.
29631 Further protection requires some further configuration at the server end.
29633 To make TLS work you need to set, in the server,
29635 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
29636 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
29638 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
29639 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
29640 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
29641 that goes with it. These files need to be
29642 PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
29643 always be given as full path names.
29644 The key must not be password-protected.
29645 They can be the same file if both the
29646 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
29647 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
29648 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
29649 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
29650 the server's certificate.
29652 For dual-stack (eg. RSA and ECDSA) configurations, these options can be
29653 colon-separated lists of file paths. Ciphers using given authentication
29654 algorithms require the presence of a suitable certificate to supply the
29655 public-key. The server selects among the certificates to present to the
29656 client depending on the selected cipher, hence the priority ordering for
29657 ciphers will affect which certificate is used.
29659 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
29660 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
29661 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
29663 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
29664 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
29665 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
29668 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
29669 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
29670 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
29672 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
29674 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
29675 with the parameters contained in the file.
29676 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
29681 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
29682 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
29683 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
29684 documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
29690 for a way of generating file data.
29692 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
29693 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
29694 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
29695 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
29696 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
29698 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
29699 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
29700 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
29701 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
29702 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
29703 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
29704 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
29705 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
29706 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
29708 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
29709 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
29710 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
29711 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
29712 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
29713 documentation for more details.
29715 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
29716 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
29719 .subsection "Requesting and verifying client certificates"
29720 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
29721 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
29722 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
29723 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
29724 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
29725 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
29726 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
29727 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
29728 expected trust-anchors or certificates.
29729 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
29730 an explicit file or,
29731 depending on library version, a directory, identified by
29732 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
29734 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
29737 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
29738 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
29739 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
29741 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
29743 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
29745 There is no checking of names of the client against the certificate
29746 Subject Name or Subject Alternate Names.
29748 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
29749 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
29750 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
29751 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
29752 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
29753 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
29754 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
29755 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
29756 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
29757 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
29759 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
29760 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
29761 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
29762 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
29764 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
29765 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
29766 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
29767 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
29768 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
29769 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
29772 .subsection "Caching of static server configuration items" "SSECTserverTLScache"
29773 .cindex certificate caching
29774 .cindex privatekey caching
29775 .cindex crl caching
29776 .cindex ocsp caching
29777 .cindex ciphers caching
29778 .cindex "CA bundle" caching
29779 .cindex "certificate authorities" caching
29780 .cindex tls_certificate caching
29781 .cindex tls_privatekey caching
29782 .cindex tls_crl caching
29783 .cindex tls_ocsp_file caching
29784 .cindex tls_require_ciphers caching
29785 .cindex tls_verify_certificate caching
29786 .cindex caching certificate
29787 .cindex caching privatekey
29788 .cindex caching crl
29789 .cindex caching ocsp
29790 .cindex caching ciphers
29791 .cindex caching "certificate authorities
29792 If any of the main configuration options &%tls_certificate%&, &%tls_privatekey%&,
29793 &%tls_crl%& and &%tls_ocsp_file%& have values with no
29794 expandable elements,
29795 then the associated information is loaded at daemon startup.
29796 It is made available
29797 to child processes forked for handling received SMTP connections.
29799 This caching is currently only supported under Linux and FreeBSD.
29801 If caching is not possible, for example if an item has to be dependent
29802 on the peer host so contains a &$sender_host_name$& expansion, the load
29803 of the associated information is done at the startup of the TLS connection.
29805 The cache is invalidated and reloaded after any changes to the directories
29806 containing files specified by these options.
29808 The information specified by the main option &%tls_verify_certificates%&
29809 is similarly cached so long as it specifies files explicitly
29810 or (under GnuTLS) is the string &"system,cache"&.
29811 The latter case is not automatically invalidated;
29812 it is the operator's responsibility to arrange for a daemon restart
29813 any time the system certificate authority bundle is updated.
29814 A HUP signal is sufficient for this.
29815 The value &"system"& results in no caching under GnuTLS.
29817 The macro _HAVE_TLS_CA_CACHE will be defined if the suffix for "system"
29818 is acceptable in configurations for the Exim executable.
29820 Caching of the system Certificate Authorities bundle can
29821 save significant time and processing on every TLS connection
29827 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECTclientTLS"
29828 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
29829 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
29830 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
29831 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
29832 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
29833 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
29834 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
29835 within the &(smtp)& transport.
29837 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" STARTTLS
29838 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
29839 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
29840 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
29841 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
29842 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
29844 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
29845 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
29846 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
29847 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
29848 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
29851 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
29852 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
29853 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
29854 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
29855 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
29856 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
29857 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
29858 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
29859 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
29860 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
29863 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
29864 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
29866 This is an optional thing for TLS connections, although either end
29868 If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
29869 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
29871 &*Note*&: Do not use a certificate which has the OCSP-must-staple extension,
29872 for client use (they are usable for server use).
29873 As the TLS protocol has no means for the client to staple before TLS 1.3 it will result
29874 in failed connections.
29876 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
29877 specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
29879 the system default set (depending on library version),
29881 or (depending on library version) a directory.
29882 The client verifies the server's certificate
29883 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
29884 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
29885 Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
29886 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
29888 The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
29889 certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
29890 or need not succeed respectively.
29892 The &%tls_verify_cert_hostnames%& option lists hosts for which additional
29893 name checks are made on the server certificate.
29894 The match against this list is, as per other Exim usage, the
29895 IP for the host. That is most closely associated with the
29896 name on the DNS A (or AAAA) record for the host.
29897 However, the name that needs to be in the certificate
29898 is the one at the head of any CNAME chain leading to the A record.
29899 The option defaults to always checking.
29901 The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
29902 &%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
29903 is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
29905 &%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
29906 a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
29907 value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
29910 The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
29911 &%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
29912 for OCSP to be relevant.
29915 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
29916 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
29917 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
29918 alternative hosts, if any.
29921 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
29922 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
29923 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
29927 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
29928 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
29929 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
29930 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
29931 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
29933 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
29934 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
29935 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
29936 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
29937 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
29938 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
29939 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
29940 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
29941 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
29942 outgoing connection.
29946 .subsection "Caching of static client configuration items" SECTclientTLScache
29947 .cindex certificate caching
29948 .cindex privatekey caching
29949 .cindex crl caching
29950 .cindex ciphers caching
29951 .cindex "CA bundle" caching
29952 .cindex "certificate authorities" caching
29953 .cindex tls_certificate caching
29954 .cindex tls_privatekey caching
29955 .cindex tls_crl caching
29956 .cindex tls_require_ciphers caching
29957 .cindex tls_verify_certificate caching
29958 .cindex caching certificate
29959 .cindex caching privatekey
29960 .cindex caching crl
29961 .cindex caching ciphers
29962 .cindex caching "certificate authorities
29963 If any of the transport configuration options &%tls_certificate%&, &%tls_privatekey%&
29964 and &%tls_crl%& have values with no
29965 expandable elements,
29966 then the associated information is loaded per smtp transport
29967 at daemon startup, at the start of a queue run, or on a
29968 command-line specified message delivery.
29969 It is made available
29970 to child processes forked for handling making SMTP connections.
29972 This caching is currently only supported under Linux.
29974 If caching is not possible, the load
29975 of the associated information is done at the startup of the TLS connection.
29977 The cache is invalidated in the daemon
29978 and reloaded after any changes to the directories
29979 containing files specified by these options.
29981 The information specified by the main option &%tls_verify_certificates%&
29982 is similarly cached so long as it specifies files explicitly
29983 or (under GnuTLS) is the string &"system,cache"&.
29984 The latter case is not automatically invaludated;
29985 it is the operator's responsibility to arrange for a daemon restart
29986 any time the system certificate authority bundle is updated.
29987 A HUP signal is sufficient for this.
29988 The value &"system"& results in no caching under GnuTLS.
29990 The macro _HAVE_TLS_CA_CACHE will be defined if the suffix for "system"
29991 is acceptable in configurations for the Exim executable.
29993 Caching of the system Certificate Authorities bundle can
29994 save significant time and processing on every TLS connection
30000 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
30001 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
30004 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
30005 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
30006 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
30007 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
30008 extensions, documented in RFC 6066 (and before that RFC 4366) is
30009 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
30010 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
30011 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
30014 This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
30015 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
30018 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
30019 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
30020 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
30021 be of limited use in that environment.
30023 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
30024 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
30025 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
30026 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
30027 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
30029 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
30030 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
30031 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
30032 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
30033 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
30035 If DANE validated the connection attempt then the value of the &%tls_sni%& option
30036 is forced to the name of the destination host, after any MX- or CNAME-following.
30038 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
30039 received from a client.
30040 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
30042 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
30043 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
30044 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
30047 &%tls_certificate%&
30053 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
30058 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
30059 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
30060 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_in_sni$& is
30061 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
30062 Further, the initial certificate is loaded before SNI has arrived, so
30063 an expansion for &%tls_certificate%& must have a default which is used
30064 when &$tls_in_sni$& is empty.
30066 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
30069 When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
30070 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
30071 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
30072 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
30074 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
30075 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
30076 built, then you have SNI support).
30080 .cindex ALPN "general information"
30081 .cindex TLS "Application Layer Protocol Names"
30082 There is a TLS feature related to SNI
30083 called Application Layer Protocol Name (ALPN).
30084 This is intended to declare, or select, what protocol layer will be using a TLS
30086 The client for the connection proposes a set of protocol names, and
30087 the server responds with a selected one.
30088 It is not, as of 2021, commonly used for SMTP connections.
30089 However, to guard against misdirected or malicious use of web clients
30090 (which often do use ALPN) against MTA ports, Exim by default check that
30091 there is no incompatible ALPN specified by a client for a TLS connection.
30092 If there is, the connection is rejected.
30094 As a client Exim does not supply ALPN by default.
30095 The behaviour of both client and server can be configured using the options
30096 &%tls_alpn%& and &%hosts_require_alpn%&.
30097 There are no variables providing observability.
30098 Some feature-specific logging may appear on denied connections, but this
30099 depends on the behaviour of the peer
30100 (not all peers can send a feature-specific TLS Alert).
30102 This feature is available when Exim is built with
30103 OpenSSL 1.1.0 or later or GnuTLS 3.2.0 or later;
30104 the macro _HAVE_TLS_ALPN will be defined when this is so.
30108 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
30110 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
30111 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
30112 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
30113 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
30114 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
30115 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
30116 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
30117 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, for sending using TLS Exim
30118 starts an additional proxy process for handling the encryption, piping the
30119 unencrypted data stream from and to the delivery processes.
30121 An older mode of operation can be enabled on a per-host basis by the
30122 &%hosts_noproxy_tls%& option on the &(smtp)& transport. If the host matches
30123 this list the proxy process described above is not used; instead Exim
30124 shuts down an existing TLS session being run by the delivery process
30125 before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
30126 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
30127 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
30129 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
30130 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
30131 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
30132 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
30133 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
30134 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
30135 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
30136 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
30137 and delay other deliveries to that host.
30139 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
30140 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
30141 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
30142 information is recorded.
30144 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
30145 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
30146 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
30151 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
30152 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
30153 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
30154 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities.
30155 This is a large topic and an introductory guide is unsuitable for the Exim
30156 reference manual, so instead we provide pointers to existing documentation.
30158 The Apache web-server was for a long time the canonical guide, so their
30159 documentation is a good place to start; their SSL module's Introduction
30160 document is currently at
30162 &url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_intro.html)
30164 and their FAQ is at
30166 &url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_faq.html)
30169 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
30170 0-201-61598-3) in 2001, contains both introductory and more in-depth
30172 More recently Ivan Ristić's book &'Bulletproof SSL and TLS'&,
30173 published by Feisty Duck (ISBN 978-1907117046) in 2013 is good.
30174 Ivan is the author of the popular TLS testing tools at
30175 &url(https://www.ssllabs.com/).
30178 .subsection "Certificate chains" SECID186
30179 A file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
30180 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
30181 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
30182 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
30183 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
30184 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
30185 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
30186 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
30187 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
30188 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
30189 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
30190 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
30192 Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
30193 even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
30194 server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
30195 diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
30199 .subsection "Self-signed certificates" SECID187
30200 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
30201 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
30202 with OpenSSL, like this:
30203 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
30204 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
30206 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
30209 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
30210 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
30211 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
30212 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
30213 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
30214 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
30215 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
30217 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
30218 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
30219 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
30220 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
30221 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
30222 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
30224 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
30225 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
30226 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
30227 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
30228 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
30229 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
30230 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
30231 be a sensible resolution).
30233 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
30234 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
30235 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
30237 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
30238 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
30239 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
30240 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
30241 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
30242 signed with that self-signed certificate.
30244 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
30245 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
30246 Open-source PKI book, available online at
30247 &url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/ospkibook/).
30250 .subsection "Revoked certificates"
30251 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
30252 .cindex "revocation list"
30253 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
30254 .cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
30255 There are three ways for a certificate to be made unusable
30259 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
30260 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
30261 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
30262 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
30263 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
30265 The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
30266 file from every certificate authority they know of.
30269 The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
30270 Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
30271 against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
30272 usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
30273 private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
30274 is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
30276 The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
30277 comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
30278 connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
30279 re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
30282 The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
30283 issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
30284 the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
30285 negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
30286 CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
30287 resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
30288 starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
30289 proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
30291 Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
30292 or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
30293 support for OCSP stapling is included.
30295 There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
30296 The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
30297 an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
30298 option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
30299 contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
30301 Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
30302 proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
30303 Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
30304 contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
30305 on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
30308 When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
30309 in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
30312 For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
30313 also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
30314 certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
30315 of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
30316 intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
30317 file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
30319 Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
30320 not any of the chain from CA to it.
30322 There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
30325 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
30326 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
30327 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
30329 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
30330 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
30331 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
30336 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
30337 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
30340 .section "TLS Resumption" "SECTresumption"
30341 .cindex TLS resumption
30342 TLS Session Resumption for TLS 1.2 and TLS 1.3 connections can be used (defined
30343 in RFC 5077 for 1.2). The support for this requires GnuTLS 3.6.3 or OpenSSL 1.1.1
30346 Session resumption (this is the "stateless" variant) involves the server sending
30347 a "session ticket" to the client on one connection, which can be stored by the
30348 client and used for a later session. The ticket contains sufficient state for
30349 the server to reconstruct the TLS session, avoiding some expensive crypto
30350 calculation and (on TLS1.2) one full packet roundtrip time.
30353 Operational cost/benefit:
30355 The extra data being transmitted costs a minor amount, and the client has
30356 extra costs in storing and retrieving the data.
30358 In the Exim/Gnutls implementation the extra cost on an initial connection
30359 which is TLS1.2 over a loopback path is about 6ms on 2017-laptop class hardware.
30360 The saved cost on a subsequent connection is about 4ms; three or more
30361 connections become a net win. On longer network paths, two or more
30362 connections will have an average lower startup time thanks to the one
30363 saved packet roundtrip. TLS1.3 will save the crypto cpu costs but not any
30366 .cindex "hints database" tls
30367 Since a new hints DB is used on the TLS client,
30368 the hints DB maintenance should be updated to additionally handle "tls".
30373 The session ticket is encrypted, but is obviously an additional security
30374 vulnarability surface. An attacker able to decrypt it would have access
30375 all connections using the resumed session.
30376 The session ticket encryption key is not committed to storage by the server
30377 and is rotated regularly (OpenSSL: 1hr, and one previous key is used for
30378 overlap; GnuTLS 6hr but does not specify any overlap).
30379 Tickets have limited lifetime (2hr, and new ones issued after 1hr under
30380 OpenSSL. GnuTLS 2hr, appears to not do overlap).
30382 There is a question-mark over the security of the Diffie-Helman parameters
30383 used for session negotiation.
30388 The &%log_selector%& "tls_resumption" appends an asterisk to the tls_cipher "X="
30391 The variables &$tls_in_resumption$& and &$tls_out_resumption$&
30392 have bits 0-4 indicating respectively
30393 support built, client requested ticket, client offered session,
30394 server issued ticket, resume used. A suitable decode list is provided
30395 in the builtin macro _RESUME_DECODE for in &%listextract%& expansions.
30400 The &%tls_resumption_hosts%& main option specifies a hostlist for which
30401 exim, operating as a server, will offer resumption to clients.
30402 Current best practice is to not offer the feature to MUA connection.
30403 Commonly this can be done like this:
30405 tls_resumption_hosts = ${if inlist {$received_port}{587:465} {:}{*}}
30407 If the peer host matches the list after expansion then resumption
30408 is offered and/or accepted.
30410 The &%tls_resumption_hosts%& smtp transport option performs the
30411 equivalent function for operation as a client.
30412 If the peer host matches the list after expansion then resumption
30413 is attempted (if a stored session is available) or the information
30414 stored (if supplied by the peer).
30420 In a resumed session:
30422 The variables &$tls_{in,out}_cipher$& will have values different
30423 to the original (under GnuTLS).
30425 The variables &$tls_{in,out}_ocsp$& will be "not requested" or "no response",
30426 and the &%hosts_require_ocsp%& smtp trasnport option will fail.
30427 . XXX need to do something with that hosts_require_ocsp
30433 .section DANE "SECDANE"
30435 DNS-based Authentication of Named Entities, as applied to SMTP over TLS, provides assurance to a client that
30436 it is actually talking to the server it wants to rather than some attacker operating a Man In The Middle (MITM)
30437 operation. The latter can terminate the TLS connection you make, and make another one to the server (so both
30438 you and the server still think you have an encrypted connection) and, if one of the "well known" set of
30439 Certificate Authorities has been suborned - something which *has* been seen already (2014), a verifiable
30440 certificate (if you're using normal root CAs, eg. the Mozilla set, as your trust anchors).
30442 What DANE does is replace the CAs with the DNS as the trust anchor. The assurance is limited to a) the possibility
30443 that the DNS has been suborned, b) mistakes made by the admins of the target server. The attack surface presented
30444 by (a) is thought to be smaller than that of the set of root CAs.
30446 It also allows the server to declare (implicitly) that connections to it should use TLS. An MITM could simply
30447 fail to pass on a server's STARTTLS.
30449 DANE scales better than having to maintain (and communicate via side-channel) copies of server certificates
30450 for every possible target server. It also scales (slightly) better than having to maintain on an SMTP
30451 client a copy of the standard CAs bundle. It also means not having to pay a CA for certificates.
30453 DANE requires a server operator to do three things:
30455 Run DNSSEC. This provides assurance to clients
30456 that DNS lookups they do for the server have not been tampered with. The domain MX record applying
30457 to this server, its A record, its TLSA record and any associated CNAME records must all be covered by
30460 Add TLSA DNS records. These say what the server certificate for a TLS connection should be.
30462 Offer a server certificate, or certificate chain, in TLS connections which is anchored by one of the TLSA records.
30465 There are no changes to Exim specific to server-side operation of DANE.
30466 Support for client-side operation of DANE can be included at compile time by defining SUPPORT_DANE=yes
30467 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
30468 If it has been included, the macro "_HAVE_DANE" will be defined.
30470 .subsection "DNS records"
30471 A TLSA record consist of 4 fields, the "Certificate Usage", the
30472 "Selector", the "Matching type", and the "Certificate Association Data".
30473 For a detailed description of the TLSA record see
30474 &url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7671#page-5,RFC 7671).
30476 The TLSA record for the server may have "Certificate Usage" (1st) field of DANE-TA(2) or DANE-EE(3).
30477 These are the "Trust Anchor" and "End Entity" variants.
30478 The latter specifies the End Entity directly, i.e. the certificate involved is that of the server
30479 (and if only DANE-EE is used then it should be the sole one transmitted during the TLS handshake);
30480 this is appropriate for a single system, using a self-signed certificate.
30481 DANE-TA usage is effectively declaring a specific CA to be used; this might be a private CA or a public,
30483 A private CA at simplest is just a self-signed certificate (with certain
30484 attributes) which is used to sign server certificates, but running one securely
30485 does require careful arrangement.
30486 With DANE-TA, as implemented in Exim and commonly in other MTAs,
30487 the server TLS handshake must transmit the entire certificate chain from CA to server-certificate.
30488 DANE-TA is commonly used for several services and/or servers, each having a TLSA query-domain CNAME record,
30489 all of which point to a single TLSA record.
30490 DANE-TA and DANE-EE can both be used together.
30492 Our recommendation is to use DANE with a certificate from a public CA,
30493 because this enables a variety of strategies for remote clients to verify
30495 You can then publish information both via DANE and another technology,
30496 "MTA-STS", described below.
30498 When you use DANE-TA to publish trust anchor information, you ask entities
30499 outside your administrative control to trust the Certificate Authority for
30500 connections to you.
30501 If using a private CA then you should expect others to still apply the
30502 technical criteria they'd use for a public CA to your certificates.
30503 In particular, you should probably try to follow current best practices for CA
30504 operation around hash algorithms and key sizes.
30505 Do not expect other organizations to lower their security expectations just
30506 because a particular profile might be reasonable for your own internal use.
30508 When this text was last updated, this in practice means to avoid use of SHA-1
30509 and MD5; if using RSA to use key sizes of at least 2048 bits (and no larger
30510 than 4096, for interoperability); to use keyUsage fields correctly; to use
30511 random serial numbers.
30512 The list of requirements is subject to change as best practices evolve.
30513 If you're not already using a private CA, or it doesn't meet these
30514 requirements, then we encourage you to avoid all these issues and use a public
30515 CA such as &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt) instead.
30517 The TLSA record should have a "Selector" (2nd) field of SPKI(1) and
30518 a "Matching Type" (3rd) field of SHA2-512(2).
30520 For the "Certificate Authority Data" (4th) field, commands like
30523 openssl x509 -pubkey -noout <certificate.pem \
30524 | openssl rsa -outform der -pubin 2>/dev/null \
30529 are workable to create a hash of the certificate's public key.
30531 An example TLSA record for DANE-EE(3), SPKI(1), and SHA-512 (2) looks like
30534 _25._tcp.mail.example.com. TLSA 3 1 2 8BA8A336E...
30537 At the time of writing, &url(https://www.huque.com/bin/gen_tlsa)
30538 is useful for quickly generating TLSA records.
30541 For use with the DANE-TA model, server certificates must have a correct name (SubjectName or SubjectAltName).
30543 The Certificate issued by the CA published in the DANE-TA model should be
30544 issued using a strong hash algorithm.
30545 Exim, and importantly various other MTAs sending to you, will not
30546 re-enable hash algorithms which have been disabled by default in TLS
30548 This means no MD5 and no SHA-1. SHA2-256 is the minimum for reliable
30549 interoperability (and probably the maximum too, in 2018).
30551 .subsection "Interaction with OCSP"
30552 The use of OCSP-stapling should be considered, allowing for fast revocation of certificates (which would otherwise
30553 be limited by the DNS TTL on the TLSA records). However, this is likely to only be usable with DANE-TA. NOTE: the
30554 default of requesting OCSP for all hosts is modified iff DANE is in use, to:
30557 hosts_request_ocsp = ${if or { {= {0}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} \
30558 {= {4}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} } \
30562 The (new) variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& is a bitfield with numbered bits set for TLSA record usage codes.
30563 The zero above means DANE was not in use, the four means that only DANE-TA usage TLSA records were
30564 found. If the definition of &%hosts_request_ocsp%& includes the
30565 string "tls_out_tlsa_usage", they are re-expanded in time to
30566 control the OCSP request.
30568 This modification of hosts_request_ocsp is only done if it has the default value of "*". Admins who change it, and
30569 those who use &%hosts_require_ocsp%&, should consider the interaction with DANE in their OCSP settings.
30572 .subsection "Client configuration"
30573 For client-side DANE there are three new smtp transport options, &%hosts_try_dane%&, &%hosts_require_dane%&
30574 and &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%&.
30575 The &"require"& variant will result in failure if the target host is not
30576 DNSSEC-secured. To get DNSSEC-secured hostname resolution, use
30577 the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router or transport option.
30579 DANE will only be usable if the target host has DNSSEC-secured MX, A and TLSA records.
30581 A TLSA lookup will be done if either of the above options match and the host-lookup succeeded using DNSSEC.
30582 If a TLSA lookup is done and succeeds, a DANE-verified TLS connection
30583 will be required for the host. If it does not, the host will not
30584 be used; there is no fallback to non-DANE or non-TLS.
30586 If DANE is requested and usable, then the TLS cipher list configuration
30587 prefers to use the option &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%& and falls
30588 back to &%tls_require_ciphers%& only if that is unset.
30589 This lets you configure "decent crypto" for DANE and "better than nothing
30590 crypto" as the default. Note though that while GnuTLS lets the string control
30591 which versions of TLS/SSL will be negotiated, OpenSSL does not and you're
30592 limited to ciphersuite constraints.
30594 If DANE is requested and useable (see above) the following transport options are ignored:
30598 tls_try_verify_hosts
30599 tls_verify_certificates
30601 tls_verify_cert_hostnames
30605 If DANE is not usable, whether requested or not, and CA-anchored
30606 verification evaluation is wanted, the above variables should be set appropriately.
30608 The router and transport option &%dnssec_request_domains%& must not be
30609 set to &"never"&, and &%dnssec_require_domains%& is ignored.
30611 .subsection Observability
30612 If verification was successful using DANE then the "CV" item in the delivery log line will show as "CV=dane".
30614 There is a new variable &$tls_out_dane$& which will have "yes" if
30615 verification succeeded using DANE and "no" otherwise (only useful
30616 in combination with events; see &<<CHAPevents>>&),
30617 and a new variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& (detailed above).
30619 .cindex DANE reporting
30620 An event (see &<<CHAPevents>>&) of type "dane:fail" will be raised on failures
30621 to achieve DANE-verified connection, if one was either requested and offered, or
30622 required. This is intended to support TLS-reporting as defined in
30623 &url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/draft-ietf-uta-smtp-tlsrpt-17).
30624 The &$event_data$& will be one of the Result Types defined in
30625 Section 4.3 of that document.
30627 .subsection General
30628 Under GnuTLS, DANE is only supported from version 3.0.0 onwards.
30630 DANE is specified in RFC 6698. It decouples certificate authority trust
30631 selection from a "race to the bottom" of "you must trust everything for mail
30633 It does retain the need to trust the assurances provided by the DNSSEC tree.
30635 There is an alternative technology called MTA-STS (RFC 8461), which
30636 instead publishes MX trust anchor information on an HTTPS website.
30637 The discovery of the address for that website does not (per standard)
30638 require DNSSEC, and could be regarded as being less secure than DANE
30641 Exim has no support for MTA-STS as a client, but Exim mail server operators
30642 can choose to publish information describing their TLS configuration using
30643 MTA-STS to let those clients who do use that protocol derive trust
30646 The MTA-STS design requires a certificate from a public Certificate Authority
30647 which is recognized by clients sending to you.
30648 That selection of which CAs are trusted by others is outside your control.
30650 The most interoperable course of action is probably to use
30651 &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt), with automated certificate
30652 renewal; to publish the anchor information in DNSSEC-secured DNS via TLSA
30653 records for DANE clients (such as Exim and Postfix) and to publish anchor
30654 information for MTA-STS as well. This is what is done for the &'exim.org'&
30655 domain itself (with caveats around occasionally broken MTA-STS because of
30656 incompatible specification changes prior to reaching RFC status).
30660 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30661 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30663 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
30664 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
30665 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
30666 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
30667 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
30668 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the runtime
30669 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
30670 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
30671 one very small ACL:
30675 accept hosts = one.host.only
30677 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
30678 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
30680 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
30681 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
30682 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
30683 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
30684 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
30685 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
30686 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
30687 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
30690 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
30691 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
30692 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
30695 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
30696 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
30697 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
30698 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
30699 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
30700 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
30701 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
30702 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
30703 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
30704 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
30705 .cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
30706 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
30707 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
30708 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
30709 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
30710 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
30711 .cindex "WELLKNOWN" "ACL for"
30712 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
30713 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
30714 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
30715 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
30718 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
30719 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
30720 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
30721 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
30722 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
30723 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
30724 .irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
30725 .irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
30726 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
30727 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
30728 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
30729 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
30730 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
30731 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
30732 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
30733 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
30734 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
30735 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
30736 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
30737 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
30738 .irow &%acl_smtp_wellknown%& "ACL for WELLKNOWN"
30741 For example, if you set
30743 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
30745 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
30746 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
30747 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
30748 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
30749 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
30750 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
30751 testing as possible at RCPT time.
30754 .subsection "The non-SMTP ACLs" SECnonSMTP
30755 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
30756 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
30757 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
30758 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
30759 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
30760 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
30761 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
30762 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
30763 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
30764 in any of these ACLs.
30766 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
30767 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
30768 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
30769 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
30770 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
30771 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
30772 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
30773 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
30775 control = suppress_local_fixups
30777 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
30778 run, it is too late.
30780 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30781 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30783 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
30784 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
30785 temporary error for these kinds of message.
30788 .subsection "The SMTP connect ACL" SECconnectACL
30789 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
30790 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
30791 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
30792 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
30793 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
30794 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
30795 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
30796 &%smtp_banner%& option.
30798 For tls-on-connect connections, the ACL is run before the TLS connection
30799 is accepted; if the ACL does not accept then the TCP connection is dropped without
30800 any TLS startup attempt and without any SMTP response being transmitted.
30803 .subsection "The EHLO/HELO ACL" SECheloACL
30804 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
30805 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
30806 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
30807 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
30808 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
30809 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
30810 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
30811 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
30813 Note also that a deny neither forces the client to go away nor means that
30814 mail will be refused on the connection. Consider checking for
30815 &$sender_helo_name$& being defined in a MAIL or RCPT ACL to do that.
30817 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
30818 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
30819 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
30820 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
30824 .subsection "The DATA ACLs" SECdataACLS
30825 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
30826 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
30827 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
30828 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
30829 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
30830 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
30831 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
30832 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
30833 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
30835 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
30836 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
30837 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
30838 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
30839 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
30840 associated with the DATA command.
30842 .cindex CHUNKING "BDAT command"
30843 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
30844 .cindex "RFC 3030" CHUNKING
30845 If CHUNKING was advertised and a BDAT command sequence is received,
30846 the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL is not run.
30847 . XXX why not? It should be possible, for the first BDAT.
30848 The &%acl_smtp_data%& is run after the last BDAT command and all of
30849 the data specified is received.
30851 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
30852 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
30853 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
30854 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
30855 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
30858 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
30859 the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
30860 the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
30861 and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
30863 .subsection "The SMTP DKIM ACL" SECTDKIMACL
30864 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
30865 enabled (which is the default).
30867 If, for a specific message, an ACL control
30868 &*dkim_disable_verify*&
30869 has been set, this &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is not called.
30871 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
30872 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
30873 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
30875 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
30877 For details on the operation of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
30880 .subsection "The SMTP MIME ACL" SECID194
30881 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
30882 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
30884 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
30887 .subsection "The SMTP PRDR ACL" SECTPRDRACL
30888 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
30889 .oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
30890 The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
30891 with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
30892 It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
30893 client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
30896 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
30897 has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
30898 with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
30899 The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
30900 The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
30901 can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
30902 for some or all recipients.
30904 PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
30905 one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
30906 content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
30907 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
30908 for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
30910 Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
30911 ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
30912 will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
30914 See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
30915 and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
30917 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
30918 If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
30919 the feature was not requested by the client.
30921 .subsection "The SMTP WELLKNOWN ACL" SECTWELLKNOWNACL
30922 .cindex "WELLKNOWN" "ACL for"
30923 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_wellknown%&"
30924 The &%acl_smtp_wellknown%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
30925 with WELLKNOWN support enabled.
30927 The ACL determines the response to an SMTP WELLKNOWN command, using the normal
30928 accept/defer/deny verbs for the response code,
30929 and a new &"control=wellknown"& modifier.
30930 This modifier takes a single option, separated by a '/'
30931 character, which must be the name of a file containing the response
30932 cleartext. The modifier is expanded before use in the usual way before
30933 it is used. The configuration is responsible for picking a suitable file
30934 to return and, most importantly, not returning any unexpected file.
30935 The argument for the SMTP verb will be available in the &$smtp_command_argument$&
30936 variable and can be used for building the file path.
30937 If the file path given in the modifier is empty or inacessible, the control will
30943 accept control = wellknown/\
30944 ${lookup {${xtextd:$smtp_command_argument}} \
30945 dsearch,key=path,filter=file,ret=full \
30946 {$spooldir/wellknown.d}}
30948 File content will be encoded in &"xtext"& form, and line-wrapping
30949 for line-length limitation will be done before transmission.
30950 A response summary line will be prepended, with the (pre-encoding) file size.
30952 The above example uses the expansion operator ${xtextd:<coded-string>}
30953 which is needed to decode the xtext-encoded key from the SMTP verb.
30955 Under the util directory there is a "mailtest" utility which can be used
30956 to test/retrieve WELLKNOWN items. Syntax is
30958 mailtest -h host.example.com -w security.txt
30961 WELLKNOWN is a ESMTP extension providing access to extended
30962 information about the server. It is modelled on the webserver
30963 facilities documented in RFC 8615 and can be used for a security.txt
30964 file and could be used for ACME handshaking (RFC 8555).
30966 Exim will advertise WELLKNOWN support in the EHLO response
30967 .oindex &%wellknown_advertise_hosts%&
30968 (conditional on a new option &%wellknown_advertise_hosts%&)
30969 and service WELLKNOWN smtp verbs having a single parameter
30970 giving a key for an item of "site-wide metadata".
30971 The verb and key are separated by whitespace,
30972 and the key is xtext-encoded (per RFC 3461 section 4).
30975 .subsection "The QUIT ACL" SECTQUITACL
30976 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
30977 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
30978 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
30979 does not in fact control any access.
30980 For this reason, it may only accept
30981 or warn as its final result.
30983 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
30984 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
30985 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
30986 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
30988 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
30989 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
30991 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
30992 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
30995 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
30996 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
30997 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
30998 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
30999 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
31002 .subsection "The not-QUIT ACL" SECTNOTQUITACL
31003 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
31004 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
31005 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
31006 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
31007 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
31008 situation even worse.
31010 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
31011 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
31012 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
31015 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
31016 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
31017 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
31018 connection. The possible values are:
31020 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
31021 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
31022 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
31023 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
31024 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
31025 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
31026 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
31027 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
31028 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
31029 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
31031 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
31032 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
31033 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
31034 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
31035 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
31039 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
31040 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
31041 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
31042 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
31044 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
31045 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
31047 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
31048 providing an RFC 4409 message &"submission"& service on port 587 and
31049 an RFC 8314 &"submissions"& service on port 465. You can use a string
31050 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
31051 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
31053 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
31054 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
31055 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
31058 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a filename, and reads its
31059 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
31060 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
31061 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
31062 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
31063 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
31065 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
31066 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
31067 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
31069 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
31070 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
31071 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
31072 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
31074 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
31075 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
31076 matches the string.
31078 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
31079 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
31080 want to have something like
31082 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
31084 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
31085 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
31091 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
31092 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
31093 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
31094 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
31095 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
31096 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
31097 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
31098 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
31099 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
31101 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
31102 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
31103 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
31106 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
31107 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
31108 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
31109 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
31111 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
31112 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
31113 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
31114 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
31115 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
31116 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
31117 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
31119 If the ACL for VRFY returns &"accept"&, a recipient verify (without callout)
31120 is done on the address and the result determines the SMTP response.
31123 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
31124 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
31125 recipients; it may create new recipients.
31129 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
31130 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
31131 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
31132 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
31133 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
31134 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
31136 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
31137 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
31138 used to accept or reject anything.
31140 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
31141 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
31142 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
31143 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
31145 For the others (&%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&,
31147 and &%acl_smtp_wellknown%&),
31148 the action when the ACL
31149 is not defined is &"deny"&. This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be
31150 defined in order to receive any messages over an SMTP connection.
31151 For an example, see the ACL in the default configuration file.
31155 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
31156 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
31158 .vindex &$local_part$&
31159 .vindex &$sender_address$&
31160 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
31161 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
31162 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
31163 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
31164 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
31165 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
31166 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
31167 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
31169 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
31170 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
31171 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
31174 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
31175 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
31176 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
31177 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
31178 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
31181 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
31182 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
31183 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
31184 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
31185 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
31186 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
31187 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
31188 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
31194 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
31195 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
31196 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
31197 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
31198 When an ACL is being run for AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
31199 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
31200 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
31201 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
31202 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
31203 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
31204 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
31205 unencrypted connections.
31208 accept encrypted = *
31209 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
31211 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
31213 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
31214 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
31215 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
31216 option to do this.)
31220 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
31221 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
31222 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
31223 An individual ACL definition consists of a number of statements.
31224 Each statement starts
31225 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
31226 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
31227 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
31229 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
31230 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
31231 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
31234 deny dnslists = list1.example
31235 dnslists = list2.example
31237 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
31238 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
31239 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
31240 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
31241 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
31243 The definition of an ACL ends where another starts,
31244 or a different configuration section starts.
31247 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
31248 The ACL verbs are as follows:
31251 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
31252 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
31253 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
31254 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
31255 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
31256 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
31257 check a RCPT command:
31259 accept domains = +local_domains
31263 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
31264 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
31265 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
31266 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
31269 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
31270 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
31271 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
31274 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
31275 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
31276 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
31277 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
31278 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
31279 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
31281 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
31282 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
31284 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
31285 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
31286 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
31288 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
31289 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
31290 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
31295 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
31296 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
31297 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
31298 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
31299 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
31300 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
31301 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
31305 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
31306 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
31307 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
31310 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31312 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
31316 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
31317 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
31318 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
31319 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
31320 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
31321 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
31322 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
31323 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
31324 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
31326 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
31327 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
31328 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
31332 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
31333 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
31334 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
31336 drop condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
31337 message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
31339 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
31340 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
31343 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
31344 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
31345 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
31346 example, when checking a RCPT command,
31348 require message = Sender did not verify
31351 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
31352 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
31353 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
31354 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
31357 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
31358 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
31359 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
31360 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
31361 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
31362 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
31363 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
31365 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
31366 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
31367 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
31368 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
31369 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
31371 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
31372 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
31373 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
31374 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
31375 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
31376 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
31380 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
31381 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
31382 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
31383 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
31385 warn !verify = sender
31386 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
31390 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
31392 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
31393 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
31394 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
31395 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
31396 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
31400 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
31401 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
31402 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
31403 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
31404 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
31405 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
31406 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
31407 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
31408 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
31409 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
31411 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
31412 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
31413 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
31414 on the same SMTP connection.
31416 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
31417 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
31418 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
31421 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
31422 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
31423 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
31425 accept hosts = whatever
31426 set acl_m4 = some value
31427 accept authenticated = *
31428 set acl_c_auth = yes
31430 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
31431 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
31432 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
31434 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
31435 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
31436 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
31437 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
31438 error is generated.
31440 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
31441 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
31444 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
31445 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
31446 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
31447 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
31449 deny domains = *.dom.example
31450 !verify = recipient
31452 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
31453 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
31454 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
31455 two statements are equivalent:
31457 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
31458 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
31460 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
31461 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
31463 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
31464 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
31465 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
31467 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
31468 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
31469 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
31470 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
31472 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
31473 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
31474 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
31475 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
31476 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
31477 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
31478 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
31480 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
31481 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
31482 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
31483 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
31484 message is handled.
31486 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
31487 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
31488 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
31489 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
31491 require message = Can't verify sender
31493 message = Can't verify recipient
31495 message = This message cannot be used
31497 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
31498 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
31499 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
31500 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
31501 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
31502 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
31504 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
31505 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
31506 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
31507 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
31510 !senders = *@my.domain.example
31511 message = Invalid sender from client host
31513 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
31514 by which time Exim has set up the message.
31518 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
31519 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
31520 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
31523 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31524 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
31525 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
31526 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
31528 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31529 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
31530 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
31531 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
31532 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
31533 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
31534 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
31535 write rather ugly lines like this:
31537 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
31539 Instead, all you need is
31541 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
31544 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31545 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
31546 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
31547 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
31548 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
31549 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
31550 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
31551 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
31553 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
31554 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
31555 in several different ways. For example:
31557 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
31558 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
31559 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
31563 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
31565 accept ...some conditions
31568 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
31569 other words, when the conditions are all true.
31572 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
31574 accept ...some conditions...
31576 ...some more conditions...
31578 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
31579 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
31580 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
31584 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
31585 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
31588 warn ...some conditions...
31592 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
31593 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
31597 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
31598 &%require%& verb. For example:
31600 require control = no_multiline_responses
31604 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
31605 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
31607 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
31608 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
31609 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
31610 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
31611 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
31612 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
31614 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
31617 deny ...some conditions...
31620 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
31621 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
31624 ...some conditions...
31626 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
31627 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
31629 warn ...some conditions...
31635 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
31636 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
31637 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
31638 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
31639 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
31640 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
31641 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
31645 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
31646 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
31647 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
31648 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
31649 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
31650 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
31651 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
31654 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31655 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
31656 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
31657 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
31659 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
31660 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
31662 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
31665 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
31666 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
31668 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
31669 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
31670 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
31673 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
31674 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
31675 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
31676 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
31677 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
31678 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
31681 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
31682 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
31683 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
31686 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
31687 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
31688 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
31689 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
31690 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
31691 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
31693 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
31694 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
31695 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
31696 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
31697 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
31698 logging rejections.
31701 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
31702 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
31703 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
31704 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
31705 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
31706 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
31707 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
31708 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
31710 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
31711 &` log_reject_target =`&
31713 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
31714 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
31718 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31719 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
31720 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
31721 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
31722 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
31723 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
31724 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
31727 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
31728 &` control = freeze`&
31729 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
31731 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
31732 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
31733 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
31736 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
31737 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
31741 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31742 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
31743 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
31744 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
31745 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
31746 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
31747 &%accept%& for details.)
31749 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
31750 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
31751 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
31752 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
31753 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
31755 require message = Host not recognized
31758 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
31761 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
31762 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
31763 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
31764 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
31765 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
31766 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
31767 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
31768 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
31769 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
31772 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
31773 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
31774 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
31776 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
31777 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
31779 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
31780 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
31781 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
31784 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
31785 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
31787 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
31788 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
31790 If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
31792 A long message line will also be split into multi-line SMTP responses,
31793 on word boundaries if possible.
31795 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
31796 While the text is being expanded, the &$acl_verify_message$& variable
31797 contains any message previously set.
31798 Afterwards, &$acl_verify_message$& is cleared.
31800 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
31801 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
31802 However, the original message is available in the variable
31803 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
31804 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
31805 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
31806 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
31808 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
31809 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
31810 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
31811 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
31812 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
31813 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
31817 .vitem &*queue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31818 .cindex "&%queue%& ACL modifier"
31819 .cindex "named queues" "selecting in ACL"
31820 This modifier specifies the use of a named queue for spool files
31822 It can only be used before the message is received (i.e. not in
31824 This could be used, for example, for known high-volume burst sources
31825 of traffic, or for quarantine of messages.
31826 Separate queue-runner processes will be needed for named queues.
31827 If the text after expansion is empty, the default queue is used.
31830 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31831 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
31832 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
31833 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
31836 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
31837 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
31838 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
31839 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
31842 .vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
31843 .cindex "UDP communications"
31844 This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
31845 collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
31846 the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
31847 of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
31848 server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
31849 separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
31850 example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
31853 udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
31854 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
31861 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
31862 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
31863 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
31866 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
31867 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
31868 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
31869 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
31870 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
31871 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
31872 not work without it. For example:
31874 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
31875 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
31877 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
31878 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
31879 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
31880 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
31881 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
31884 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
31885 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
31886 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
31887 .cindex "case of local parts"
31888 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
31889 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
31890 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
31891 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
31892 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
31893 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
31896 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
31897 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
31898 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
31899 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
31900 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
31902 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
31903 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
31906 warn control = caseful_local_part
31907 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
31909 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
31911 control = caselower_local_part
31913 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
31914 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
31917 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery/*&<&'options'&>
31918 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
31919 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
31920 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
31922 The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
31923 If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
31924 and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
31925 is used for all recipients of the message,
31926 then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
31927 and data is copied from one to the other.
31929 An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
31930 for a mail will be quietly ignored.
31931 If a recipient-verify callout
31933 connection is subsequently
31934 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
31935 any subsequent recipients and the data,
31936 otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
31938 Note that routers are used in verify mode,
31939 and cannot depend on content of received headers.
31940 Note also that headers cannot be
31941 modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
31942 Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
31943 The &'Received-By:'& header is generated as soon as the body reception starts,
31944 rather than the traditional time after the full message is received;
31945 this will affect the timestamp.
31947 All the usual ACLs are called; if one results in the message being
31948 rejected, all effort spent in delivery (including the costs on
31949 the ultimate destination) will be wasted.
31950 Note that in the case of data-time ACLs this includes the entire
31953 Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
31954 of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
31955 before the entire message has been received from the source.
31956 It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR
31960 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
31961 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
31962 If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
31963 the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
31964 before the acceptance "<=" line.
31966 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
31968 This behaviour can be adjusted by appending the option &*defer=*&<&'value'&>
31969 to the control; the default value is &"spool"& and the alternate value
31970 &"pass"& copies an SMTP defer response from the target back to the initiator
31971 and does not queue the message.
31972 Note that this is independent of any recipient verify conditions in the ACL.
31974 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
31976 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
31979 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
31980 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
31981 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
31982 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
31983 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile in the usual logs directory,
31984 by default called &'debuglog'&.
31986 Logging set up by the control will be maintained across spool residency.
31988 Options are a slash-separated list.
31989 If an option takes an argument, the option name and argument are separated by
31990 an equals character.
31991 Several options are supported:
31993 tag=<&'suffix'&> The filename can be adjusted with thise option.
31994 The argument, which may access any variables already defined,
31995 is appended to the default name.
31997 opts=<&'debug&~options'&> The argument specififes what is to be logged,
31998 using the same values as the &`-d`& command-line option.
32000 stop Logging started with this control may be
32001 stopped by using this option.
32003 kill Logging started with this control may be
32004 stopped by using this option.
32005 Additionally the debug file will be removed,
32006 providing one means for speculative debug tracing.
32008 pretrigger=<&'size'&> This option specifies a memory buffuer to be used
32009 for pre-trigger debug capture.
32010 Debug lines are recorded in the buffer until
32011 and if) a trigger occurs; at which time they are
32012 dumped to the debug file. Newer lines displace the
32013 oldest if the buffer is full. After a trigger,
32014 immediate writes to file are done as normal.
32016 trigger=<&'reason'&> This option selects cause for the pretrigger buffer
32017 see above) to be copied to file. A reason of &*now*&
32018 take effect immediately; one of &*paniclog*& triggers
32019 on a write to the panic log.
32022 Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
32026 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
32027 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
32028 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
32029 control = debug/kill
32030 control = debug/opts=+all/pretrigger=1024/trigger=paniclog
32031 control = debug/trigger=now
32035 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
32036 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
32037 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
32038 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
32039 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
32042 .vitem &*control&~=&~dmarc_disable_verify*&
32043 .cindex "disable DMARC verify"
32044 .cindex "DMARC" "disable verify"
32045 This control turns off DMARC verification processing entirely. For details on
32046 the operation and configuration of DMARC, see section &<<SECDMARC>>&.
32049 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
32050 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
32051 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
32052 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
32053 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
32054 strings or to numeric value.
32055 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
32056 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
32057 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
32059 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
32060 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
32061 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
32062 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
32063 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
32066 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
32067 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
32068 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
32069 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
32070 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
32071 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
32072 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
32073 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
32075 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
32076 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
32077 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
32078 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
32079 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
32080 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
32084 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
32085 .cindex "fake defer"
32086 .cindex "defer, fake"
32088 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
32089 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
32090 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
32091 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
32092 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
32094 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
32095 .cindex "fake rejection"
32096 .cindex "rejection, fake"
32098 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
32099 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
32100 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
32101 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
32102 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
32103 the same SMTP connection.
32105 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
32106 message is supplied, the following is used:
32108 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
32109 550-kept for evaluation.
32110 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
32111 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
32113 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
32115 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
32116 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
32117 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
32118 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
32119 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
32120 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
32123 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
32124 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
32125 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
32126 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
32128 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
32129 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
32130 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
32131 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
32132 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
32133 disables such output flushing.
32135 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
32136 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
32137 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
32138 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
32139 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
32140 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
32142 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
32143 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
32144 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
32145 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
32146 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
32147 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
32148 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
32149 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
32150 to be useful in production.
32152 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
32153 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
32154 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
32155 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
32156 SMTP responses, despite the fact that RFC 821 defined them over 20 years ago.
32158 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
32159 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
32160 one long line. However, RFC 2821 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
32161 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
32162 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
32163 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
32166 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
32167 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
32168 verification failed"&) is sent.
32170 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
32174 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
32175 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
32177 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
32178 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
32179 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PIPELINING
32180 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
32181 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
32182 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
32183 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
32184 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
32186 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue/*&<&'options'&>* &&&
32187 &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
32188 .oindex "&%queue%&"
32189 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
32190 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
32191 .cindex queueing "forcing in ACL"
32192 .cindex "first pass routing"
32193 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
32194 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
32195 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
32197 If used with no options set,
32198 no immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
32199 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option or &'-odq'& command-line option.
32201 If the &'first_pass_route'& option is given then
32202 the behaviour is like the command-line &'-oqds'& option;
32203 a delivery process is started which stops short of making
32204 any SMTP delivery. The benefit is that the hints database will be updated for
32205 the message being waiting for a specific host, and a later queue run will be
32206 able to send all such messages on a single connection.
32208 The control only applies to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that
32209 may be received in the same SMTP connection.
32211 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
32212 .cindex "message" "submission"
32213 .cindex "submission mode"
32214 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
32215 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
32216 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
32217 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
32218 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
32219 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
32220 late (the message has already been created).
32222 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
32223 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
32224 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
32225 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
32226 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
32228 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
32229 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
32230 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
32231 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
32232 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
32235 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
32236 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
32238 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
32240 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
32243 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
32244 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
32245 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
32246 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
32249 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
32250 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
32252 .vitem &*control&~=&~utf8_downconvert*&
32253 This control enables conversion of UTF-8 in message envelope addresses
32255 For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
32257 .vitem &*control&~=&~wellknown*&
32258 This control sets up a response data file for a WELLKNOWN SMTP command.
32259 It may only be used in an ACL servicing that command.
32260 For details see section &<<SECTWELLKNOWNACL>>&.
32264 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
32265 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
32268 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
32270 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
32271 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
32273 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
32275 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
32280 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
32281 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
32282 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
32283 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
32284 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
32285 to an incoming message, as in this example:
32287 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
32288 dialup.mail-abuse.org
32289 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
32291 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
32292 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
32293 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
32294 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
32295 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
32298 Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
32299 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
32301 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
32302 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
32303 contains one or more newlines that
32304 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
32305 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
32306 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
32308 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
32309 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
32310 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
32311 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
32312 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
32313 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
32314 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
32315 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
32316 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
32317 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
32318 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
32320 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
32321 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
32323 until they are added to the
32324 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
32325 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
32326 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
32327 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
32328 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
32329 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
32330 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
32332 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
32334 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
32335 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
32337 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
32338 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
32340 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
32341 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
32343 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
32344 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
32345 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
32346 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
32349 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
32350 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
32351 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
32352 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
32353 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
32354 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
32355 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
32358 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
32359 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
32360 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
32361 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
32362 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
32364 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
32365 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
32366 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
32367 to be a header name first.) For example:
32369 warn add_header = \
32370 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
32372 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
32373 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
32374 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
32375 up in reverse order.
32377 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
32378 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
32379 system filter or in a router or transport.
32383 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
32384 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
32385 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
32386 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
32387 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
32388 from an incoming message, as in this example:
32390 warn message = Remove internal headers
32391 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
32393 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
32394 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
32395 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
32396 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
32397 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
32398 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
32400 Headers will not be removed from the message if the modifier is used in
32401 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
32403 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
32404 list of header specifiers.
32405 If a specifier does not start with a circumflex (^)
32406 then it is treated as a header name.
32407 The header name matching is case insensitive.
32408 If it does, then it is treated as a (front-anchored)
32409 regular expression applied to the whole header.
32411 &*Note*&: The colon terminating a header name will need to be doubled
32412 if used in an RE, and there can legitimately be whitepace before it.
32416 remove_header = \N^(?i)Authentication-Results\s*::\s*example.org;\N
32419 List expansion is not performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
32420 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
32421 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
32423 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
32424 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
32425 warn message = Remove internal headers
32426 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
32428 Header specifiers for removal are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
32429 Matching header lines are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
32430 If multiple header lines match, all are removed.
32431 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor in removing
32432 a non-existent header. Further header specifiers for removal may be accumulated
32433 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which matching headers are removed
32434 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, remove specifiers are
32435 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are acted on after
32436 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
32437 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
32438 would have been removed.
32440 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
32441 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
32442 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
32443 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
32444 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
32445 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
32446 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
32447 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
32448 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
32450 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
32451 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
32453 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
32454 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
32456 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
32457 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
32459 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
32460 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
32461 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
32462 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
32465 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
32466 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
32467 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
32472 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
32473 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
32474 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
32475 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
32476 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
32477 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
32479 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
32480 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
32481 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
32482 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
32483 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
32484 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
32485 The conditions are as follows:
32489 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
32490 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
32491 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
32492 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
32493 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
32494 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
32495 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
32496 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
32497 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
32498 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
32499 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
32500 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
32502 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
32503 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
32504 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
32505 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
32506 The name and values are expanded separately.
32507 Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
32508 will act as argument separators.
32510 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
32511 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
32512 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
32513 conditions are tested.
32515 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
32516 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
32517 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
32518 for different local users or different local domains.
32520 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
32521 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
32522 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
32523 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
32524 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
32525 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
32526 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
32531 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
32532 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
32533 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
32534 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
32535 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
32536 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
32537 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
32538 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
32539 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
32540 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
32541 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
32542 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
32545 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
32546 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
32547 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
32548 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
32549 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
32550 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
32551 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
32552 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
32554 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
32555 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
32556 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
32557 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
32558 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
32559 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
32560 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
32561 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
32562 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
32563 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
32565 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
32566 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
32567 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
32568 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
32569 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
32570 This condition is relevant only in a RCPT ACL. It checks that the domain
32571 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
32572 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
32573 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
32576 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
32577 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
32580 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
32581 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
32582 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
32583 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
32584 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
32585 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
32586 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
32592 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
32593 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
32594 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
32595 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
32596 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
32597 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
32598 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
32600 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
32602 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
32603 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
32604 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
32606 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
32607 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
32608 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
32609 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
32610 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
32611 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
32613 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
32614 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
32616 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
32617 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
32619 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
32620 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
32621 statement can then check the IP address.
32623 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
32624 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
32625 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
32626 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
32628 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
32629 message = $host_data
32631 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
32633 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
32634 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
32635 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
32636 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
32637 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
32638 This condition is relevant only in a RCPT ACL. It checks that the local
32639 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
32640 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
32641 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
32642 the next &%local_parts%& test.
32644 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
32645 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
32646 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
32647 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
32648 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
32649 content-scanning extension
32650 and only after a DATA command.
32651 It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
32652 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
32654 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
32655 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
32656 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
32657 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
32658 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
32659 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
32660 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
32663 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
32664 .cindex "rate limiting"
32665 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
32666 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
32668 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
32669 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
32670 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
32671 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
32672 This condition is relevant only in a RCPT ACL. It checks the entire
32673 recipient address against a list of recipients.
32675 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
32676 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
32677 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
32678 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
32679 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
32680 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
32681 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
32683 .vitem &*seen&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
32684 .cindex "&%seen%& ACL condition"
32685 This condition can be used to test if a situation has been previously met,
32686 for example for greylisting.
32687 Details are given in section &<<SECTseen>>&.
32689 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
32690 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
32691 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
32692 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
32693 .vindex "&$domain$&"
32694 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
32695 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
32696 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
32697 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
32698 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
32699 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
32700 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
32701 influence the sender checking.
32703 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
32704 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
32706 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
32707 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
32708 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
32709 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
32710 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
32711 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
32715 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
32716 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
32718 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
32719 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
32720 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
32721 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
32722 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
32723 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
32725 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
32726 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32727 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
32728 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
32729 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
32730 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
32731 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
32732 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
32733 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
32734 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
32736 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
32737 .cindex "CSA verification"
32738 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
32739 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
32740 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
32742 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
32743 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32744 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
32745 .cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
32746 .cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
32747 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
32749 This usually means an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
32750 It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
32751 there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
32752 allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
32754 Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
32755 problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
32756 detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
32758 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
32759 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32760 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
32761 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
32762 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
32763 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
32764 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
32765 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
32766 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
32767 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
32768 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
32769 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
32770 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
32771 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
32772 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
32774 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
32775 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
32776 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
32777 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
32780 !verify = header_sender
32781 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
32784 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
32785 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32786 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
32787 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
32788 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
32789 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
32790 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
32791 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
32792 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
32793 and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
32794 Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
32795 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
32796 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
32799 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
32800 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
32804 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
32805 common as they used to be.
32807 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
32808 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32809 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
32810 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
32811 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
32812 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
32813 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
32814 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
32815 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
32816 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
32817 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
32818 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
32819 independently of this condition, and for detail of the verification.
32821 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
32822 option), this condition is always true.
32825 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind/*&<&'options'&>
32826 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
32827 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
32828 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
32829 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
32830 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
32831 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
32832 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
32833 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
32835 There is one possible option, &`case_insensitive`&. If this is present then
32836 local parts are checked case-insensitively.
32838 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
32839 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
32842 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
32843 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32844 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
32845 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
32846 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
32847 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
32848 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
32849 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
32850 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
32851 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
32852 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
32853 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
32854 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
32855 value for the child address.
32857 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
32858 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32859 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
32860 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
32861 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
32862 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
32863 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
32864 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
32865 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
32866 original IP address.
32868 There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
32869 DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
32871 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
32872 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
32874 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
32875 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32876 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
32877 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
32878 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
32879 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
32880 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
32881 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
32882 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
32884 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
32885 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
32886 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
32887 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
32888 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
32889 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
32890 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
32892 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
32893 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
32894 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
32896 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
32897 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
32898 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
32899 verified as a sender.
32901 Note that '/' is legal in local-parts; if the address may have such
32902 (eg. is generated from the received message)
32903 they must be protected from the options parsing by doubling:
32905 verify = sender=${listquote{/}{${address:$h_sender:}}}
32911 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
32912 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
32913 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
32914 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
32915 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
32916 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
32917 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
32918 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
32919 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
32920 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
32922 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
32923 dialups.mail-abuse.org
32925 the following records are looked up:
32927 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
32928 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
32930 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
32931 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
32932 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
32933 use two separate conditions:
32935 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
32936 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
32938 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
32939 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
32940 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
32943 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
32944 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
32945 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
32946 following special items in the list:
32947 .itable none 0 0 2 25* left 75* left
32948 .irow "+include_unknown" "behave as if the item is on the list"
32949 .irow "+exclude_unknown" "behave as if the item is not on the list (default)"
32950 .irow "+defer_unknown " "give a temporary error"
32952 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
32953 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
32954 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
32955 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
32957 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
32959 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
32960 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
32962 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
32963 warn dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
32964 message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
32966 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
32968 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
32969 (but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
32970 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
32971 connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
32972 Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
32973 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
32975 There are a number of DNS lists to choose from, some commercial, some free,
32976 or free for small deployments. An overview can be found at
32977 &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Comparison_of_DNS_blacklists).
32981 .subsection "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" SECID201
32982 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
32983 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
32984 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
32985 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
32987 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
32989 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
32990 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
32991 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
32992 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
32997 .subsection "DNS lists keyed on domain names" SECID202
32998 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
32999 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
33000 addresses (see, e.g., the &'domain based zones'& link at
33001 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
33002 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
33003 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
33005 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
33006 message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
33008 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
33009 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
33010 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
33011 up by this example is
33013 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
33015 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
33016 addresses. For example:
33018 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
33019 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
33021 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
33022 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
33027 .subsection "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" SECTmulkeyfor
33028 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
33029 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
33030 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
33031 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
33032 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
33033 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
33034 either to double the separators like this:
33036 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
33038 or to change the separator character, like this:
33040 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
33042 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
33043 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
33044 occurs. Consider this condition:
33046 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
33048 The DNS lookups that occur are:
33050 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
33051 a.domain.black.list.tld
33053 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
33054 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
33055 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
33056 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
33057 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
33058 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
33059 error for a previous item.
33061 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
33062 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
33064 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
33065 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
33067 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
33068 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
33070 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
33071 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
33072 $sender_address_domain} }} }
33073 message = The mail servers for the domain \
33074 $sender_address_domain \
33075 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
33078 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
33079 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
33080 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
33081 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
33083 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
33085 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
33086 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
33088 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
33089 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
33094 .subsection "Data returned by DNS lists" SECID203
33095 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
33096 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
33097 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
33098 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
33099 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
33100 .itable none 0 0 2 20* left 80* left
33101 .irow 127.1.0.1 "RBL"
33102 .irow 127.1.0.2 "DUL"
33103 .irow 127.1.0.3 "DUL and RBL"
33104 .irow 127.1.0.4 "RSS"
33105 .irow 127.1.0.5 "RSS and RBL"
33106 .irow 127.1.0.6 "RSS and DUL"
33107 .irow 127.1.0.7 "RSS and DUL and RBL"
33109 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
33110 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
33111 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
33113 Values returned by a properly running DBSBL should be in the 127.0.0.0/8
33114 range. If a DNSBL operator loses control of the domain, lookups on it
33115 may start returning other addresses. Because of this, Exim now ignores
33116 returned values outside the 127/8 region.
33119 .subsection "Variables set from DNS lists" SECID204
33120 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
33121 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
33122 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
33123 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
33124 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
33125 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
33126 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
33127 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
33128 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
33129 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
33130 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
33131 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
33132 cases, for example:
33134 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
33136 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
33137 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
33138 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
33139 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
33141 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
33143 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
33144 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
33146 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
33147 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
33148 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
33149 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
33150 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
33153 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
33154 &-- even if these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
33155 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
33157 deny hosts = !+local_networks
33158 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
33160 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
33165 .subsection "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" SECTaddmatcon
33166 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
33167 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
33168 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
33171 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
33173 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
33174 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
33175 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
33176 describes how multiple records are handled.
33178 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
33179 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
33180 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
33182 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
33184 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
33185 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
33186 first. For example:
33188 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
33189 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
33192 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
33193 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
33194 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
33195 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
33196 tested. For example:
33198 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
33200 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
33201 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
33202 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
33204 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
33206 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
33211 .subsection "Negated DNS matching conditions" SECID205
33212 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
33215 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
33217 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
33218 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
33220 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
33222 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
33223 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
33224 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
33225 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
33227 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
33228 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
33230 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
33231 previous example is precisely equivalent to
33233 deny dnslists = a.b.c
33234 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
33236 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
33237 Consider this example:
33239 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
33241 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
33244 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
33246 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
33248 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
33249 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
33250 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
33252 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
33254 Negation can also be used with a bitwise-and restriction.
33255 The dnslists condition with only be trus if a result is returned
33256 by the lookup which, anded with the restriction, is all zeroes.
33259 deny dnslists = zen.spamhaus.org!&0.255.255.0
33265 .subsection "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" SECThanmuldnsrec
33266 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
33267 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
33268 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
33269 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
33270 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
33272 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
33274 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
33275 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
33276 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
33277 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
33278 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
33279 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
33282 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
33283 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
33284 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
33286 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
33287 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
33290 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
33292 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
33293 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
33295 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
33297 for the condition to be true.
33300 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
33301 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
33303 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
33304 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
33306 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
33308 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
33309 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
33311 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
33312 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
33314 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
33316 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
33317 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
33319 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
33321 for the condition to be false.
33323 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
33324 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
33329 .subsection "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" SECTmordetinf
33330 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
33331 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
33332 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
33333 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
33334 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
33335 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
33336 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
33337 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
33340 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
33341 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
33342 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
33343 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
33344 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
33345 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
33346 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
33349 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
33350 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
33352 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
33353 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
33355 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
33356 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
33357 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
33358 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
33359 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
33360 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
33362 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
33363 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
33364 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
33367 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
33368 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
33369 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
33370 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
33372 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
33373 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
33374 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
33378 .subsection "DNS lists and IPv6" SECTmorednslistslast
33379 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
33380 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
33381 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
33382 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
33383 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
33385 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
33386 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
33388 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
33389 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
33390 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
33392 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
33394 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
33395 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
33397 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
33398 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
33400 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
33401 dnslists = some.list.example
33404 If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
33405 address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
33406 (DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
33408 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
33412 .section "Previously seen user and hosts" "SECTseen"
33413 .cindex "&%seen%& ACL condition"
33414 .cindex greylisting
33415 The &%seen%& ACL condition can be used to test whether a
33416 situation has been previously met.
33417 It uses a hints database to record a timestamp against a key.
33418 The syntax of the condition is:
33420 &`seen =`& <&'optional flag'&><&'time interval'&> &`/`& <&'options'&>
33425 defer seen = -5m / key=${sender_host_address}_$local_part@$domain
33427 in a RCPT ACL will implement simple greylisting.
33429 The parameters for the condition are
33430 a possible minus sign,
33432 then, slash-separated, a list of options.
33433 The interval is taken as an offset before the current time,
33434 and used for the test.
33435 If the interval is preceded by a minus sign then the condition returns
33436 whether a record is found which is before the test time.
33437 Otherwise, the condition returns whether one is found which is since the
33440 Options are read in order with later ones overriding earlier ones.
33442 The default key is &$sender_host_address$&.
33443 An explicit key can be set using a &%key=value%& option.
33445 If a &%readonly%& option is given then
33446 no record create or update is done.
33447 If a &%write%& option is given then
33448 a record create or update is always done.
33449 An update is done if the test is for &"since"&.
33450 If none of those hold and there was no existing record,
33451 a record is created.
33453 Creates and updates are marked with the current time.
33455 Finally, a &"before"& test which succeeds, and for which the record
33456 is old enough, will be refreshed with a timestamp of the test time.
33457 This can prevent tidying of the database from removing the entry.
33458 The interval for this is, by default, 10 days.
33459 An explicit interval can be set using a
33460 &%refresh=value%& option.
33462 Note that &"seen"& should be added to the list of hints databases
33463 for maintenance if this ACL condition is used.
33466 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
33467 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
33468 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
33469 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
33470 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
33471 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
33472 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
33473 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
33474 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
33475 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
33477 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
33479 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
33480 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
33482 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
33483 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
33484 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
33487 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
33488 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
33489 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
33490 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
33491 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
33492 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
33493 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
33494 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
33495 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
33497 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
33498 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
33499 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
33500 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
33502 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
33503 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
33504 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
33505 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
33506 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
33507 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
33508 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
33509 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
33510 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
33511 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
33513 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
33514 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
33515 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
33518 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
33519 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example, messages or recipients
33520 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
33521 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
33522 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
33523 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
33525 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
33526 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
33527 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
33528 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
33529 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
33530 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
33531 the &%count=%& option.
33534 .subsection "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" ratoptmea
33535 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
33538 .cindex "rate limiting" per_conn
33539 This option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
33540 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
33541 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
33544 .cindex "rate limiting" per_conn
33545 This option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
33546 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
33547 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
33548 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
33551 .cindex "rate limiting" per_conn
33552 This option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
33553 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
33554 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
33555 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
33556 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
33557 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
33558 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
33561 .cindex "rate limiting" per_rcpt
33562 This option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
33563 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
33564 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, or &%acl_smtp_data%& ACLs. In
33565 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
33566 ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
33567 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
33568 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
33571 .cindex "rate limiting" per_addr
33572 This option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
33573 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
33574 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
33575 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
33579 .cindex "rate limiting" per_cmd
33580 This option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
33581 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
33582 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
33583 multiple different commands.
33586 .cindex "rate limiting" count
33587 This option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
33589 A value is required, after an equals sign.
33590 For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
33591 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&.
33592 If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
33593 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
33594 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&).
33595 The count does not have to be an integer.
33598 .cindex "rate limiting" unique
33599 This option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
33603 .subsection "Ratelimit update modes" ratoptupd
33604 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
33605 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
33606 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
33607 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
33609 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
33610 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
33612 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
33613 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
33614 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
33615 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
33619 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
33620 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
33621 (max $sender_rate_limit)
33624 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
33625 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
33626 (max $sender_rate_limit)
33629 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
33630 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
33631 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
33632 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
33633 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
33634 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
33637 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
33638 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
33639 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
33640 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
33641 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
33644 .subsection "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" ratoptfast
33645 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
33646 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
33647 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
33648 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
33649 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
33652 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
33653 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
33654 client's average rate of successfully sent email,
33655 up to the given limit.
33656 This is appropriate if the countermeasure when the condition is true
33657 consists of refusing the message, and
33658 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
33659 If the action when true is anything more complex then this option is
33660 likely not what is wanted.
33662 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
33663 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
33664 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
33665 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
33666 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
33667 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
33668 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
33669 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
33671 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
33675 .subsection "Limiting the rate of different events" ratoptuniq
33676 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
33677 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
33678 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
33679 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
33680 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
33681 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
33682 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
33683 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
33685 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
33686 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
33687 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
33688 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
33689 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
33690 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
33692 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
33693 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
33696 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
33697 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
33698 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
33699 required increases with larger limits.
33701 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
33702 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
33703 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
33704 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
33705 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
33706 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
33707 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
33708 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
33709 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
33713 .subsection "Using rate limiting" useratlim
33714 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
33715 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
33716 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
33717 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
33718 message. For example:
33720 # Log all senders' rates
33721 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
33722 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
33724 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
33725 # at the decimal point.
33726 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
33727 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
33728 $sender_rate_limit }s
33730 # Keep authenticated users under control
33731 deny authenticated = *
33732 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
33734 # System-wide rate limit
33735 defer ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
33736 message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
33738 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
33739 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
33740 defer ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
33741 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
33742 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
33743 message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
33744 messages per $sender_rate_period
33746 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
33747 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
33748 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
33749 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
33750 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
33751 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
33752 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
33756 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
33757 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
33758 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
33759 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
33760 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
33761 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
33762 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
33763 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
33764 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
33766 verify = sender/callout
33767 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
33769 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
33770 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
33771 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
33772 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
33773 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
33774 The available options are as follows:
33777 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
33778 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
33779 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
33781 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
33782 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
33783 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
33784 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
33786 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
33787 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
33789 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
33790 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
33791 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
33792 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
33794 If the &%quota%& option is specified for recipient verify,
33795 successful routing to an appendfile transport is followed by a call into
33796 the transport to evaluate the quota status for the recipient.
33797 No actual delivery is done, but verification will succeed if the quota
33798 is sufficient for the message (if the sender gave a message size) or
33799 not already exceeded (otherwise).
33802 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
33803 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
33804 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
33805 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
33806 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
33807 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
33810 warn !verify = sender
33811 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
33813 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
33814 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
33815 verification failure.
33816 This variable is cleared at the end of processing the ACL verb.
33818 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
33819 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
33822 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
33823 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
33825 &%route%&: Routing failed.
33827 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
33828 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
33829 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
33831 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
33833 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
33835 &%quota%&: The quota check for a local recipient did non pass.
33838 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
33839 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
33841 The above variables may also be set after a &*successful*&
33842 address verification to:
33845 &%random%&: A random local-part callout succeeded
33851 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
33852 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
33853 .cindex "callout" "verification"
33854 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
33855 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
33856 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
33857 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
33858 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
33859 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
33860 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
33861 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
33862 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
33865 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
33866 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
33867 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
33868 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
33869 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
33870 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
33872 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
33873 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
33874 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
33875 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
33876 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
33878 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
33879 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
33880 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
33881 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
33882 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
33883 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
33884 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
33885 supplies a host list.
33886 Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
33888 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
33889 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
33890 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
33891 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
33892 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
33893 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
33894 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
33896 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
33897 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
33898 following SMTP commands are sent:
33900 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
33902 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
33905 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
33908 The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
33911 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
33912 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
33913 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
33914 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
33915 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
33916 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
33918 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
33919 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
33920 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
33921 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
33922 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
33924 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
33925 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
33926 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
33927 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
33928 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
33930 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
33931 .cindex "de-tainting" "using recipient verify"
33932 A recipient callout which gets a 2&'xx'& code
33933 will assign untainted values to the
33934 &$domain_data$& and &$local_part_data$& variables,
33935 corresponding to the domain and local parts of the recipient address.
33940 .subsection "Additional parameters for callouts" CALLaddparcall
33941 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
33942 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
33943 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
33945 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
33947 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
33948 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
33949 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
33953 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
33954 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
33955 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
33958 verify = sender/callout=5s
33960 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
33961 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
33962 the &%connect%& parameter.
33965 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
33966 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
33967 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
33968 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
33970 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
33972 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
33974 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
33975 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
33976 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
33977 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
33978 updated in this circumstance.
33980 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
33981 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
33982 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
33983 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
33984 accordance with the specification in RFC 2821. The RFC states that the
33985 unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
33988 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
33989 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
33990 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
33991 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
33992 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
33993 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
33994 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
33995 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
33996 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
33997 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
33999 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
34001 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
34004 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
34005 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
34006 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
34009 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
34011 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
34012 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
34013 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
34014 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
34015 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
34018 .vitem &*no_cache*&
34019 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
34020 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
34021 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
34023 .vitem &*postmaster*&
34024 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
34025 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
34026 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
34027 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
34028 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
34029 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
34030 made, until the cache record expires.
34032 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
34033 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
34034 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
34037 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
34039 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
34040 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
34042 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
34044 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
34045 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
34046 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
34047 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
34051 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
34052 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
34053 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
34054 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
34055 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
34057 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
34059 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
34060 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
34061 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
34062 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
34063 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
34065 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
34066 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
34067 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
34069 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
34071 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
34072 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
34073 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
34074 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
34075 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
34077 .vitem &*use_sender*&
34078 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
34080 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
34082 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
34083 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
34084 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
34085 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
34086 usefulness of callout caching.
34089 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
34091 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender,hold
34093 It causes the connection to be held open and used for any further recipients
34094 and for eventual delivery (should that be done quickly).
34095 Doing this saves on TCP and SMTP startup costs, and TLS costs also
34096 when that is used for the connections.
34097 The advantage is only gained if there are no callout cache hits
34098 (which could be enforced by the no_cache option),
34099 if the use_sender option is used,
34100 if neither the random nor the use_postmaster option is used,
34101 and if no other callouts intervene.
34104 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
34105 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
34106 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
34107 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
34108 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
34109 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
34110 these circumstances.
34112 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
34113 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
34114 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
34115 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
34116 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
34117 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
34118 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
34120 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
34121 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
34122 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
34123 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
34128 .subsection "Callout caching" SECTcallvercache
34129 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
34130 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
34131 .cindex "caching" "callout"
34132 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
34133 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
34134 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
34135 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
34136 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
34137 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
34139 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
34140 the failure. However, for subsequent failures that use the cache data, this message
34143 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
34144 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
34145 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
34147 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
34148 commands up to and including
34152 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
34153 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
34154 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
34155 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
34156 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
34157 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
34158 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
34160 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
34161 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
34162 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
34163 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
34164 will eventually be noticed.
34166 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
34167 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
34168 behaviour will be the same.
34172 .section "Quota caching" "SECTquotacache"
34173 .cindex "hints database" "quota cache"
34174 .cindex "quota" "cache, description of"
34175 .cindex "caching" "quota"
34176 Exim caches the results of quota verification
34177 in order to reduce the amount of resources used.
34178 The &"callout"& hints database is used.
34180 The default cache periods are five minutes for a positive (good) result
34181 and one hour for a negative result.
34182 To change the periods the &%quota%& option can be followed by an equals sign
34183 and a number of optional paramemters, separated by commas.
34186 verify = recipient/quota=cachepos=1h,cacheneg=1d
34188 Possible parameters are:
34190 .vitem &*cachepos&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
34191 .cindex "quota cache" "positive entry expiry, specifying"
34192 Set the lifetime for a positive cache entry.
34193 A value of zero seconds is legitimate.
34195 .vitem &*cacheneg&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
34196 .cindex "quota cache" "negative entry expiry, specifying"
34197 As above, for a negative entry.
34199 .vitem &*no_cache*&
34200 Set both positive and negative lifetimes to zero.
34202 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
34203 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
34204 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
34205 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
34206 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
34207 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
34210 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
34212 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
34213 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
34214 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
34215 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
34216 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
34217 550 Sender verification failed
34219 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
34220 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
34221 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
34222 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
34225 verify = sender/no_details
34228 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
34229 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
34230 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
34231 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
34232 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
34233 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
34234 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
34237 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
34238 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
34239 verification also fails.
34241 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
34242 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
34245 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
34246 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
34247 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
34250 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
34252 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
34253 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
34254 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
34255 verification to succeed.
34257 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
34258 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
34259 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
34260 option. For example:
34262 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
34264 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
34265 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
34267 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
34268 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
34269 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
34270 address and a report is output for each of them.
34274 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
34275 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
34276 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
34277 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
34278 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
34279 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
34280 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
34284 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
34285 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
34286 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
34287 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
34288 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
34289 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
34291 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
34292 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
34293 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
34294 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
34297 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
34299 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
34301 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
34302 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
34304 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
34305 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
34308 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
34309 use for the DNS query. The default is:
34311 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
34313 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
34314 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
34315 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
34316 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
34319 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
34321 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
34322 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
34323 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
34325 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
34326 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
34327 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
34328 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
34329 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
34330 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
34331 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
34332 of legitimate HELO domains.
34334 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
34335 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
34336 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
34337 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
34340 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
34342 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
34343 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
34344 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
34349 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
34350 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
34351 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
34352 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
34353 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
34354 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
34355 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
34356 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
34358 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
34359 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
34360 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
34361 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
34362 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
34363 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
34364 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
34365 The validity period on signed addresses is seven days.
34367 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
34368 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
34371 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
34372 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
34375 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
34376 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
34379 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
34381 recipients = +batv_senders
34382 message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
34384 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
34386 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
34387 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
34388 !condition = $prvscheck_result
34389 message = Invalid reverse path signature.
34391 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
34392 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
34393 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
34394 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
34395 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
34397 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
34398 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
34399 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
34400 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
34401 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
34402 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
34403 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
34405 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
34406 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
34407 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
34408 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
34412 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
34414 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
34415 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
34416 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
34419 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
34422 external_smtp_batv:
34424 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
34425 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
34426 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
34427 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
34430 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
34434 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
34435 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
34436 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
34437 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
34438 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
34439 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
34440 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
34441 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
34442 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
34443 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
34445 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
34446 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
34447 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
34448 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
34449 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
34450 same host is fulfilling both functions,
34452 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
34454 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
34455 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
34456 system to arbitrary domains.
34459 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
34460 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
34461 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
34462 example, suppose you want to do the following:
34465 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
34466 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
34467 &'my.dom2.example'&.
34469 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
34470 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
34472 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
34473 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
34477 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
34479 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
34480 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
34481 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
34483 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
34487 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
34488 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
34490 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
34491 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
34492 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
34493 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
34494 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
34495 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
34496 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
34500 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
34501 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
34502 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
34503 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
34504 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
34509 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34510 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34512 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
34513 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
34514 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
34515 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
34516 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
34517 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
34520 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
34521 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
34522 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
34523 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
34524 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
34526 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
34527 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
34528 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
34531 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
34532 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
34534 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
34535 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
34536 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
34538 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
34539 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
34541 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
34544 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
34547 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
34548 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
34549 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
34550 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
34551 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
34552 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
34554 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
34555 temporarily created in a file called:
34557 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
34559 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
34560 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
34561 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
34562 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
34563 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
34565 control = no_mbox_unspool
34567 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
34568 same directory by default.
34572 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
34573 .cindex "virus scanning"
34574 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
34575 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
34576 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
34577 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
34578 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
34579 in memory and thus are much faster.
34581 Since message data needs to have arrived,
34582 the condition may be only called in ACL defined by
34584 &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
34585 &%acl_smtp_mime%& or
34588 A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
34589 if it expires then a defer action is taken.
34591 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
34592 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
34593 to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
34594 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
34596 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
34598 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
34600 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
34602 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
34604 The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
34605 The following scanner types are supported in this release,
34606 though individual ones can be included or not at build time:
34610 .cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
34611 This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
34612 Security (currently at version 2.2.0).
34613 You can get a trial version at &url(https://www.avast.com) or for Linux
34614 at &url(https://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
34615 This scanner type takes one option,
34616 which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
34617 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
34618 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
34619 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
34620 A list of options may follow. These options are interpreted on the
34621 Exim's side of the malware scanner, or are given on separate lines to
34622 the daemon as options before the main scan command.
34624 .cindex &`pass_unscanned`& "avast"
34625 If &`pass_unscanned`&
34626 is set, any files the Avast scanner can't scan (e.g.
34627 decompression bombs, or invalid archives) are considered clean. Use with
34632 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
34633 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:pass_unscanned:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
34634 av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
34636 If you omit the argument, the default path
34637 &_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
34639 If you use a remote host,
34640 you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
34641 as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
34642 For information about available commands and their options you may use
34644 $ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
34650 If the scanner returns a temporary failure (e.g. license issues, or
34651 permission problems), the message is deferred and a paniclog entry is
34652 written. The usual &`defer_ok`& option is available.
34654 .vitem &%aveserver%&
34655 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
34656 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
34657 at &url(https://www.kaspersky.com/). This scanner type takes one option,
34658 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
34661 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
34666 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
34667 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
34668 &url(https://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
34669 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
34670 in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
34672 The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
34673 a UNIX socket specification,
34674 a TCP socket specification,
34675 or a (global) option.
34677 A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
34678 For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
34679 for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
34680 and the second a port number,
34681 Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
34682 These per-server options are supported:
34684 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
34687 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
34688 a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
34690 If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
34694 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
34695 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
34696 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
34697 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
34698 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
34700 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
34702 option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
34703 to be scanned, which should normally result in less I/O happening and be
34704 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
34705 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
34707 The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
34708 randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
34709 that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
34710 socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
34711 unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
34712 When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
34713 not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
34714 selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
34715 email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
34717 2013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
34718 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
34719 (Connection refused)
34722 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
34723 contributing the code for this scanner.
34726 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
34727 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
34728 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
34729 type takes 3 mandatory options:
34732 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
34733 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
34736 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
34737 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
34738 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
34739 the &"trigger"& expression.
34742 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
34743 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
34744 &"name"& expression.
34747 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
34749 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
34751 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
34752 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
34753 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
34754 configuration setting:
34756 av_scanner = cmdline:\
34757 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
34758 found in file:'(.+)'
34761 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
34762 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(https://www.sald.ru/)) interface
34764 either a full path to a UNIX socket,
34765 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
34766 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
34767 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
34770 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
34771 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
34773 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
34774 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
34777 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
34778 The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
34779 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
34783 av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
34785 If you omit the argument, the default values shown above are used.
34787 .vitem &%f-prot6d%&
34788 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-prot6d"
34789 The f-prot6d scanner is accessed using the FPSCAND protocol over TCP.
34790 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number.
34793 av_scanner = f-prot6d:localhost 10200
34795 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
34798 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
34799 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(https://www.f-secure.com/)) takes one
34800 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
34802 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
34804 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
34805 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
34807 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
34808 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
34809 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
34810 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
34811 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
34814 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
34816 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
34819 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
34820 This was a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users,
34821 though some documentation was available in English.
34822 The history can be shown at &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Mks_vir)
34823 and this appears to be a candidate for removal from Exim, unless
34824 we are informed of other virus scanners which use the same protocol
34826 The only option for this scanner type is
34827 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
34828 provided that mksd has
34829 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
34831 av_scanner = mksd:2
34833 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
34836 .cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
34837 This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
34838 running on the local machine.
34839 There are four options:
34840 an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
34841 a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
34842 the path to the mail file to be scanned),
34843 an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
34844 and an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
34847 av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)$
34849 Note that surrounding whitespace is stripped from each option, meaning
34850 there is no way to specify a trailing newline.
34851 The socket specifier and both regular-expressions are required.
34852 Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_& (note this does have a trailing newline);
34853 specify an empty element to get this.
34856 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
34857 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
34858 You can get Sophie at &url(http://sophie.sourceforge.net/). The only option
34859 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
34860 client communication. For example:
34862 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
34864 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
34868 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
34869 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
34872 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
34873 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
34874 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
34875 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
34876 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
34877 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
34880 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
34881 use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
34882 The first element can then be one of
34885 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
34886 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
34889 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
34890 the condition fails immediately.
34892 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
34893 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
34894 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
34895 Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
34896 unless the separator is changed (in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
34899 You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
34900 messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
34901 Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
34903 You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
34904 specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
34907 malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
34909 A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
34911 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
34912 When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
34913 is set to record the actual address used.
34915 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
34916 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
34917 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
34918 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
34921 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
34922 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
34924 Here is a very simple scanning example:
34927 message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
34929 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
34931 deny malware = */defer_ok
34932 message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
34934 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
34935 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
34937 av_scanner = $acl_m0
34939 in the main Exim configuration.
34941 deny set acl_m0 = sophie
34943 message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
34945 deny set acl_m0 = aveserver
34947 message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
34951 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
34952 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
34953 .cindex "spam scanning"
34954 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
34956 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
34957 score and a report for the message.
34958 Support is also provided for Rspamd.
34960 For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
34961 Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
34962 &url(https://spamassassin.apache.org/) and &url(https://www.rspamd.com/)
34964 SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
34966 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
34968 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
34969 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
34972 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
34973 By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
34974 intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
34975 &%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
34976 you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
34977 configuration as follows (example):
34979 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 783
34981 The SpamAssassin protocol relies on a TCP half-close from the client.
34982 If your SpamAssassin client side is running a Linux system with an
34983 iptables firewall, consider setting
34984 &%net.netfilter.nf_conntrack_tcp_timeout_close_wait%& to at least the
34985 timeout, Exim uses when waiting for a response from the SpamAssassin
34986 server (currently defaulting to 120s). With a lower value the Linux
34987 connection tracking may consider your half-closed connection as dead too
34991 To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
34993 you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
34995 spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
34998 As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
34999 sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
35000 filename instead of an address/port pair:
35002 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
35004 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
35005 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
35006 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
35007 option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&):
35009 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
35010 192.168.2.11 783 : \
35013 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
35014 When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
35015 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
35018 Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
35019 Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
35020 and changeable in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&);
35021 take care to not double the separator.
35023 For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
35024 subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
35025 and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
35026 In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
35028 Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
35030 The supported options are:
35032 pri=<priority> Selection priority
35033 weight=<value> Selection bias
35034 time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
35035 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
35036 tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
35037 variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
35040 The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
35041 higher values being tried first.
35042 The default priority is 1.
35044 The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
35045 Within a priority set
35046 servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
35047 The default value for selection bias is 1.
35049 Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
35050 in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
35051 Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
35052 characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
35054 Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
35055 are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
35057 The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
35058 The default value is two minutes.
35060 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
35061 a failed connect is made.
35062 The default is to not retry.
35064 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
35065 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
35066 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
35069 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
35070 When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
35071 is set to record the actual address used.
35073 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
35074 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
35077 message = This message was classified as SPAM
35079 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
35080 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
35081 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
35082 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
35083 Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
35086 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
35087 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
35088 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
35089 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
35090 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
35092 Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
35093 (e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
35095 or the use of PRDR,
35096 .cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
35097 are needed to use this feature.
35099 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
35100 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
35101 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
35104 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
35105 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
35106 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
35109 deny condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
35111 message = This message was classified as SPAM
35114 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
35115 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
35116 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
35117 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
35119 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
35120 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
35122 Except for &$spam_report$&,
35123 these variables are saved with the received message so are
35124 available for use at delivery time.
35127 .vitem &$spam_score$&
35128 The spam score of the message, for example, &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
35129 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
35131 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
35132 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
35133 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
35134 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
35135 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
35137 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
35138 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
35139 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
35140 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
35141 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
35142 spam bar is 50 characters.
35144 .vitem &$spam_report$&
35145 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
35146 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
35147 This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
35148 Beware that SpamAssassin may return non-ASCII characters, especially
35149 when running in country-specific locales, which are not legal
35150 unencoded in headers.
35152 .vitem &$spam_action$&
35153 For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
35154 spam score versus threshold.
35155 For Rspamd, the recommended action.
35159 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
35160 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
35161 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
35163 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
35164 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
35165 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
35166 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
35167 spam condition, like this:
35169 deny spam = joe/defer_ok
35170 message = This message was classified as SPAM
35172 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
35174 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
35177 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
35178 warn spam = nobody:true
35179 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
35180 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
35182 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
35183 # is over threshold
35185 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
35187 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
35188 deny spam = nobody:true
35189 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
35190 message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
35195 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
35196 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
35197 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
35198 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
35199 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
35200 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
35201 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
35202 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
35203 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
35204 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
35207 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
35208 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
35209 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
35210 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
35211 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
35212 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
35213 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
35215 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
35216 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
35217 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
35218 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
35219 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
35221 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
35222 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
35223 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
35224 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
35225 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
35228 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
35230 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
35234 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
35236 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
35237 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
35238 a sequential filename consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
35239 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
35241 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
35242 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
35243 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
35244 the full path and filename.
35246 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
35247 filename, and the default path is then used.
35249 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
35250 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages.
35251 The variable &$mime_filename$& will have the suggested name for the file.
35252 Note however that this might contain anything, and is very difficult
35253 to safely use as all or even part of the filename.
35254 If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
35255 automatically unlinked.
35257 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
35258 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
35259 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
35260 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
35261 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
35263 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
35264 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
35265 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
35267 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
35268 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
35269 available in the MIME ACL:
35272 .vitem &$mime_anomaly_level$& &&&
35273 &$mime_anomaly_text$&
35274 .vindex &$mime_anomaly_level$&
35275 .vindex &$mime_anomaly_text$&
35276 If there are problems decoding, these variables contain information on
35277 the detected issue.
35279 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
35280 .vindex &$mime_boundary$&
35281 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$& below), it should
35282 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
35283 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
35284 contains the empty string.
35286 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
35287 .vindex &$mime_charset$&
35288 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
35289 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
35295 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
35296 case-insensitively.
35298 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
35299 .vindex &$mime_content_description$&
35300 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
35301 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
35302 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
35303 only used for display purposes.
35305 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
35306 .vindex &$mime_content_disposition$&
35307 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
35308 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
35310 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
35311 .vindex &$mime_content_id$&
35312 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
35313 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
35315 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
35316 .vindex &$mime_content_size$&
35317 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
35318 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
35319 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
35320 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
35322 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
35323 .vindex &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
35324 This variable contains the normalized content of the
35325 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
35326 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
35328 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
35329 .vindex &$mime_content_type$&
35330 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
35331 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
35332 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
35336 application/octet-stream
35340 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
35343 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
35344 .vindex &$mime_decoded_filename$&
35345 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
35346 successfully run. It contains the full path and filename of the file
35347 containing the decoded data.
35352 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
35353 .vindex &$mime_filename$&
35354 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
35355 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
35356 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
35359 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
35361 found, this variable contains the empty string.
35363 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
35364 .vindex &$mime_is_coverletter$&
35365 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
35366 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
35367 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
35369 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
35370 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
35374 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
35377 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
35378 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
35381 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
35382 and the rest are attachments.
35385 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
35388 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
35389 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
35390 coverletter mail attached to non-HTML coverletter mail will also be allowed:
35392 deny !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
35393 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
35394 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
35395 message = HTML mail is not accepted here
35398 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
35399 .vindex &$mime_is_multipart$&
35400 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
35401 &"multipart"&, for example, &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
35402 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
35403 want to carry out specific actions on them.
35405 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
35406 .vindex &$mime_is_rfc822$&
35407 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
35408 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
35409 decoding is fully recursive.
35411 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
35412 .vindex &$mime_part_count$&
35413 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
35414 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
35415 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
35416 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
35417 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
35418 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
35423 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
35424 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
35425 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
35426 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
35427 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
35429 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
35430 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
35431 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
35432 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
35433 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
35435 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
35436 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
35437 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
35438 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
35439 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
35440 32K characters are checked.
35442 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
35443 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
35444 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
35445 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
35446 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
35448 deny regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
35449 message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
35451 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
35452 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
35453 matching regular expression.
35454 The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
35455 are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
35457 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
35465 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35466 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35468 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
35469 "Local scan function"
35470 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
35471 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
35472 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
35473 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
35474 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
35476 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
35477 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
35478 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
35479 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
35480 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
35482 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
35483 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
35484 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
35485 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
35487 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
35488 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
35489 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
35490 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
35492 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
35493 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
35494 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
35495 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
35496 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
35497 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
35498 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
35499 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
35500 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
35504 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
35505 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
35506 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
35507 function is before building Exim, by setting
35508 both HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN and
35509 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
35510 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
35511 directory, so you might set
35513 HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN=yes
35514 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
35516 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&;
35517 the source file(s) for it should first #define LOCAL_SCAN
35518 and then #include "local_scan.h".
35520 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
35521 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
35522 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
35523 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
35524 _src/local_scan.c_.
35526 If you want to make use of Exim's runtime configuration file to set options
35527 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
35529 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
35531 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
35536 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
35537 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
35538 .cindex &%dlfunc%& "API description"
35539 You must include this line near the start of your code:
35542 #include "local_scan.h"
35544 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
35545 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
35546 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
35547 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
35548 It also makes available the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
35549 strings and pointers to character strings:
35551 #define CS (char *)
35552 #define CCS (const char *)
35553 #define CSS (char **)
35554 #define US (unsigned char *)
35555 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
35556 #define USS (unsigned char **)
35558 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
35560 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
35562 The arguments are as follows:
35565 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
35566 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
35567 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
35569 The descriptor is positioned at character 26 of the file, which is the first
35570 character of the body itself, because the first 26 characters (19 characters
35571 before Exim 4.97) are the message id followed by &`-D`& and a newline.
35572 If you rewind the file, you should use the
35573 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
35574 case this changes in some future version.
35576 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
35577 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
35580 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
35583 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
35584 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
35585 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
35586 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
35587 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
35588 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
35590 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
35591 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
35592 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
35594 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
35595 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
35596 queued without immediate delivery.
35598 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
35599 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
35600 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
35601 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
35602 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
35605 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
35606 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
35607 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
35610 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
35611 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
35612 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
35613 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
35614 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
35615 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
35616 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
35618 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
35619 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
35620 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
35623 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
35624 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
35625 &%-oe%& command line options.
35629 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
35630 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
35631 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
35632 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
35633 want to do this, you must have the line
35635 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
35637 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
35638 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
35639 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
35642 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
35643 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
35644 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
35645 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
35646 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
35647 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
35649 static int my_integer_option = 42;
35650 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
35652 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
35653 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
35654 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
35657 int local_scan_options_count =
35658 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
35660 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
35661 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
35665 my_string = some string of text...
35667 The available types of option data are as follows:
35670 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
35671 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
35672 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
35673 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
35674 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
35675 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
35678 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
35679 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
35680 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
35681 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
35684 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
35685 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
35688 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
35689 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
35690 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
35691 printed with the suffix K or M.
35693 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
35694 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
35695 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
35696 always output in octal.
35698 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
35699 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
35700 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
35702 .vitem &*opt_time*&
35703 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
35704 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
35707 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
35708 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
35712 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
35713 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
35714 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
35715 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
35716 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
35717 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
35718 C variables are as follows:
35721 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
35722 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
35723 It is not valid if the &%spool_wireformat%& option is used.
35725 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
35726 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
35727 It is not valid if the &%spool_wireformat%& option is used.
35729 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
35730 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
35731 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
35732 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
35735 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
35736 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
35737 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
35740 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
35741 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
35745 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
35746 selected, you should use code like this:
35748 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
35749 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
35751 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
35752 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
35753 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
35755 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
35756 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
35759 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
35760 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
35762 .vitem &*const&~uschar&~*headers_charset*&
35763 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
35765 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
35766 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
35767 &%-bh%& command line option.
35769 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
35770 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
35771 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
35773 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
35774 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
35775 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
35776 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
35778 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
35779 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
35780 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
35782 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
35783 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
35785 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
35786 The number of accepted recipients.
35788 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
35789 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
35790 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
35791 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
35792 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
35793 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
35794 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
35795 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
35796 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
35797 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
35798 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
35799 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
35801 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
35802 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
35804 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
35805 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
35806 locally-submitted messages.
35808 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
35809 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
35810 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
35812 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
35813 The name of the sending host, if known.
35815 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
35816 The port on the sending host.
35818 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
35819 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
35821 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
35822 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
35824 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
35825 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
35826 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
35830 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
35831 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
35832 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
35833 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
35838 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
35839 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
35841 .vitem &*int&~type*&
35842 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
35843 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
35844 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
35845 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
35846 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
35847 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
35849 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
35850 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
35853 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
35854 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
35855 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
35860 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
35861 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
35864 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
35865 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
35867 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
35868 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
35869 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
35870 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
35872 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
35873 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
35874 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
35875 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
35876 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
35877 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
35878 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
35879 is NULL for all recipients.
35884 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
35885 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
35886 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
35887 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
35891 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
35892 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
35894 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
35895 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
35896 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
35897 for the process in &%newumask%&.
35899 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
35900 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
35901 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
35902 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
35903 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
35905 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
35907 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
35908 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
35909 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
35910 return value is as follows:
35915 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
35921 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
35927 The process timed out.
35931 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
35934 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
35935 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
35936 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
35937 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
35938 forks a subprocess that is running
35940 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
35942 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
35943 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
35944 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
35945 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
35947 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
35948 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
35949 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
35950 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
35953 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
35954 *sender_authentication)*&
35955 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
35958 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
35960 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
35963 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
35964 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'(printf()'&. The
35965 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
35966 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
35967 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
35969 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
35970 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
35973 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
35974 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
35975 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
35976 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
35977 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
35978 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
35979 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
35980 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
35982 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
35983 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
35984 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
35985 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
35986 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
35987 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
35989 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
35990 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
35991 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
35992 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
35994 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
35995 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
35996 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
35997 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
35998 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
35999 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
36000 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
36001 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
36002 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
36003 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
36005 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
36006 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
36008 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
36009 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
36012 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
36013 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
36014 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
36015 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
36016 match the specification, the function does nothing.
36019 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
36020 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
36021 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
36022 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
36023 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
36024 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
36026 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
36028 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
36029 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
36030 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
36031 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
36032 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
36035 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
36036 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
36037 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
36038 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
36039 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
36040 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
36041 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
36042 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
36044 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
36045 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
36046 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
36047 .itable none 0 0 2 15* left 85* left
36048 .irow &`OK`& "match succeeded"
36049 .irow &`FAIL`& "match failed"
36050 .irow &`DEFER`& "match deferred"
36052 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
36053 inability to contact a database.
36055 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
36057 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
36058 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
36059 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
36061 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
36063 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
36064 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
36065 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
36067 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
36069 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
36072 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
36074 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
36075 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
36076 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
36077 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
36078 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
36079 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
36082 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
36084 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
36085 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
36086 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
36087 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
36088 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
36089 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
36092 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
36093 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
36094 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
36095 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
36097 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
36098 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
36099 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
36100 value afterwards. For example:
36102 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
36103 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
36104 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
36107 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
36108 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
36109 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
36110 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
36117 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
36118 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
36119 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to RFC 2047. Typically
36120 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
36121 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
36122 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
36123 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
36124 binary string is returned with an error message.
36126 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
36127 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
36128 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
36130 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
36131 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
36132 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
36133 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
36134 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
36136 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
36137 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
36138 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
36140 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
36141 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
36142 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
36143 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
36147 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
36148 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
36151 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,BOOL,&~...)*&
36152 The arguments of this function are almost like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
36153 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
36154 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
36155 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
36156 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
36157 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
36158 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
36161 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
36162 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
36164 The second argument is used to request that the data be buffered
36165 (when TRUE) or flushed (along with any previously buffered, when FALSE).
36166 This is advisory only, but likely to save on system-calls and packets
36167 sent when a sequence of calls to the function are made.
36169 The argument was added in Exim version 4.90 - changing the API/ABI.
36170 Nobody noticed until 4.93 was imminent, at which point the
36171 ABI version number was incremented.
36173 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
36174 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
36175 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
36176 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
36177 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
36178 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
36179 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
36181 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
36182 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
36184 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
36185 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
36186 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
36187 multiple output lines.
36189 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
36191 guarantee a flush of
36192 pending output, and therefore does not test
36193 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
36194 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
36195 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
36196 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
36197 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
36200 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int,BOOL)*&
36201 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
36202 chunk of memory whose size is given by the first argument.
36203 The second argument should be given as TRUE if the memory will be used for
36204 data possibly coming from an attacker (eg. the message content),
36205 FALSE if it is locally-sourced.
36206 Exim bombs out if it ever
36207 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
36209 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int,BOOL)*&
36210 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
36211 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
36213 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
36216 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
36219 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
36220 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
36221 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
36222 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
36223 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
36224 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
36230 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
36231 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
36232 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
36233 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
36234 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
36235 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
36236 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
36239 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
36240 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
36241 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
36242 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
36244 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
36245 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
36247 store_pool = POOL_PERM
36249 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
36250 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
36251 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
36252 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
36254 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
36255 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
36256 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
36257 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
36264 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36265 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36267 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
36268 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
36269 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
36270 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
36271 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
36272 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
36273 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
36274 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
36276 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
36277 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
36278 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
36279 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
36280 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
36282 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
36283 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
36284 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
36285 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
36286 .cindex retry condition
36287 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
36288 prevent it happening on retries.
36290 .vindex "&$domain$&"
36291 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
36292 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
36293 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
36294 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
36295 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
36296 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
36297 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
36300 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
36301 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
36302 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
36303 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
36304 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
36305 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
36306 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
36308 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
36309 system_filter_user = exim
36311 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
36312 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
36313 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
36314 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
36315 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
36316 by the &%reply%& command.
36319 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
36320 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
36321 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
36322 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
36324 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
36325 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
36329 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
36330 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
36331 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
36332 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
36333 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
36334 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
36337 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
36338 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
36339 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
36340 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
36341 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
36342 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
36343 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
36345 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
36346 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
36347 succeed, it will not be tried again.
36348 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
36349 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
36351 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
36352 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
36353 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
36354 to which users' filter files can refer.
36358 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
36359 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
36360 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
36361 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
36362 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
36366 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
36367 .cindex "freezing messages"
36368 .cindex "message" "freezing"
36369 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
36370 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
36371 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
36372 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
36373 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
36374 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
36375 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
36376 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
36377 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
36379 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
36381 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
36383 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
36384 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
36385 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
36386 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
36387 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
36390 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
36391 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
36392 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
36393 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
36395 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
36396 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
36397 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
36398 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
36399 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
36400 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
36401 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
36402 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
36403 message. For example:
36405 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
36406 because it contains attachments that we are \
36407 not prepared to receive."
36410 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
36411 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
36412 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
36413 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
36414 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
36415 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
36418 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
36419 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
36421 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
36422 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
36423 generated by the filter.
36425 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
36427 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
36428 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
36434 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
36435 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
36440 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
36441 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
36442 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
36443 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
36444 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
36446 headers add <string>
36447 headers remove <string>
36449 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
36450 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
36451 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to RFC 2822 syntax. Leading white
36452 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
36453 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
36455 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
36456 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
36457 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
36460 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
36461 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
36464 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
36465 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
36466 space after input continuations is ignored.
36468 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
36469 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
36470 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
36471 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
36472 header with the same name, they are all removed.
36474 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
36475 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
36476 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
36477 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
36478 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
36479 used for all recipients of the message.
36481 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
36482 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
36483 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
36484 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
36485 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
36486 until the message is actually being written (see section
36487 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
36489 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
36490 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
36491 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
36492 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
36493 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
36494 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
36495 modified more than once.
36497 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
36498 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
36501 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
36502 headers remove "Subject"
36503 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
36504 headers remove "Old-Subject"
36509 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
36510 .cindex "envelope from"
36511 .cindex "envelope sender"
36512 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
36514 errors_to <some address>
36516 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
36517 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
36518 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
36521 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
36523 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
36524 address if its delivery failed.
36528 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
36529 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
36530 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
36531 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
36532 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
36533 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
36534 such as &$local_part_data$& and &$domain_data$& can be used,
36535 and indeed, the choice of filter file could be made dependent on them.
36536 This is an example of a router which implements such a filter:
36541 domains = +local_domains
36542 file = /central/filters/$local_part_data
36547 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
36548 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
36549 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
36550 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
36552 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
36553 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
36554 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
36555 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
36557 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
36558 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
36559 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
36566 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36567 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36569 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
36570 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
36571 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
36572 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
36573 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
36574 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
36575 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
36576 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
36578 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
36579 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
36580 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
36581 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
36582 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
36584 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
36585 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
36586 loopback interface specially in any way.
36588 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
36589 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
36594 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
36595 .cindex "message" "submission"
36596 .cindex "submission mode"
36597 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
36598 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
36599 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
36600 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
36602 control = submission
36604 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
36605 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
36606 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
36607 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
36608 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
36609 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
36611 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
36612 control = submission
36614 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
36615 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
36616 is used to separate options. For example:
36618 control = submission/sender_retain
36620 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
36621 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
36622 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
36623 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
36624 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
36625 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
36626 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
36628 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
36629 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
36632 control = submission/domain=some.domain
36634 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
36635 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
36636 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
36637 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
36639 accept authenticated = *
36640 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
36641 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
36642 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
36644 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
36645 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
36646 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
36648 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
36650 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
36653 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
36655 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
36656 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
36657 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
36658 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
36660 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
36661 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
36662 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
36663 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
36664 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
36665 spoof another's address.
36667 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
36668 .cindex "line endings"
36669 .cindex "carriage return"
36671 RFC 2821 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
36672 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
36673 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
36674 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
36675 use CRLF or just CR.
36677 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
36678 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
36679 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
36680 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
36681 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
36682 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
36683 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
36684 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
36688 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
36691 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
36692 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
36695 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
36696 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
36697 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
36698 people trying to play silly games.
36700 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
36701 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
36702 line and a bare LF in a body line is replaced with a space.
36704 If the first header line received in a message does not end with CRLF, a subsequent
36705 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
36712 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
36713 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
36714 .cindex "address" "qualification"
36715 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
36716 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
36717 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
36718 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
36719 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
36721 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
36722 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
36723 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
36724 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
36725 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
36727 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
36728 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
36729 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
36730 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
36731 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
36732 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
36733 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
36734 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
36739 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
36740 .cindex "&""From""& line"
36741 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
36742 .cindex "sender" "address"
36743 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
36744 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
36745 .cindex "envelope from"
36746 .cindex "envelope sender"
36747 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
36748 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
36749 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
36750 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
36752 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
36753 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
36755 This line precedes the RFC 2822 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
36756 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
36757 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
36758 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
36759 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
36760 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
36761 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
36762 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
36763 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
36765 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
36766 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
36767 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
36768 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
36769 then parsed as an RFC 2822 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
36770 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
36771 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
36773 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
36774 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
36775 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
36777 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
36778 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
36779 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
36780 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
36784 .section "Header lines"
36785 .subsection "Resent- header lines" SECID220
36787 RFC 2822 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
36788 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
36789 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
36790 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
36791 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
36794 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
36795 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
36798 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
36799 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
36803 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
36804 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
36806 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
36807 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
36808 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
36810 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
36813 For a locally-submitted message,
36814 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
36815 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
36816 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
36817 included in log lines in this case.
36819 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
36820 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
36826 .subsection Auto-Submitted: SECID221
36827 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
36828 includes the header line:
36830 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
36833 .subsection Bcc: SECID222
36834 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
36835 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
36836 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
36837 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
36838 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
36841 .subsection Date: SECID223
36843 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
36844 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
36845 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
36847 .subsection Delivery-date: SECID224
36848 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
36849 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
36850 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header
36851 set. Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
36852 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
36853 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
36854 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
36858 .subsection Envelope-to: SECID225
36859 .chindex Envelope-to:
36860 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
36861 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard RFC 2822 header set.
36862 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
36863 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
36864 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
36865 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
36869 .subsection From: SECTthefrohea
36871 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
36872 .cindex "message" "submission"
36873 .cindex "submission mode"
36874 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
36875 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
36878 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
36879 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
36881 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
36882 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
36884 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
36885 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
36886 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
36888 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
36889 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
36891 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
36892 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
36896 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
36898 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
36899 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
36900 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
36901 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
36902 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
36903 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
36904 &%qualify_domain%&.
36906 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
36907 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
36908 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
36909 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
36912 .subsection Message-ID: SECID226
36913 .chindex Message-ID:
36914 .cindex "message" "submission"
36915 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
36916 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
36917 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
36918 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
36919 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
36920 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
36921 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
36922 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
36923 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
36924 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
36927 .subsection Received: SECID227
36929 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
36930 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
36931 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
36933 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
36934 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
36935 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
36936 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
36938 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
36939 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
36940 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
36943 .subsection References: SECID228
36944 .chindex References:
36945 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
36946 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
36947 section 3.64 of RFC 2822 (which states that replies should contain such a
36948 header line), and section 3.14 of RFC 3834 (which states that automatic
36949 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
36950 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
36951 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
36952 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
36953 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
36957 .subsection Return-path: SECID229
36958 .chindex Return-path:
36959 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
36960 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
36961 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
36962 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
36963 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
36964 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
36968 .subsection Sender: SECTthesenhea
36969 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
36970 .cindex "message" "submission"
36972 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
36973 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
36974 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
36975 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
36978 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
36979 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
36980 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
36981 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
36982 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
36983 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
36984 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
36985 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
36986 line is added to the message.
36988 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
36989 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
36990 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
36991 options true at the same time.
36993 .cindex "submission mode"
36994 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
36995 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
36996 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
36997 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
36999 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
37000 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
37001 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
37002 created as follows:
37005 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
37006 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
37007 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
37009 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
37010 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
37012 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
37013 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
37016 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
37017 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
37018 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
37019 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
37021 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
37022 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
37023 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
37024 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
37028 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
37029 "SECTheadersaddrem"
37030 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
37031 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
37032 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
37033 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
37034 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
37035 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
37036 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
37038 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
37039 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
37040 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
37041 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
37042 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
37043 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
37045 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
37046 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
37047 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
37049 For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
37050 option must be in the form of one or more RFC 2822 header lines, separated by
37051 newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
37053 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
37054 X-added-second: another added header line
37056 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
37058 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
37059 specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
37060 Each header-line is separately expanded.
37062 The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
37063 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
37064 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
37065 not part of the names. For example:
37067 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
37070 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
37071 specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
37072 Each item is separately expanded.
37073 Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
37074 form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
37075 will act as list separators.
37077 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
37078 items are expanded at routing time,
37079 and then associated with all addresses that are
37080 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
37081 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
37082 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
37084 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
37085 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
37086 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
37087 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
37089 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
37090 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
37091 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
37094 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
37095 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
37096 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
37097 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
37098 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
37099 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
37100 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
37102 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
37103 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
37104 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
37105 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
37107 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
37108 the following consequences:
37111 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
37112 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
37113 to it, at all times.
37115 Header lines that are added by a router's
37116 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
37117 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
37119 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
37120 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
37122 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
37123 a later router or by a transport.
37125 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
37126 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
37128 headers_remove = subject
37129 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
37133 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
37134 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
37140 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
37141 .cindex "address" "constructed"
37142 .cindex "constructed address"
37143 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
37146 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
37150 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
37152 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
37153 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
37154 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
37155 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
37156 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
37157 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
37158 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
37159 there is no password file entry.
37162 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to RFC 2822 by quoting all or
37163 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
37164 characters, it is encoded as described in RFC 2047, which defines a way of
37165 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
37166 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
37167 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
37168 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
37169 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
37173 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
37174 .cindex "case of local parts"
37175 .cindex "local part" "case of"
37176 RFC 2822 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
37177 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
37178 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
37179 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
37180 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
37181 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
37184 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
37185 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
37186 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
37187 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
37188 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
37192 domains = +local_domains
37193 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
37194 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
37197 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
37198 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
37199 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
37200 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
37201 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
37205 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
37206 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
37207 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
37208 RFC 2822 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
37209 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
37210 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
37211 empty components for compatibility.
37215 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
37216 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
37217 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
37218 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
37219 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
37220 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
37222 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
37223 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
37224 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
37225 example, a header such as
37229 might get rewritten as
37231 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
37233 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
37234 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
37237 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
37238 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
37239 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
37240 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
37241 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
37242 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
37243 .ecindex IIDmesproc
37247 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37248 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37250 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
37251 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
37252 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
37253 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
37254 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
37255 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
37256 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
37259 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
37261 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
37263 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
37266 For mail delivery, the following are available:
37269 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
37271 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
37274 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
37277 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
37278 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
37281 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
37282 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
37283 used to contain the envelope information.
37287 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
37288 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
37289 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
37290 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
37291 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
37294 .cindex "SIZE" "option on MAIL command"
37295 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
37296 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
37297 processing is the same in both cases.
37299 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" SIZE
37300 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
37301 extension is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
37302 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
37303 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
37304 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
37305 .cindex "transport" "filter"
37306 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
37307 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
37310 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
37311 pipelining extension to SMTP (RFC 2197) to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets
37312 required for the transaction.
37314 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
37315 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
37316 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
37317 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
37318 is called for verification.
37320 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
37321 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
37322 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
37324 .cindex "carriage return"
37326 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
37327 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
37328 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
37331 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
37332 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
37333 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
37334 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
37335 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
37336 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
37337 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
37338 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
37339 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
37341 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
37342 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
37343 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
37344 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
37346 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
37347 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
37348 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
37349 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
37351 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
37352 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
37353 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
37354 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
37355 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected.
37356 If it finds one, it arranges to attempt that message on the same connection.
37358 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
37359 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
37361 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
37362 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
37363 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
37364 square bracket of the IP address.
37369 .subsection "Errors in outgoing SMTP" SECToutSMTPerr
37370 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
37371 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
37372 .cindex "host" "error"
37373 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
37374 message errors, and recipient errors.
37377 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
37378 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
37379 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
37382 Connection refused or timed out,
37384 Any error response code on connection,
37386 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
37388 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
37390 I/O errors at any time,
37392 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
37393 the &"."& at the end of the data.
37396 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
37397 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
37398 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
37399 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
37400 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
37401 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
37402 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
37403 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
37405 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
37406 .cindex "message" "error"
37407 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
37408 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
37409 message errors are:
37412 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
37415 Timeout after MAIL,
37417 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
37418 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
37419 connection at any other time.
37422 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
37423 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
37424 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
37425 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
37426 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
37427 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
37428 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
37429 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
37430 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
37431 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
37433 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
37434 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
37435 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
37438 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
37439 .cindex "recipient" "error"
37440 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
37441 recipient errors are:
37444 Any error response to RCPT,
37446 Timeout after RCPT.
37449 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
37450 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
37451 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
37452 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
37453 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
37454 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
37455 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
37456 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
37457 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
37458 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
37459 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
37460 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
37461 the retry clock is reset.
37463 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
37464 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
37465 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
37466 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
37467 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
37468 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
37469 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
37470 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
37471 recipient's retry time.
37474 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
37475 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
37476 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
37477 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
37478 until the next delivery attempt.
37480 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
37481 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
37482 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
37483 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
37484 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
37487 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
37488 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
37489 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
37490 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
37491 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
37492 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
37493 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
37495 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
37496 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
37497 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
37498 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
37499 then to be treated as a host error.
37501 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
37502 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
37503 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
37504 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
37505 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
37510 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
37511 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
37512 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
37515 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
37516 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
37517 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
37519 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
37521 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
37522 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
37523 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
37524 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
37525 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
37526 stream and exits with an error code.
37528 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
37529 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
37530 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
37531 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
37533 .cindex "carriage return"
37535 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
37536 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
37537 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
37539 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
37540 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
37541 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
37543 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
37544 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
37545 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
37546 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
37547 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
37548 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
37549 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
37550 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
37552 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
37553 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
37554 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
37555 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
37556 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
37557 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
37558 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
37559 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
37560 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
37562 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
37563 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
37564 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
37566 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
37567 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
37568 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
37569 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
37570 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
37572 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
37573 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
37574 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
37575 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
37576 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
37577 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
37578 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
37580 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
37581 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
37582 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
37583 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
37584 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
37586 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
37587 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
37588 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
37589 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
37590 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
37591 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
37592 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
37593 a delivery process.
37595 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
37596 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
37597 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
37598 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
37599 however, available with &'inetd'&.
37601 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
37602 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
37603 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
37604 section &<<SSECTrewriteS>>&.
37606 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
37607 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
37608 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
37612 .subsection "Unrecognized SMTP commands" SECID234
37613 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
37614 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
37615 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
37616 the error response to the last command. The default value for
37617 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
37618 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
37619 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
37622 .subsection "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" SECID235
37623 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
37624 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
37625 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
37626 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
37627 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
37628 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
37629 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
37630 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
37631 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
37632 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
37636 .subsection "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" SECID236
37637 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
37638 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
37639 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
37640 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
37641 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
37642 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
37643 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
37645 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
37646 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
37647 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
37648 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
37649 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
37652 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
37653 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
37654 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
37656 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
37657 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
37658 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
37659 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
37660 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
37665 .subsection "The VRFY and EXPN commands" SECID237
37666 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
37667 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
37668 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
37670 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
37671 When no ACL is defined for VRFY, or if it rejects without
37672 setting an explicit response code, the command is accepted
37673 (with a 252 SMTP response code)
37674 in order to support awkward clients that do a VRFY before every RCPT.
37675 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
37676 called with the &%-bv%& option, and returns 250/451/550
37677 SMTP response codes.
37679 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
37680 If no ACL for EXPN is defined, the command is rejected.
37681 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
37682 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
37683 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
37684 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
37685 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
37686 VRFY verification failures are logged in the main log for consistency with
37691 .subsection "The ETRN command" SECTETRN
37692 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
37693 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" ETRN
37694 Most modern installations never need to use this.
37695 It is used for managing messages queued for an intermittently-connecting
37696 destination (eg. one using a dialup connection).
37698 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_etrn%&"
37699 The command is only available if permitted by an ACL
37700 specfied by the main-section &%acl_smtp_etrn%& option.
37702 RFC 1985 describes an ESMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
37703 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
37704 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
37705 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
37706 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
37708 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
37709 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
37710 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
37711 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
37712 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
37713 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
37714 argument. For example,
37722 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
37723 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
37724 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
37725 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
37726 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
37728 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
37729 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
37730 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
37731 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
37732 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
37733 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
37734 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
37735 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
37737 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
37738 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
37739 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
37740 whatever the form of its argument. For
37743 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
37744 $sender_host_address
37746 .vindex "&$domain$&"
37747 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
37748 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
37749 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
37750 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
37751 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
37752 for it to change them before running the command.
37756 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
37757 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
37758 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
37759 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
37760 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
37761 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
37762 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
37763 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
37764 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
37765 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
37766 runs for RCPT commands:
37770 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
37774 .section "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
37775 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
37776 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
37777 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
37778 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
37779 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
37780 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
37781 envelope along with the message.
37783 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
37784 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
37785 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
37786 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
37787 can be used to specify it.
37789 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
37790 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
37791 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
37792 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
37793 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
37796 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
37797 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
37798 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
37803 driver = manualroute
37804 transport = smtp_appendfile
37805 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
37809 driver = appendfile
37810 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
37815 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
37816 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
37817 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
37821 .section "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
37822 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
37823 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
37824 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
37825 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
37826 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
37827 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
37828 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
37829 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
37830 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
37832 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
37833 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
37835 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
37836 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
37837 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
37838 make some use of automatically, for example:
37840 554 Unexpected end of file
37841 Transaction started in line 10
37842 Error detected in line 14
37844 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
37847 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
37848 The error message was:
37850 501 '>' missing at end of address
37852 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
37853 The error was detected in line 12.
37854 The SMTP command at fault was:
37856 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
37858 1 previous message was successfully processed.
37859 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
37861 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
37862 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
37864 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
37865 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
37869 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37870 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37872 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
37873 "Customizing messages"
37874 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains in the queue for more than a
37875 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
37876 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
37877 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
37878 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
37880 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
37881 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
37882 option. Exim also adds the line
37884 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
37886 to all warning and bounce messages,
37889 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
37890 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
37891 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
37892 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
37893 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
37894 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
37895 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
37897 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
37898 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
37899 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
37900 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
37901 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
37904 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
37905 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
37906 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
37907 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
37908 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
37909 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
37910 option, rounded to a whole number.
37912 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
37915 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
37916 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
37918 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
37919 failing addresses with their error messages.
37921 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
37922 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
37924 The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
37925 The fields exist for back-compatibility
37928 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
37929 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
37930 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
37932 Subject: Mail delivery failed
37933 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
37934 {: returning message to sender}}
37936 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
37938 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
37939 {that you sent }{sent by
37943 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
37944 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
37946 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
37948 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
37951 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
37953 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
37956 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
37957 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
37958 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
37959 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
37960 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
37964 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
37965 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
37967 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
37968 the delayed addresses.
37970 The third item then ends the message.
37973 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
37974 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
37976 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
37977 $warn_message_delay
37979 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
37981 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
37982 {that you sent }{sent by
37986 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
37987 more than $warn_message_delay in the queue on $primary_hostname.
37989 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
37990 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
37991 The date of the message is: $h_date
37993 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
37995 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
37996 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
37997 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
37998 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
37999 the message will be returned to you.
38001 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
38002 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
38003 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
38004 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
38005 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
38006 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
38007 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
38008 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
38014 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38015 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38017 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
38018 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
38019 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
38023 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
38024 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
38025 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
38026 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
38027 routing explicitly:
38029 send_to_smart_host:
38030 driver = manualroute
38031 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
38032 transport = remote_smtp
38034 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
38035 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
38036 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
38037 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
38038 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
38043 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
38044 .cindex "mailing lists"
38045 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
38046 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
38047 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
38049 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
38050 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
38051 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
38052 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
38056 domains = lists.example
38057 file = ${lookup {$local_part} dsearch,ret=full {/usr/lists}}
38060 errors_to = ${quote_local_part:$local_part-request}@lists.example
38063 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
38064 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
38065 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
38066 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
38068 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
38069 expanded into a filename or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
38072 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
38073 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
38074 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
38075 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
38076 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
38078 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
38079 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
38080 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
38081 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
38082 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
38083 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
38084 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
38085 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
38086 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
38090 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
38091 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
38092 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
38093 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
38094 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
38095 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
38096 addresses are not rigorously checked.
38098 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
38099 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
38100 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
38101 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
38102 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
38106 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
38107 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
38108 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
38109 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
38110 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
38111 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
38112 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
38113 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
38114 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
38115 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
38117 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
38118 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
38119 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
38120 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
38121 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
38122 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
38123 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
38124 pre-existing messages.
38126 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
38127 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
38128 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
38129 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
38130 one level of expansion anyway.
38134 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
38135 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
38136 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
38137 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
38138 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
38139 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
38141 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
38142 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
38146 domains = lists.example
38147 local_part_suffix = -request
38148 local_parts = ${lookup {$local_part} dsearch,filter=file {/usr/lists}}
38149 file = /usr/lists/${local_part_data}-request
38154 domains = lists.example
38155 local_parts = ${lookup {$local_part} dsearch,filter=file,ret=full {/usr/lists}}
38156 senders = ${if exists {$local_part_data} {lsearch;$local_part_data}{*}}
38157 file = ${lookup {$local_part} dsearch,ret=full {/usr/lists}}
38160 errors_to = ${quote_local_part:$local_part-request}@lists.example
38165 domains = lists.example
38167 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
38169 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
38170 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
38171 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
38174 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
38175 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
38176 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
38177 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
38178 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
38179 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
38180 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
38181 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
38182 &"unrouteable address"& error.
38184 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
38185 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
38186 the address, giving a suitable error message.
38191 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
38193 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
38194 .cindex "envelope from"
38195 .cindex "envelope sender"
38196 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(https://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
38197 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
38198 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
38199 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
38200 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
38201 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
38203 .oindex &%errors_to%&
38204 .oindex &%return_path%&
38205 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
38206 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
38207 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
38208 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
38209 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
38210 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
38211 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
38217 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
38218 {${quote_local_part:$1-request+$local_part=$domain}@your.dom.example}fail}
38220 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
38221 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
38222 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
38223 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
38224 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
38225 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
38226 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
38229 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
38231 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
38232 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
38233 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
38234 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
38235 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
38236 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
38238 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
38239 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
38240 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
38241 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
38245 domains = ! +local_domains
38247 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
38248 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
38251 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
38252 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
38253 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
38254 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
38257 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
38258 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
38259 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
38260 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
38261 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
38265 domains = ! +local_domains
38266 transport = remote_smtp
38268 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
38269 {${quote_local_part:$1-request+$local_part=$domain}@your.dom.example}fail}
38272 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
38273 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
38274 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
38275 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
38278 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
38279 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
38280 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
38281 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
38282 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
38283 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
38291 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
38292 .cindex "virtual domains"
38293 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
38294 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
38298 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
38299 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
38300 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
38302 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
38303 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
38304 have login accounts on that host.
38307 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
38308 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
38309 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
38310 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
38311 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
38312 to a router of this form:
38316 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
38317 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain_data}}
38320 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
38321 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
38322 domain that is being processed.
38323 The &(dsearch)& lookup used results in an untainted version of &$domain$&
38324 being placed into the &$domain_data$& variable.
38326 When the router runs, it looks up the local
38327 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
38328 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
38329 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
38331 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias filenames
38332 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
38333 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
38334 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
38336 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
38337 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
38338 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
38342 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
38343 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
38344 transport = my_mailboxes
38346 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
38347 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
38348 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
38349 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
38350 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
38354 driver = appendfile
38355 file = /var/mail/$domain_data/$local_part_data
38358 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
38359 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
38361 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
38362 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
38363 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
38364 information about the domains.
38368 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
38369 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
38370 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
38371 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
38372 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
38373 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
38374 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
38375 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
38376 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
38377 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
38378 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
38379 example, consider this router:
38384 file = $home/.forward
38385 local_part_suffix = -*
38386 local_part_suffix_optional
38389 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
38390 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
38391 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
38392 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
38394 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
38395 save /home/$local_part_data/Mail/special
38398 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
38399 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
38400 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
38401 control over which suffixes are valid.
38403 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
38404 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
38410 local_part_suffix = -*
38411 local_part_suffix_optional
38412 file = ${lookup {.forward$local_part_suffix} dsearch,ret=full {$home} {$value}fail}
38415 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
38416 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
38417 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
38418 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
38419 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
38423 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
38424 .cindex "vacation processing"
38425 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
38426 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
38427 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
38428 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
38429 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
38432 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
38433 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
38434 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
38435 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
38437 spqr, vacation-spqr
38440 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
38441 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
38442 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
38443 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
38444 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
38448 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
38449 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
38453 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
38454 .cindex "message" "copying every"
38455 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
38456 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
38457 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
38458 each day's messages.
38460 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
38461 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
38462 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
38463 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
38467 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
38468 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
38469 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
38470 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
38471 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
38472 permanently connected.
38474 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
38475 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
38476 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
38479 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
38480 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
38481 host to remain in Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
38482 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
38483 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
38484 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
38485 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
38486 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
38488 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
38489 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
38490 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
38491 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
38492 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
38493 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
38496 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
38497 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
38498 intermittent host. For example:
38500 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
38502 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
38503 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
38504 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
38505 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
38506 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
38507 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
38510 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
38511 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
38512 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
38513 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
38514 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
38515 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
38516 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
38520 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
38521 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
38522 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
38523 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
38524 delivered immediately.
38526 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
38527 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
38528 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
38529 .cindex "first pass routing"
38530 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
38531 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
38532 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
38533 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
38534 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
38535 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
38536 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
38537 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
38538 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
38539 single SMTP connection.
38543 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38544 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38546 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
38547 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
38548 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
38549 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
38550 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
38551 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
38552 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
38553 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
38554 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
38555 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
38558 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
38559 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
38560 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
38561 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
38562 email is not desirable.
38564 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
38565 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
38566 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
38567 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
38568 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
38569 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
38570 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
38572 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
38573 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
38574 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
38575 before sending a message to the smart host.
38577 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
38578 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
38579 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
38581 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
38582 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
38583 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
38584 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
38585 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
38586 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
38587 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
38589 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
38593 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
38594 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
38596 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
38597 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
38598 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
38599 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
38600 successful, a zero return code is given.
38602 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
38603 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
38604 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
38605 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
38606 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
38609 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
38610 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
38611 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
38613 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
38614 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
38615 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
38616 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
38617 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
38619 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
38620 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
38621 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
38623 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
38624 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
38625 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
38626 are ever generated.
38628 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
38630 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
38631 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
38632 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
38635 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
38636 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
38637 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
38638 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
38639 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
38640 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
38645 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38646 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38648 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
38649 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
38650 .cindex "log" "types of"
38651 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
38656 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
38657 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
38658 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
38659 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
38660 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
38661 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
38662 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
38663 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
38665 .cindex "reject log"
38666 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
38667 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
38668 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
38669 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
38670 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
38671 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
38672 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
38673 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
38674 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
38677 .cindex "panic log"
38678 .cindex "system log"
38679 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
38680 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
38681 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
38682 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
38683 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
38684 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
38685 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
38686 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
38687 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
38690 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
38691 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
38692 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
38694 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
38697 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
38698 ways of changing this:
38701 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
38706 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
38708 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
38711 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
38715 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
38716 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
38717 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
38718 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
38719 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
38720 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
38725 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
38726 .cindex "log" "destination"
38727 .cindex "log" "to file"
38728 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
38730 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
38731 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
38732 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
38733 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
38734 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
38735 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
38736 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
38738 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
38739 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the runtime
38740 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
38741 references to the host name:
38743 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
38745 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
38746 rather than at runtime, because then the setting is available right from the
38747 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
38748 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
38749 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
38752 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
38753 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
38754 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
38755 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
38756 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
38757 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
38758 implying the use of a default path.
38760 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
38761 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
38762 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
38763 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. If no such item exists, log
38764 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
38765 equivalent to the configuration file setting:
38767 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
38769 If you do not specify anything at build time or runtime,
38770 or if you unset the option at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
38771 that is where the logs are written.
38773 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log filenames
38774 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
38776 Here are some examples of possible Makefile settings:
38778 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
38779 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
38780 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
38781 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
38783 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
38788 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
38789 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
38790 .cindex "cycling logs"
38791 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
38792 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
38793 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
38794 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
38795 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
38796 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
38797 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
38799 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
38800 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
38801 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
38802 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
38803 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
38804 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
38805 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
38806 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
38807 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
38808 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
38809 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
38814 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
38815 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
38816 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
38817 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
38818 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
38819 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
38820 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
38821 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
38823 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
38824 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
38825 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
38826 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
38828 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
38829 examples of names generated by the above examples:
38831 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
38832 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
38833 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
38834 /var/log/exim/main.200212
38836 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
38837 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
38838 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
38839 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
38841 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
38842 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
38843 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
38844 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
38845 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
38846 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
38849 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
38850 /var/log/exim-panic.log
38851 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
38852 /var/log/exim/panic
38856 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
38857 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
38858 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
38859 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
38860 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
38861 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
38862 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
38863 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
38864 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
38865 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
38866 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
38867 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
38868 the time and host name to each line.
38869 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
38872 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
38874 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
38876 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
38879 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
38880 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
38881 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
38882 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
38884 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
38885 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
38886 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
38887 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
38888 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
38889 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
38890 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
38891 RFC 3164, you should set
38893 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
38895 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
38896 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
38898 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
38899 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
38900 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
38901 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
38902 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
38903 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
38904 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
38905 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
38906 name, and pid as added by syslog:
38908 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
38909 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
38910 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
38911 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
38914 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
38917 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
38918 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
38919 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
38920 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
38922 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
38923 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
38924 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
38925 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
38926 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
38927 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
38929 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
38930 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
38931 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
38934 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
38936 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
38937 without modification.
38939 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
38940 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
38941 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
38946 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
38947 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
38948 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
38949 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
38950 timestamp. The flags are:
38951 .itable none 0 0 2 10* left 90* left
38952 .irow &%<=%& "message arrival"
38953 .irow &%(=%& "message fakereject"
38954 .irow &%=>%& "normal message delivery"
38955 .irow &%->%& "additional address in same delivery"
38956 .irow &%>>%& "cutthrough message delivery"
38957 .irow &%*>%& "delivery suppressed by &%-N%&"
38958 .irow &%**%& "delivery failed; address bounced"
38959 .irow &%==%& "delivery deferred; temporary problem"
38963 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
38964 .cindex "log" "reception line"
38965 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
38966 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
38967 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
38969 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
38970 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
38971 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
38973 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
38974 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
38975 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
38979 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
38983 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
38984 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
38985 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
38986 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
38987 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
38988 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
38989 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
38990 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
38991 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
38992 name in parentheses.
38994 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
38995 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
38996 the log containing text like these examples:
38998 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
38999 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
39001 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
39004 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
39005 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
39008 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
39009 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
39010 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
39011 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
39012 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
39013 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
39014 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
39015 suite that was used.
39017 .cindex log protocol
39018 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
39019 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
39020 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
39021 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
39022 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
39023 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
39024 authenticator name.
39026 .cindex "size" "of message"
39027 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
39028 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
39029 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
39030 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
39033 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
39034 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
39038 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
39039 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
39040 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
39041 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
39042 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into multiple lines in order
39043 to fit it on the page:
39045 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
39046 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
39047 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
39048 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
39049 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
39051 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
39052 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
39053 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
39054 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
39055 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
39057 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
39058 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
39059 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
39060 option, this is logged too, as a second colon-separated list item.
39061 Optionally (see the &%smtp_mailauth%& &%log_selector%&) there may be a third list item.
39063 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
39064 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
39066 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
39068 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
39069 parentheses afterwards.
39071 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
39072 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
39073 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
39074 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
39075 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the
39076 remote IP address (and port if enabled)
39077 in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
39078 When two or more messages are delivered down a single TLS connection, the
39079 DNS and some TLS-related information logged for the first message delivered
39080 will not be present in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
39081 TLS cipher information is still available.
39083 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
39084 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
39085 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
39086 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
39087 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
39089 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
39090 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
39092 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
39093 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
39096 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
39097 .cindex "discarded messages"
39098 .cindex "message" "discarded"
39099 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
39100 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
39101 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
39103 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
39104 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
39106 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
39107 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
39109 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
39110 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
39114 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
39115 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
39117 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
39118 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
39120 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
39121 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
39122 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
39124 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
39125 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
39127 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
39128 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
39129 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
39133 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
39134 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
39135 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
39136 following form is logged:
39138 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
39139 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
39141 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
39142 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
39144 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
39145 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
39146 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
39147 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
39148 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
39150 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
39151 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
39152 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
39153 flagged with &`**`&.
39157 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
39158 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
39159 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
39160 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
39161 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
39165 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
39168 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
39170 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
39171 at the end of its processing.
39176 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
39177 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
39178 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
39179 the following table:
39181 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
39182 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
39183 &`Ci `& connection identifier
39184 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
39185 &`CV `& certificate verification status
39186 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
39187 &`DKIM`& domain verified in incoming message
39188 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
39189 &`DS `& DNSSEC secured lookups
39190 &`DT `& on &`=>`&, &'=='& and &'**'& lines: time taken for, or to attempt, a delivery
39191 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
39192 &`H `& host name and IP address
39193 &`I `& local interface used
39194 &`id `& message id (from header) for incoming message
39195 &`K `& CHUNKING extension used
39196 &`L `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: PIPELINING extension used
39197 &`M8S `& 8BITMIME status for incoming message
39198 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
39199 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
39200 &`PRDR`& PRDR extension used
39201 &`PRX `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: proxy address
39202 &`Q `& alternate queue name
39203 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
39204 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
39205 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
39206 &` `& on &`=>`& &`>>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
39207 &`RT `& on &`<=`& lines: time taken for reception
39208 &`S `& size of message in bytes
39209 &`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
39210 &`ST `& shadow transport name
39211 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
39212 &`TFO `& connection took advantage of TCP Fast Open
39213 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
39214 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
39215 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
39219 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
39220 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
39221 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
39224 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
39225 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
39226 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
39227 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
39228 during the first delivery attempt.
39230 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
39231 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
39232 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
39234 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
39235 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
39236 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
39237 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
39238 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
39241 .cindex "error" "ignored"
39242 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
39245 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
39246 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
39248 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
39249 failed. The delivery was discarded.
39251 A delivery set up by a router configured with
39252 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
39253 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
39257 failed. The delivery was discarded.
39260 .cindex DKIM "log line"
39261 &'DKIM: d='&&~&~Verbose results of a DKIM verification attempt, if enabled for
39262 logging and the message has a DKIM signature header.
39269 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
39270 .cindex "log" "selectors"
39271 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
39272 default logging to the main log, or you can request additional logging. The value of
39273 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
39276 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
39278 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
39279 selection marked by asterisks:
39280 .itable none 0 0 3 2.8in left 10pt center 3in left
39281 .irow &`8bitmime`& "received 8BITMIME status"
39282 .irow &`acl_warn_skipped`& * "skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL"
39283 .irow &`address_rewrite`& "address rewriting"
39284 .irow &`all_parents`& "all parents in => lines"
39285 .irow &`arguments`& "command line arguments"
39286 .irow &`connection_id`& "connection identifier"
39287 .irow &`connection_reject`& * "connection rejections"
39288 .irow &`delay_delivery`& * "immediate delivery delayed"
39289 .irow &`deliver_time`& "time taken to attempt delivery"
39290 .irow &`delivery_size`& "add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines"
39291 .irow &`dkim`& * "DKIM verified domain on <= lines"
39292 .irow &`dkim_verbose`& "separate full DKIM verification result line, per signature; DKIM signing"
39293 .irow &`dnslist_defer`& * "defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups"
39294 .irow &`dnssec`& "DNSSEC secured lookups"
39295 .irow &`etrn`& * "ETRN commands"
39296 .irow &`host_lookup_failed`& * "as it says"
39297 .irow &`ident_timeout`& "timeout for ident connection"
39298 .irow &`incoming_interface`& "local interface & port on <= and => lines"
39299 .irow &`incoming_port`& "remote port on <= lines"
39300 .irow &`lost_incoming_connection`& * "as it says (includes timeouts)"
39301 .irow &`millisec`& "millisecond timestamps and RT,QT,DT,D times"
39302 .irow &`msg_id`& * "on <= lines, Message-ID: header value"
39303 .irow &`msg_id_created`& "on <= lines, Message-ID: header value when one had to be added"
39304 .irow &`outgoing_interface`& "local interface on => lines"
39305 .irow &`outgoing_port`& "add remote port to => lines"
39306 .irow &`queue_run`& * "start and end queue runs"
39307 .irow &`queue_time`& "time on queue for one recipient"
39308 .irow &`queue_time_exclusive`& "exclude recieve time from QT times"
39309 .irow &`queue_time_overall`& "time on queue for whole message"
39310 .irow &`pid`& "Exim process id"
39311 .irow &`pipelining`& "PIPELINING use, on <= and => lines"
39312 .irow &`proxy`& "proxy address on <= and => lines"
39313 .irow &`receive_time`& "time taken to receive message"
39314 .irow &`received_recipients`& "recipients on <= lines"
39315 .irow &`received_sender`& "sender on <= lines"
39316 .irow &`rejected_header`& * "header contents on reject log"
39317 .irow &`retry_defer`& * "&<quote>&retry time not reached&</quote>&"
39318 .irow &`return_path_on_delivery`& "put return path on => and ** lines"
39319 .irow &`sender_on_delivery`& "add sender to => lines"
39320 .irow &`sender_verify_fail`& * "sender verification failures"
39321 .irow &`size_reject`& * "rejection because too big"
39322 .irow &`skip_delivery`& * "delivery skipped in a queue run"
39323 .irow &`smtp_confirmation`& * "SMTP confirmation on => lines"
39324 .irow &`smtp_connection`& "incoming SMTP connections"
39325 .irow &`smtp_incomplete_transaction`& "incomplete SMTP transactions"
39326 .irow &`smtp_mailauth`& "AUTH argument to MAIL commands"
39327 .irow &`smtp_no_mail`& "session with no MAIL commands"
39328 .irow &`smtp_protocol_error`& "SMTP protocol errors"
39329 .irow &`smtp_syntax_error`& "SMTP syntax errors"
39330 .irow &`subject`& "contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines"
39331 .irow &`tls_certificate_verified`& * "certificate verification status"
39332 .irow &`tls_cipher`& * "TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines"
39333 .irow &`tls_peerdn`& "TLS peer DN on <= and => lines"
39334 .irow &`tls_resumption`& "append * to cipher field"
39335 .irow &`tls_sni`& "TLS SNI on <= lines"
39336 .irow &`unknown_in_list`& "lookup failed in list match"
39337 .irow &`all`& "&*all of the above*&"
39339 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
39340 section &<<SECID99>>&
39342 More details on each of these items follows:
39346 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
39347 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
39348 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
39349 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
39350 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
39351 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
39353 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
39354 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
39355 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
39356 this log selector is set.
39358 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
39359 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
39360 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
39361 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
39362 such users cannot access the log).
39364 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
39365 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
39366 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
39367 parentheses between them.
39369 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
39370 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
39371 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
39372 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
39373 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
39374 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
39375 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
39376 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
39377 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
39378 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
39379 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
39380 between the caller and Exim.
39382 .cindex log "connection identifier"
39383 .cindex connection "identifier logging"
39384 &%connection_id%&: An identifier for the accepted connection is added to
39385 connection start and end lines and to message accept lines.
39386 The identifier is tagged by Ci=.
39387 The value is PID-based, so will reset on reboot and will wrap.
39389 .cindex log "connection rejections"
39390 .cindex connection "rejection logging"
39391 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
39392 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
39394 .cindex log "delayed delivery"
39395 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
39396 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
39397 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
39398 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
39399 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
39401 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
39402 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
39403 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
39404 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
39405 precision, eg. &`DT=0.304s`&.
39407 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
39408 .cindex "size" "of message"
39409 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
39410 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
39412 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
39413 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
39414 &%dkim%&: For message acceptance log lines, when an DKIM signature in the header
39415 verifies successfully a tag of DKIM is added, with one of the verified domains.
39417 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
39418 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
39419 &%dkim_verbose%&: A log entry is written for each attempted DKIM verification.
39420 Also, on message delivery lines signing information (domain and selector)
39421 is added, tagged with DKIM=.
39423 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
39424 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
39425 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
39426 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
39427 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
39430 .cindex dnssec logging
39431 &%dnssec%&: For message acceptance and (attempted) delivery log lines, when
39432 dns lookups gave secure results a tag of DS is added.
39433 For acceptance this covers the reverse and forward lookups for host name verification.
39434 It does not cover helo-name verification.
39435 For delivery this covers the SRV, MX, A and/or AAAA lookups.
39437 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
39438 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
39439 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
39440 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
39441 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
39442 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
39444 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
39445 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
39446 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
39447 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
39448 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
39450 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
39451 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
39452 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
39453 client's ident port times out.
39455 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
39456 .cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
39457 .cindex "log" "local interface"
39458 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
39459 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
39460 .cindex "interface" "logging"
39461 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
39462 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
39463 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
39464 added to other SMTP log lines, for example, &"SMTP connection from"&, to
39465 rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing
39466 &"=>"&, &"->"&, &"=="& and &"**"& lines.
39467 The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
39469 .cindex log "incoming proxy address"
39470 .cindex proxy "logging proxy address"
39471 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging proxy address"
39472 &%proxy%&: The internal (closest to the system running Exim) IP address
39473 of the proxy, tagged by PRX=, on the &"<="& line for a message accepted
39474 on a proxied connection
39475 or the &"=>"& line for a message delivered on a proxied connection.
39476 See &<<SECTproxyInbound>>& for more information.
39478 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
39479 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
39480 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
39481 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
39482 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
39483 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
39484 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
39485 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
39486 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
39487 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
39488 important with the widening use of NAT (see RFC 2505).
39490 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
39491 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
39492 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
39494 .cindex "log" "millisecond timestamps"
39495 .cindex millisecond logging
39496 .cindex timestamps "millisecond, in logs"
39497 &%millisec%&: Timestamps have a period and three decimal places of finer granularity
39498 appended to the seconds value.
39500 .cindex "log" "message id"
39501 &%msg_id%&: The value of the Message-ID: header.
39503 &%msg_id_created%&: The value of the Message-ID: header, when one had to be created.
39504 This will be either because the message is a bounce, or was submitted locally
39505 (submission mode) without one.
39506 The field identifier will have an asterix appended: &"id*="&.
39508 .cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
39509 .cindex "log" "local interface"
39510 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
39511 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
39512 .cindex "interface" "logging"
39513 &%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
39514 interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
39515 followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
39516 off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
39518 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
39519 .cindex "port" "logging outgoing remote"
39520 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging outgoing remote port"
39521 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
39522 containing => tags) following the IP address.
39523 The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
39524 &%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
39525 This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
39526 configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
39527 local port is a random ephemeral port.
39529 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
39530 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
39531 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
39532 immediately after the time and date.
39534 .cindex log pipelining
39535 .cindex pipelining "logging outgoing"
39536 &%pipelining%&: A field is added to delivery and accept
39537 log lines when the ESMTP PIPELINING extension was used.
39538 The field is a single "L".
39540 On accept lines, where PIPELINING was offered but not used by the client,
39541 the field has a minus appended.
39543 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
39544 If Exim is built without the DISABLE_PIPE_CONNECT build option
39545 accept "L" fields have a period appended if the feature was
39546 offered but not used, or an asterisk appended if used.
39547 Delivery "L" fields have an asterisk appended if used.
39550 .cindex "log" "queue run"
39551 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
39552 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
39554 .cindex "log" "queue time"
39555 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
39556 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
39558 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
39559 precision, eg. &`QT=1.578s`&.
39561 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
39562 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
39563 example, &`QT=3m45s`&.
39565 .cindex "log" "receive duration"
39566 &%receive_time%&: For each message, the amount of real time it has taken to
39567 perform the reception is logged as RT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`RT=1s`&.
39568 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
39569 precision, eg. &`RT=0.204s`&.
39571 .cindex "log" "recipients"
39572 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
39573 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
39574 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
39575 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
39577 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
39580 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
39581 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
39582 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
39583 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
39585 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
39586 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
39587 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
39588 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
39589 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
39591 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
39592 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
39593 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
39594 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
39597 .cindex "log" "return path"
39598 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
39599 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
39600 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
39601 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
39603 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
39604 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
39605 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
39606 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
39607 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
39609 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
39610 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
39611 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
39612 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
39615 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
39616 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
39619 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
39620 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
39621 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
39622 queue run because it another process is already delivering it or because
39624 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
39625 .cindex "&""message is frozen""&"
39626 The message that is written is either &"spool file is locked"& or
39627 &"message is frozen"&.
39629 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
39630 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
39631 .cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
39632 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
39633 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
39634 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
39637 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
39638 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
39639 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
39640 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
39641 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
39642 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
39643 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
39644 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
39645 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
39646 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
39648 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
39649 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
39650 reset if the daemon is restarted.
39651 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
39652 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
39653 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
39654 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
39655 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
39657 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
39658 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
39659 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
39660 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
39661 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
39662 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
39664 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
39665 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
39666 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
39667 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
39668 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
39669 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
39670 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
39671 already have their own log lines.
39673 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
39674 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
39675 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
39676 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
39677 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
39678 the same logging options.
39680 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
39681 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
39685 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
39686 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
39687 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
39688 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
39689 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
39691 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
39692 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
39693 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
39694 was accepted or used.
39696 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
39697 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
39698 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
39699 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
39700 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
39701 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
39702 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
39703 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
39705 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
39706 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
39707 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
39708 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
39709 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
39710 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
39711 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
39712 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
39713 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
39715 .cindex "log" "subject"
39716 .cindex "subject, logging"
39717 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
39718 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
39719 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
39720 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
39721 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
39723 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
39725 .cindex DANE logging
39726 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
39727 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
39729 using a CA trust anchor,
39730 &`CV=dane`& if using a DNS trust anchor,
39731 and &`CV=no`& if not.
39733 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
39734 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
39735 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
39736 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
39738 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
39739 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
39740 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
39741 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
39742 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
39744 .cindex "log" "TLS resumption"
39745 .cindex "TLS" "logging session resumption"
39746 &%tls_resumption%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
39747 connection and the TLS session resumed one used on a previous TCP connection,
39748 an asterisk is appended to the X= cipher field in the log line.
39750 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
39751 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
39752 .cindex SNI logging
39753 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
39754 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
39755 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
39757 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
39758 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
39759 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed, or because
39760 a bad IP address was in the list.
39764 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
39765 .cindex "message" "log file for"
39766 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
39767 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
39768 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
39769 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
39770 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
39771 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
39772 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
39773 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
39774 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
39775 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
39776 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
39778 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
39779 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
39780 &%message_logs%& option false.
39786 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39787 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39789 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
39790 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
39791 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
39792 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
39793 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
39795 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
39796 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
39797 "list what Exim processes are doing"
39798 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
39799 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
39800 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
39801 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
39803 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
39804 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
39805 "extract statistics from the log"
39806 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
39807 "check address acceptance from given IP"
39808 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
39809 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
39810 .irow &<<SECTdumpdb>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
39811 .irow &<<SECTtidydb>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
39812 .irow &<<SECTfixdb>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
39813 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
39814 .irow &<<SECTexim_msgdate>>& &'exim_msgdate'& "Message Ids for humans (exim_msgdate)"
39817 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
39818 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
39819 &url(https://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
39824 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
39825 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
39826 .cindex "process, querying"
39828 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
39829 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
39830 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
39831 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
39832 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
39833 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
39834 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
39835 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
39837 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
39838 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
39839 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
39842 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
39843 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
39844 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
39845 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
39846 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
39848 .itable none 0 0 2 30* left 70* left
39849 .irow &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD`& "the command for running &'ps'&"
39850 .irow &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG`& "the argument for &'ps'&"
39851 .irow &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG`& "the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output"
39852 .irow &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG`& "the argument for the &'kill'& command"
39854 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
39856 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
39857 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
39858 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
39859 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
39860 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
39861 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
39863 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
39864 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
39868 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
39869 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
39870 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
39871 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
39875 or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
39879 to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
39880 that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
39883 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
39884 Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
39885 tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
39889 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
39890 Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
39891 tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
39893 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
39894 Match against the size field.
39896 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
39897 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
39899 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
39900 Match messages that are older than the given time.
39903 Match only frozen messages.
39906 Match only non-frozen messages.
39908 .vitem &*-G*&&~<&'queuename'&>
39909 Match only messages in the given queue. Without this, the default queue is searched.
39912 The following options control the format of the output:
39916 Display only the count of matching messages.
39919 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
39923 Display message ids only.
39926 Brief format &-- one line per message.
39929 Display messages in reverse order.
39932 Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
39935 The following options give alternates for configuration:
39938 .vitem &*-C*&&~<&'config&~file'&>
39939 is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
39940 contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
39942 .vitem &*-E*&&~<&'path'&>
39943 can be used to specify a path for the exim binary,
39944 overriding the built-in one.
39947 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
39948 At least one selection option, or either the &*-c*& or &*-h*& option, must be given.
39952 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
39953 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
39954 .cindex "queue" "summary"
39955 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
39956 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages in the queue. Thus, you use it by
39957 running a command such as
39959 exim -bp | exiqsumm
39961 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
39962 it, as in the following example:
39964 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
39966 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
39967 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
39968 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
39969 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
39971 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
39972 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
39973 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
39974 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
39975 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
39976 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
39979 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
39980 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
39981 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
39982 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
39983 level"& addresses).
39988 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
39990 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
39991 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
39992 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
39993 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
39994 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
39995 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
39996 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
39997 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
39998 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
39999 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
40001 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
40003 If no log filenames are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
40005 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
40006 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
40007 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds in the queue.
40009 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
40010 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
40011 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
40012 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
40013 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
40015 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
40016 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
40017 regular expression.
40019 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
40020 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
40022 The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
40023 that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
40027 user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
40028 &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
40029 displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
40030 the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
40031 when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
40032 &"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
40035 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
40036 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
40037 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
40038 If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
40039 autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
40042 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
40043 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
40044 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
40045 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
40046 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, run &'exipick'& with
40047 the &%--help%& option.
40050 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
40051 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
40052 .cindex "cycling logs"
40053 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
40054 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
40055 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
40056 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
40057 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
40058 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
40059 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
40061 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
40062 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
40064 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
40065 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
40066 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
40070 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the filenames get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
40071 the main log filename is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
40072 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
40073 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
40074 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
40075 logs are handled similarly.
40077 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
40078 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
40079 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
40080 any existing log files.
40082 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
40083 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
40084 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
40085 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
40086 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
40088 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
40090 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
40091 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
40095 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
40096 .cindex "statistics"
40097 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
40098 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
40099 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
40100 . --- 2018-09-07: LogReport's Lire appears to be dead; website is a Yahoo Japan
40101 . --- 404 error and everything else points to that.
40103 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
40104 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
40105 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
40106 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
40107 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
40109 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
40111 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
40112 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
40113 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
40114 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
40115 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
40116 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
40117 also produced per user.
40119 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
40120 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
40121 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
40122 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
40123 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
40125 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
40126 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
40127 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
40128 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
40129 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
40130 an entirely separate message.
40132 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
40133 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
40134 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
40135 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
40136 least one address that failed.
40138 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
40139 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
40140 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
40141 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent in the queue,
40142 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
40143 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
40144 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
40146 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
40147 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
40148 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
40150 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
40151 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
40152 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
40154 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
40157 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
40158 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
40159 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
40160 .cindex "checking access"
40161 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
40162 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
40163 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
40164 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
40165 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
40166 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
40168 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
40169 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
40171 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
40173 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
40174 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
40175 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
40176 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
40179 550 Relay not permitted
40181 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
40182 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
40183 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
40184 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
40187 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
40188 -f himself@there.example
40190 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
40191 mandatory arguments.
40193 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
40194 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
40195 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
40199 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
40200 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
40201 .cindex "building DBM files"
40202 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
40203 .cindex "lower casing"
40204 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
40205 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
40206 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
40207 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
40208 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
40209 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
40211 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
40212 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
40213 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
40214 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
40217 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
40218 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
40219 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
40223 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
40224 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two
40225 filenames must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions
40226 create a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
40228 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
40230 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
40231 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
40233 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
40234 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
40235 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
40236 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
40237 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
40238 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the filename.
40240 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
40241 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
40242 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
40243 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
40244 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
40245 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
40246 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
40252 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
40253 .cindex "retry" "times"
40254 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
40255 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
40256 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
40257 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
40258 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
40259 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
40260 output. For example:
40262 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
40263 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
40264 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
40265 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
40266 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
40267 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
40268 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
40269 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
40270 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
40271 past final cutoff time
40273 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
40274 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
40275 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
40276 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
40277 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
40278 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
40281 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
40282 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
40283 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
40284 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
40285 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
40286 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
40290 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
40291 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
40292 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
40293 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
40294 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
40295 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
40296 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
40299 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
40301 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
40304 &'callout'&: the callout cache
40306 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
40308 &'tls'&: TLS session resumption data
40310 &'misc'&: other hints data
40313 The &'misc'& database is used for
40316 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
40317 &(smtp)& transport)
40319 Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
40322 Recording EHLO-time facilities advertised by hosts
40324 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
40329 .subsection "exim_dumpdb" "SECTdumpdb"
40330 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
40331 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
40332 &'exim_dumpdb'& program,
40333 taking as arguments the spool and database names.
40334 An option &'-z'& may be given to request times in UTC;
40335 otherwise times are in the local timezone.
40336 An option &'-k'& may be given to dump only the record keys.
40337 For example, to dump the retry database:
40339 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
40341 For the retry database
40342 two lines of output are produced for each entry:
40344 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
40345 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
40347 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
40348 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
40349 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
40350 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
40351 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
40352 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
40353 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
40354 and a textual description of the error.
40356 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
40357 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
40358 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
40361 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
40362 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
40363 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
40364 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
40365 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
40366 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
40371 .subsection "exim_tidydb" "SECTtidydb"
40372 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
40373 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
40374 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
40375 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
40376 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
40377 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
40378 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
40379 updated sufficiently often.
40381 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
40382 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
40383 the retry database:
40385 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
40387 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
40388 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
40389 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
40390 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
40391 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
40392 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
40393 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
40394 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
40395 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
40396 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
40397 whenever it removes information from the database.
40399 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
40400 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
40401 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
40402 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
40403 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
40405 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
40406 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
40407 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
40408 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
40409 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
40410 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
40411 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
40414 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
40415 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
40420 .subsection "exim_fixdb" "SECTfixdb"
40421 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
40422 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
40423 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
40424 getting round problems in a live system. Its interface
40425 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
40426 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
40429 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
40430 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
40431 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
40432 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
40433 by new data, for example:
40437 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
40438 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
40439 used as optional separators.
40441 Both displayed and input times are in the local timezone by default.
40442 If an option &'-z'& is used on the command line, displayed times
40448 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
40449 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
40450 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
40451 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
40452 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
40453 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
40454 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
40455 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
40456 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
40457 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
40458 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
40459 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
40460 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
40464 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
40467 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
40470 .vitem &%-interval%&
40471 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
40472 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
40474 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
40475 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
40478 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
40481 Suppress verification output.
40483 .vitem &%-retries%&
40484 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
40485 the lock (default 10).
40487 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
40488 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
40489 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
40490 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
40493 .vitem &%-timeout%&
40494 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
40495 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
40496 default), a non-blocking call is used.
40499 Generate verbose output.
40502 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
40503 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
40504 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
40505 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
40506 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
40507 file does not last forever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
40508 more than 30 minutes old.
40510 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
40511 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
40512 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
40513 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
40514 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
40515 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
40517 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
40518 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
40519 suppresses all output except error messages.
40523 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
40525 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
40527 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
40528 <&'some commands'&>
40531 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
40532 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
40535 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
40536 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
40538 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
40539 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
40542 .section "Message Ids for humans (exim_msgdate)" "SECTexim_msgdate"
40543 .cindex "exim_msgdate"
40544 The &'exim_msgdate'& utility is written by Andrew Aitchison and included in the Exim distribution.
40545 This Perl script converts an Exim Mesage ID back into a human readable form.
40546 For details of &'exim_msgdate'&'s options, run &'exim_msgdate'& with the &%--help%& option.
40548 Section &<<SECTmessiden>>& (Message identification) describes Exim Mesage IDs.
40550 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40551 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40553 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
40554 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
40555 .cindex "X-windows"
40556 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
40557 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
40558 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
40559 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
40560 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
40561 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
40562 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
40563 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
40567 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
40568 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
40569 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
40570 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
40571 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
40572 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
40573 parameters are for.
40575 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
40576 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
40577 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
40579 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
40581 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
40582 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
40583 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
40584 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
40585 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
40587 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
40588 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
40590 Eximon*background: gray94
40592 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
40593 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
40594 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
40595 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
40596 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
40597 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
40598 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
40601 Eximon*highlight: gray
40604 .cindex "admin user"
40605 In order to see the contents of messages in the queue, and to operate on them,
40606 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
40608 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
40609 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
40610 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
40611 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
40612 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
40614 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
40615 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
40616 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
40617 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
40618 different parts of the display.
40623 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
40624 .cindex "stripchart"
40625 The first stripchart is always a count of messages in the queue. Its name can
40626 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
40627 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
40628 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
40629 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
40630 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
40631 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
40632 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
40633 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
40635 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
40636 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
40637 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
40638 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
40640 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
40641 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
40642 to a single partition.
40644 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
40645 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
40646 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
40647 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
40648 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
40649 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
40650 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
40655 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
40656 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
40657 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
40658 .cindex "window size"
40659 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
40660 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
40661 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
40662 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
40663 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
40664 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
40666 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
40667 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
40668 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
40669 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
40671 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
40672 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
40673 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
40674 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
40675 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
40676 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
40678 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
40679 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
40680 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
40684 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
40685 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
40686 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
40687 the main log is maintained.
40688 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
40689 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
40690 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
40691 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
40692 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
40694 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
40695 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
40696 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
40697 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
40698 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
40699 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
40700 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
40701 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
40702 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
40703 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
40704 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
40706 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
40707 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
40708 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
40709 It cannot go further back up the log.
40711 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
40712 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
40713 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
40714 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
40715 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
40716 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
40718 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
40719 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
40720 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
40721 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
40722 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
40723 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
40725 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
40726 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
40727 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
40728 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
40729 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
40730 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
40731 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
40732 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
40733 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
40738 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
40739 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
40740 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
40741 are in the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
40742 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
40743 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
40744 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
40745 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
40746 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
40747 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
40749 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
40750 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages in the queue. To help
40751 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
40752 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
40753 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
40754 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
40755 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
40757 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
40758 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
40759 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
40760 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
40761 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
40762 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
40763 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
40765 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
40766 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
40767 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
40768 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
40770 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
40771 time it has been in the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
40772 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
40773 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
40774 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
40775 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
40776 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
40779 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
40780 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
40782 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
40783 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
40784 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
40785 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
40786 display is updated.
40790 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
40791 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
40792 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
40793 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
40794 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
40797 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
40798 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
40799 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
40800 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
40801 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
40803 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
40805 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
40809 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
40810 in a new text window.
40812 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
40813 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
40814 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
40816 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
40817 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
40818 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
40819 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at runtime.
40821 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
40822 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
40823 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
40824 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
40825 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
40827 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
40828 that the message be frozen.
40830 .cindex "thawing messages"
40831 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
40832 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
40833 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
40834 that the message be thawed.
40836 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
40837 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
40838 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
40839 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
40841 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
40842 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
40845 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
40846 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
40847 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
40848 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
40849 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
40850 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
40851 which case no action is taken.
40853 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
40854 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
40855 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
40856 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
40857 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
40858 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
40859 case no action is taken.
40861 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
40862 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
40864 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
40865 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
40866 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
40867 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
40868 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
40869 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
40870 the address is qualified with that domain.
40873 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
40874 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
40875 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
40876 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
40877 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
40878 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
40879 if no output is generated.
40881 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
40882 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
40883 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
40884 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
40886 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
40887 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
40888 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
40895 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40896 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40898 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
40899 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
40900 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
40901 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
40903 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
40904 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
40905 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
40906 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
40907 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
40908 its security as compared with other MTAs.
40910 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
40911 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
40912 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
40913 as soon as possible.
40916 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
40917 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
40918 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
40919 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
40920 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
40921 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
40924 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
40925 start of any filenames used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these
40926 filenames are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if
40927 the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
40928 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
40929 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
40931 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
40932 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
40933 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
40934 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
40937 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
40938 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
40939 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
40940 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
40941 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
40942 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
40943 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
40944 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
40945 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
40949 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
40950 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
40951 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
40952 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
40953 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
40954 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
40955 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
40957 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
40960 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
40961 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
40962 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
40963 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
40964 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
40969 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
40971 .cindex "root privilege"
40972 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
40973 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
40974 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
40975 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
40976 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
40977 is required for two things:
40980 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
40981 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
40984 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
40985 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
40989 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
40990 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
40991 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
40992 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
40993 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
40994 group"&. Their values can be changed by the runtime configuration, though this
40995 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
40996 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
40998 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
40999 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
41000 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
41002 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
41003 uid and gid in the following cases:
41008 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
41009 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
41010 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
41011 the calling process.
41012 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
41013 option may not be used at all.
41014 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
41015 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
41016 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
41021 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
41022 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
41025 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
41026 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
41027 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
41028 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
41029 testing address verification
41032 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
41035 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
41036 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
41039 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
41042 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
41043 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
41044 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
41045 will be used during message reception.
41047 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
41048 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
41050 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution,
41051 but any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
41052 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid. For local
41053 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox; for
41054 remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used. Once all the delivery
41055 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
41056 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
41057 generating bounce and warning messages.
41059 While the recipient addresses in a message are being routed, the delivery
41060 process runs as root. However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
41061 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
41062 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
41064 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
41065 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
41071 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
41072 .cindex "privilege, running without"
41073 .cindex "unprivileged running"
41074 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
41075 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
41076 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
41077 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
41078 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
41079 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
41080 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
41084 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
41085 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
41086 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
41087 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
41089 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
41090 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
41091 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
41092 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
41093 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
41095 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
41096 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
41097 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
41100 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
41101 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
41102 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
41104 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
41105 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
41106 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
41107 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
41108 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
41109 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
41110 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
41111 address this problem at this time.
41113 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
41114 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
41115 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
41116 be used in the most straightforward way.
41118 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
41119 number of restrictions on what you can do:
41122 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
41123 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
41124 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
41125 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
41126 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
41128 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
41129 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
41131 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
41132 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
41133 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
41134 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
41136 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
41137 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
41140 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
41141 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
41142 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
41144 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
41145 owned by the Exim user.
41147 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
41148 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
41149 mailboxes need to be created manually.
41154 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
41155 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
41156 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
41157 gives more security at essentially no cost.
41159 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
41160 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
41165 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
41166 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
41167 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
41171 .section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
41172 .cindex "security" "local commands"
41173 .cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
41174 There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
41175 commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
41176 configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
41177 run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
41180 Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
41181 injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
41182 be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
41183 allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
41184 has &%use_shell%& enabled.
41186 A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
41187 &%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
41188 &_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
41189 hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
41190 NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
41191 forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
41192 need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
41194 The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
41195 administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
41196 Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
41198 Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
41199 taint checking might apply to their usage.
41201 Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
41202 administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
41203 instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
41205 Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
41206 Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
41207 each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
41209 The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
41210 real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
41211 injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
41212 Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
41218 .section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
41219 .cindex "security" "data sources"
41220 .cindex "security" "regular expressions"
41221 .cindex "regular expressions" "security"
41222 .cindex "PCRE2" "security"
41223 If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
41224 are some issues to be aware of:
41227 Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
41229 Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
41231 Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
41232 data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE2. Be aware of what
41233 "backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
41234 expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
41235 when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
41236 possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
41239 It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
41240 &%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
41241 items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
41243 Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
41244 expected to yield one result.
41250 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
41251 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
41252 .cindex "IP source routing"
41253 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
41254 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
41255 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
41256 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
41260 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
41261 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
41262 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
41267 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
41268 .cindex "trusted users"
41269 .cindex "admin user"
41270 .cindex "privileged user"
41271 .cindex "user" "trusted"
41272 .cindex "user" "admin"
41273 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
41274 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
41275 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
41276 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
41277 permit a remote host to be specified.
41280 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
41281 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
41282 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
41283 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
41284 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
41285 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
41287 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
41288 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
41289 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
41290 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
41291 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
41293 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
41294 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
41295 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
41296 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
41297 includes the contents of files on the spool.
41301 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
41302 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
41303 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
41304 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
41305 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
41306 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
41308 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
41309 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
41310 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
41311 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
41312 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
41313 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
41316 By default, regular users are trusted to perform basic testing and
41317 introspection commands, as themselves. This setting can be tightened by
41318 setting the &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& option.
41319 This affects most of the checking options,
41320 such as &%-be%& and anything else &%-b*%&.
41323 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
41324 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
41325 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
41326 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
41327 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
41328 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
41332 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
41333 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
41334 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
41335 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
41336 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
41341 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
41342 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
41343 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
41344 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
41349 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
41350 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
41351 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
41352 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
41353 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
41357 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
41358 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
41359 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
41363 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
41364 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
41365 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
41366 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
41367 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
41368 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
41369 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
41371 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
41372 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
41377 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
41378 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
41379 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
41380 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
41384 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
41385 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
41386 enough to hold the result.
41387 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
41392 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41393 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41395 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
41396 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
41397 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
41398 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
41399 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
41400 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
41401 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
41402 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
41403 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
41404 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
41405 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
41406 themselves are recoverable.
41408 The file formats may be changed, or new formats added, at any release.
41409 Spool files are not intended as an interface to other programs
41410 and should not be used as such.
41412 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
41413 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
41414 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
41417 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
41418 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
41419 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
41420 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
41421 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
41423 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
41424 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
41425 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect and can
41426 cause incomplete transmission of messages or undeliverable messages.
41428 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
41430 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
41433 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
41435 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
41436 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
41437 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
41438 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
41439 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
41440 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
41441 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
41442 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
41445 Files whose names end with -K or .eml may also be seen in the spool.
41446 These are temporaries used for DKIM or malware processing, when that is used.
41447 They should be tidied up by normal operations; any old ones are probably
41448 relics of crashes and can be removed.
41450 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
41451 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
41452 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
41453 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
41454 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
41455 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
41456 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
41457 normally the Exim user.
41459 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
41460 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
41461 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
41462 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
41463 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
41464 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
41465 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
41466 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
41468 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
41469 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
41470 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
41471 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
41473 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen.
41474 These contain variables, can appear in any
41475 order, and are omitted when not relevant.
41477 If there is a second hyphen after the first,
41478 the corresponding data is tainted.
41479 If there is a value in parentheses, the data is quoted for a lookup.
41481 The following word specifies a variable,
41482 and the remainder of the item depends on the variable.
41485 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
41486 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
41487 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
41488 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
41489 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
41490 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
41491 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
41492 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
41493 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
41496 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
41497 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
41498 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
41499 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
41500 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
41501 character. It may contain internal newlines.
41503 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
41504 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
41505 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
41506 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
41507 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
41508 character. It may contain internal newlines.
41510 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
41511 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
41512 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
41514 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
41515 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
41516 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
41517 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
41518 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
41520 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
41521 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
41522 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
41523 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
41524 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
41526 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
41527 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
41528 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
41530 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
41531 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
41532 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
41534 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
41535 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is
41536 present unless &%-spool_file_wireformat%& is.
41538 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
41539 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
41540 present if the number is greater than zero.
41542 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
41543 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
41544 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
41546 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
41547 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
41548 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
41550 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
41551 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
41554 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
41555 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
41556 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
41559 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
41560 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
41561 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
41562 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
41564 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
41565 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
41566 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
41568 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
41569 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
41570 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
41571 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
41572 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
41573 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
41575 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
41576 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
41577 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
41578 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
41579 supplied by the remote host, if any.
41581 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
41582 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
41583 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
41584 generated messages.
41587 The message is from a local sender.
41589 .vitem &%-localerror%&
41590 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
41592 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
41593 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
41594 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
41595 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
41597 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
41598 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
41599 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
41602 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
41603 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
41606 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
41607 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
41608 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
41610 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
41611 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
41612 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
41614 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
41615 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
41616 of &$spam_score_int$&.
41618 .vitem &%-spool_file_wireformat%&
41619 The -D file for this message is in wire-format (for ESMTP CHUNKING)
41620 rather than Unix-format.
41621 The line-ending is CRLF rather than newline.
41622 There is still, however, no leading-dot-stuffing.
41624 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
41625 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
41626 certificate was verified by the server.
41628 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
41629 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
41630 name of the cipher suite that was used.
41632 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
41633 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
41634 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
41638 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
41639 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
41640 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
41641 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
41642 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
41643 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
41644 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
41645 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
41646 addresses are complete.
41648 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
41649 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
41650 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
41651 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
41652 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
41653 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
41655 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
41656 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
41657 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
41659 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
41660 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
41661 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
41662 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
41666 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
41667 darcy@austen.fict.example
41669 alice@wonderland.fict.example
41671 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
41672 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
41673 line is of the following form:
41675 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
41676 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
41678 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
41679 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
41680 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
41681 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
41682 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
41683 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
41684 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
41685 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
41688 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
41689 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
41690 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
41691 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
41692 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
41696 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
41697 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
41698 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
41699 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
41700 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
41701 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
41702 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
41703 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
41704 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
41705 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
41708 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
41709 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
41710 typical set of headers:
41712 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
41713 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
41714 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
41715 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
41716 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
41717 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
41718 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
41719 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
41720 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
41721 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
41722 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
41724 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
41725 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
41726 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
41727 .ecindex IIDforspo1
41728 .ecindex IIDforspo2
41729 .ecindex IIDforspo3
41731 .section "Format of the -D file" "SECID282a"
41732 The data file is traditionally in Unix-standard format: lines are ended with
41733 an ASCII newline character.
41734 However, when the &%spool_wireformat%& main option is used some -D files
41735 can have an alternate format.
41736 This is flagged by a &%-spool_file_wireformat%& line in the corresponding -H file.
41737 The -D file lines (not including the first name-component line) are
41738 suitable for direct copying to the wire when transmitting using the
41739 ESMTP CHUNKING option, meaning lower processing overhead.
41740 Lines are terminated with an ASCII CRLF pair.
41741 There is no dot-stuffing (and no dot-termination).
41743 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41744 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41746 .chapter "DKIM, SPF, SRS and DMARC" "CHAPdkim" &&&
41747 "DKIM, SPF, SRS and DMARC Support"
41749 .section "DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" SECDKIM
41752 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
41753 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
41754 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
41755 DKIM is documented in RFC 6376.
41757 As DKIM relies on the message being unchanged in transit, messages handled
41758 by a mailing-list (which traditionally adds to the message) will not match
41759 any original DKIM signature.
41761 DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default if TLS support is present.
41762 It can be disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
41764 Exim's DKIM implementation allows for
41766 Signing outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
41767 It can co-exist with all other Exim features
41768 (including transport filters) except cutthrough delivery.
41769 However, signing options may not depend on headers modified by
41770 routers, the transport or a transport filter.
41772 Verifying signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
41773 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
41774 different signature contexts.
41777 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
41778 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
41779 Exim's standard controls.
41781 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
41782 on by default for logging (in the <= line) purposes.
41784 Additional log detail can be enabled using the &%dkim_verbose%& log_selector.
41785 When set, for each signature in incoming email,
41786 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
41787 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
41789 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
41790 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
41791 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
41792 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
41795 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
41796 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
41797 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
41798 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
41802 .subsection "Signing outgoing messages" SECDKIMSIGN
41803 .cindex DKIM signing
41805 For signing to be usable you must have published a DKIM record in DNS.
41806 Note that RFC 8301 (which does not cover EC keys) says:
41808 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
41810 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
41811 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
41814 Note also that the key content (the 'p=' field)
41815 in the DNS record is different between RSA and EC keys;
41816 for the former it is the base64 of the ASN.1 for the RSA public key
41817 (equivalent to the private-key .pem with the header/trailer stripped)
41818 but for EC keys it is the base64 of the pure key; no ASN.1 wrapping.
41820 Signing is enabled by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
41821 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
41823 .option dkim_domain smtp "string list&!!" unset
41824 The domain(s) you want to sign with.
41825 After expansion, this can be a list.
41826 Each element in turn,
41828 .vindex "&$dkim_domain$&"
41829 is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable
41830 while expanding the remaining signing options.
41831 If it is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done,
41832 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
41834 .option dkim_selector smtp "string list&!!" unset
41835 This sets the key selector string.
41836 After expansion, which can use &$dkim_domain$&, this can be a list.
41837 Each element in turn is put in the expansion
41838 .vindex "&$dkim_selector$&"
41839 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which may be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
41840 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
41841 If the option is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done for this domain,
41842 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
41844 To do, for example, dual-signing with RSA and EC keys
41845 this could be be used:
41847 dkim_selector = ec_sel : rsa_sel
41848 dkim_private_key = KEYS_DIR/$dkim_selector
41851 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
41852 This sets the private key to use.
41853 You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
41854 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
41855 The result can either
41857 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor (.pem file), including line breaks
41859 with GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
41860 be a valid Ed25519 private key (same format as above)
41862 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
41865 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
41866 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
41870 To generate keys under OpenSSL:
41872 openssl genrsa -out dkim_rsa.private 2048
41873 openssl rsa -in dkim_rsa.private -out /dev/stdout -pubout -outform PEM
41875 The result file from the first command should be retained, and
41876 this option set to use it.
41877 Take the base-64 lines from the output of the second command, concatenated,
41878 for the DNS TXT record.
41879 See section 3.6 of RFC6376 for the record specification.
41883 certtool --generate-privkey --rsa --bits=2048 --password='' -8 --outfile=dkim_rsa.private
41884 certtool --load-privkey=dkim_rsa.private --pubkey-info
41887 Note that RFC 8301 says:
41889 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
41890 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
41893 EC keys for DKIM are defined by RFC 8463.
41894 They are considerably smaller than RSA keys for equivalent protection.
41895 As they are a recent development, users should consider dual-signing
41896 (by setting a list of selectors, and an expansion for this option)
41897 for some transition period.
41898 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
41901 OpenSSL 1.1.1 and GnuTLS 3.6.0 can create Ed25519 private keys:
41903 openssl genpkey -algorithm ed25519 -out dkim_ed25519.private
41904 certtool --generate-privkey --key-type=ed25519 --outfile=dkim_ed25519.private
41907 To produce the required public key value for a DNS record:
41909 openssl pkey -outform DER -pubout -in dkim_ed25519.private | tail -c +13 | base64
41910 certtool --load_privkey=dkim_ed25519.private --pubkey_info --outder | tail -c +13 | base64
41913 Exim also supports an alternate format
41914 of Ed25519 keys in DNS which was a candidate during development
41915 of the standard, but not adopted.
41916 A future release will probably drop that support.
41918 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
41919 Can be set to any one of the supported hash methods, which are:
41921 &`sha1`& &-- should not be used, is old and insecure
41923 &`sha256`& &-- the default
41925 &`sha512`& &-- possibly more secure but less well supported
41928 Note that RFC 8301 says:
41930 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
41933 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
41934 If set after expansion, the value is used to set an "i=" tag in
41935 the signing header. The DKIM standards restrict the permissible
41936 syntax of this optional tag to a mail address, with possibly-empty
41937 local part, an @, and a domain identical to or subdomain of the "d="
41938 tag value. Note that Exim does not check the value.
41940 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
41941 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
41942 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
41943 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
41944 only supports signing with the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
41946 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
41947 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
41948 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
41949 either &"1"& or &"true"&, Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
41950 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
41953 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "see below"
41954 If set, this option must expand to a colon-separated
41955 list of header names.
41956 Headers with these names, or the absence of such a header, will be included
41957 in the message signature.
41958 When unspecified, the header names listed in RFC4871 will be used,
41959 whether or not each header is present in the message.
41960 The default list is available for the expansion in the macro
41961 &"_DKIM_SIGN_HEADERS"&
41962 and an oversigning variant is in &"_DKIM_OVERSIGN_HEADERS"&.
41964 If a name is repeated, multiple headers by that name (or the absence thereof)
41965 will be signed. The textually later headers in the headers part of the
41966 message are signed first, if there are multiples.
41968 A name can be prefixed with either an &"="& or a &"+"& character.
41969 If an &"="& prefix is used, all headers that are present with this name
41971 If a &"+"& prefix if used, all headers that are present with this name
41972 will be signed, and one signature added for a missing header with the
41973 name will be appended.
41975 .option dkim_timestamps smtp integer&!! unset
41976 This option controls the inclusion of timestamp information in the signature.
41977 If not set, no such information will be included.
41978 Otherwise, must be an unsigned number giving an offset in seconds from the
41979 current time for the expiry tag (e.g. 1209600 for two weeks); both creation
41980 (t=) and expiry (x=) tags will be included unless the offset is 0 (no expiry).
41982 RFC 6376 lists these tags as RECOMMENDED.
41985 .subsection "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" SECDKIMVFY
41986 .cindex DKIM verification
41988 Verification of DKIM signatures in SMTP incoming email is done for all
41989 messages for which an ACL control &%dkim_disable_verify%& has not been set.
41991 .cindex DKIM "selecting signature algorithms"
41992 Individual classes of DKIM signature algorithm can be ignored by changing
41993 the main options &%dkim_verify_hashes%& or &%dkim_verify_keytypes%&.
41994 The &%dkim_verify_minimal%& option can be set to cease verification
41995 processing for a message once the first passing signature is found.
41997 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
41998 Performing verification sets up information used by the
41999 &%authresults%& expansion item.
42001 For most purposes the default option settings suffice and the remainder
42002 of this section can be ignored.
42004 The results of verification are made available to the
42005 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL, which (for complex needs) can examine and modify them.
42006 A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
42007 By default, the ACL is called once for each
42008 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
42009 If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
42010 If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message, that is
42011 summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
42013 To evaluate the verification result in the ACL
42014 a large number of expansion variables
42015 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
42016 runtime of the ACL.
42018 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
42019 more advanced policies. For that reason, the main option
42020 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and an expansion variable
42021 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
42023 The main option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
42024 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
42025 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
42026 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
42027 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
42028 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
42031 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
42033 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
42034 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
42035 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
42037 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
42039 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
42040 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
42041 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
42043 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
42046 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
42047 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
42049 Note that if the option is set using untrustworthy data
42050 (such as the From: header)
42051 care should be taken to force lowercase for domains
42052 and for the domain part if identities.
42053 The default setting can be regarded as trustworthy in this respect.
42055 If multiple signatures match a domain (or identity), the ACL is called once
42056 for each matching signature.
42059 Inside the DKIM ACL, the following expansion variables are
42060 available (from most to least important):
42064 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
42065 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
42066 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
42067 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
42069 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
42070 So long as a DKIM ACL is defined
42071 (it need do no more than accept, which is the default),
42072 after all the DKIM ACL runs have completed, the value becomes a
42073 colon-separated list of the values after each run.
42074 The value is maintained for the MIME, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
42076 Within the DKIM ACL,
42077 a string describing the general status of the signature. One of
42079 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
42080 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
42082 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
42083 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
42085 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
42086 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
42088 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
42091 This variable can be overwritten using an ACL 'set' modifier.
42092 This might, for instance, be done to enforce a policy restriction on
42093 hash-method or key-size:
42095 warn condition = ${if eq {$dkim_verify_status}{pass}}
42096 condition = ${if eq {${length_3:$dkim_algo}}{rsa}}
42097 condition = ${if or {{eq {$dkim_algo}{rsa-sha1}} \
42098 {< {$dkim_key_length}{1024}}}}
42099 logwrite = NOTE: forcing DKIM verify fail (was pass)
42100 set dkim_verify_status = fail
42101 set dkim_verify_reason = hash too weak or key too short
42104 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
42105 A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
42106 "fail" or "invalid". One of
42108 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
42109 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
42111 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
42112 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
42114 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
42115 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
42116 means that the message body was modified in transit.
42118 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
42119 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
42120 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
42121 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
42124 This variable can be overwritten, with any value, using an ACL 'set' modifier.
42126 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
42127 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
42128 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
42129 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
42131 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
42132 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
42133 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
42134 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
42136 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
42137 The key record selector string.
42139 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
42140 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
42141 If running under GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
42142 may also be 'ed25519-sha256'.
42143 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
42146 Note that RFC 8301 says:
42148 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
42150 DKIM signatures identified as having been signed with historic
42151 algorithms (currently, rsa-sha1) have permanently failed evaluation
42154 To enforce this you must either have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
42155 and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above,
42156 or have set the main option &%dkim_verify_hashes%& to exclude
42157 processing of such signatures.
42159 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
42160 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
42162 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_headers%&
42163 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
42165 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
42166 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
42167 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
42168 Note that RFC6376 requires that verification fail if the From: header is
42169 not included in the signature. Exim does not enforce this; sites wishing
42170 strict enforcement should code the check explicitly.
42172 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
42173 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
42174 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
42175 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
42176 &*Note:*& The presence of the signature tag specifying a signing body length
42177 is one possible route to spoofing of valid DKIM signatures.
42178 A paranoid implementation might wish to regard signature where this variable
42179 shows less than the "no limit" return as being invalid.
42181 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
42182 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
42183 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
42185 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
42186 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
42187 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
42188 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
42189 integer size comparisons against this value.
42190 Note that Exim does not check this value.
42192 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
42193 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
42195 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
42196 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
42198 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
42199 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
42201 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
42202 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
42205 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
42206 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
42209 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
42210 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
42212 .vitem &%$dkim_key_length%&
42213 Number of bits in the key.
42214 Valid only once the key is loaded, which is at the time the header signature
42215 is verified, which is after the body hash is.
42217 Note that RFC 8301 says:
42219 Verifiers MUST NOT consider signatures using RSA keys of
42220 less than 1024 bits as valid signatures.
42223 This is enforced by the default setting for the &%dkim_verify_min_keysizes%&
42228 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
42231 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
42232 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
42233 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
42234 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
42235 This condition is only usable in a DKIM ACL.
42236 This is typically used to restrict an ACL
42237 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
42240 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no gmail signature
42241 warn sender_domains = gmail.com
42242 dkim_signers = gmail.com
42244 log_message = GMail sender without gmail.com DKIM signature
42247 Note that the above does not check for a total lack of DKIM signing;
42248 for that check for empty &$h_DKIM-Signature:$& in the data ACL.
42250 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
42251 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
42252 results against the actual result of verification,
42253 given by &$dkim_verify_status$& if that is non-empty or "none" if empty.
42254 This condition may be used in DKIM, MIME, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
42256 A basic verification might be:
42258 deny !dkim_status = pass:none:invalid
42261 A more complex use could be
42262 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
42265 deny sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
42266 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
42267 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
42268 message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
42271 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
42272 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
42273 for more information of what they mean.
42275 The condition is true if the status
42276 (or any of the list of status values)
42277 is any one of the supplied list.
42283 .section "SPF (Sender Policy Framework)" SECSPF
42284 .cindex SPF verification
42286 SPF is a mechanism whereby a domain may assert which IP addresses may transmit
42287 messages with its domain in the envelope from, documented by RFC 7208.
42288 For more information on SPF see &url(http://www.open-spf.org), a static copy of
42289 the &url(http://openspf.org).
42290 . --- 2019-10-28: still not https, open-spf.org is told to be a
42291 . --- web-archive copy of the now dead openspf.org site
42292 . --- See https://www.mail-archive.com/mailop@mailop.org/msg08019.html for a
42295 Messages sent by a system not authorised will fail checking of such assertions.
42296 This includes retransmissions done by traditional forwarders.
42298 SPF verification support is built into Exim if SUPPORT_SPF=yes is set in
42299 &_Local/Makefile_&. The support uses the &_libspf2_& library
42300 &url(https://www.libspf2.org/).
42301 There is no Exim involvement in the transmission of messages;
42302 publishing certain DNS records is all that is required.
42304 For verification, an ACL condition and an expansion lookup are provided.
42305 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
42306 Performing verification sets up information used by the
42307 &%authresults%& expansion item.
42310 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
42311 .cindex ACL "spf condition"
42312 The ACL condition "spf" can be used at or after the MAIL ACL.
42313 It takes as an argument a list of strings giving the outcome of the SPF check,
42314 and will succeed for any matching outcome.
42318 The SPF check passed, the sending host is positively verified by SPF.
42321 The SPF check failed, the sending host is NOT allowed to send mail for the
42322 domain in the envelope-from address.
42324 .vitem &%softfail%&
42325 The SPF check failed, but the queried domain can't absolutely confirm that this
42329 The queried domain does not publish SPF records.
42332 The SPF check returned a "neutral" state. This means the queried domain has
42333 published a SPF record, but wants to allow outside servers to send mail under
42334 its domain as well. This should be treated like "none".
42336 .vitem &%permerror%&
42337 This indicates a syntax error in the SPF record of the queried domain.
42338 You may deny messages when this occurs.
42340 .vitem &%temperror%&
42341 This indicates a temporary error during all processing, including Exim's
42342 SPF processing. You may defer messages when this occurs.
42345 There was an error during processing of the SPF lookup
42348 You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert
42349 its meaning, for example "!fail" will match all results but
42350 "fail". The string list is evaluated left-to-right, in a
42351 short-circuit fashion.
42356 message = $sender_host_address is not allowed to send mail from \
42357 ${if def:sender_address_domain \
42358 {$sender_address_domain}{$sender_helo_name}}. \
42359 Please see http://www.open-spf.org/Why;\
42360 identity=${if def:sender_address_domain \
42361 {$sender_address}{$sender_helo_name}};\
42362 ip=$sender_host_address
42365 Note: The above mentioned URL may not be as helpful as expected. You are
42366 encouraged to replace the link with a link to a site with more
42369 When the spf condition has run, it sets up several expansion
42372 .cindex SPF "verification variables"
42374 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$&
42375 .vindex &$spf_header_comment$&
42376 This contains a human-readable string describing the outcome
42377 of the SPF check. You can add it to a custom header or use
42378 it for logging purposes.
42380 .vitem &$spf_received$&
42381 .vindex &$spf_received$&
42382 This contains a complete Received-SPF: header (name and
42383 content) that can be added to the message. Please note that
42384 according to the SPF draft, this header must be added at the
42385 top of the header list, i.e. with
42387 add_header = :at_start:$spf_received
42389 See section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>& for further details.
42391 Note: in case of "Best-guess" (see below), the convention is
42392 to put this string in a header called X-SPF-Guess: instead.
42394 .vitem &$spf_result$&
42395 .vindex &$spf_result$&
42396 This contains the outcome of the SPF check in string form,
42397 currently one of pass, fail, softfail, none, neutral, permerror,
42398 temperror, or &"(invalid)"&.
42400 .vitem &$spf_result_guessed$&
42401 .vindex &$spf_result_guessed$&
42402 This boolean is true only if a best-guess operation was used
42403 and required in order to obtain a result.
42405 .vitem &$spf_smtp_comment$&
42406 .vindex &$spf_smtp_comment$&
42407 .vindex &%spf_smtp_comment_template%&
42408 This contains a string that can be used in a SMTP response
42409 to the calling party. Useful for "fail".
42410 The string is generated by the SPF library from the template configured in the main config
42411 option &%spf_smtp_comment_template%&.
42415 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
42416 .cindex ACL "spf_guess condition"
42417 .cindex SPF "best guess"
42418 In addition to SPF, you can also perform checks for so-called
42419 "Best-guess". Strictly speaking, "Best-guess" is not standard
42420 SPF, but it is supported by the same framework that enables SPF
42422 Refer to &url(http://www.open-spf.org/FAQ/Best_guess_record)
42423 for a description of what it means.
42424 . --- 2019-10-28: still not https:
42426 To access this feature, simply use the spf_guess condition in place
42427 of the spf one. For example:
42430 deny spf_guess = fail
42431 message = $sender_host_address doesn't look trustworthy to me
42434 In case you decide to reject messages based on this check, you
42435 should note that although it uses the same framework, "Best-guess"
42436 is not SPF, and therefore you should not mention SPF at all in your
42439 When the spf_guess condition has run, it sets up the same expansion
42440 variables as when spf condition is run, described above.
42442 Additionally, since Best-guess is not standardized, you may redefine
42443 what "Best-guess" means to you by redefining the main configuration
42444 &%spf_guess%& option.
42445 For example, the following:
42448 spf_guess = v=spf1 a/16 mx/16 ptr ?all
42451 would relax host matching rules to a broader network range.
42454 .cindex SPF "lookup expansion"
42456 A lookup expansion is also available. It takes an email
42457 address as the key and an IP address
42462 ${lookup {username@domain} spf {ip.ip.ip.ip}}
42465 The lookup will return the same result strings as can appear in
42466 &$spf_result$& (pass,fail,softfail,neutral,none,err_perm,err_temp).
42472 .subsection "SRS (Sender Rewriting Scheme)" SECTSRS
42473 .cindex SRS "sender rewriting scheme"
42474 .cindex VERP "variable envelope return path"
42476 SRS can be used to modify sender addresses when forwarding so that
42477 SPF verification does not object to them.
42478 It can also be used to identify a received bounce message as
42479 likely (or not) having been trigged by a message from the
42480 local system, and for identifying dead addresses in mailing lists.
42481 It is one implementation of a VERP (Variable Envelope Return Path) method.
42483 SRS operates by encoding the original envelope sender in a new
42484 sender local part and using a domain run by the forwarding site
42485 as the new domain for the sender. Any DSN message should be returned
42486 to this new sender at the forwarding site, which can extract the
42487 original sender from the coded local part and forward the DSN to
42490 This is a way of avoiding the breakage that SPF does to forwarding.
42491 The constructed local-part will be longer than the original,
42492 leading to possible problems with very long addresses.
42493 The changing of the sender address also hinders the tracing of mail
42496 Exim can be built to include native SRS support. To do this
42497 SUPPORT_SRS=yes must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&.
42498 If this has been done, the macros _HAVE_SRS and _HAVE_NATIVE_SRS
42500 The support is limited to SRS0-encoding; SRS1 is not supported.
42502 .cindex SRS excoding
42503 To encode an address use this expansion item:
42505 .vitem &*${srs_encode&~{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'return&~path'&>&*}{*&<&'original&~domain'&>&*}}*&
42506 .cindex "&%srs_encode%& expansion item"
42507 .cindex SRS "expansion item"
42508 The first argument should be a secret known and used by all systems
42509 handling the recipient domain for the original message.
42510 There is no need to periodically change this key; a timestamp is also
42512 The second argument should be given as the envelope sender address before this
42513 encoding operation.
42514 If this value is empty the the expansion result will be empty.
42515 The third argument should be the recipient domain of the message when
42516 it arrived at this system.
42517 All arguments are expanded before use.
42519 The result of the expansion is the replacement envelope-from (return path)
42523 .cindex SRS decoding
42524 To decode an address use this expansion condition:
42526 .vitem &*inbound_srs&~{*&<&'local&~part'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}*&
42527 The first argument should be the recipient local part as it was received.
42528 The second argument is the site secret.
42529 Both arguments are expanded before use.
42531 If the messages is not for an SRS-encoded recipient the condition will
42533 If it is, the condition will return true and the variable
42534 &$srs_recipient$& will be set to the decoded (original) value.
42536 If the second argument is empty then the condition returns true if
42537 the first argument is in valid SRS formet, else false.
42538 The variable &$srs_recipient$& is not set for this case.
42544 SRS_SECRET = <pick something unique for your site for this. Use on all MXs.>
42550 # if outbound, and forwarding has been done, use an alternate transport
42551 domains = ! +my_domains
42552 transport = ${if eq {$local_part@$domain} \
42553 {$original_local_part@$original_domain} \
42554 {remote_smtp} {remote_forwarded_smtp}}
42559 domains = +my_domains
42560 # detect inbound bounces which are SRS'd, and decode them
42561 condition = ${if inbound_srs {$local_part} {SRS_SECRET}}
42562 data = $srs_recipient
42564 inbound_srs_failure:
42567 domains = +my_domains
42568 # detect inbound bounces which look SRS'd but are invalid
42569 condition = ${if inbound_srs {$local_part} {}}
42571 data = :fail: Invalid SRS recipient address
42573 #... further routers here get inbound_srs-redirected recipients
42574 # and any that were not SRS'd
42577 # transport; should look like the non-forward outbound
42578 # one, plus the max_rcpt and return_path options
42579 remote_forwarded_smtp:
42581 # single-recipient so that $original_domain is valid
42583 # modify the envelope from, for mails that we forward
42584 return_path = ${srs_encode {SRS_SECRET} {$return_path} {$original_domain}}
42591 .section DMARC SECDMARC
42592 .cindex DMARC verification
42594 DMARC combines feedback from SPF, DKIM, and header From: in order
42595 to attempt to provide better indicators of the authenticity of an
42596 email. This document does not explain the fundamentals; you
42597 should read and understand how it works by visiting the website at
42598 &url(http://www.dmarc.org/).
42600 If Exim is built with DMARC support,
42601 the libopendmarc library is used.
42603 For building Exim yourself, obtain the library from
42604 &url(http://sourceforge.net/projects/opendmarc/)
42605 to obtain a copy, or find it in your favorite package
42606 repository. You will need to attend to the local/Makefile feature
42607 SUPPORT_DMARC and the associated LDFLAGS addition.
42608 This description assumes
42609 that headers will be in /usr/local/include, and that the libraries
42610 are in /usr/local/lib.
42612 .subsection Configuration SSECDMARCCONFIG
42613 .cindex DMARC configuration
42615 There are three main-configuration options:
42616 .cindex DMARC "configuration options"
42618 The &%dmarc_tld_file%& option
42619 .oindex &%dmarc_tld_file%&
42620 defines the location of a text file of valid
42621 top level domains the opendmarc library uses
42622 during domain parsing. Maintained by Mozilla,
42623 the most current version can be downloaded
42624 from a link at &url(https://publicsuffix.org/list/public_suffix_list.dat).
42625 See also the util/renew-opendmarc-tlds.sh script.
42626 The default for the option is unset.
42627 If not set, DMARC processing is disabled.
42630 The &%dmarc_history_file%& option, if set
42631 .oindex &%dmarc_history_file%&
42632 defines the location of a file to log results
42633 of dmarc verification on inbound emails. The
42634 contents are importable by the opendmarc tools
42635 which will manage the data, send out DMARC
42636 reports, and expire the data. Make sure the
42637 directory of this file is writable by the user
42639 The default is unset.
42641 The &%dmarc_forensic_sender%& option
42642 .oindex &%dmarc_forensic_sender%&
42643 defines an alternate email address to use when sending a
42644 forensic report detailing alignment failures
42645 if a sender domain's dmarc record specifies it
42646 and you have configured Exim to send them.
42647 If set, this is expanded and used for the
42648 From: header line; the address is extracted
42649 from it and used for the envelope from.
42650 If not set (the default), the From: header is expanded from
42651 the dsn_from option, and <> is used for the
42654 .subsection Controls SSECDMARCCONTROLS
42655 .cindex DMARC controls
42657 By default, the DMARC processing will run for any remote,
42658 non-authenticated user. It makes sense to only verify DMARC
42659 status of messages coming from remote, untrusted sources. You can
42660 use standard conditions such as hosts, senders, etc, to decide that
42661 DMARC verification should *not* be performed for them and disable
42662 DMARC with an ACL control modifier:
42664 control = dmarc_disable_verify
42666 A DMARC record can also specify a "forensic address", which gives
42667 exim an email address to submit reports about failed alignment.
42668 Exim does not do this by default because in certain conditions it
42669 results in unintended information leakage (what lists a user might
42670 be subscribed to, etc). You must configure exim to submit forensic
42671 reports to the owner of the domain. If the DMARC record contains a
42672 forensic address and you specify the control statement below, then
42673 exim will send these forensic emails. It is also advised that you
42674 configure a &%dmarc_forensic_sender%& because the default sender address
42675 construction might be inadequate.
42677 control = dmarc_enable_forensic
42679 (AGAIN: You can choose not to send these forensic reports by simply
42680 not putting the dmarc_enable_forensic control line at any point in
42681 your exim config. If you don't tell exim to send them, it will not
42684 There are no options to either control. Both must appear before
42687 .subsection ACL SSECDMARCACL
42688 .cindex DMARC "ACL condition"
42690 DMARC checks can be run on incoming SMTP messages by using the
42691 &"dmarc_status"& ACL condition in the DATA ACL. You are required to
42692 call the &"spf"& condition first in the ACLs, then the &"dmarc_status"&
42693 condition. Putting this condition in the ACLs is required in order
42694 for a DMARC check to actually occur. All of the variables are set
42695 up before the DATA ACL, but there is no actual DMARC check that
42696 occurs until a &"dmarc_status"& condition is encountered in the ACLs.
42698 The &"dmarc_status"& condition takes a list of strings on its
42699 right-hand side. These strings describe recommended action based
42700 on the DMARC check. To understand what the policy recommendations
42701 mean, refer to the DMARC website above. Valid strings are:
42702 .itable none 0 0 2 20* left 80* left
42703 .irow &'accept'& "The DMARC check passed and the library recommends accepting the email"
42704 .irow &'reject'& "The DMARC check failed and the library recommends rejecting the email"
42705 .irow &'quarantine'& "The DMARC check failed and the library recommends keeping it for further inspection"
42706 .irow &'none'& "The DMARC check passed and the library recommends no specific action, neutral"
42707 .irow &'norecord'& "No policy section in the DMARC record for this RFC5322.From field"
42708 .irow &'nofrom'& "Unable to determine the domain of the sender"
42709 .irow &'temperror'& "Library error or dns error"
42710 .irow &'off'& "The DMARC check was disabled for this email"
42712 You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert its
42713 meaning, for example "!accept" will match all results but
42714 "accept". The string list is evaluated left-to-right in a
42715 short-circuit fashion. When a string matches the outcome of the
42716 DMARC check, the condition succeeds. If none of the listed
42717 strings matches the outcome of the DMARC check, the condition
42720 Of course, you can also use any other lookup method that Exim
42721 supports, including LDAP, Postgres, MySQL, etc, as long as the
42722 result is a list of colon-separated strings.
42724 Performing the check sets up information used by the
42725 &%authresults%& expansion item.
42727 Several expansion variables are set before the DATA ACL is
42728 processed, and you can use them in this ACL. The following
42729 expansion variables are available:
42732 .vitem &$dmarc_status$&
42733 .vindex &$dmarc_status$&
42734 .cindex DMARC result
42735 A one word status indicating what the DMARC library
42736 thinks of the email. It is a combination of the results of
42737 DMARC record lookup and the SPF/DKIM/DMARC processing results
42738 (if a DMARC record was found). The actual policy declared
42739 in the DMARC record is in a separate expansion variable.
42741 .vitem &$dmarc_status_text$&
42742 .vindex &$dmarc_status_text$&
42743 Slightly longer, human readable status.
42745 .vitem &$dmarc_used_domain$&
42746 .vindex &$dmarc_used_domain$&
42747 The domain which DMARC used to look up the DMARC policy record.
42749 .vitem &$dmarc_domain_policy$&
42750 .vindex &$dmarc_domain_policy$&
42751 The policy declared in the DMARC record. Valid values
42752 are "none", "reject" and "quarantine". It is blank when there
42753 is any error, including no DMARC record.
42756 .subsection Logging SSECDMARCLOGGING
42757 .cindex DMARC logging
42759 By default, Exim's DMARC configuration is intended to be
42760 non-intrusive and conservative. To facilitate this, Exim will not
42761 create any type of logging files without explicit configuration by
42762 you, the admin. Nor will Exim send out any emails/reports about
42763 DMARC issues without explicit configuration by you, the admin (other
42764 than typical bounce messages that may come about due to ACL
42765 processing or failure delivery issues).
42767 In order to log statistics suitable to be imported by the opendmarc
42768 tools, you need to:
42770 Configure the global option &%dmarc_history_file%&
42772 Configure cron jobs to call the appropriate opendmarc history
42773 import scripts and truncating the dmarc_history_file
42776 In order to send forensic reports, you need to:
42778 Configure the global option &%dmarc_forensic_sender%&
42780 Configure, somewhere before the DATA ACL, the control option to
42781 enable sending DMARC forensic reports
42784 .subsection Example SSECDMARCEXAMPLE
42785 .cindex DMARC example
42790 warn domains = +local_domains
42791 hosts = +local_hosts
42792 control = dmarc_disable_verify
42794 warn !domains = +screwed_up_dmarc_records
42795 control = dmarc_enable_forensic
42797 warn condition = (lookup if destined to mailing list)
42798 set acl_m_mailing_list = 1
42801 warn dmarc_status = accept : none : off
42803 log_message = DMARC DEBUG: $dmarc_status $dmarc_used_domain
42805 warn dmarc_status = !accept
42807 log_message = DMARC DEBUG: '$dmarc_status' for $dmarc_used_domain
42809 warn dmarc_status = quarantine
42811 set $acl_m_quarantine = 1
42812 # Do something in a transport with this flag variable
42814 deny condition = ${if eq{$dmarc_domain_policy}{reject}}
42815 condition = ${if eq{$acl_m_mailing_list}{1}}
42816 message = Messages from $dmarc_used_domain break mailing lists
42818 deny dmarc_status = reject
42820 message = Message from $dmarc_used_domain failed sender's DMARC policy, REJECT
42822 warn add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
42829 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
42830 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
42832 .chapter "Proxies" "CHAPproxies" &&&
42834 .cindex "proxy support"
42835 .cindex "proxy" "access via"
42837 A proxy is an intermediate system through which communication is passed.
42838 Proxies may provide a security, availability or load-distribution function.
42841 .section "Inbound proxies" SECTproxyInbound
42842 .cindex proxy inbound
42843 .cindex proxy "server side"
42844 .cindex proxy "Proxy protocol"
42845 .cindex "Proxy protocol" proxy
42847 Exim has support for receiving inbound SMTP connections via a proxy
42848 that uses &"Proxy Protocol"& to speak to it.
42849 To include this support, include &"SUPPORT_PROXY=yes"&
42852 It was built on the HAProxy specification, found at
42853 &url(https://www.haproxy.org/download/1.8/doc/proxy-protocol.txt).
42855 The purpose of this facility is so that an application load balancer,
42856 such as HAProxy, can sit in front of several Exim servers
42857 to distribute load.
42858 Exim uses the local protocol communication with the proxy to obtain
42859 the remote SMTP system IP address and port information.
42860 There is no logging if a host passes or
42861 fails Proxy Protocol negotiation, but it can easily be determined and
42862 recorded in an ACL (example is below).
42864 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%hosts_proxy%&
42865 main configuration option to a hostlist; connections from these
42866 hosts will use Proxy Protocol.
42867 Exim supports both version 1 and version 2 of the Proxy Protocol and
42868 automatically determines which version is in use.
42870 The Proxy Protocol header is the first data received on a TCP connection
42871 and is inserted before any TLS-on-connect handshake from the client; Exim
42872 negotiates TLS between Exim-as-server and the remote client, not between
42873 Exim and the proxy server. The Proxy Protocol header must be received
42874 within &%proxy_protocol_timeout%&, which defaults to 3s.
42876 The following expansion variables are usable
42877 (&"internal"& and &"external"& here refer to the interfaces
42879 .itable none 0 0 2 30* left 70* left
42880 .irow $proxy_external_address "IP of host being proxied or IP of remote interface of proxy"
42881 .irow $proxy_external_port "Port of host being proxied or Port on remote interface of proxy"
42882 .irow $proxy_local_address "IP of proxy server inbound or IP of local interface of proxy"
42883 .irow $proxy_local_port "Port of proxy server inbound or Port on local interface of proxy"
42884 .irow $proxy_session "boolean: SMTP connection via proxy"
42886 If &$proxy_session$& is set but &$proxy_external_address$& is empty
42887 there was a protocol error.
42888 The variables &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&
42889 will have values for the actual client system, not the proxy.
42891 Since the real connections are all coming from the proxy, and the
42892 per host connection tracking is done before Proxy Protocol is
42893 evaluated, &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& must be set high enough to
42894 handle all of the parallel volume you expect per inbound proxy.
42895 With the option set so high, you lose the ability
42896 to protect your server from many connections from one IP.
42897 In order to prevent your server from overload, you
42898 need to add a per connection ratelimit to your connect ACL.
42899 A possible solution is:
42901 # Set max number of connections per host
42903 # Or do some kind of IP lookup in a flat file or database
42904 # LIMIT = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}iplsearch{/etc/exim/proxy_limits}}
42906 defer ratelimit = LIMIT / 5s / per_conn / strict
42907 message = Too many connections from this IP right now
42912 .section "Outbound proxies" SECTproxySOCKS
42913 .cindex proxy outbound
42914 .cindex proxy "client side"
42915 .cindex proxy SOCKS
42916 .cindex SOCKS proxy
42917 Exim has support for sending outbound SMTP via a proxy
42918 using a protocol called SOCKS5 (defined by RFC1928).
42919 The support can be optionally included by defining SUPPORT_SOCKS=yes in
42922 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%socks_proxy%& option
42923 on an smtp transport.
42924 The option value is expanded and should then be a list
42925 (colon-separated by default) of proxy specifiers.
42926 Each proxy specifier is a list
42927 (space-separated by default) where the initial element
42928 is an IP address and any subsequent elements are options.
42930 Options are a string <name>=<value>.
42931 The list of options is in the following table:
42932 .itable none 0 0 2 10* left 90* left
42933 .irow &'auth'& "authentication method"
42934 .irow &'name'& "authentication username"
42935 .irow &'pass'& "authentication password"
42936 .irow &'port'& "tcp port"
42937 .irow &'tmo'& "connection timeout"
42938 .irow &'pri'& "priority"
42939 .irow &'weight'& "selection bias"
42942 More details on each of these options follows:
42945 .cindex authentication "to proxy"
42946 .cindex proxy authentication
42947 &%auth%&: Either &"none"& (default) or &"name"&.
42948 Using &"name"& selects username/password authentication per RFC 1929
42949 for access to the proxy.
42950 Default is &"none"&.
42952 &%name%&: sets the username for the &"name"& authentication method.
42955 &%pass%&: sets the password for the &"name"& authentication method.
42958 &%port%&: the TCP port number to use for the connection to the proxy.
42961 &%tmo%&: sets a connection timeout in seconds for this proxy.
42964 &%pri%&: specifies a priority for the proxy within the list,
42965 higher values being tried first.
42966 The default priority is 1.
42968 &%weight%&: specifies a selection bias.
42969 Within a priority set servers are queried in a random fashion,
42970 weighted by this value.
42971 The default value for selection bias is 1.
42974 Proxies from the list are tried according to their priority
42975 and weight settings until one responds. The timeout for the
42976 overall connection applies to the set of proxied attempts.
42978 .section Logging SECTproxyLog
42979 To log the (local) IP of a proxy in the incoming or delivery logline,
42980 add &"+proxy"& to the &%log_selector%& option.
42981 This will add a component tagged with &"PRX="& to the line.
42983 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
42984 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
42986 .chapter "Internationalisation" "CHAPi18n" &&&
42987 "Internationalisation""
42988 .cindex internationalisation "email address"
42991 .cindex utf8 "mail name handling"
42993 Exim has support for Internationalised mail names.
42994 To include this it must be built with SUPPORT_I18N and the libidn library.
42995 Standards supported are RFCs 2060, 5890, 6530 and 6533.
42997 If Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N_2008 (in addition to SUPPORT_I18N, not
42998 instead of it) then IDNA2008 is supported; this adds an extra library
42999 requirement, upon libidn2.
43001 .section "MTA operations" SECTi18nMTA
43002 .cindex SMTPUTF8 "ESMTP option"
43003 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" SMTPUTF8
43004 The main configuration option &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& specifies
43005 a host list. If this matches the sending host and
43006 accept_8bitmime is true (the default) then the ESMTP option
43007 SMTPUTF8 will be advertised.
43009 If the sender specifies the SMTPUTF8 option on a MAIL command
43010 international handling for the message is enabled and
43011 the expansion variable &$message_smtputf8$& will have value TRUE.
43013 The option &%allow_utf8_domains%& is set to true for this
43014 message. All DNS lookups are converted to a-label form
43015 whatever the setting of &%allow_utf8_domains%&
43016 when Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N.
43018 Both localparts and domain are maintained as the original
43019 UTF-8 form internally; any comparison or regular-expression use will
43020 require appropriate care. Filenames created, eg. by
43021 the appendfile transport, will have UTF-8 names.
43023 HELO names sent by the smtp transport will have any UTF-8
43024 components expanded to a-label form,
43025 and any certificate name checks will be done using the a-label
43028 .cindex log protocol
43029 .cindex SMTPUTF8 logging
43030 .cindex i18n logging
43031 Log lines and Received-by: header lines will acquire a "utf8"
43032 prefix on the protocol element, eg. utf8esmtp.
43034 The following expansion operators can be used:
43036 ${utf8_domain_to_alabel:str}
43037 ${utf8_domain_from_alabel:str}
43038 ${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:str}
43039 ${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:str}
43042 .cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
43043 .cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
43045 may use the following modifier:
43047 control = utf8_downconvert
43048 control = utf8_downconvert/<value>
43050 This sets a flag requiring that envelope addresses are converted to
43051 a-label form before smtp delivery.
43052 This is usually for use in a Message Submission Agent context,
43053 but could be used for any message.
43055 If a value is appended it may be:
43056 .itable none 0 0 2 5* right 95* left
43057 .irow &`1`& "mandatory downconversion"
43058 .irow &`0`& "no downconversion"
43059 .irow &`-1`& "if SMTPUTF8 not supported by destination host"
43061 If no value is given, 1 is used.
43063 If mua_wrapper is set, the utf8_downconvert control
43064 is initially set to -1.
43066 The smtp transport has an option &%utf8_downconvert%&.
43067 If set it must expand to one of the three values described above,
43068 or an empty string.
43069 If non-empty it overrides value previously set
43070 (due to mua_wrapper or by an ACL control).
43073 There is no explicit support for VRFY and EXPN.
43074 Configurations supporting these should inspect
43075 &$smtp_command_argument$& for an SMTPUTF8 argument.
43077 There is no support for LMTP on Unix sockets.
43078 Using the "lmtp" protocol option on an smtp transport,
43079 for LMTP over TCP, should work as expected.
43081 There is no support for DSN unitext handling,
43082 and no provision for converting logging from or to UTF-8.
43086 .section "MDA operations" SECTi18nMDA
43087 To aid in constructing names suitable for IMAP folders
43088 the following expansion operator can be used:
43090 ${imapfolder {<string>} {<sep>} {<specials>}}
43093 The string is converted from the charset specified by
43094 the "headers charset" command (in a filter file)
43095 or &%headers_charset%& main configuration option (otherwise),
43097 modified UTF-7 encoding specified by RFC 2060,
43098 with the following exception: All occurrences of <sep>
43099 (which has to be a single character)
43100 are replaced with periods ("."), and all periods and slashes that are not
43101 <sep> and are not in the <specials> string are BASE64 encoded.
43103 The third argument can be omitted, defaulting to an empty string.
43104 The second argument can be omitted, defaulting to "/".
43106 This is the encoding used by Courier for Maildir names on disk, and followed
43107 by many other IMAP servers.
43111 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}} `& yields &`Foo.Bar`&
43112 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}{.}{/}} `& yields &`Foo&&AC8-Bar`&
43113 &`${imapfolder {Räksmörgås}} `& yields &`R&&AOQ-ksm&&APY-rg&&AOU-s`&
43116 Note that the source charset setting is vital, and also that characters
43117 must be representable in UTF-16.
43120 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43121 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43123 .chapter "Events" "CHAPevents" &&&
43127 The events mechanism in Exim can be used to intercept processing at a number
43128 of points. It was originally invented to give a way to do customised logging
43129 actions (for example, to a database) but can also be used to modify some
43130 processing actions.
43132 Most installations will never need to use Events.
43133 The support can be left out of a build by defining DISABLE_EVENT=yes
43134 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
43136 There are two major classes of events: main and transport.
43137 The main configuration option &%event_action%& controls reception events;
43138 a transport option &%event_action%& controls delivery events.
43140 Both options are a string which is expanded when the event fires.
43141 An example might look like:
43142 .cindex logging custom
43144 event_action = ${if eq {msg:delivery}{$event_name} \
43145 {${lookup pgsql {SELECT * FROM record_Delivery( \
43146 '${quote_pgsql:$sender_address_domain}',\
43147 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$sender_address_local_part}}', \
43148 '${quote_pgsql:$domain}', \
43149 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$local_part}}', \
43150 '${quote_pgsql:$host_address}', \
43151 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$host}}', \
43152 '${quote_pgsql:$message_exim_id}')}} \
43156 Events have names which correspond to the point in process at which they fire.
43157 The name is placed in the variable &$event_name$& and the event action
43158 expansion must check this, as it will be called for every possible event type.
43161 The current list of events is:
43162 .itable all 0 0 4 25* left 10* center 15* center 50* left
43163 .row auth:fail after both "per driver per authentication attempt"
43164 .row dane:fail after transport "per connection"
43165 .row dns:fail after both "per lookup"
43166 .row msg:complete after main "per message"
43167 .row msg:defer after transport "per message per delivery try"
43168 .row msg:delivery after transport "per recipient"
43169 .row msg:rcpt:host:defer after transport "per recipient per host"
43170 .row msg:rcpt:defer after transport "per recipient"
43171 .row msg:host:defer after transport "per host per delivery try; host errors"
43172 .row msg:fail:delivery after transport "per recipient"
43173 .row msg:fail:internal after main "per recipient"
43174 .row tcp:connect before transport "per connection"
43175 .row tcp:close after transport "per connection"
43176 .row tls:cert before both "per certificate in verification chain"
43177 .row tls:fail:connect after main "per connection"
43178 .row smtp:connect after transport "per connection"
43179 .row smtp:ehlo after transport "per connection"
43180 .row smtp:fail:protocol after main "per connection"
43181 .row smtp:fail:syntax after main "per connection"
43184 New event types may be added in future.
43186 The event name is a colon-separated list, defining the type of
43187 event in a tree of possibilities. It may be used as a list
43188 or just matched on as a whole. There will be no spaces in the name.
43190 The second column in the table above describes whether the event fires
43191 before or after the action is associates with. Those which fire before
43192 can be used to affect that action (more on this below).
43194 The third column in the table above says what section of the configuration
43195 should define the event action.
43197 An additional variable, &$event_data$&, is filled with information varying
43198 with the event type:
43200 .itable all 0 0 2 20* left 80* left
43201 .row auth:fail "smtp response"
43202 .row dane:fail "failure reason"
43203 .row dns:fail "failure reason, key and lookup-type"
43204 .row msg:defer "error string"
43205 .row msg:delivery "smtp confirmation message"
43206 .row msg:fail:internal "failure reason"
43207 .row msg:fail:delivery "smtp error message"
43208 .row msg:host:defer "error string"
43209 .row msg:rcpt:host:defer "error string"
43210 .row msg:rcpt:defer "error string"
43211 .row tls:cert "verification chain depth"
43212 .row tls:fail:connect "error string"
43213 .row smtp:connect "smtp banner"
43214 .row smtp:ehlo "smtp ehlo response"
43215 .row smtp:fail:protocol "error string"
43216 .row smtp:fail:syntax "error string"
43220 The :defer events populate one extra variable: &$event_defer_errno$&.
43222 For complex operations an ACL expansion can be used in &%event_action%&,
43223 however due to the multiple contexts that Exim operates in during
43224 the course of its processing:
43226 variables set in transport events will not be visible outside that
43229 acl_m variables in a server context are lost on a new connection,
43230 and after smtp helo/ehlo/mail/starttls/rset commands
43232 Using an ACL expansion with the logwrite modifier can be
43233 a useful way of writing to the main log.
43235 The expansion of the event_action option should normally
43236 return an empty string. Should it return anything else the
43237 following will be forced:
43238 .itable all 0 0 2 20* left 80* left
43239 .row auth:fail "log information to write"
43240 .row tcp:connect "do not connect"
43241 .row tls:cert "refuse verification"
43242 .row smtp:connect "close connection"
43244 All other message types ignore the result string, and
43245 no other use is made of it.
43247 For a tcp:connect event, if the connection is being made to a proxy
43248 then the &$host_address$& and &$host_port$& variables
43249 will be that of the proxy and not the target system.
43251 For tls:cert events, if GnuTLS is in use this will trigger only per
43252 chain element received on the connection.
43253 For OpenSSL it will trigger for every chain element including those
43256 For dns:fail events from dnsdb lookups, a &"defer_never"& option does not
43257 affect the reporting of DNS_AGAIN.
43259 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43260 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43262 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
43263 "Adding drivers or lookups"
43264 .cindex "adding drivers"
43265 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
43266 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
43267 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
43268 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
43271 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
43272 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
43274 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
43276 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
43278 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
43279 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
43280 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
43282 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
43284 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
43287 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
43288 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
43290 Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
43291 near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
43292 Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
43293 As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
43294 simple form that most lookups have.
43296 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
43297 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
43298 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
43300 Edit &_OS/Makefile-Base_& adding a &_.o_& file for the predefined-macros, to the
43301 definition of OBJ_MACRO. Add a set of line to do the compile also.
43303 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
43306 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
43307 as for other drivers and lookups.
43310 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
43311 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
43312 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
43313 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
43314 searched using a binary chop procedure.
43316 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
43317 the interface that is expected.
43322 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43323 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43325 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43326 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
43327 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
43328 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
43330 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43335 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
43336 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
43340 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
43341 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
43342 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
43345 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43346 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////